338 101 4MB
Russian Pages [642]
Technical Handbook
Alcatel 1660SM STM 16 Multiservice Metro Node
1660SM Rel. 4.4
3AL 91668 AAAA Ed.02
3AL 91668 AAAA Ed.02
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1660SM REL.4.4 TECHNICAL HANDBOOK
TABLE OF CONTENTS LIST OF FIGURES AND TABLES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7
HANDBOOK GUIDE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
15
1 HANDBOOK STRUCTURE AND CONFIGURATION CHECK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1 General information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 Handbook applicability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.3 Product-release handbooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.4 Handbook Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5 Handbook Configuration Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5.1 List of the editions and of modified parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5.2 Notes on Ed.01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5.3 Notes on Ed.02 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
17 17 17 18 24 25 25 25 25
2 COMPLIANCE WITH EUROPEAN NORMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1 Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2 Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
27 27 28
3 SAFETY NORMS AND LABELS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1 First aid for electric shock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 Safety Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2.1 General Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2.2 Labels Indicating Danger, Forbiddance, Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2.3 Dangerous Electrical Voltages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2.4 Harmful Optical Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2.5 Risks of Explosions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2.6 Moving Mechanical Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2.7 Heat–radiating Mechanical Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2.8 Specific safety rules in this handbook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
29 29 31 31 32 33 34 36 36 37 38
4 OTHER NORMS AND LABELS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1 Electromagnetic Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1.1 General Norms – Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1.2 General Norms – Turn–up & Commissioning, Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1.3 General Norms – Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 Electrostatic Dischargers (ESD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
39 39 39 40 40 41
02
050411
01
041021
ED
DATE
ECR 23080
CHANGE NOTE
J. MIR ITAVE S. MAGGIO – C. FAVERO J. MIR ITAVE S. MAGGIO – C. FAVERO
P. GHELFI ITAVE
APPRAISAL AUTHORITY
ORIGINATOR
P. GHELFI ITAVE
1660SM REL. 4.4 TECHNICAL HANDBOOK
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
1 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
42 42
5 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
53
6 GENERAL ON ALCATEL CUSTOMER DOCUMENTATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1 Products, product-releases, versions and Customer Documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2 Handbook supply to Customers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3 Aims of standard Customer Documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.4 Handbook Updating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.4.1 Changes introduced in the same product-release (same handbook P/N) . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.4.2 Changes due to new product version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.5 Customer documentation on CD–ROM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.5.1 Contents, creation and production of a CD–ROM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.5.2 Use of the CD–ROM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.5.3 CD–ROM identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.5.4 CD–ROM updating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
59 59 59 59 60 60 60 61 61 62 62 62
DESCRIPTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
63
1 GENERAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1 Introduction to the equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 Insertion of the equipment into the network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2.1 Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2.2 Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2.3 SDH / CWDM integration in “ring” network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2.4 SDH / CWDM integration in “linear” network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2.5 Network protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
65 65 73 73 74 77 81 83
2 PHYSICAL CONFIGURATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1 Equipment front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1.1 1660SM Shelf front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1.2 19” Fans subrack front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2 Part list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2.1 Equipment Shelf part list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2.2 Fans Subrack 19” part list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2.3 Explanatory notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3 Relationship between Port Card and Access Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4 Units front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4.1 Port cards front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4.2 Access cards front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4.3 FAN subrack cover front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
85 86 86 87 88 89 104 105 110 120 121 145 165
3 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1 General description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 Connections sub–system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3 SIGNAL MANAGEMENT SUB–SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3.1 Signal management referred to ”G.783 1994” . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3.2 SIGNAL MANAGEMENT referred to ”G. 783” . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.4 ISA (Integrated Service Adapter) introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 ISA – ATM management sub–system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5.1 ATM ( Asynchronous Transfer Mode) basic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5.2 ATM in1660SM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6 ISA – PR_EA (MPLS) sub–system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6.1 PR_EA (MPLS) generalities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
167 167 188 190 190 196 213 215 215 219 224 224
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
2 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
4.3 Suggestions, notes and cautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4 Labels affixed to the Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
231 235 235 236 253 253 255 262 264 270 270 273 282 289 290 292 293 296 298 304 306 308 310 311 323 325 327 332 336 339 342 351 353 355 358 359 367 370
4 UNIT DESCRIPTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1 21 x 2 Mbit/s access card (A21E1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 3 X 34 Mbit/s access card (A3E3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3 3 X 45 Mbit/s access card (A3T3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4 2 x 140/STM–1 O/E adapter (A2S1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.5 4 x STM–1 electrical access card (A4ES1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.6 High Speed protection access card (HPROT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.7 Ethernet access card (ETH–ATX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.8 Gigabit Ethernet access Card (GETH–AG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.9 Fast Ethernet Access Card (16 FEA–PR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.10 Fast Ethernet Access Card (2 GBA–PR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.11 Optical booster (BST10, BST15, BST17) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.12 Optical 2.5 Gbit/s Preamplifier (PR16) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.13 Electrical module (ICMI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.14 STM–1 optical modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
373 373 375 377 379 381 383 385 387 390 393 396 400 407 409
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.6.2 PR_EA (MPLS) service in 1660SM equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.7 ISA – PR Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.7.1 PR Generalities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.7.2 PR in 1660SM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8 ISA – ETHERNET management sub–system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8.1 Generalities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8.2 Main features description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8.3 Technical specification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8.4 Ethernet boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.9 ISA – ES (Ethernet Switch) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.9.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.9.2 ISA–ES series modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.10 4 x ANY HOST C subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.11 Coarse WDM sub–system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.11.1 Equipment facilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.11.2 Functional description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.11.3 “Ring” node functional scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.11.4 “Terminal” node functional scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.11.5 Optical span design . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.12 Controller sub–system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.12.1 Network management interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.12.2 ATM/IP/MPLS over SDH Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.13 Protection sub–system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.13.1 EPS Protections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.13.2 MS linear trail Protection (1+1 linear APS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.13.3 MS linear trail Protection (1:N linear dual–ended APS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.13.4 SNCP (Sub–Network Connection Protection) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.13.5 Drop & Continue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.13.6 Collapsed dual node ring interconnection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.13.7 Collapsed single node ring interconnection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.13.8 MS–SPRING protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.14 Synchronizing sub–system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.15 Auxiliary and DCC sub–system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.16 Power supply sub–system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.17 Remote inventory Sub–system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.18 Frames Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.18.1 Synchronous 2048 Kb/s frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.18.2 ATM cells mapping into SDH/PDH frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
3 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
STM–4 optical modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gigabit Ethernet optical modules (1000B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 x ANY plug–in modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 x 2 Mbit/s port card (P63E1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 x 2 Mbit/s / G703 / ISDN–PRA port card (P63E1N–M4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 x 34/45 Mbit/s port card (P3E3T3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 x STM–1 electrical/optical port card (P4S1N) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 X 140/STM1 switchable O/E port card (P4E4N) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 x STM–1 port (P4ES1N) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 x OC3 AU3/TU3 CONVERSION port (P4OC3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . STM–4 optical ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 x STM–4 optical port (P4S4N) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . STM–16 optical port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ISA – ATM MATRIX 4X4 (ATM4X4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ISA – ATM MATRIX 4X4 ENHANCED (ATM4X4D3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ISA – ATM MATRIX 4X4 ENHANCED (ATM4X4V2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ISA – ATM MATRIX 8X8 (ATM8X8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ISA–Packet Ring Edge Aggregator Unit (PREA1GBE, PREA4ETH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ISA – Packet Ring unit (ISA–PR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ISA – Ethernet/Fast Ethernet port (ETH–MB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ISA –Giga Ethernet Main Board (GETH–MB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ISA– Ethernet switch (ES1–8FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ISA– Ethernet switch (ES1–8FX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ISA– Ethernet switch (ES4–8FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ISA ES–16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 X ANY HOST C card (4XANYC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COADM1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COADM2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COMDX8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2xCH Transponder SFP without optics (COWLA2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EQUICO card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Matrix card (MATRIXN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CONGI card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SERVICE card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FAN UNIT FOR FAN SHELF 19” . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
410 411 412 413 416 421 424 429 436 441 449 454 459 465 472 472 478 485 492 496 500 504 508 508 513 518 523 525 527 529 534 537 541 546 552
5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1 General characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1.1 Optical Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1.2 Electrical Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2 Electrical interface characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.1 21 X 2 Mbit/s 75 Ohm electrical characteristics (A21E1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.2 21 X 2 Mbit/s 120 Ohm electrical characteristics (A21E1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.3 21 X 2 Mbit/s 120 Ohm K20 electrical characteristics (A21E1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.4 3 X 34 Mbit/s electrical characteristics (A3E3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.5 3 X 45 Mbit/s electrical characteristics (A3T3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.6 STM–1 electrical characteristics (A4 ES1 and ICMI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.7 140 Mbit/s electrical characteristics (ICMI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.8 Engineering Order Wire characteristics (SERVICE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.9 AUX channels characteristics (SERVICE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3 ATM interface characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3.1 ATM matrix 4x4 switching capability (ATM4X4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3.2 ATM matrix 4x4V2 switching capability (ATM4X4V2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3.3 ATM matrix 4x4 D3 switching capability (ATM4X4D3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
557 557 561 565 566 566 566 566 566 567 567 567 568 568 570 570 571 572
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
4 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
4.15 4.16 4.17 4.18 4.19 4.20 4.21 4.22 4.23 4.24 4.25 4.26 4.27 4.28 4.29 4.30 4.31 4.32 4.33 4.34 4.35 4.36 4.37 4.38 4.39 4.40 4.41 4.42 4.43 4.44 4.45 4.46 4.47 4.48 4.49
573 574 575 575 575 576 577 577 577 578 579 580 581 582 583 583 584 585 586 587 588 589 590 602 603 603 604 605 606 606 608 608 611 612 612 614 616 618
MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
619
6 MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1 General safety rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2 General rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3 Maintenance Aspects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.4 Instruments And Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.5 Routine Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.5.1 Routine maintenance every three months . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.5.2 Routine maintenance every year . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.5.3 Routine Maintenance every five year . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 Corrective Maintenance (Trouble/Shooting) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6.1 Fan unit for fan shelf 19”substitution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7 Set of spare parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.1 Suggested Spare Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
621 621 622 622 622 623 623 624 625 625 625 626 626
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.3.4 ATM matrix 8x8 switching capability (ATM8X8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 PR_EA characteristics and MPLS data traffic management (PREA4ETH, PREA1GBE) 5.5 PR characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.5.1 ISA–PR port card interface characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.5.2 16FEA–PR access card interface characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.5.3 2GBA–PR access card interface characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.6 ETHERNET characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.6.1 Ethernet 10/100Base–T interface characteristics (ETH–MB + ETH–ATX) . . . . . . . . . . . 5.6.2 Ethernet switch port card characteristics (ES1–8FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.6.3 Ethernet switch port card characteristics (ES1–8FX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.6.4 Ethernet switch port card characteristics (ES4–8FE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.6.5 Ethernet switch port card characteristics (ISA ES–16) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.6.6 Access Card Gigabit Ethernet interfaces characteristics (GETH–AG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.6.7 Gigabit Ethernet ports card interfaces (GETH–MB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7 4 x ANY clients characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7.1 Gigabit Ethernet LX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7.2 Gigabit Ethernet SX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7.3 Fiber Channel 100–SM–LL–I . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7.4 Fiber Channel 100–M5–SL–I . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7.5 Fast Ethernet (100BASE FX)/FDDI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7.6 ESCON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7.7 Digital Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.8 Optical interface characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.8.1 Example of a link using 1660SM with L–16.2 JE2 Port and 15 dBm Booster . . . . . . . . 5.9 Coarse WDM subsystem units characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9.1 COADM–1 Channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9.2 COADM–2 Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9.3 MUX/DEMUX 8 Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9.4 2 Channels TRANSPONDER SFP without optical modulle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9.5 CWDM optical PLUGIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.10 Power Supply characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.11 Alarm Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.12 Mechanical characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.13 Environmental conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.13.1 Climatic for operating conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.13.2 Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.13.3 Transportation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.13.4 EMI/EMC condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
5 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
626 626 626
HARDWARE SETTING DOCUMENTATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
629
UNITS DOCUMENTATION LIST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
631
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
6 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
6.7.2 General rules on spare parts management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.3 Particular rules on spare parts management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.8 Repair Form . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
LIST OF FIGURES AND TABLES FIGURES Figure 1. Subrack label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 2. Subrack label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 3. Subrack label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 4. Labels on units with standard cover plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 5. Modules label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 6. Internal label for Printed Board Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 7. Back panels internal label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 8. Label specifying item not on catalogue (P/N. and serial number) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 9. Label specifying item on catalogue (P/N. and serial number) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 10. Item identification labels – item on catalog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 11. Label identifying the equipment (example) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 12. Example of SDH/DATA/CWDM integration in “metro area” . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 13. Example of ATM Transport management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 14. ISA–PR Deployment Scenario . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 15. Ethernet service application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 16. Terminal multiplexer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 17. Add/Drop Multiplexer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 18. ”HUB” STM–1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 19. Point–to–point links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 20. Linear drop–insert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 21. Ring structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 22. Meshed topology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 23. SDH/CWDM integration in “ring” with COADM units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 24. SDH/CWDM integration in “ring” with COADM unit: detailed view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 25. SDH/CWDM integration in “ring” with MUX/DEMUX unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 26. SDH/CWDM integration in “ring” with MUX/DEMUX unit: detailed view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 27. SDH/CWDM integration in “linear” network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 28. SDH/CWDM integration in “linear” network (MUX/DEMUX): detailed view . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 29. SDH/CWDM integration in “linear” network (COADM unit): detailed view . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 30. 1660SM units positioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 31. 19” Fans subrack unit slots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 32. PDH, SDH electrical ports front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 33. 4 x STM–1, 4 x OC3 port : front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 34. STM–4 optical port front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 35. 4 x STM–4 port card – front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 36. STM–16 optical front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 37. I–16 PORT SFF (intra–office) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 38. STM–16 SFP port optical front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 39. ATM 4X4, ATM 4X4V2 and ATM4X4D3 cards – front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 40. ATM 8X8 card – front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 41. ISA – Ethernet port front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 42. ISA– Gigabit ETHERNET board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 43. ISA – ES4–8FE port front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 44. ISA – ES1–8FE port front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 45. ISA ES–8FX front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 46. ISA ES–16 front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 47. ISA– PRE_EA Matrix 4x Ethernet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 48. ISA– PRE_EA Matrix 1 x GB–ETH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 49. ISA– PR Matrix 4x4STM4 PLUG–IN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 50. COWLA2 front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ED
43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 50 51 51 69 70 71 72 73 73 74 74 75 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 81 82 86 87 121 122 123 124 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 132 133 134 135 136 137 138 139
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
7 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
140 141 142 143 144 145 146 147 148 149 150 151 152 153 154 155 156 157 158 159 160 161 162 163 164 165 167 168 168 178 179 180 181 182 183 184 185 186 187 189 193 194 195 206 208 210 212 214 215 216 217 218 222 223
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
8 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Figure 51. 4xANY Host C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 52. Matrix card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 53. Equipment controller EQUICO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 54. Control and General interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 55. SERVICE interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 56. 21 x 2 Mbit/s 75 ohm access card 1.0/2.3 connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 57. 21 X 2 Mbit/s 120 Ohm access card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 58. 3 X 34 Mbit/s 75 ohm access card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 59. 3 X 45 Mbit/s 75 ohm access card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 60. 4 X STM–1 access card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 61. High Speed protection – front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 62. 2 x 140/STM–1 O/E adapter (access card)– front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 63. ISA – Ethernet access front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 64. ISA – Gigabit Ethernet access card front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 65. ISA PR 2XGBE 1000 access card front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 66. ISA PR16XETH 10/100 access card front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 67. COADM1 front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 68. COADM2 front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 69. COMDX8 front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 70. STM–1/STM–4 optical module front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 71. STM–1 or 140 Mbit/s electrical module front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 72. Relationship between SFP modules and housing boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 73. 4XANY plug–in module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 74. Optical Booster card front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 75. PREAMPLIFIER 2.5 GB/S front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 76. 19” Fans subrack cover front view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 77. LOI block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 78. HOI block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 79. TTF and HOA block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 80. 1660SM Block diagram – (SDH and PDH boards) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 81. 1660SM Block diagram – (SDH and PDH boards) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 82. 1660SM Block diagram – (SONET and 4xANY HOSTC boards) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 83. 1660SM Block diagram – (CWDM boards) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 84. 1660SM Block diagram – (CWDM boards) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 85. 1660SM Block diagram – ( Common units and ISA boards) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 86. 1660SM Block diagram – (ISA boards) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 87. 1660SM Block diagram – (ISA – ES boards) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 88. 1660SM Block diagram – (ISA – ETHERNET boards) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 89. 1660SM Block diagram – (ISA–PR board) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 90. High Order/Low Order connections for 1660SM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 91. SDH signal management block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 92. 2Mbit/s, 34 Mbit/s, 45 Mbit/s signal management block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 93. 140Mbit/s signal management block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 94. 1660SM Block Diagram: signal management (SDH port) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 95. 1660SM Block Diagram: signal management ( 2Mbit/s PDH ports) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 96. 1660SM Block Diagram: signal management ( 34 Mbit/s and 45 Mbit/s PDH ports) . . Figure 97. 1660SM Block Diagram: signal management ( 140 Mbit/s PDH ports) . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 98. Example of technology convergency with ISA boards in OMSN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 99. Relationship between the VC, the VP and the TP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 100. Basic format of an ATM cell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 101. ATM network interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 102. UNI and NNI ATM cell header and payload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 103. 1660SM with ATM Matrix architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 104. Leased line service versus Data transport service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Figure 105. MPLS subsystem, protocol stacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 106. Framing for MPLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 107. MPLS label format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 108. PPP frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 109. HDLC frame with PPP encapsulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 110. Ethernet MAC 802.3 frame format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 111. Ethernet “Tagged” MAC 802.3 frame format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 112. Ethernet frame format for “MPLS over Ethernet” . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 113. MPLS Tunnelling Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 114. Generic MPLS aggregation scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 115. MPLS subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 116. ISA–PR Sub–System Architecture (Overlay Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 117. ISA–PR Sub–System Architecture (Independent Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 118. Traffic flow and processing in 1660 SM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 119. ISA–PR Policing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 120. ISA–PR Traffic Management Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 121. Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 122. Bottlenecks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 123. RPR protection mechanism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 124. Packet protection (and QoS assurance) in multiring network : MPLS over RPR . . . . . Figure 125. Customer Edge Dual Homing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 126. Relationship with other ISA Cards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 127. Example of an Ethernet stream transport through a SDH network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 128. LAN to LAN service block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 129. GFP frame format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 130. GFP encapsulation of the MAC frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 131. Flow control mechanism: input control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 132. Flow control mechanism: output control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 133. Flow control mechanism: External control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 134. Messages dispatching via Virtual Concatenation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 135. Messages dispatching via Packet Concatenation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 136. Board Ethernet 10/100: System architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 137. Example of Ethernet service application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 138. Gigabit Ethernet System architecture: Gigabit access with Fast Ethernet board . . . . . Figure 139. Gigabit Ethernet System architecture:Gigabit Ethernet main board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 140. Ethernet Private Line service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 141. Ethernet Virtual Private Line service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 142. Ethernet Virtual LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 143. Broadband Access service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 144. ISA–ES access port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 145. Traffic flow and processing in ISA–ES series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 146. ISA–ES series ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 147. ISA–ES series traffic parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 148. WRED Congestion avoidance mechanisms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 149. ISA–ES series operational modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 150. Ethernet Multiplexing Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 151. Multiple customers on a single NNI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 152. 4xANY HOST–C: Client allocation grid in “enhanced” slot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 153. 4xANY HOST–C: module configuration in “enhanced” slot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 154. Client allocation grid in “HS slots” with GE/FC/FICON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 155. Client allocation grid in “HS slots” with FE/FDDI/ESCON/DV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 156. module configuration in “HS” slots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 157. COADM functionality: example of equipment shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 158. MUX/DEMUX functionality: example of shelf equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ED
225 226 227 227 227 228 228 228 229 230 234 237 237 240 243 245 247 248 249 250 251 252 253 254 256 258 259 260 261 261 262 265 266 268 269 270 271 271 272 274 275 275 277 279 280 280 281 284 284 286 287 287 290 291
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
9 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
292 293 293 294 295 296 297 299 301 301 302 305 307 307 308 309 312 313 315 317 318 320 321 324 324 326 328 329 331 333 333 334 335 335 337 338 338 339 340 341 342 344 344 345 345 346 348 349 350 352 354 357 358 359
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
10 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Figure 159. 1660SM signal flow diagram with WDM application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 160. 1660SM (WDM application) ’ring’ node functional scheme (1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 161. 1660SM (WDM application) ’ring’ node functional scheme (2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 162. 1660SM (WDM application) ’ring’ node functional scheme (3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 163. 1660SM (WDM application) ’ring’ node functional scheme (4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 164. 1660SM (WDM application)’end’ node functional scheme (Mux/Demux) . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 165. 1660SM (WDM application) ’end’ node functional scheme (COADM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 166. Passive optical operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 167. COMDX8 insertion loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 168. COADM2 insertion loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 169. COADM1 insertion loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 170. 1660SM Control Sub–system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 171. 1660SM general management architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 172. Connection Mode for TMN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 173. Protocol stack for SDH/ATM management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 174. Example of management of a network with SDH and ATM/IP/MPLS traffic . . . . . . . . . Figure 175. Low Speed Link Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 176. Example of EPS protection schemes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 177. High Speed connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 178. Examples of ATM MATRIX EPS protection scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 179. Messages exchanged between the EC and the ISA–ATM boards in EPS group . . . . . Figure 180. Examples of MPLS (PR_EA..) boards protection scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 181. Messages exchanged between EC and ISA–PR_EA Matrix... boards in EPS group . Figure 182. Linear 1+1 single ended protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 183. Linear 1+1 dual ended protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 184. MSP Linear 1:N Dual–Ended protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 185. Typical ring network with SNCP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 186. Failure examples in SNCP ring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 187. SNCP example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 188. Drop and Continue D/C A INS A (called “Normal” on C.T.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 189. Drop and Continue D/C A INS B (called “Inverse” on C.T.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 190. Drop and Continue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 191. Drop and Continue – 1st failure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 192. Drop and Continue – 2nd failure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 193. Collapsed dual node interconnection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 194. Collapsed dual node interconnection – 1st failure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 195. Collapsed dual node interconnection – 2nd failure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 196. Collapsed single node ring interconnection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 197. Collapsed single node ring interconnection –1st failure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 198. Collapsed single node ring interconnection –2nd failure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 199. 2F MS SPRING Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 200. Effect of a BRIDGE “B side” operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 201. Effect of a BRIDGE “A side” operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 202. Effect of SWITCH “B side” operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 203. Effect of SWITCH “A side” operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 204. Line break recovering operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 205. 2F MS–SPRING example of operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 206. Squelching on isolated Node connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 207. MS SPRING Drop and Continue, Insert Continues (protected) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 208. Synchronization function : block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 209. AUX and DCC management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 210. 1660SM –Input power stage and distributed power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 211. Remote Inventory sub–system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 212. 1660SM: SDH multiplexing structure and AU–3/TU–3 conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Figure 213. VC–12 Structure (asynchronous mapping of 2048 Kbit/s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 214. TU–12 Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 215. VC–3 structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 216. TU–3 structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 217. VC–4 Structure and POH byte contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 218. STM–1 structure and SOH byte contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 219. STM–4 structure and SOH byte contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 220. Structure of STM–16 and SOH bytes contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 221. Synchronous 2048 Kb/s signal: basic frame overhead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 222. Synchronous 2048 Kb/s signal: CRC–4 multiframe overhead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 223. Mapping of ATM cells into VC12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 224. Mapping of ATM cells into VC4/VC3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 225. Mapping of ATM cells into 2048 kb/s frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 226. Mapping of ATM cells into 34368 kb/s frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 227. 21 x 2 access card – Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 228. 3 x 34 access card block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 229. 3 x 45 access card block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 230. 2 x 140/STM–1 O/E adapter (access card) block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 231. 4 x STM–1 access card block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 232. HPROT access card block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 233. Ethernet Access –Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 234. Gigabit Ethernet Access card –Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 235. 16FEA–PR Card Functional Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 236. 2GBA–PR Card Functional Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 237. BSTxx – optical block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 238. BSTxx – card block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 239. PR16 optical path and control signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 240. PR16 card block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 241. STM–1 Electrical module –block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 242. STM–1 Optical module – block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 243. STM–4 optical module block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 244. Gigabit Ethernet optical module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 245. 63 x 2 Mbit/s card – Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 246. 63 x 2 Mbit/s G.703/ISDN–PRA, Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 247. Functional Diagram of the NT ISDN–PRA block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 248. 3x34/45 port card –Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 249. 4 x STM–1 Electrical/Optical port block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 250. 4 x 140/STM–1 Electrical / Optical port block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 251. Mapper /Demapper 140–PDH / 155–STM1 block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 252. 4 x STM–1 Electrical port block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 253. 4 x OC3 AU3/TU3 conversion port(P40C3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 254. AU3/TU3 conversion block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 255. STM–4 –block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 256. 4xSTM–4 optical port block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 257. STM–16 optical port block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 258. ATM 4X4 card – Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 259. ATM4X4V2 and ATM4X4D3 card – Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 260. ATM 8X8 card – Block diagram part A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 261. ATM 8X8 card – Block diagram part B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 262. MPLS+4FE Unit (PREA4ETH) – Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 263. MPLS+1GbE Unit (PREA1GBE) – Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 264. PR unit functional block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 265. ETHERNET port (ETH–MB) – Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 266. Gigabit Ethernet Unit – Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ED
360 361 362 362 363 364 365 366 367 368 370 370 371 371 374 376 378 380 382 384 386 389 390 393 396 399 405 406 408 409 410 411 415 419 420 423 428 434 435 440 447 448 453 458 464 471 477 483 484 490 491 492 499 503
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
11 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
507 512 517 522 524 526 528 533 536 540 545 551 554 555 613 615 627
TABLES Table 1. Handbooks related to the specific product hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Table 2. Handbooks related to the METRO OMSN specific product SW management and local product control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Table 3. Handbooks related to ATM specific product SW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Table 4. Handbooks related to PR_EA specific product SW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Table 5. Handbooks related to PR specific product SW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Table 6. Handbooks related to ISA ES specific product SW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Table 7. Handbooks common to Alcatel Network Elements using 1320CT platform . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Table 8. Optional handbooks common to 16xxSM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Table 9. Documentation on CD–ROM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Table 10. Handbook configuration check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Table 11. IEC 950 –Table 16: Overtemperature limits, Part 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Table 12. Label references . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Table 13. List of Abbreviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Table 14. Network application versus configuration modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Table 15. Main part list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Table 16. Accessories list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Table 17. Fans Subrack 19” part list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 Table 18. Explanatory notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Table 19. Relationship between P63E1, P63E1N–M4 (63 X 2 Mbit/s unit) port card and A21E1 access card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Table 20. Relationship between P3E3T3 (3X34/45 Mbit/s Switchable unit) port card and A3E3 access card (3X34 Mbit/s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Table 21. Relationship between P3E3T3 (3X34/45 Mbit/s Switchable unit) port card and A3T3 access card (3X45 Mbit/s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Table 22. Relationship between P4S1N, P4E4N, P4OC3 port card and A2S1 access card . . . . 113 Table 23. Relationship between P4ES1N (4xSTM–1 Electrical) port card and A4ES1 access card. 114 Table 24. Relationship between ETH–MB (11x10/100 Mb/s Ethernet) port card and ETH–ATX access card. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Table 25. Relationship between ETH–MB (10/100Mb) port card and GETH–AG (1.25 Gb/s) access card. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Table 26. Relationship between ISA ES–16 port card and and ETH–ATX access card. . . . . . . . . . 117 Table 27. Relationship between ISA ES–16 port card and and GETH–AG access card. . . . . . . . . . 118 Table 28. Relationship between ISA–PR port card and 16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR access cards. . . 119 Table 29. Interfaces acceding to the MPLS functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
12 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Figure 267. ISA ES1–8FE block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 268. ISA ES4–8FE block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 269. ISA ES16 unit block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 270. 4 x ANY HOST C card block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 271. COADM1 unit block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 272. COADM2 block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 273. MUX/DEMUX8 (COMDX8) block diagram and LOS detection in ’passive’ boards . . . Figure 274. 2xCH Transponder SFP Without optics COWLA2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 275. 1660SM EQUICO Card Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 276. MATRIX card block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 277. CONGI – Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 278. SERVICE block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 279. Fans shelf 19” general block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 280. Fans unit for fan shelf 19” block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 281. Climatogram for Class 3.2 : Partly temperature controlled locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 282. Climatogram for Class 1.2: not temperature controlled storage location . . . . . . . . . . . . Figure 283. Repair form . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 30. Sub–systems & involved cards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 Table 31. High Order/Low Order connections for 1660SM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 Table 32. ATM transport network layered model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 Table 33. ATM traffic contracts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 Table 34. MPLS layer stack over SDH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 Table 35. MPLS layer stack over ETHERNET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 Table 36. Interfaces acceding to the MPLS functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Table 37. Relationship between 4xANY optical modules and client type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 Table 38. 4xANY HOST C client type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 Table 39. Modules configuration in “Enhanced HS” slot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285 Table 40. Modules configuration in “HS” slot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 Table 41. CWDM channels grid supported by 1660SM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298 Table 42. Boards insertion loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300 Table 43. Fiber technical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302 Table 44. Optical transceiver characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 Table 45. MSP protection schemes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323 Table 46. Example of SNCP protected groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 Table 47. 16FEA–PR card LEDs designation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392 Table 48. 16FEA–PR interface LED designation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392 Table 49. 2GBA–PR card LED designation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395 Table 50. 2GBA–PR interface LED designation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395 Table 51. PR unit LED designation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494 Table 52. CONGI A and CONGI B interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541 Table 53. Remote alarm provided by the AND/OR block available on CONGI in slot 10 . . . . . . . . . 542 Table 54. Remote alarm provided by the AND/OR block available on CONGI in slot 12 . . . . . . . . . 543 Table 55. Rack lamps signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543 Table 56. L1, L2 LEDs status for selective call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547 Table 57. L1, L2 LEDs status for omnibus call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547 Table 58. Hazard level classification of different optical interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561 Table 59. ATM4X4 board: configurable TPs type and max, number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 570 Table 60. ATM4X4V2 board: configurable TPs type and max, number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 571 Table 61. ATM4X4D3 board: configurable TPs type and max, number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572 Table 62. ATM8X8 board: configurable TPs type and max, number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 573 Table 63. Parameters specified for STM–1 Optical Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 591 Table 64. Parameters specified for STM–4 Optical Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 593 Table 65. Parameters specified for SFP STM–4 Optical Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 594 Table 66. STM–16 Optical interfaces (Single Channel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 595 Table 67. STM–16 Optical interfaces (Multi Channel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 597 Table 68. Parameters specified for 1000B–SX Optical Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 598 Table 69. Parameters specified for 1000B–LX Optical Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 599 Table 70. Parameters specified for 1000B–ZX Optical Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600 Table 71. Parameters specified for Optical Booster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 601 Table 72. Relation between Alarm severity terminology displayed on C.T./O.S. and alarm severity terminology used for the EQUICO leds and CONGI remote alarm connector pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 609 Table 73. Transportation climatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 617 Table 74. Example of correspondence between CS and ’suffix + ICS’ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 631 Table 75. Hardware presetting documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 634
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
13 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
14 / 636 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
HANDBOOK GUIDE
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
15 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
16 / 636 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1 HANDBOOK STRUCTURE AND CONFIGURATION CHECK 1.1 General information WARNING ALCATEL makes no warranty of any kind with regards to this manual, and specifically disclaims the implied warranties of merchantability and fitness for a particular purpose. ALCATEL will not be liable for errors contained herein or for damages, whether direct, indirect, consequential, incidental, or special, in connection with the furnishing, performance, or use of this material. NOTICE The product specification and/or performance levels contained in this document are for information purposes only and are subject to change without notice. They do not represent any obligation on the part of ALCATEL. COPYRIGHT NOTIFICATION The technical information of this manual is the property of ALCATEL and must not be copied, reproduced or disclosed to a third party without written consent.
1.2 Handbook applicability
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
This handbook applies to the following product-releases:
ED
PRODUCT
ANV P/N
FACTORY P/N
1660SM
3AL 36301 AAAA
521.203.300
ANV P/N
FACTORY P/N
3AL 81025 ADAA
––.––.––
PRODUCT
RELEASE
1660SM
4.4
VERSION
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
17 / 636
The list of handbooks given here below is valid on the issue date of this Handbook and can be changed without any obligation for ALCATEL to update it in this Handbook. Some of the handbooks listed here below may not be available on the issue date of this Handbook. The standard Customer Documentation in the English language for the equipment whose product-release-version is stated in para.1.2 on page 17 consists of the following handbooks: Table 1. Handbooks related to the specific product hardware
REF
HANDBOOK
1660SM Rel.4.4 Technical Handbook
ANV Part No.
THIS HDBK
3AL 91668 AAAA
[1] Provide information regarding Equipment description, Maintenance , Hardware setting documentation 1660SM Rel.4.4 Installation Handbook
3AL 91668 BAAA
[2] Provide information regarding Equipment Installation, according to A–Installation Engineering Department rules. 1660SM Rel.4.4 Turnup & Commissionig Handbook
3AL 91668 CAAA
[3]
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Provide information regarding Equipment Turn–On, Test and Operation, according to A–Installation Engineering Department rules.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
18 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1.3 Product-release handbooks
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 2. Handbooks related to the METRO OMSN specific product SW management and local product control
REF
HANDBOOK
ANV Part No.
Metro OMSN Rel.4.4/5.2 CT Operator’s Handbook
THIS HDBK or note
3AL 91670 AAAA
[4] Provides Metro OMSN (1640FOX, 1650SMC, 1660SM) “SDH” Craft Terminal screens and operational procedures Table 3. Handbooks related to ATM specific product SW
HANDBOOK
REF
ANV Part No.
[5]
ATM Rel.1.2 Operator’s Handbook
3AL 80814 AAAA
[6]
ATM Rel.2.0 Operator’s Handbook
3AL 81826 AAAA
[7]
ATM Rel.2.1 Operator’s Handbook
3AL 89777 AAAA
[8]
ATM Rel.2.2 Operator’s Handbook
3AL 91714 AAAA
THIS HDBK or note
Provides ATM Craft Terminal screens and operational procedures
Table 4. Handbooks related to PR_EA specific product SW
REF
HANDBOOK
ANV Part No.
PR_EA Rel.1.1 Operator’s Handbook
[9]
THIS HDBK or note
3AL 81062 BAAA
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Provides PR_EA Terminal screens and operational procedures
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
19 / 636
REF
HANDBOOK
ANV Part No.
[10]
PR Rel.1.0 Operator’s Handbook
3AL 81771 AAAA
[11]
PR Rel.1.1 Operator’s Handbook
3AL 91658 AAAA
[12]
PR Rel.1.2 Operator’s Handbook
3AL 91715 AAAA
THIS HDBK or note
Provides PR Craft Terminal screens and operational procedures
Table 6. Handbooks related to ISA ES specific product SW
REF
HANDBOOK
ANV Part No.
[13]
ES1 Rel.1.0 Operator’s Handbook
3AL 89872 AAAA
[14]
ES1/ES4 Rel.1.1 Operator’s Handbook
3AL 89871 AAAA
[15]
ES1/ES4 Rel.1.2 Operator’s Handbook
3AL91804 AAAA
[16]
ES16 Rel.2.0 Operator’s Handbook
3AL 89870 AAAA
[17]
ES16 Rel.2.1 Operator’s Handbook
3AL 91716 AAAA
THIS HDBK or note
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Provides ISA–ES Craft Terminal screens and operational procedures
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
20 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 5. Handbooks related to PR specific product SW
Table 7. Handbooks common to Alcatel Network Elements using 1320CT platform
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
REF
ANV Part No.
FACTORY Part No.
3AL 79551 AAAA
957.140.042 N
HANDBOOK
1320CT 3.x Basic Operator’s Handbook
THIS HDBK
[18] Provides general information and operational procedures common to all 1320CT (Craft terminal) of Alcatel InfoModel Network Elements. 1330AS Rel.6.5 Operator’s Handbook
3AL 88876 AAAA
––––––––
Provides detailed information and operational procedures regarding the alarm Surveillance software embedded in the 1320CT software package. Information about Historical Alarms an Network Element Symbols Management ( Physical Network Management) are not valid for Craft Terminal. They are only used by Network Management.
[19]
ELB Rel.2.x Operator’s Handbook [20]
3AL 88877 AAAA
––––––––
Provide detailed information and operational procedures regarding the Event Log Browser software embedded in the 1320CT software package.
Table 8. Optional handbooks common to 16xxSM REF
HANDBOOK S9–16xxSM System Installation Handbook
ANV Part No.
FACTORY Part No.
3AL 78901 AAAA
955.100.692 N
THIS HDBK
[21] Provides general installation rules necessary to install the Optinex family equipment in the S9 Rack. Optinex RACK–16xxSM System Installation Handbook
3AL 38207 AAAA
955.110.202 L
[22] Provides general installation rules necessary to install the Optinex family equipment in the Optinex Rack.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
N.B.
ED
Handbooks REF. [21] and [22] are available only on paper support
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
21 / 636
Table 9. Documentation on CD–ROM
REF
CD–ROM TITLE METRO OMSN Rel.4.4/5.2 CD–ROM–DOC EN
[23]
ANV Part No.
FACTORY Part No.
3AL 91671 AAAA
––.––.––
Contains, in electronic format, the following handbooks: REF. [1] to [4] 1320CT 3.x BASIC CD–ROM–DOC EN
3AL 79552 AAAA
417.100.032
[24] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbooks: REF. [18] to [20] ATM 1.2 CD–ROM–DOC EN
3AL 80815 AAAA
––.––.––
[25] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbooks: REF. [5] ATM 2.0 CD–ROM–DOC EN
3AL 81829 AAAA
––.––.––
[26] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbook: REF. [6] ATM 2.1 CD–ROM–DOC EN
3AL 89778 AAAA
––.––.––
[27] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbooks: REF. [7] ATM 2.2 CD–ROM–DOC EN
3AL 91717 AAAA
––.––.––
[28] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbooks: REF. [8] PR_EA 1.1 CD–ROM–DOC EN
3AL 81063 BAAA
––.––.––
[29] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbook: REF. [9] PR 1.0 CD–ROM–DOC EN
3AL 81769 AAAA
––.––.––
[30] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbook: REF. [10] PR 1.1 CD–ROM–DOC EN
3AL 91659 AAAA
––.––.––
[31] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbooks: REF. [11] PR 1.2 CD–ROM–DOC EN
3AL 91718 AAAA
––.––.––
[32] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbooks: REF. [12] ES1 1.0 CD–ROM–DOC EN
3AL 89875 AAAA
––.––.––
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
[33] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbooks: REF. [13]
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
22 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
See para. 6.5 on page 61
REF
CD–ROM TITLE
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ES1/ES4 1.1 CD–ROM–DOC EN
ANV Part No.
FACTORY Part No.
3AL 89874 AAAA
––.––.––
[34] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbooks: REF. [14] ES1/ES4 1.2 CD–ROM–DOC EN
3AL91805 AAAA
––.––.––
[35] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbooks: REF. [15] ES16 2.0 CD–ROM–DOC EN
3AL 89873 AAAA
––.––.––
[36] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbooks: REF. [16] ES16 2.1 CD–ROM–DOC EN
3AL 91719 AAAA
––.––.––
[37] Contains, in electronic format, the following handbooks: REF. [17]
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
23 / 636
This handbook has been edited according to the Alcatel standardized “drawing–up guides” complying with such suggestion. This handbook is divided into the following main topics as described in the table of contents: HANDBOOK GUIDE:
It contains general information on safety norms, EMC and type of labels that might be affixed to the equipment. Furthermore, it describes the handbook structure and the customer documentation. The abbreviation list is supplied too.
DESCRIPTION:
It contains all the equipment’s general and detailed system features including its application in the telecommunication network. Furthermore, it supplies the equipment description and specifications (i.e., system, mechanical,electrical and/or optical).
MAINTENANCE:
It contains all the details for periodic checks, fault location and repair procedures and restore to normal operation through the withdrawal of faulty units and their replacement with spares (*)
APPENDICES:
Section envisaged (but not necessarily included) to describe possible alternative unit.
HARDWARE SETTING DOCUMENTATION:
It encloses the documents related to unit hardware setting operations, if envisaged.
ANNEXES:
Section envisaged (but not necessarily included) containing additional documentation or general information on other topics not inherent to the chapters making up the handbook.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(*)
ED
If the equipment is software integrated and man–machine interfaced (through a PCD, PC, Work Station or other external processing/displaying system) the maintenance carried out with such system is described in the Operator’s Handbook (see para.1.3 on page 18 )
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
24 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1.4 Handbook Structure
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1.5 Handbook Configuration Check 1.5.1 List of the editions and of modified parts The following table indicates the handbook parts new and modified with respect to the previous edition. Legenda n m
= new part = modified part
p =proposal part PR =proposal edition
Table 10. Handbook configuration check EDITION
01
02
DESCRIPTION
n
1. GENERAL
n
2. PHYSICAL CONFIGURATION
n
3. FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
n
4. UNITS DESCRIPTION
n
m
5. TECHNICAL SPECIFICATION
n
m
MAINTENANCE
03
04
05
06
m
n
6. MAINTENANCE
n
APPENDICES Nothing envisaged HARDWARE SETTING DOCUMENTATION
n
Unit documentation list
n
m
ANNEXES Nothing envisaged Note:
the edition of the enclosed documents (sections HARDWARE SETTING DOCUMENTATION and ANNEXES) is not subjected to configuration check.
1.5.2 Notes on Ed.01 Ed.01 created on October 2004 is the first validated and officially released issue of this Handbook. 1.5.3 Notes on Ed.02
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Ed.02 created on April 2005 has been edited for: –
New Hardware setting document (MSZZQ) has been added
–
Correction of CWDM units characteristics
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
25 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
26 / 636 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2 COMPLIANCE WITH EUROPEAN NORMS 2.1 Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) The CE markings printed on the product denote compliancy with the following Directives: •
89/336/EEC of May 3rd, 1989 (EMC directives), amended: –
by the 92/31/EEC Directive issued on April 28th, 1992
–
by the 93/68/EEC Directive issued on July 22nd, 1993
Compliancy to the above Directives is declared, whenthe equipment is installed as for the manifacturer handbooks, according to the following European Norms: •
EN 300 386 (V1.3.1), environment “Telecommunication Center”
WARNING
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
This is a class A product EN55022. In domestic, residential and light industry environments, this product may cause radio interference in which case the user may be required to take adequate measures.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
27 / 636
2.2 Safety
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
•
IEC 60950–1 ed.2001 ,
for electrical safety
•
EN 60950–1 ed.2001 ,
for electrical safety
•
EN 60825–1 ed.1994 + A11 ed.1996+A2 ed.2001
for optical safety
•
IEC 60825–1 ed.1993 + A2 ed. 2001 (1999)
for optical safety
•
EN 60825–2 ed.2000
for optical safety
•
IEC 60825–2 ed.2000
for optical safety
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Compliancy to Safety Norms is declared in that the equipment satisfies standardized Norms :
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
28 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3 SAFETY NORMS AND LABELS 3.1 First aid for electric shock Do not touch the patient with bare hands until the circuit has been opened. Open the circuit by switching off the line switches. If that is not possible, protect yourself with dry material and free the patient from the conductor. ARTIFICIAL RESPIRATION It is important to start mouth to mouth resuscitation at once and seek medical help immediately. TREATMENT OF BURNS This treatment should be used after the patient has regained consciousness. It can also be employed while the artificial respiration is being applied (in this case there should be at least two persons present). WARNING:
ED
•
Do not attempt to remove his clothing from the burnt parts;
•
Apply dry gauze on the burns;
•
Do not apply ointments or other oily substances.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
29 / 636
1
Lay the patient supine with his arms parallel with the body, if the patient is laying on an inclined plane, make sure that his stomach is slightly lower than his chest. Open the patient’s mouth and check that there are no extraneous bodies in his mouth (dentures, chewing–gum etc.),
2
Kneel beside the patient level with his head. Put a hand under the patient’s head and one under his neck (see fig.) Lift the patient’s head and let it recline backwards as far as possible
3
Shift the hand from the patient’s neck to is chin: place your thumb between his chin and his mouth, the index along his jawbone, and keep the other fingers closed together (see fig.). While performing these operations take a good supply of oxygen by taking deep breaths with your mouth open.
4
With your thumb between the patient’s chin and mouth keep his lips together and blow into his nasal cavities (see fig.)
5
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
6
ED
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Mouth to mouth resuscitation method
While performing these operations observe if the patient’s chest rises (see fig.) If not it is possible that his nose is blocked: in that case open the patient’s mouth as much as possible by pressing on his chin with your hand, place your lips around his mouth and blow into his oral cavity. Observe if the patient’s chest heaves. This second method can be used instead of the first even when the patient’s nose is kept closed by pressing the nostrils together using the hand you were holding his head with. The patient’s head must be kept sloping backwards as much as possible. Start with ten rapid expirations, hence continue at a rate of twelve/fifteen expirations per minute. Go on like this until the patient has regained consciousness, or until a doctor has ascertained his death.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
30 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.2 Safety Rules 3.2.1 General Rules •
Before carrying out any installation, turn–up & commissioning, operation and maintenance operations carefully read the relevant Handbook and chapters.
•
Observe safety rules –
When equipment is operating nobody is allowed to have access inside on the equipment parts which are protected with Cover Plate Shields removable with tools
–
In case of absolute need to have access inside, on the equipment parts when it is operating this is allowed exclusively to service personnel, where for Service Personnel or Technical assistance is meant : ”personnel which has adequate Technical Knowledge and experience necessary to be aware of the danger that he might find in carrying out an operation and of the necessary measurements to reduce danger to minimum for him and for others”. The Service Personnel can only replace the faulty units with spare parts. The Service Personnel is not allowed to repair: hence the access to the parts no specified is not permitted. The keys and/or the tools used to open doors, hinged covers to remove parts which give access to compartments in which are present high dangerous voltages must belong exclusively to the service personnel.
–
For the eventual cleaning of the external parts of the equipment, absolutely do not use any inflammable substance or substances which in some way may alter the markings, inscriptions ect.
–
It is recommended to use a slightly wet cleaning cloth.
•
The Safety Rules stated in the handbook describe the operations and/or precautions to observe to safeguard service personnel during the working phases and to guarantee equipment safety, i.e., not exposing persons, animals, things to the risk of being injured/damaged.
•
Whenever the safety protection features have been impaired, REMOVE POWER. To cut off power proceed to switch off the power supply units as well as cut off power station upstream (rack or station distribution frame).
•
The safety rules described at the beginning of the handbook are distinguished by the following symbol and statement:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
SAFETY RULES
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
31 / 636
3.2.2 Labels Indicating Danger, Forbiddance, Command
The labels are fully compliant with International Norms ISO 3846–1984. The symbols or statements are enclosed in geometric shapes: ISO 3864–1984.
CONTAINS A SYMBOL STATEMENT INDICATES FORBIDDANCE (WHITE BACKGROUND WHIT RED RIM–BLACK SYMBOL OR STATEMENT) IT IS A COMMAND (BLUE BACKGROUND–WHITE SYMBOL OR STATEMENT).
CONTAINS A SYMBOL INDICATES WARNING OR DANGER (YELLOW BACKGROUND–BLACK SYMBOL AND RIM)
CONTAINS A STATEMENT PROVIDING INFORMATION OR INSTRUCTION. (YELLOW BACKGROUND–BLACK STATEMENT AND RIM)
The labels have been affixed to indicate a dangerous condition. They may contain any standard–known symbol or any statement necessary to safeguard users and service personnel against the most common ones, specifically: •
dangerous electrical voltages
•
harmful optical signals
•
risk of explosion
•
moving mechanical parts
•
heat–radiating mechanical parts
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Pay attention to the information stated in the following, and proceed as instructed
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
32 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
It is of utmost importance to follow the instructions printed on the labels affixed to the units and assemblies.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The symbols presented in para.3.2.3 through 3.2.7 are all the possible symbols that could be present on Alcatel equipment, but are not all necessarily present on the equipment this handbook refers to.
3.2.3 Dangerous Electrical Voltages 3.2.3.1 Labelling The following warning label is affixed next to dangerous voltages (>42.4 Vp; >60 Vdc).
If it is a Class 1 equipment connected to mains, then the label associated to it will state that the equipment will have to be grounded before connecting it to the power supply voltage, e.g.:
WARNING ! Ground protect the equipment before connecting it to mains Make sure that power has been cut off before disconnecting ground protection.
3.2.3.2 Electrical safety: general rules
DANGER! Possibility of personal injury:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
carefully observe the specific procedures for installation / turn–up and commissioning / maintenance of equipment parts where a.c. or d.c. power is present, described in the relevant installation / turn–up and commissioning / maintenance documents and the following general rules: a)
Personal injury can be caused by –48 V dc (or by 220 V ac if envisaged in the equipment). Avoid touching powered terminals with any exposed part of your body.
b)
Short circuiting, low-voltage, low-impedance, dc circuits can cause severe arcing that can result in burns and/or eye damage. Remove rings, watches, and other metal jewelry before working with primary circuits. Exercise caution to avoid shorting power input terminals.
3.2.3.3 Electrical safety: equipment specific data Refer to para.5.1.2 on page 565.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
33 / 636
3.2.4 Harmful Optical Signals
If the assembly or unit is fitted with a LASER, the labels must comply with the IEC 60825–1 and –2 International Norms.
The symbol indicates the presence of a LASER beam. Danger level is stated within a rectangular label:
If the LASER is a Hazard Level 1, 1M product, the label depicting the symbol within a triangle is not compulsory. If the LASER is a Hazard Level 3A product, the label depicting the symbol within a triangle is compulsory. NOTE: the equipment may be provided with labels of a type other than the illustrated one (reason: previous standard). The rectangular shaped label bears all the information needed, i.e.:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
• • • • • •
LASER class Power emitted Wave length Ref. Norm Precautionary measures taken depend on LASER class Indications given on openings, panels and safety interlockers
exemple of power and lenght values
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
34 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.2.4.1 Labelling
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.2.4.2 Optical safety: general rules On handling optical equipments or units or cables always check that laser labels are properly affixed and that the system complies with applicable optical standards.
DANGER! Possibility of eyes damage: invisible infrared radiations emitted by the fiber optic transmitters can cause eyes damages. Carefully observe the specific procedures for installation / turn–up and commissioning / maintenance of units containing laser devices or cables transporting optical signals, described in the relevant installation / turn–up and commissioning / maintenance documents and the following general rules: a)
Laser radiation is not visible by the naked eye or with laser safety glasses. Although it cannot be seen, laser radiation may be present.
b)
Never look directly into an unterminated fiber optic connector or into a broken optical fiber cable, unless it is absolutely known that no laser radiation is present.
c)
Never look at an optical fiber splice, cable or connector, unless it is absolutely known that no laser radiation is present.
d)
All optical connectors, terminating either fibers and transmitters/receivers, are provided with protective covers that must always be used, as soon as possible, when any optical link is disconnected for installation/test/maintenance purposes or whatever operation.
e)
Never look directly into an unterminated fiber optic connector or into a broken optical fiber cable by means of magnifiers/microscopes, unless it is absolutely known that no laser radiation is present. A magnifier/microscope greatly increases the damage hazard to the eyes.
f)
Never point an unterminated optical fiber splice, cable or connector to other persons, unless it is absolutely known that no laser radiation is present.
g)
Always remove electrical power from near and far optical transmitters before disconnecting optical links between the transmitter and the receiver.
h)
Wearing of laser safety goggles or eyes shields is recommended for every person working on optical devices, whenever the above listed rules cannot be followed.
3.2.4.3 Optical safety: equipment specific data
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Refer to paragraph 5.1.1 on page 561 .
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
35 / 636
3.2.5 Risks of Explosions
This risk is present when batteries are used, and it is signalled by the following label:
Therefore, slits or apertures are made to let air circulate freely and allow dangerous gasses to downflow (battery–emitted hydrogen). A 417–IEC–5641 Norm. compliant label is affixed next to it indicating that the openings must not be covered up.
3.2.6 Moving Mechanical Parts
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The following warning label is affixed next to fans or other moving mechanical parts:
Before carrying out any maintenance operation see that all the moving mechanical parts have been stopped.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
36 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.2.5.1 Labelling and safety instructions
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.2.7 Heat–radiating Mechanical Parts The presence of heat–radiating mechanical parts is indicated by the following warning label in compliancy with IEC 417 Norm, Fig.5041:
As stated by IEC 950 Norm., para.1.4.7 mechanical parts which carry the above pictured label and that could inadvertently be touched, have a temperature T established by the following formula:
(T–Tamb) (DTmax + 25° – Tmra) where:
T
Temperature of the mechanical part measured at ambient temperature Tamb.
Tamb
Ambient temperature during the test
DTmax
Value defined by IEC 60950 Norm, Table 16 part 2a, para.5.1, and specified in the table below.
Tmra
The maximum room ambient temperature permitted by the equipment specification or 25°C, whichever is greater.
Table 11. IEC 950 –Table 16: Overtemperature limits, Part 2
Maximum overtemperature (°C ) Operator–accessible parts Metal
Glass, porcelain
Plastic, rubber
Handle knob, ect., held or touched for short periods
35
45
60
Handles, knobs, ect., regularly held
30
40
50
Outer surface of the equipment that can be touched
45
55
70
Inner surface of the equipment that can be touched
45
55
70
DANGER! Possibility of personal injury:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
carefully observe the specific procedures for installation / turn–up and commissioning / maintenance of equipment parts where heat–radiating mechanical parts are present, described in the relevant installation / turn–up and commissioning / maintenance documents and the following general rule: a)
ED
Personal injury can be caused by heat. Avoid touching powered terminals with any exposed part of your body.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
37 / 636
3.2.8 Specific safety rules in this handbook
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
•
ED
–
Chapter 6 paragraph 6.1 on page 621
–
Chapter 6 paragraph 6.5.2.1 on page 624
–
Chapter 6 paragraph 6.6.1 on page 625
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The safety rules are specified in the following chapters:
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
38 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
4 OTHER NORMS AND LABELS 4.1 Electromagnetic Compatibility The equipment’s EMC norms depend on the type of installation being carried out (cable termination, grounding etc.,) and on the operating conditions (equipment, setting options of the electrical/electronic units, presence of dummy covers, etc.). •
Before starting any installation, turn–up & commissioning, operation and maintenance work refer to the relevant Handbook and chapters.
•
The norms set down to guarantee EMC compatibility, are distinguished inside this handbook by the symbol and term:
ATTENTION
EMC NORMS.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
4.1.1 General Norms – Installation
ED
•
All connections (towards the external source of the equipment) made with shielded cables use only cables and connectors suggested in this technical handbook or in the relevant Plant Documentation, or those specified in the Customer’s”Installation Norms.” (or similar documents)
•
Shielded cables must be suitably terminated
•
Install filters outside the equipment as required
•
Ground connect the equipment utilizing a conductor with proper dia. and impedance
•
Mount shields (if utilized), previously positioned during the installation phase, but not before having cleaned and degreased it.
•
Before inserting the shielded unit proceed to clean and degrease all peripheral surfaces (contact springs and connection points, etc.)
•
Screw fasten the units to the subrack.
•
To correctly install EMC compatible equipment follow the instructions given.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
39 / 636
•
Preset the electrical units as required to guarantee EMC compatibility
•
Check that the equipment is operating with all the shields properly positioned (dummy covers, ESD connector protections, etc.)
•
To properly use EMC compatible equipment observe the information given
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
4.1.3 General Norms – Maintenance
ED
•
Before inserting the shielded unit, which will replace the faulty or modified unit, proceed to clean and degrease all peripheral surfaces (contact springs and connection points, etc.)
•
Clean the dummy covers of the spare units as well.
•
Screw fasten the units to the subrack.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
40 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
4.1.2 General Norms – Turn–up & Commissioning, Operation
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
4.2 Electrostatic Dischargers (ESD) Before removing the ESD protections from the monitors, connectors etc., observe the precautionary measures stated. Make sure that the ESD protections have been replaced and after having terminated the maintenance and monitoring operations. Most electronic devices are sensitive to electrostatic dischargers, to this concern the following warning labels have been affixed:
Observe the precautionary measures stated when having to touch the electronic parts during the installation/maintenance phases. Workers are supplied with antistatic protection devices consisting of:
ELASTICIZED BAND
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
COILED CORD
ED
•
an elasticized band worn around the wrist
•
a coiled cord connected to the elasticized band and to the stud on the subrack.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
41 / 636
4.3 Suggestions, notes and cautions
Suggestion or note.... Cautions to avoid possible equipment damage are marked by the following symbol: TITLE... (caution to avoid equipment damage) statement....
4.4 Labels affixed to the Equipment This chapter indicates the positions and the information contained on the identification and serial labels affixed to the equipment. Figure 1. thru’ Figure 7. illustrate the most common positions of the labels on the units, modules and subracks. Figure 8. thru’ Figure 11. illustrate the information (e.g., identification and serial No.) printed on the labels. The table below relates the ref. numbers stated on the figures to the labels used. Labelling depicted hereafter is for indicative purposes and could be changed without any notice. Table 12. Label references
Ref. No.
Name of Label
1
label specifying item not on catalogue (P/N. and serial number)
2
label specifying item on catalogue (P/N. and serial number)
3
item identification label – item on catalog
4
label identifying the equipment
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
On contract basis, customized labels can be affixed to the equipment. Standard labels can be affixed to any position on the equipment, as required by the Customer. However, for each of the above are applied the rules defined by each individual Customer.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
42 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Suggestions and special notes are marked by the following symbol:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NOTE : The above reference numbers are detailed on Table 12. on page 42
Figure 1. Subrack label
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
43 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
NOTE : The above reference numbers are detailed on Table 12. on page 42
Figure 2. Subrack label
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
44 / 636 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NB.1 = The label is present on the support side
NOTE : The above reference numbers are detailed on Table 12. on page 42
Figure 3. Subrack label
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
45 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
NOTE : The above reference numbers are detailed on Table 12. on page 42
Figure 4. Labels on units with standard cover plate
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
46 / 636 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
NOTE : The above reference numbers are detailed on Table 12. on page 42
Figure 5. Modules label
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
47 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NB.1 = The label is present on the p.c.s. component side
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
NOTE : The above reference numbers are detailed on Table 12. on page 42 Figure 6. Internal label for Printed Board Assembly
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
48 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
NB. 1 = The label is present on p.c.s. components side or rear side on the empty spaces. NOTE : The above reference numbers are detailed on Table 12. on page 42 Figure 7. Back panels internal label
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
49 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
FACTORY P/N + CS FACTORY SERIAL NUMBER
SERIAL NUMBER BAR CODE (format 128; Module = 0,166; EN 799; Subset B/C)
Figure 8. Label specifying item not on catalogue (P/N. and serial number)
ANV ITEM PART NUMBER + space + ICS ANV ITEM PART NUMBER + ICS BAR CODE (format ALFA 39 (+ * start, stop); Module = 0,166; Ratio = 2)
ALCATEL FACTORY PART NUMBER + SPACE + CS
ACRONYM
SERIAL NUMBER
SERIAL NUMBER BAR CODE (format ALFA 39 (+ * start, stop); Module = 0,166; Ratio = 2)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 9. Label specifying item on catalogue (P/N. and serial number)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
50 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
FREQUENCY (Optional)
ACRONYM
ANV ITEM PART NUMBER
Figure 10. Item identification labels – item on catalog
EQUIPMENT NAME
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 11. Label identifying the equipment (example)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
51 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
52 / 636 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 13. List of Abbreviations
MEANING
ABBREVIATION ABIL
Enabling
ABN
Abnormal
ADM
Add/Drop Multiplexer
AIS
Alarm indication Signal
ALS
Automatic Laser Shutdown
APD
Avalanche Photodiode
APS
Automatic Protection Switching
AND
Alarm on both station batteries
ANSI
American National Standards International
ASIC
Application Specific Integrated Circuit
ATM
Asynchronous Transfer Module
ATTD
Attended (alarm storing)
AU
Administrative Unit
AUG
Administrative Unit Group
AUOH
AU Pointer
AUX
Auxiliary
AU4
Administrative unit – level 4
BATT
Battery
BER
Bit Error Rate
BIP
Bit Interleaved Parity
BNC
Bayonet Not Coupling
C
Storing command
CE
European Conformity
CO
Central Office
CPE
Customer premises equipment
CT
Craft Terminal
CMI
Code Mark Inversion
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
53 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
MEANING
COAX
Coaxial
CPI
Incoming parallel contacts
CPO
Outgoing parallel contacts
CPU
Central Processing Unit (referred to Controller equipment unit or Microprocessor)
C12/C3/C4
1st, 3rd and 4th level container
DC
Direct Current
DCC
Data Communication Channel
DCE
Data Circuit Terminating Equipment
DPLL
Digital Phase Locked Loop
DTE
Data Terminal Equipment
EBU
European Broadcasting Union
EC
Equipment Controller
ECC
Embedded Control Channel
ECT
Equipment Craft Terminal
EMC
Electromagnetic compatibility
EMI
Electromagnetic interference
EOW
Engineering Order Wire
EPS
Equipment Protection Switching
ESD
Electrostatic discharges
ETSI
European Telecommunication Standards Institute
E2PROM
Electrically erasable programmable read only memory
F
Interface F (for Craft Terminal) or Fuse
FEBE
Far End Block Error
FEPROM
Flesh Electrically erasable programmable read only memory
FERF
Far End Receive Failure
FPGA
Field Programmable Gate Array
GA
Gate Array
GND
Ground
HDBK
Handbook
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
54 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ABBREVIATION
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ABBREVIATION
MEANING
HDB3
High Density Bipolar Code
HIGHREFL
High Optical reflections
HOA
High Order Adaptation
HOI
High Order Interface
HPC
High order Path Connection
HPT
Higher Order Path Termination
HPOM
High order Path Overhead Monitoring
HSUT
High order Supervisory Unequipped Termination
HW
Hardware
ICS
Item Change Status
ID
Identification signals
IEC
International Electrotechnical Committee
IEEE
Institute of Electrical and Electronic Engineering
IN
Input
IND
Indicative alarm
INT
Internal Local Alarms
IP
Internet Protocol
ISO
International Organism for standardization
ITU–T (*)
International Telecommunication Union–Telecommunication Sector
JE1
Joint Engineering
LAN
Local Area Network
LDSSHUT
Command for ALS
LED
Light emitting diode
LOF
Loss of alignment
LOI
Low Order Interface
LOM
Loss Of Multiframe
LOP
Loss Of Pointer
LOS
Loss of signal
LPA
Lower order path adaption
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
55 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
MEANING
LPC
Lower order path connection
LPOM
Lower Order Path Monitoring
LPT
Lower order path termination or Loopback equipment side (local)
LSUT
Lower order Supervisory Unequipped Termination
M
Tagblock or Alarm storing
MCF
Message Communication Function
MLM
Multi Longitudinal mode
MSA
Multiplex section adaptation
MSOH
Multiplex Section Overhead
MSP
Multiplex section protection
MST
Multiplex section termination
NRZ
No return to zero
NURG
Not urgent alarm
OH–BUS
Dedicated housekeeping stream
OMSN
Optinex MultiService Node
OOF
Out Of Frame
OR
Logic sum/Loss of only one station battery
OS
Operating system
OUT
Output
P/S
Parallel/Serial converter
PC
Personal Computer
PDH
Plesiochronous Digital Hierarchy
PFAIL
Power supply failure
PI
Physical interface
PJE
Pointer Justification Event
PPI
Plesiochronous Physical interface
POH
Path Overhead
PMMF
Physical Machine Management Function
PPS
Path Protection Switching
ED
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ABBREVIATION
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
56 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ABBREVIATION
MEANING
PRBS
Pseudo Random Binary Signal
PR_EA
Packet Ring Edge Aggregator
PWALM
Power supply alarm
PWANDOR
ANDOR/3 failure
Q2/QB2
TMN Interface with B2 protocol. Interface towards plesiochronous equipment
Q3/QB3
TMN Interface with B3 protocol. Interface towards TMN
R
Reset command /General alarm
RAI
Remote Alarm Indication
RECC
Recommendation
RAM
Random Access Memory
RDI
Remote Defect Indication
REI
Remote Error Indication
RCK
Received clock
REF
Reference
REL
Release
RIBUS
Remote Inventory BUS
RMS
Root Mean Square
RNURG
Not urgent Alarm command. Lights up the relative rack red LED
RSOH
Regenerator Section Overhead
RST
Regenerator Section Termination
RURG
Urgent Alarm command. Lights up the relative rack red LED
Rx
Reception
SC
Shelf Controller
SDH
Synchronous Digital Hierarchy
SETG
Synchronous Equipment Timing Generation function
SLM
Single Longitudinal Mode
SM
Single Mode/Synchronous Mux
SNCP/I (** )
Subnetwork Connection Protection Inherent
SOH
Section Overhead
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
57 / 636
MEANING
S/P
Serial/Parallel Converter
SPI
Synchronous Physical Interface
SSF
Server Signal Fail
SQ
Squelch
STM–0/STM–1
Synchronous Transport Module, levels 0 etc.
SW
Software
TANC
Remote alarm due to failure of all power supply units
TD
Layout drawing
TIM
Trace Identifier Mismatch
TMN
Telecommunication Management Network
TOR
Remote alarm indicating loss of one of the station batteries
TORC
Remote alarm due to a faulty/missing power supply unit
TSD
Trail Signal Degrade
TSF
Trail Signal Fail
TTF
Transport Terminal Function
TUG2/3
Tributary unit group, level 2,3
TUOH
Tributary Unit Overhead
TUP/UP
Equipment Controller remote alarm
TU12/TU3
Tributary unit level 12, 3
TX
Transmission
URG
Urgent
VCXO/VCO
Voltage controlled oscillator
VC12/VC3/VC4
Virtual Container, levels 12,3,4
VMMF
Virtual Machine Management Function
WAN
Wide Access Network
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ABBREVIATION
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
NOTES – (*) Owing to change of name, all documents issued by the two ITU committees (CCIR ND CCITT) in 1992 (and in some cases even before then) are classified as ITU–R and ITU–T, respectively. (**) Substitutes PPS
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
58 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
6 GENERAL ON ALCATEL CUSTOMER DOCUMENTATION 6.1 Products, product-releases, versions and Customer Documentation A ”product” is defined by the network hierarchical level where it can be inserted and by the whole of performance and services for which it is meant. A ”product” evolves through successive ”product-releases” which are the real products marketed for their delivery at a certain ”product-release” availability date. So, a ”product–release” defines a set of hardware components and a software package which, as a whole, identify the possible network applications and the equipment performance which the specific ”product-release” has been designed, engineered and marketed for. In some cases a ”product-release” has further development steps, named ”versions”, that are born to improve or add some performance (mainly software) with respect to the previous version, or for bug fixing purposes. A ”product-release” has its own standard Customer Documentation, composed by one or more handbooks. A new ”version” of a ”product-release” may or may not produce a change in the status of the Customer Documentation set, as described in para. 6.4 on page 60.
6.2 Handbook supply to Customers Handbooks are not automatically delivered together with the equipment they refer to. The number of handbooks per type to be supplied must be decided at contract level.
6.3 Aims of standard Customer Documentation Standard Customer Documentation, referred to hereafter, must be always meant as plant-independent. Plant-dependent documentation, if envisaged by the contract, is subjected to commercial criteria as far as contents, formats and supply conditions are concerned (plant-dependent documentation is not described here). Standard hardware and software documentation is meant to give the Customer personnel the possibility and the information necessary for installing, commissioning, operating and maintaining the equipment according to Alcatel–Telecom Laboratory design choices. In particular: the contents of the handbooks associated to the software applications focus on the explanation of the man-machine interface and of the operating procedures allowed by it; maintenance is described down to faulty PCB location and replacement.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Consequently, no supply to the Customers of design documentation (like PCB hardware design and production documents and files, software source programs, programming tools, etc.) is envisaged. The handbooks concerning hardware (usually the ”Technical Handbook”) and software (usually the ”Operator’s Handbook”) are kept separate in that any product changes do not necessarily concern their contents. For example, only the Technical Handbook might be revised because of hardware configuration changes (e.g., replacing a unit with one having different P/N but the same function). On the other hand, the Operator’s Handbook is updated because of a new software version but which does not concern the Technical Handbook as long as it does not imply hardware modifications. However, both types of handbooks can be updated to improve contents, correct mistakes, etc..
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
59 / 636
6.4 Handbook Updating
Each handbook is identified by: – the name of the ”product-release” (and ”version” when the handbook is applicable to the versions starting from it, but not to the previous ones), – the handbook name, – the handbook P/N, – the handbook edition (usually first edition=01), – the handbook issue date. The date on the handbook does not refer to the date of print but to the date on which the handbook source file has been completed and released for the production. 6.4.1 Changes introduced in the same product-release (same handbook P/N) The edition and date of issue might change on future handbook versions for the following reasons: –
only the date changes (pointed out in the Table of Contents) when modifications are made to the editorial system not changing the technical contents of the handbook.
–
the edition, hence the date, is changed because modifications made concern technical contents. In this case: • •
the chapters modified with respect to the previous edition are listed in Table 10. on page 25.; in affected chapters, revision bars on the left of the page indicate modifications in text and drawings.
Changes concerning the technical contents of the handbook cause the edition number increase (e.g. from Ed.01 to Ed.02). Slight changes (e.g. for corrections) maintain the same edition but with the addition of a version character (e.g. from Ed.02 to Ed.02A). Version character can be used for draft or proposal editions. NOTES FOR HANDBOOKS RELEVANT TO SOFTWARE APPLICATIONS
Handbooks relevant to software applications (typically the Operator’s Handbooks) are not modified unless the new software ”version” distributed to Customers implies man–machine interface changes or in case of slight modifications not affecting the understanding of the explained procedures. Moreover, should the screen prints included in the handbook contain the product-release’s ”version” marking, they are not replaced in the handbooks related to a subsequent version, if the screen contents are unchanged. 6.4.1.1 Supplying updated handbooks to Customers
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Supplying updated handbooks to Customers who have already received previous issues is submitted to commercial criteria. By updated handbook delivery it is meant the supply of a complete copy of the handbook new issue (supplying errata–corrige sheets is not envisaged). 6.4.2 Changes due to new product version A new product version changes the handbook P/N and the edition starts from 01. In this case the modified parts of the handbook are not listed.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
60 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The handbooks associated to the ”product–release” are listed in para.1.3 on page 18.
6.5 Customer documentation on CD–ROM
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
In the following by ’CD–ROM’ it is meant ’Customer Documentation on CD–ROM’ 6.5.1 Contents, creation and production of a CD–ROM In most cases, a CD–ROM contains in read–only eletronic format the documentation of one product–release(–version) and for a certain language. In some other cases, the same CD–ROM can contain the documentation of different product–release(–version)s for a certain language. As a general rule: –
–
CD–ROMs for Network Management products do not contain: •
the Installation Guides
•
the documentation of system optional features that Customers could not buy from Alcatel together with the main applicative SW.
CD–ROMs for Network Elements products do not contain: •
the documentation of system optional features (e.g. System Installation Handbooks related to racks that Customers could not buy from Alcatel together with the main equipment).
A CD–ROM is obtained collecting various handbooks and documents in .pdf format. Bookmarks and hyperlinks make the navigation easier. No additional information is added to each handbook, so that the documentation present in the CD–ROMs is exactly the same the Customer would receive on paper. The files processed in this way are added to files/images for managing purpose and a master CD–ROM is recorded. Suitable checks are made in order to have a virus–free product.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
After a complete functional check, the CD–ROM image is electronically transferred to the archive of the Production Department, so that the CD–ROM can be produced and delivered to Customers.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
61 / 636
6.5.2 Use of the CD–ROM
The CD–ROM starts automatically with autorun and hyperlinks from the opened “Index” document permit to visualize the .pdf handbooks Other hyperlinks permit to get, from the Technical handbooks, the specific .pdf setting documents. In order to open the .pdf documents Adobe Acrobat Reader Version 4.0 (minimum) must have been installed on the platform. The CD–ROM doesn’t contain the Adobe Acrobat Reader program. The Customer is in charge of getting and installing it. ReadMe info is present on the CD–ROM to this purpose. Then the Customer is allowed to read the handbooks on the PC/WS screen, using the navigation and zooming tools included in the tool, and to print selected parts of the documentation through a local printer. 6.5.3 CD–ROM identification Each CD–ROM is identified: 1)
by the following external identifiers, that are printed on the CD–ROM upper surface: – the name of the ”product–release(s)” (and ”version” if applicable) – a writing indicating the language(s), – the CD–ROM P/N ), – the CD–ROM edition (usually first edition=01)
2)
and, internally, by the list of the source handbooks and documents (P/Ns and editions) by whose collection and processing the CD–ROM itself has been created.
6.5.4 CD–ROM updating
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The list of source handbook/document P/Ns–editions indicated in previous para. 6.5.3 point 2 ) , in association with the CD–ROM’s own P/N–edition, is also loaded in the Alcatel–Information–System as a structured list. Whenever a new edition of any of such handbooks/documents is released in the Alcatel archive system, a check in the Alcatel–Information–System is made to identify the list of CD–ROMs that must be updated to include the new editions of these handbooks/documents. This causes the planning and creation of a new edition of the CD–ROM. Updating of CD–ROMs always follows, with a certain delay, the updating of the single handbooks composing the collection.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
62 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The CD–ROM can be used both in PC and Unix WS environments.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
DESCRIPTIONS
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
63 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
64 / 636 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1 GENERAL 1.1 Introduction to the equipment The Alcatel 1660SM is a synchronous Optical Multi Service Node (OMSN); it complies with the Synchronous Digital Hierarchy (SDH) defined in ITU–T Recommendation G.707. The integration of SDH and WDM technology represents the chance to enhance the network capacity with no impact on the starting physical means (i.e. fibers): the presence of a wavelength grid allows the user to multiply the capacity with limited costs, if compared to the cable laying; on the other side the SDH network (specifically configured with OMSN’s equipment) represents the most flexible and reliable way to handle different types of clients, both TDM and data. The availability of Coarse WDM technology in the 1660SM matches a second driver for network integration, i.e. ’cost reduction’. CWDM optical devices represent a cost effective solution, if compared to the Dense WDM technology and fit most of the network scenarios in area ’metro’(refer to Figure 12. on page 69). 1660SM, makes available up to 8 channels for traffic transport according the ITU –T G.694.2 wavelength grid: 1470 – 1490 – 1510 – 1530 – 1550 – 1570 – 1590 – 1610 nm. The 1660SM with CWDM technology fulfits both ’ring’ and ’linear’ applications (refer to paragraph 1.2.3 on page 77 and paragraph 1.2.4 on page 81). Compatible with existing plesiochronous systems as well as with the installed SDH networks, the 1660SM is a transmission equipment operating at 155 (STM–1), 622(STM–4) and 2488(STM–16) Mbit/s bit rates. It can be configured as a Multiple Line Terminal Multiplexers or as a Multiple Add/Drop Multiplexers or mini cross connect for applications in linear links, network rings and meshed networks. A wide range of ports can be added/dropped/connected by the equipment according to the traffic type to be managed: –
2.048 Mbit/s signal (with asynchronous mapping) Processing of unstructured and structured (ISDN–PRA) 2Mb/s signal.
–
34/45 Mbit/s
–
STM–1 Electrical/Optical
–
STM–4 Optical Signal
–
STM–16 Optical Signal
–
OC3 Electrical/Optical
–
A mixing of SDH and Data Services is possible by inserting the 4xANY board in the 1660SM subrack. It allows to multiplex in the time domain up to 4 client signals into one single 2.5Gb/s optical channel (server signal). Server STM–16 signal is connected to SDH matrix through 1660SM backpanel. Multiplexing scheme delivers a fully compliant SDH frame. The signal can hence be directly connected to a SDH ADM/DXC without requiring prior de–concentration.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The clients signals can be independently handled among the following types: • • • • •
ED
Fast Ethernet FDDI (125Mbps) ESCON (200Mbps) Digital Video (270Mbps) Fiber Channel (1.0625Gbps) 02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
65 / 636
• •
ISA (Integrated Service Adapter)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Alcatel’s Integrated Service Adapter (ISA) series of plug–in cards are specially designed to enhance the optical transport network by adding data–aware features that are easy to introduce, allowing carriers to efficiently and cost–effectively aggregate, switch and transport the expanding amount of data services in their metropolitan network. 1660SM equipped with ISA plug–in cards give telecom operators a new generation modular platform for multi–service SDH transport and further strengthen Alcatel’s leading position in the supply of optical multi–technology transmission networks. The ISA system is modular and the plug–ins can be chosen according to the specific application the 1660SM needs to manage; the following ISA boards are available:
ED
•
ISA–ATM (Asynchronous Transfer Module); the ATM cells, mapped into SDH G707 payloads (VC4, VC4–C, VC3, VC12) or PDH G704/G832/G804 frames (E1, E3), can be processed, routed and switched, using the dedicated unit. Such functionalities are particularly useful in urban and local access ring to consolidate data traffic from different users onto the same SDH Virtual Containers, thereby optimizing the utilization of transmission bandwidth (see Figure 13. on page 70).
•
ISA–PR_EA (Packet Ring Edge Aggregator) also called MPLS (Multi Protocol Label Switching); the packets data services of level 3 of the protocol stack, transported over Ethernet, are routed into the SDH network by means of MPLS labels. Topology can be either meshed or ring networks. It is especially made as interface aggregator.
•
ISA–PR (Packet Ring); the packets data services of level 3 of the protocol stack, transported over Ethernet, are routed into the SDH network by means of MPLS labels. PR is for ring network topology, with dedicated data protector scheme. The role of PR functionality is to provide a shared carrier–class Ethernet Packet Ring either embedded physically into the SDH infrastructure, in which case the embedded Packet Ring is provided in a flexible manner over SDH Virtual Containers (VC–4–Xv), or alternatively the PR can be connected directly to independent fibers to create a Packet Ring over single or dual STM4. PR Deployment Scenario is presented on Figure 14. on page 71.
•
ISA–Ethernet: the Ethernet MAC frames are accessed at 10/100BaseT format, and then mapped into SDH G707 payloads (VC4, VC3, VC12); they can be transparently linked, point–to–point, in the SDH network to allow LAN to LAN connections as depicted in the example of Figure 15. on page 72. If the customer has N sites to be interconnected, each Customer Box uses N–1 Point to Point Ethernet interfaces. Ethernet frames are mapped over a SDH VC using Generic Framing Procedure encapsulation. As SDH Network is transparent, the customer Boxes see them as directly connected in a mesh.
•
ISA–Gbit/s Ethernet: the Ethernet signals are accessed at 1.25Gb/s over optical fiber medium, and then mapped into SDH G707 payloads VC4; they can be transparently linked, point–to–point, in the SDH network to allow LAN to LAN connections as depicted in the example of Figure 15. on page 72 If the customer has N sites to be interconnected, each Customer Box uses N–1 Point to Point Ethernet interfaces. Ethernet frames are mapped over a SDH VC using Generic Framing Procedure encapsulation. As SDH Network is transparent, the customer Boxes see them as directly connected in a mesh.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
66 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
FICON (1.0625Gbps) Gigabit Ethernet (1.25Gbps)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
•
ISA–ES (Ethernet Switching). ISA–ES series modules provide ETH 10/100/1000 interfaces connectivity for LAN based clients premises inside the metro area. Beyond mapping ETH flows onto the SDH metro network by means of standard mechanisms (as specified in ITU G.7071, ITU G.7042 and ITU G.707) the ISA–ES series cards introduce wire speed classifying, policing and scheduling capability empowered by carrier class Ethernet switching engine. Per customer traffic flow management with low bandwidth granularity, segregation and QoS are just few of the value added arguments that these series of modules offer to the carrier operators at a competitive price.
When 1660SM is used as Add/Drop Multiplexer , mixed STM–N ports can be used in the same configuration thus allowing to manage in the same equipment and at the same time STM–1 , STM–4 and STM–16 rings (multiring) . A large variety of STM–1 optical plug–in modules operating at 1300 nm and 1550 nm is available to cover short and long haul systems. Dedicated optical interfaces are also available to inter–work with boosters and optical pre–amplifiers at all STM–N levels. 1660SM also features “colored” STM–16 interfaces for direct interworking with WDM equipment without intermediate wavelength adapters. All the electrical units (traffic ports) and the common units can be optionally EPS protected with different modularity (1+1; 1+N with 1 v N v15 as far as regards the traffic ports ): –
The EPS protection of the High Speed electrical traffic units ( 34 Mbit/s, 45 Mbit/s and155 Mbit/s) is implemented using a dedicated access module.
–
The EPS protection of the ATM/PR_EA units is implemented.
–
The EPS protection of the ISA–ES16 units is implemented.
According to the network topology, network protection mechanisms are provided: –
Single ended and dual ended MSP (Multiplex Section Protection) can be implemented at any STM–N level.
–
MS–SPRing (Multiple Section Shared Protection Ring) on two fibers bidirectional rings can be implemented at STM–16 level.
A centralized matrix implements the cross–connect function allowing allocation of the PDH and VCi signals into every port, providing add/drop and pass–through functionality at all VCi levels. The maximum matrix cross connection capability can be 96 x 96 STM–1 equivalent port at VC–4 level or 64x64 STM–1 equivalent port at VC–12 / VC–3 level + 32x32 equivalent port at VC–4 level.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
A wide auxiliary capacity, in accordance with SDH standards, is available for embedded services. An Engineering Order Wire channel, with DTMF signalling, can be accessed by a microtelephone for maintenance facility. The clock reference function, housed in the centralized unit, synchronizes the 1660SM and provides generation and distribution of a synchronism clock. The distributed clock can be locked to an external 2MHz or 2Mbit/s source, to any STM–N or 2Mbit/s signal. The SSM (Synchronization Status Message) and priority algorithms are supported.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
67 / 636
Traffic ports have no on–board processor (except for some ISA boards) and may be reused from one equipment to another or retrieve from stocks with no worries about software version. The system can be managed either by a Personal Computer through the F interface or by a Network Management System through the Q interface. Moreover, the 1660SM can work as a Mediation Device for Alcatel NE accessible through Q2/RQ2 interface. In this way, it can be possible to transport information about alarms and configurations of PDH and/or Access Systems to/from a centralized TMN using the standard SDH DCC network. A DC/DC converter, located on each board, guarantees the powering of the system. The distribution of Power Supplies inherently guarantees protection.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Other functionalities :
ED
•
Bidirectional Transmission For the 1660SM optical interface a bidirectional transmission on single fiber function is implemented, using an external passive optical coupler.
•
Remote Equipment Control This function allows a centralized management system for small SDH networks, similar to that offered by an OS. That means that it is possible to perform management functionalities , from one of the NEs of the network, toward the other NEs (up to 31), like configuration modification and remote control.
•
Dual OS O.S. Spare is foreseen to protect the Main one.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
68 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The Equipment Controller function provides unit configuration and collects unit alarms, statuses and performance monitoring data. A Local software download facility is available in order to update the complete software of the control subsystem.
Metro Access Ring
CWDM
2.5/nx2.5G CWDM VC–4/3/12 network PACKET Metro Core Ring/Mesh CWDM 1–N x STM–16
E3/DS3 10/100/GbE
E1/DS1
2.5/nx2.5G CWDM network
Metro Edge Ring (up to 100–X Km)
Metro OMSN VC–4/3/12 PACKET
Metro G OMSN
CWDM
CWDM
VC–4/3/12 PACKET
Core OMSN
CWDM
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Link: up to 100 Km
VC–4/3/12 PACKET
SDH@STM–16
1–N x STM–16
E1/DS1 E3/DS3 STM–n/10GbE
10/100/GbE
E1/DS1 STM–n/10GbE
E3/DS3
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
E/FE
Figure 12. Example of SDH/DATA/CWDM integration in “metro area”
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
69 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
1640FOX
1640FOX
ÑÑ ÑÑ ÑÑ ÌÌÌÌ ÌÌÌÌ ÌÌÌÌ Consolidated bandwidth
ÓÓ ÓÓÌÌÌ ÑÑÔ ÓÓÌÌÌ ÑÑÔ ÔÌÌÌ ÌÌÌ
ÌÌÌÌ ÌÌÌÌ ÌÌÌÌ Ô Ó ÌÌÌÌ Ô Ó ÔÓ
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
1640FOX
ATM Switch
SDH Network
10/100 Base T Full Duplex 1000 BASE –LX 1000 BASE –SX
Ethernet:
1650SMC
1660SM
ÌÌÌÌ ÌÌÌÌ ÌÌÌÌ
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Traffic engineering: MPLS Routing ATM switching
ÌÌÌÌ ÌÌÌÌ ÑÑ Ó ÑÑÌÌÌÌ Ó ÑÑ Ó
Bandwidth control: – ATMM QoS
1650SMC
TDM ATM PR_EA
PDH Interfaces:
TDM ATM PR_EA
SDH Interfaces:
1640FOX
ÌÌÌÌ ÌÌÌÌ ÌÌÌÌ ÌÌÌÌ
Figure 13. Example of ATM Transport management
02
70 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Legend : 1660SM with ISA –PR –
Ethernet/IP Core
Customer Switch/Router Hand –off of aggregated packet traffic to core network
1640FOX
GbE
Overlay MPLS Packet Ring created over VC –4–Xv Bandwidth
1650
L3 Router
STM16 SDH Ring
Fe or GbE 1640FOX
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
1640FOX
ISA –PR does not have to be installed in all ring nodes
End –to–end Metro Ethernet Service created with QoS/SLA
Figure 14. ISA–PR Deployment Scenario
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
71 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 15. Ethernet service application
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
72 / 636
1660SM with LAN to LAN board
Customer box: either LAN Switch or Router
Legenda: protection
SDH level
Ethernet frames are mapped in SDH VC–12. VC–3, VC–4
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The LAN to LAN board is present only at each terminating node
SDH RING NETWORK
mapped on a dedicated SDH VC
Site to Site Traffic is
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1.2 Insertion of the equipment into the network The 1660SM equipment belongs to the Alcatel Optinex family product, compliant with the SDH Synchronous Digital Hierarchy defined by the ITU–T Recs. The equipment 1660SM can be utilized in local, regional and metropolitan networks configured for standard plesiochronous or synchronous systems. The product can be suitably employed on linear, ring and hub networks and on protected or unprotected line links. The equipment applications depends on the different types of networks available. 1.2.1 Configuration •
Terminal multiplexer (see Figure 16. ). The NE is provided with an STM–1/STM–4/STM–16 station interface (eventually stand–by too) to be connected to a Digital Electronic Cross–Connect or to a higher hierarchical line system.
SDH PORT PDH PORTS
NE SDH PORT (SPARE)
Figure 16. Terminal multiplexer •
Add/Drop Multiplexer ( see Figure 17. ) The NE can be programmed to drop (insert) signals from (into) the STM1/STM4/STM–16 stream. Part of the signal pass–through between the line sides, defined A and B in Figure 17. on page 73.
Side A
SDH PORT
SDH PORT
NE
Side B
SDH PORT (SPARE)
SDH PORT (SPARE)
SDH, PDH PORTS
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 17. Add/Drop Multiplexer
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
73 / 636
•
SDH PORT
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
”HUB” STM–N (see Figure 18. ) The NE permits to drop/insert STM–N tributaries into a multiple stream and then branch them off in HUB structures.
SDH PORT
NE
SDH PORT (SPARE)
SDH PORT (SPARE)
SDH PORT Figure 18. ”HUB” STM–1 •
Mixed Configuration The NE can handle in the same node all the previously configuration thus performing a mixed configuration.
1.2.2 Application For each of the above configurations different network topologies may be used. The most important network topologies are: Point to Point Linear Ring and multiring topology Meshed topology
•
Point–to–point link (see Figure 19. ) In this case the NE can be connected to another multiplexer through the line
SDH PORT PDH PORTS
NE
NE
SDH PORT SPARE
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
SDH PORT PDH PORTS
SDH PORT SPARE
Figure 19. Point–to–point links
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
74 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
•
Linear Drop–insert (see Figure 20. ) The NE can be programmed to drop (insert) PDH and SDH ports from (into) the STM–1, STM–4, STM–16 stream or terminate PDH ports SDH PORT
SDH PORT
NE
NE SPARE
SDH PORT
NE
NE
SPARE
SPARE
PDH PORTS
PDH PORTS SDH AND PDH PORTS
SDH AND PDH PORTS
Figure 20. Linear drop–insert •
Ring structure (see Figure 21. ) The drop–insert function permits to realize ring structures. The VC can be automatically rerouted if the optical splice breaks down or one of the equipment nodes fails SDH AND PDH PORTS
STM–4
NE STM–4
RING 1 SDH AND PDH PORTS
NE
SDH AND PDH PORTS
NE
SDH AND PDH PORTS
STM–4
STM–4
NE STM–1
SDH AND PDH PORTS
PDH PORTS
NE
SDH AND PDH PORTS
NE
RING 2 STM–1
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
STM–1
STM–1
NE SDH AND PDH PORTS Figure 21. Ring structure
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
75 / 636
•
The Meshed topology may be used in case of collection of traffic in peripheral nodes or customer premises sites. 1+1 line protection may be used to protect against line failure and, in some cases, node failure could be protected using dual hub topology too. For this type of network topologies the mini digital cross connect system is very useful and SNCP/I is used. PDH PORT
NE STM–N
SDH AND PDH PORTS
STM–N
PDH PORT
STM–1
PDH PORT
NE
RING
NE
NE
STM–N
STM–1
NE
STM–N
PDH PORT NE
STM–N
SDH AND PDH PORTS
STM–N
NE
NE
RING
NE
NE
STM–N
STM–N
STM–N
PDH PORT
NE
STM–N
PDH PORT
SDH AND PDH PORTS STM–N
PDH PORT
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 22. Meshed topology
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
76 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Meshed Topology (see Figure 22. on page 76)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1.2.3 SDH / CWDM integration in “ring” network NOTE: in this paragraph and in the following 1.2.4 on page 81 , 1660SM equipped with Coarse WDM units will be called 1660OADM. 1660SM equipped with “Coarse WDM units” fulfits ’ring’ application by using two possible items according to the traffic matrix to be considered : •
COADM 1 (2) channel;
•
MUX/DEMUX 8 channels.
The use of COADM unit for interfacing WDM ring, allows the operator to duplicate/triplicate the starting network capacity based on a ’single optical channel’ provided by ’pure’ STM–N interfaces.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 23. SDH/CWDM integration in “ring” with COADM units According to the amount of traffic to be handled at a node of the ring, 1(2) channels (λx, λy) out of the 8 specified by ITU–T grid are added/dropped in order to be handled by 1660SM; the remaining channels possibly not terminated, are by–passed, from one side to the opposite one of the node (W to E, E to W) through a specific link (at WDM level) between COADM’s units.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
77 / 636
In Figure 23. the representation of a ’ring’ network using COADM as ring interface is provided; while in Figure 24. the functional parts related to each node of the ring are detailed.
Figure 24. SDH/CWDM integration in “ring” with COADM unit: detailed view In the showed example, ’added/dropped’ wavelengths ( λ1, λ2, ) are terminated by STM16 ’CWDM’ interfaces operating in compliance with the ITU–T grid. Traffic streams terminated are, then, cross–connected at SDH level and made available to the relevant ’client’ interfaces (SDH/PDH/MPLS/Ethernet).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The use of MUX/DEMUX unit for interfacing WDM ring, allows the operator to terminate the whole pool of optical channels available. MUX/DEMUX unit is required when the traffic matrix is larger than the capacity provided by COADM 1(2) channel/s. The application in a ’ring’ network, requires the use of two MUX/DEMUX units respectively for West side interfacing and East side interfacing.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
78 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
COADM unit is specifically devoted to application in a ’ring’ network (due to WDM pass–through link) and requires the use of two separate units respectively for West side interfacing and East side interfacing.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Figure 25. SDH/CWDM integration in “ring” with MUX/DEMUX unit Up to 8 channels may be added/dropped at a node of the ring, according to the amount of traffic to be terminated; while wavelengths not terminated at a node, are by–passed, from one side to the opposite one of the node (W to E, E to W) through a specific link (at channel level) between MUX/DEMUX units. In Figure 25. the representation of a ’ring’ network using MUX/DEMUX as ring interfaces is provided.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
In Figure 26. the functional parts related to each node of the ring are detailed.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
79 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Figure 26. SDH/CWDM integration in “ring” with MUX/DEMUX unit: detailed view
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
In the showed example, 4 wavelengths ( λ1, λ2, λ3, λ4, ) are ’added/dropped’ at a generic node, then terminated by STM16 ’CWDM’ interfaces operating in compliance with the ITU–T grid. As for previous COADM application, traffic streams terminated are cross–connected at SDH level and made available to the relevant ’client’ interfaces (SDH/PDH/MPLS/Ethernet).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
80 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1.2.4 SDH / CWDM integration in “linear” network The use of 16660SM with “Coarse WDM units” in linear network is properly based on MUX/DEMUX unit deployment. As, already seen for ’ring’ application, the use of MUX/DEMUX allows the termination of 8 available channels. Nevertheless, the use of COADMn unit may be considered for those network scenarios whose traffic demand is satisfied by 1 or 2 wavelengths.
Figure 27. SDH/CWDM integration in “linear” network Figure 27. shows a ’linear’ network application for 1660SM. In Figure 28. a detailed vision of a node in this kind of network is also provided; wavelength multi/ demultiplexing is supposed to be performed by MUX/DEMUX unit.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 28. SDH/CWDM integration in “linear” network (MUX/DEMUX): detailed view In the showed example, the whole pool of 8 wavelengths is terminated at the end of the link by STM16 ’CWDM’ interfaces operating in compliance with the ITU–T grid: two shelves are considered in order to allow the equipment of ’colored’ interfaces needed.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
81 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
In Figure 8, the possible use of an COADM unit for wavelength multi/demultiplexing is considered; for this functionality, COADM ’pass–through’ link is not used.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 29. SDH/CWDM integration in “linear” network (COADM unit): detailed view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
82 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1.2.5 Network protection The relationship between the network application with their own protection and the configuration modes is summed up in Table 14. on page 83. Table 14. Network application versus configuration modes
NE Configuration
Network Protection Scheme
TM
Point to Point
MSP
Ǹ
Linear
MSP
Ǹ
Network application
Ring
Ǹ
SNCP
Hub and Meshed
ED
ADM
MSP & SNCP
Ǹ Ǹ
Ǹ
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
83 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
84 / 636 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2 PHYSICAL CONFIGURATION
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
In all this document, three types of cards will be distinguished : •
access card : it is a board containing the signal physical interfaces ( electrical connectors)
•
ports card : it is the board that performs the SDH elaboration of the signal
•
module (electrical or optical) : It is a particular plug–in card ( of small dimensions ) that is inserted on the front panel of some particular boards.
This Chapter illustrates the physical structure, layout and composition, coding and partition of the Equipment and Fans subrack.
EQUIPMENT: The Equipment Shelf front view is illustrated in Figure 30. on page 86. 1660SM is composed of one shelf containing 21 slots in the access area and 20 slots in the basic area. The two areas are located on different “lines” inside the shelf. The main part code and partition are listed in Table 15. on page 89. The accessories codes and partition are listed in Table 16. on page 102. For the relationship between access cards and port cards refer to paragraph 2.3 on page 110. FANS SUBRACKS: The Fans subracks front view is illustrated in Figure 31. on page 87. The main part code and partition are listed in Table 17. on page 104. NOTES: The explanatory notes are reported in Table 18. on page 105. UNITS FRONT VIEW:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
For the units front view refer to para 2.4 on page 120.
N.B.
Table 15. on page 89 contains the units of current equipment release. Units belonging to previous equipment releases/versions (e.g. for configuration updating) are not here listed but still supported, if compatible with the current one. (For eventual units belonging to previous equipment releases/versions refer to the relevant Technical Handbook).
N.B.
The Personal Computer (Craft Terminal) utilized for Initial Turn–on and Maintenance operations is not listed as an item of the equipment, but it can be supplied by Alcatel. See Operator’s Handbook for PC hardware configuration.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
85 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
A
R
E
ED A
S
I
C
A PORT LS – HS TBUS
W20
W35
29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
3AL 91668 AA AA
636 40
W20
PORT ENHANCED – HS
W20
B
MATRIX B
PORT ENHANCED – HS
PORT LS – HS
W20
ACCESS LS – HS ACCESS LS – HS ACCESS LS – HS
W30
SERVICE
ACCESS LS
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
W20
W20
W20
W20
W20
W20
W20
W20
W20
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACCESS LS – HS
ACCESS LS – HS
ACCESS LS – HS
ACCESS LS – HS
ACCESS LS – HS
ACCESS LS – HS
ACCESS LS – HS
ACCESS LS – HS
CONGI B
W20
W20
ACCESS LS – HS CONGI A
11
W20
PORT LS SPARE – HS
W20
ACCESS LS – HS
9 10
PORT LS – HS
PORT HS
W20
25 26 27 28
W20
W20 8
W20
PORT LS – HS
W20
W20
7
PORT ENHANCED – HS
PORT ENHANCED – HS
W20
W20
6
W20
PORT ENHANCED – HS
W20
W20
5
PORT ENHANCED – HS
PORT LS – HS
W20
W20
ACCESS LS – HS 4
W20
PORT ENHANCED – HS
24
W20
23
PORT ENHANCED – HS
22
W20
W20
E ACCESS LS – HS
R 3
PORT LS – HS
A W20
S 2
ACCESS LS – HS
E 1
W20
MATRIX A
C W20
C
ACCESS LS
S
TBUS
EQUICO A
A
W35
W20
2.1 Equipment front view
2.1.1 1660SM Shelf front view
A
41
W = mm width
Figure 30. 1660SM units positioning
02
86 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2.1.2 19” Fans subrack front view
Left side
SLOT 0 SLOT 1
ED Right side
SLOT 2
SLOT 4 SLOT 3 SLOT 5
Figure 31. 19” Fans subrack unit slots
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
87 / 636
In the tables of the following paragraphs are listed, named and coded the items and units making up the Equipment Shelf (see para. 2.2.1 on page 89) and Fans subrack (see para 2.2.2 on page 104). Furthermore, for any item the position and the maximum quantity that can be allocated inside the subracks are indicated too. Such tables report the following information : •
Item Name
•
The ”Acronym” identifying the units is silk–screen printed on the front cover plate. The same Acronym, not provided with the point (e.g. L–4.1 becomes L–41), is used by the Craft Terminal to distinguish the unit. There is in exception to this rule for the P3E3T3; the unit is identified as P3E3T3 on the front cover plate and as P3E3/T3 on the Craft Terminal.
•
Factory and ANV part numbers (e.g. 411.XXX.XXX ; 3ALXXXXX XXXX)
•
Maximum quantity
•
Position of the unit inside the equipment. Refer to Figure 30. at page 86 for slot numbering.
•
Number of explanatory notes
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Table 18. on page 105 (see para 2.2.3 on page 105) reports all the explanatory notes .
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
88 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2.2 Part list
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2.2.1 Equipment Shelf part list
Table 15. Main part list NAME
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
3AL 78834 AA–– (593.155.059E)
–
–
SR60M
3AL 79157 AA–– (593.155.073 U)
1
–
1
TBUS
3AL 79088 AC–– (487.166.408 B)
2
23, 40
2
3AL 81728 AA––
1
––
3
ACRONYM
MECHANICAL STRUCTURE 1660SM SHELF Made up of: 1660SM SHELF
TERMINATION BUS/2 SFP EXTRACTOR LOW SPEED PORTS (PDH)
63x2 MBIT/S PORT 1.0/2.3
4
P63E1
63x2 MBIT/S G703/ISDN– P63E1N–M4 PRA–FS PORT
3AL 79092 AA–– (474.166.425 V )
3AL 79092AC–– (474.166.046 C)
7
24, 27, 30, 32, 33, 36, 39
5
7
24, 27, 30, 32, 33, 36, 39
5 6
HIGH SPEED PORTS (PDH) 3x34/45 MBIT/S SWIT. PORT
7 P3E3T3
3AL 78864 AA–– (474.156.339L)
16
24 to 39
HIGH SPEED PORTS : STM–1 (SDH) and 140 Mbit/s (PDH) P4ES1N
3AL 78823 AA–– (474.166.423T)
4 X 140/STM1 SWITCH. O/E PORT/1
P4E4N
3AL 79263 AA–– (474.156.371L)
4x STM–1 PORT/1
P4S1N
3AL 78821 BA–– (474.156.375 Q)
4 x STM–1 ELECTRICAL PORT/1
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
NOTES
ED
8 9 10
16
24 to 39
11 12 12
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
89 / 636
ACRONYM
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
NOTES
3AL 81736 AA–– (474.156.186 U)
16
24 to 39
12
6
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38 30+31 32+33
13
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NAME
HIGH SPEED PORTS : OC3 (SONET) 4 x OC3 PORT
AU3/TU3 CONV.
P4OC3
4 x ANY CONCENTRATOR
4 x ANY HOST C
4XANYC
3AL 81635 AA–– (411.102.533 K)
HIGH SPEED PORTS : STM–4 (SDH)
9
S–4.1 PORT/1 FC/PC
S–4.1N
3AL 78856 BA–– (474.156.376 R)
S–4.1 PORT/1 SC/PC
S–4.1N
3AL 78856 BB–– (474.156.377 J)
L–4.1 PORT/1 FC/PC
L–4.1 N
3AL 78856 BC–– (474.156.378 T)
L–4.1 PORT/1 SC/PC
L–4.1 N
3AL 78856 BD–– (474.156.379 U)
L–4.2 PORT/1 FC/PC
L–4.2N
3AL 78856 BE–– (474.156.380 J)
L–4.2 PORT/1 SC/PC
L–4.2N
3AL 78856 BF–– (474.156.381 F)
4 x STM–4 PORT
P4S4N
3AL 79176 AA–– (411.101.062 V)
16
24 to 39
4
25,26, 28,29, 34,35, 37,38
14 15
16
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(Table continues)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
90 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NAME
ACRONYM
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
HIGH SPEED PORTS : STM–16 (SDH)
9, 17
S–16.1 PORT FC/PC/16C
S–16.1ND
3AL 78894 CA–– (411.101.308 R)
S–16.1 PORT SC /16C
S–16.1ND
3AL 78895 CA–– (411.101.309 J)
L–16.1 PORT FC/PC/16C
L–16.1ND
3AL 78896 CA–– (411.101.310 E)
L–16.1 PORT SC/16C
L–16.1ND
3AL 78897 CA–– (411.101.311 T)
L–16.2 PORT FC/PC/16C
L–16.2ND
3AL 78898 CA–– (411.101.312 U)
L–16.2 PORT SC/16C
L–16.2ND
3AL 78899 CA–– (411.101.313 V)
L–16.2 JE2 PORT FC/PC/16C
L–16.2ND
3AL 79029 CA–– (411.101.316 Y)
L–16.2 JE2 PORT SC/PC/16C
L–16.2ND
3AL 79029 CB–– (411.101.317 Z)
L–16.2 JE3 PORT FC/PC/16C CH34
L–16.2ND
3AL 79030 DA–– (411.102.549 B)
L–16.2 JE3 PORT SC/PC/16C CH34
L–16.2ND
3AL 79030 DB–– (411.102.550 G)
I–16.1 PORT /SFF (Intra office)
STM 16 PORT SFP
NOTES
I–16.1ND
3AL 80881AA–– (411.102.022 N)
CO–16
3AL 81434 AA–– (411.102.522 Q)
4
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38
14 15
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38
14 15 18
4
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38
14 19
4
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38
20
4
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(Table continues)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
91 / 636
ACRONYM
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
NOTES
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38
14 21
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38
14 22
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NAME
HIGH SPEED PORTS : STM–16 COLORED PORT (SDH) STM16 195.7 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C
L–16.2ND
3AL 79187 BA–– (411.101.320 G)
STM16 195.5 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C
L–16.2ND
3AL 79187 BB–– (411.101.321 V)
STM16 195.3 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C
L–16.2ND
3AL 79187 BC–– (411.101.322 W)
STM16 195.1 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C
L–16.2ND
3AL 79187 BD–– (411.101.323 X)
STM16 194.9 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C
L–16.2ND
3AL 79187 BE–– (411.101.324 Y)
STM16 194.7 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C
L–16.2ND
3AL 79187 BF–– (411.101.325 Z)
STM16 194.5 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C
L–16.2ND
3AL 79187 BG–– (411.101.326 S)
STM16 194.3 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C
L–16.2ND
3AL 79187 BH–– (411.101.327 T)
STM16 193.7 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C STM16 193.5 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C STM16 193.3 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C STM16 193.1 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C STM16 192.9 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C STM16 192.7 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C STM16 192.5 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C STM16 192.3 PORT 6400 SC/PC/16C
L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND
3AL 79187 BL–– (411.101.328 C) 3AL 79187 BM–– (411.101.329 D) 3AL 79187 BN–– (411.101.330 A) 3AL 79187 BP–– (411.101.331 X) 3AL 79187 BQ–– (411.101.332 Y) 3AL 79187 BR–– (411.101.333 Z) 3AL 79187 BS–– (411.101.334 S) 3AL 79187 BT–– (411.101.335 T)
4
4
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(Table continues)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
92 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NAME
ACRONYM
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
NOTES
4
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38
14 21
4
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38
14 22
HIGH SPEED PORTS : STM–16 COLORED PORT (SDH) STM16 195.7 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 195.5 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 195.3 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 195.1 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 194.9 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 194.7 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 194.5 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 194.3 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 193.7 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 193.5 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 193.3 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 193.1 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 192.9 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 192.7 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 192.5 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C STM16 192.3 PORT 12800 SC/PC/16C
L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND L–16.2ND
3AL 79188 BA–– (411.101.336 U) 3AL 79188 BB–– (411.101.337V) 3AL 79188 BC–– (411.101.338 E) 3AL 79188 BD–– (411.101.339 F) 3AL 79188 BE–– (411.101.340 L) 3AL 79188 BF–– (411.101.341 H) 3AL 79188 BG–– (411.101.342 A) 3AL 79188 BH–– (411.101.343 B) 3AL 79188 BL–– (411.101.344 C) 3AL 79188 BM–– (411.101.345 D) 3AL 79188 BN–– (411.101.346 E) 3AL 79188 BP–– (411.101.347 F) 3AL 79188 BQ–– (411.101.348 Q) 3AL 79188 BR–– (411.101.349 R) 3AL 79188 BS–– (411.101.350N) 3AL 79188 BT–– (411.101.351 B)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(Table continues)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
93 / 636
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
ETH–MB
3AL 80407 AA–– (474.156.038 A)
6
24 to 39
GETH–MB
3AL 80702 AB–– ––.––.––
8
24 to 39
ATM MATRIX 4X4
ATM4X4
3AL 79093 AA–– (411.101.035 J)
ATM MATRIX 4X4 ENHANCED
ATM4X4V2
3AL 81185 AA–– (411.102.475 Z)
ATM4X4D3
3AL 89917 AA–– ––.––.––
ATM8X8
3AL 79094 AA–– (411.101.036 K)
PREA4ETH
3AL 79631 AA–– (411.101.281 W)
PREA1GBE
3AL 81275 AA–– (411.102.505 Y)
ISA–PR
3AL 89677 AA–– ––.––.––
3
25 to 38
ISA–ES1 8FE
ES1–8FE
3AL 98128AA–– ––.––.––
8
24 to 39
ISA–ES1 8FX
ES1–8FX
3AL 98150AA–– ––.––.––
8
24 to 39
ISA–ES4 8FE + 1GE
ES4–8FE
3AL81879 AA–– (474.156.195 V)
ISA–ES16
3AL81915 AA–– ––.––.––
COWLA2
3AL 81427 AA–– (411.102.520 S)
NOTES All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
NAME ISA – ETHERNET PORT ETHERNET PORT
GIGABIT ETHERNET PORT/2
23
24 25
ISA – ATM PARTS 26 24 to 39
27
4 ATM MATRIX 4X4 D3
ATM MATRIX 8X8
28
24 to 38
29
ISA – PR_EA PARTS PR_EA MATRIX 4X ETHERNET
30 4
PR_EA MATRIX 1XGB–ETH
24 to 39 31
ISA – PR PARTS PR MATRIX 4X STM4 PLUG–IN
32
ISA – ES PARTS
ISA–ES16 BOARD
33
34 8
24 to 39
16
24 to 39
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
CWDM PORTS 2xCH TRANSPONDER SFP W/O OPTICS
ED
35
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
94 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NAME
ACRONYM
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
18
1 to 9, 13 to 21
NOTES
LS (LOW SPEED) ACCESS CARDS 21x2 MBIT/S PROT. 75 OHM 1.0/2.3
A21E1
3AL78831AA–– (474.156.323C)
21x2 MBIT/S PROT. 120 OHM
A21E1
3AL78832AA–– (474.156.324D)
21x2 MBIT/S PROT. 120 OHM K20
A21E1
3AL 79163 AA–– (474.156.366 P)
36, 37
38
36
HS (HIGH SPEED) ACCESS CARDS 3x34 MBIT/S 75 OHM
A3E3
3AL78865AB–– (474.156.181 X)
3x45 MBIT/S 75 OHM
A3T3
3AL78866AB–– (474.156.182 Y)
4xSTM–1 ELECTRICAL 75 OHM
A4ES1
3AL78835AA–– (474.156.325E)
HIGH SPEED PROTECTION
HPROT
3AL 78849 AA–– (474.156.127 Y)
8
2 to 9, 13 to 20
41
2x140/STM–1 O/E ADAPTER
A2S1
3AL78818AA–– (474.166.421Z)
16
2 to 9, 13 to 20
42
3AL 80404 AA–– (474.156.039 B)
6
16
2 to 9, 13 to 20
39
40
ISA – ETHERNET ACCESS CARDS ETHERNET ACCESS GIGABIT ETHERNET ACCESS/2
ETH–ATX
GETH–AG
3AL 80411 AB––
8
43 2 to 9, 13 to 20
44
ISA – PR ACCESS CARDS ISA–PR 16XETH 10/100 ACCESS
16FEA–PR
3AL 89678 AA–– ––.––.–– 6
ISA–PR 2XGBE 1000 ACCESS PLUG–IN
2 GBA–PR
3AL 89679AA–– ––.––.––
2 to 8, 13 to 20
45 46
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(Table continues)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
95 / 636
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
NOTES
CONGI
3AL78830AD–– ––
2
10, 12
47
SERVICE
3AL78817AA–– (411.100.704R)
1
11
48
ACRONYM
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NAME
CONTROL AND GENERAL INTERFACE CONTROL AND GENERAL INTERFACE R5 SERVICE SERVICES I/F
BOOSTER AND PREAMPLIFIER OMSN BOOSTER +10dBm FC/PC
BST10
3AL 78962 AA–– (411.100.902 G)
OMSN BOOSTER +10dBm SC/PC
BST10
3AL 78962 BA–– (411.101.245 H)
OMSN BOOSTER +15dBm FC/PC
BST15
3AL 78962 AC–– (411.100.904 A)
OMSN BOOSTER +15dBm SC/PC
BST15
3AL 78962 BC–– (411.101.247 B)
OMSN BOOSTER +17dBm FC/PC
BST17
3AL 78962 AD–– (411.100.905 B)
OMSN BOOSTER +17dBm SC/PC
BST17
3AL 78962 BD–– (411.101.248 L)
PREAMPLIFIER 2.5 GB/S SC/PC CH34
PR16
3AL 78963 AD–– (411. 102.557 T)
PREAMPLIFIER 2.5 GB/S FC/PC CH34
PR16
2 to 8 13 to 19
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
8
ED
49
2 to 8 13 to 19
3AL 78963 AC–– (411.102.558 C)
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
96 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NAME
ACRONYM
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
8
1 to 8 13 to 20
NOTES
CWDM CONNECTION MODULES COADM 1 CH (1470)
COADM1
3AL 81344 AA–– (411.102.513P)
COADM 1 CH (1490)
COADM1
3AL 81344 AB–– (411.102.542 U)
COADM 1 CH (1510)
COADM1
3AL 81344 AC–– (411.102.543 V)
COADM 1 CH (1530)
COADM1
3AL 81344 AD–– (411.102.544 W)
COADM 1 CH (1550)
COADM1
3AL 81344 AE–– (411.102.545 X)
COADM 1 CH (1570)
COADM1
3AL 81344 AF–– (411.102.546 Y)
COADM 1 CH (1590)
COADM1
3AL 81344 AG–– (411.102.547 Z)
COADM 1 CH (1610)
COADM1
3AL 81344 AH–– (411.102.548 A)
COADM 2 CH (1470–1490)
COADM2
3AL 81346 AA–– (411.102.541 R)
COADM 2 CH (1510–1530)
COADM2
3AL 81346 AB–– (411.102.539 Z)
COADM 2 CH (1550–1570)
COADM2
3AL 81346 AC–– (411.102.540 E)
COADM 2 CH (1590–1610)
COADM2
3AL 81346 AD–– (411.102.541 T)
MUX – DEMUX 8 CH.
COMDX8
3AL 81348 AA–– (411.102.517 K)
ED
49
8
1 to 8 13 to 20
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
97 / 636
ACRONYM
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
S–1.1 OPT. INTERF. FC/PC
IS–1.1
3AL78815AA–– (474.166.420 C)
S–1.1 OPT. INTERF. SC/PC
IS–1.1
3AL 78815 AB–– (474.166.424 U)
L–1.1 OPT. INTERF. FC/PC
IL–1.1
3AL78838AA–– (474.156.326 F)
L–1.1 OPT. INTERF. SC/PC
IL–1.1
3AL 78838 AB–– (474.156.352 R)
L–1.2 OPT. INTERF. FC/PC
IL–1.2
3AL78839AA–– (474.156.327 G)
L–1.2 OPT. INTERF. SC/PC
IL–1.2
3AL 78839 AB–– (474.156.353 J)
L–1.2 JE OPT. INTERF. FC/PC
IL–1.2
3AL78840AA–– (474.156.328 R)
L–1.2 JE OPT. INTERF. SC/PC
IL–1.2
3AL 78840 AB–– (474.156.354 K)
140/155 ELECTRICAL INTERFACE
ICMI
3AL37558AB–– (474.156.346 K)
53
STM–1 MULTIMODE OPT SC/PC
MM1
3AL 80741 AA–– (474.166.035 Z)
50
Max. Qty
SLOT
NOTES All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NAME STM–1 MODULES
50,51
64
––
50,51,52
STM–4 MODULES S–4.1 OPTICAL INTERF. FC/PC S–4.1 OPTICAL INTERF. SC/PC L–4.1 OPTICAL INTERF. FC/PC L–4.1 OPTICAL INTERF. SC/PC L–4.2 OPTICAL INTERF. FC/PC L–4.2 OPTICAL INTERF. SC/PC
IS–4.1
IL–4.1
IL–4.2
3AL 79340 AA–– 474.156.372 M 3AL 79451 AA–– 474.156.384 A 3AL 79452 AA–– 474.156.385 B 3AL 79452 AB–– 474.156.386 C
8
––
54
3AL 79453 AA–– 474.156.387 D 3AL 79453 AB–– 474.156.388 N
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
4xANY MODULES 4 X ANY HS PLUG–IN 1310 (OH–I)
OH–I
3AL 81616 AA–– (474.156.178 K)
12
Refer to Figure 51.
55
4 X ANY LS PLUG–IN 1310 (OL–I)
OL–IN
3AL 81617 AA–– (474.156.179 L)
24
Refer to Figure 51.
56
4 X ANY HS PLUG–IN 850
OH–MM
3AL81613 AA–– (474.156.175 G)
12
Refer to Figure 51.
55
4 X ANY LS PLUG–IN 850
OL–MM
3AL81615 AA–– (474.156.177 A)
24
Refer to Figure 51.
56
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
98 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NAME
ACRONYM
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
NOTES
64
––
57 58
1AB 194670001
64
––
58
1AB 196360001
8
––
58
ETHERNET “SFP” OPTICAL MODULES OPTO TRX 1.25GBE SFP–LX 1000B–LX OPTO TRX 1.25GBE SFP–SX 1000B–SX
1AB 18728 0001
1000B
OPTO TRX 1.25GBE SFP–ZX 1000B–ZX
1AB 18728 0002
1AB 18728 0028
STM–1 “SFP” OPTICAL MODULES OPTO TRX SFP S–1.1
100B
STM–4 “SFP” OPTICAL MODULES OPTO TRX SFP S–4.1
S S–4.1
STM–16 “SFP” OPTICAL MODULES (Black and white) OPTO TRX SFP S–16.1
SS–161
1AB 19637 0001
OPTO TRX SFP L–16.1
SL–161
1AB 19637 0004
OPTO TRX SFP L–16.2
SL–162
1AB 19637 0003
–– 4
––
58
––
CWDM “SFP” OPTICAL MODULES (colored) CWDM 1470 NM PIN PLUGIN
SS–162C
1AB 19634 0001
CWDM 1490 NM PIN PLUGIN
SS–162C
1AB 19634 0002
CWDM 1510 NM PIN PLUGIN
SS–162C
1AB 19634 0003
CWDM 1530 NM PIN PLUGIN
SS–162C
1AB 19634 0004
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
16 CWDM 1550 NM PIN PLUGIN
SS–162C
1AB 19634 0005
CWDM 1570 NM PIN PLUGIN
SS–162C
1AB 19634 0006
CWDM 1590 NM PIN PLUGIN
SS–162C
1AB 19634 0007
CWDM 1610 NM PIN PLUGIN
SS–162C
1AB19634 0008
ED
––
58
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
99 / 636
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
CWDM 1470 NM APD PLUGIN
SL–162C
1AB19635 0001
CWDM 1490 NM APD PLUGIN
SL–162C
1AB19635 0002
CWDM 1510 NM APD PLUGIN
SL–162C
1AB19635 0003
CWDM 1530 NM APD PLUGIN
SL–162C
1AB19635 0004
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
CWDM 1550 NM APD PLUGIN
SL–162C
1AB19635 0005
CWDM 1570 NM APD PLUGIN
SL–162C
1AB19635 0006
CWDM 1590 NM APD PLUGIN
SL–162C
1AB19635 0007
CWDM 1610 NM APD PLUGIN
SL–162C
1AB19635 0008
ED
Max. Qty
SLOT
NOTES
16
––
58
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
NAME
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
100 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NAME
ACRONYM
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
NOTES
EQUICO
3AL78836AA–– (411.100.708V)
1
22
59
MATRIXN
3AL78848BA–– (411.101.244 G)
2
23,40
60
MEM–DEV
1AB 17634 0002 ––––
1
––
61
CONTROLLER EQUIPMENT CONTROLLER MATRIX MATRIX /1 FLASH CARD FLASH CARD 256 MB –20/85° C
(End of table)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
101 / 636
Table 16. Accessories list ACRONYM
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
DUMMY PLATE W20
––
3AN49397AA–– (299.701.587 J)
32
––
DUMMY PLATE W30
––
3AN49399AA–– (299.701.590 Z)
1
––
DUMMY PLATE W35
––
3AN49400AA–– (299.701.591 N)
1
––
TELEPHONE HANDSET
––
1AF00398AA–– (013.200.016A)
1
––
65
S9 INSTALLATION KIT
––
3AL78913AA– (299.701.333 S)
1
––
66
OPTINEX RACK INST. KIT X OMSN
––
3AL79463AA–– (299.701.747 H)
1
––
67
40A 72V CIRCUIT BREAKER
––
2
––
68
15A 72V CIRCUIT BREAKER
––
1AB016271 0006 (001.791.356 L)
2
––
69
16A CIRCUIT BREAKER
––
1AB024380012 (001.700.121 J)
2
––
70
4A 72Vdc CIRCUIT BREAKER
––
1AB 162710003 (001.791.353 R)
2
––
71
4A CIRCUIT BREAKER
––
1AB 024380010 (001700122K)
2
––
72
19” / 21” ADAPTER KIT
––
3CA 08540 AA–– (299.701.597 L)
1
––
73
CAPS ESD COMMON PART OMSN
––
3AL 79266 AA–– (299.701.877 U)
1
––
CAPS ESD 1.0/2.3 OMSN
––
3AL 79267 AA–– (299.701.878 D)
38
––
CAPS ESD SUB/D OMSN
––
3AL 79268 AA–– (299.701.879 E)
6
––
CASE EMC 1.0/2.3 FOR CABLE 3.6 mm
––
3AL 80915 AA–– (298.701.209 N)
64
––
75
120 OHM KIT FOR CABLE SUPPORT
––
3AN 50125 AA–– (299.701.063 X)
2
––
76
SM JUMPER FC/PC 1,35 MT
––
16
––
77
NOTES All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NAME
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
EQUIPMENT ACCESSORIES
SM JUMPER SC/PC 1,35 MT
ED
––
1AB16271 0015
62 63 64
74
1AB 07984 0025 1AB 08001 0065
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
102 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
NAME
ACRONYM
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
NOTES
KIT T_BUS UPGRADE FOR ISA APPLICATION
––
3AL 81202 AA (299.701.228 H)
1
––
78
KIT SM/MM 50 um PATCH CORD
––
3AL 81465 AA–– (299.701.237 S)
64
––
79
KIT SM/MM 62.5 um PATCH CORD
––
3AL 81466 AA–– (299.701.2378B)
64
––
79
KIT–CABLING ETHERNET
––
3AL 81639 AA––
1
––
80
120 OHM NEW CONNECTOR KIT
––
3AL80834 AA–– (299.701.066 S)
54
––
81
1.0/2.3 COAXIAL CONNECTOR (3mm)
––
1AB061220003 (040.144.001N)
764
––
82
1.0/2.3 MALE COAXIAL CONNECTOR 75 OHM (3.6 mm)
––
1AB009720049 ––
128
––
83
1.0/2.3 MALE COAXIAL CONNECTOR BALUN
––
1AB158340001 (040.144.010J)
8
––
84
RJ45 MALE CONNECTORS 8 WIRES IDC CAT. 6
––
1AB074610019 ––
300
––
85
TBUS
3AL 79088 AC–– (487.166.408 B)
1
–
EXTRACTORS KIT
––
3AL 79497 AA–– (299.701.341 A)
1
––
SFP MODULE PLUG–IN TOOL
––
3AL 81728 AA––
1
––
DUST FILTER FOR FAN SHELF 19”
––
3AL 80371 AA–– (299.908.007 Y)
2
––
OFFICE SIDE ACCESSORIES
SPARE PARTS TERMINATION BUS/2
SOFTWARE
86
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(End of table)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
103 / 636
2.2.2 Fans Subrack 19” part list
NAME
ACRONYM
ANV Part Number (Factory Part Number)
Max. Qty
SLOT
SRFAN
3AL79773AA–– (593.153.008 A)
1
–
FAN
3AL 79772 AA–– (411.101.423 L)
4
0,1,2,3
––
3AL 80371 AA–– (299.908.007 Y)
2
4,5
––
3AL 81812 AA––
2
4.5
NOTES
MECHANICAL STRUCTURE FANS SHELF 19” ACCESSORIES FAN UNIT FOR FAN SHELF 19” DUST FILTER SHELF 19”
FOR
METALLIC FAN GRID
FAN
87
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(End of table)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
104 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 17. Fans Subrack 19” part list
2.2.3 Explanatory notes
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 18. Explanatory notes Note
ED
Explanation
1
It is the main shelf of the equipment, also with the back panel
2
Mandatory unit. Used to provide voltage logical reference to all Control and Auxiliary bus.
3
Extractors used to remove the SFP module.
4
As Low Speed ports are intended the 2 Mbit/s speed ports
5
To be used with the LS access cards. Three access cards are needed to fully connect the port’s channel. The P63E1, P63E1N–M4 spare port must be inserted in slot 32.
6
The board supports the NT functionality, performance monitoring, Retiminig and Frame Slip functionalities.
7
As High Speed PDH ports are intended the 34 Mbit/s and the 45 Mbit/s ports
8
The same board can be used as 3x34 Mbit/s or 3x45Mbit/s but its corresponding access cards are separated (i.e A3E3 for 3x34 Mbit/s and A3T3 for 3x45 Mbit/s)
9
As High Speed SDH ports are intended STM–1, STM–4, STM–16 ports
10
The port needs an access card with 4 STM–1 electrical interfaces
11
Each port of this board can be configured as 140 Mbit/s or STM–1.
12
The port needs four (electrical or optical) modules to reach the maximum capability of four channels. Two modules have to be inserted on the card front panel and two on the corresponding access card 2 x STM–1 front panel (A2S1). Notice that different kind of access module (electrical and optical, also of different characteristic and connectors) can be inserted in the port card or in the access card
13
The unit is two slot wide and it can house up to 4 optical modules (OH–I, OL–IN, OH–MM, OL– MM). For details about the max. board capabilty refer to paragraph 3.10 on page 282.
14
The ports does not need access card
15
Ports supplied with different connectors types
16
The board is used in conjunction with ISA–PR board and does not support Low Order traffic termination. Two modules have to be inserted on the card front panel. Notice that different kind of STM–4 modules (also of different characteristic and connectors) can be inserted in the port card .
17
STM–16 port is two slot wide
18
Ports to be used with the Booster
19
The board is used to interconnect distances less than approximately 2Km (intra–office application)
20
The unit is two slot wide and must be equipped with removable SFP optical module. Refer to Figure 72. on page 161 for relationship between SFP modules and relevant Housing board.
21
Port used as input for the WDM equipment (blue band)
22
Port used as input for the WDM equipment (red band)
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
105 / 636
23
The board has #11 RJ45 interfaces
24
The board can be equipped with up to four 1.25 Gbit/s Modules. Refer to Figure 72. on page 161 for relationship between SFP modules and relevant Housing board. The max. quantity of GETH–MB units that can be equipped depends on the CONGI type present in the subrack as indicated in the folllowing: a) 8 GETH–MB units if CONGI type 3AL 78830 AB–– is equipped in the subrack b) 8 GETH–MB units if CONGI type 3AL 78830 AC–– is equipped in the subrack c) 6 GETH–MB units if CONGI type 3AL 78830 AA–– is equipped in the subrack
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
25
ED
Explanation
26
The unit provides a STM–1 interface on the front coverplate. It manages up to 16 ports configurable as: SDH VC–4, SDH VC–3, SDH VC–12, PDH 34M, PDH 2M. The max throughput towards backpanel is 622 Mbit/s. The unit supports the PNNI.
27
It manages up to 252 ports configurable as: SDH VC–4, SDH VC–3, SDH VC–12, PDH 45M, PDH 34M, PDH 2M. The max throughput towards backpanel is 622 Mbit/s. The unit supports the IMA.
28
It manages up to 16 ports configurable as: SDH VC–4, SDH VC–3, SDH VC–12, PDH 45M, PDH 34M, PDH 2M. The max throughput towards backpanel is 622 Mbit/s. The unit supports the IMA.
29
The board is two slot wide. It manages up to 16+16 ports configurable as: SDH VC–4, SDH VC4–C, SDH VC–3, SDH VC–12, PDH 45M, PDH 34M, PDH 2M. The max throughput towards backpanel is 1.2 Gbit/s. The unit supports the PNNI.
30
With a max. data throughput of 1Gb/s, it allows the transportation of MPLS packets over SDH, their routing, and the traffic congestion management. It hosts, further, 4x 10/100BaseT interfaces carring MPLS over ethernet.
31
With a max. data throughput of 1.6 Gb/s, it allows the transportation of MPLS packets over SDH, their routing, and the traffic congestion management. The board can be equipped with one 1.25 Gbit/s Modules. Refer to Figure 72. on page 161 for relationship between SFP modules and relevant Housing board.
32
The board is two slot wide. With a max. data throughput of 6.5 Gb/s data throughput, it allows the transportation of ethernet packets over SDH, their routing, and the traffic congestion management. It hosts four STM4 SFP optical modules interfacing physical line (Refer to Figure 72. on page 161 for relationship between SFP modules and relevant Housing board). Two access cards max are used for each PR board. Mixed access cards configuration are allowed.
33
The unit must be equipped with SFP optical module. Refer to Figure 72. on page 161 for relationship between SFP modules and relevant Housing board.
34
The unit can be equipped with one SFP 1.25 Gbit/s Modules. Refer to Figure 72. on page 161 for relationship between SFP modules and relevant Housing board.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
106 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Note
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Note
Explanation
35
The board must be equipped with SFP optical module “colored” (1470 – 1610 nm) or “Black and White”. The max. number of SFP module per board is equal to four. Refer to Figure 72. on page 161 for relationship between SFP modules and relevant Housing board.
36
Protected LS access card . Allow the bidirectional connection of up to twenty–one 2 Mbit/s channels. To be used in EPS protected configurations.
37
Compliant with ITU K20 norms
38
HS access card dedicated to the 3x34 port. Allows the bidirectional connection of up to three 34 Mbit/s channels.
39
HS access card dedicated to the 3x45 port. Allows the bidirectional connection of up to three 45 Mbit/s channels.
40
HS access card to be used for the 4 x STM–1 electrical port. Allows the bidirectional connection of up to 4 channels
41
To be used in an EPS protection scheme as access card for the HS electrical spare port. (3x34 Mbit/s, 3x45 Mbit/s and 155 Mbit/s)
42
The access card needs up to 2 optical or electrical modules to be inserted inside
43
The board has #14 RJ45 interfaces.
44
The board can be used in conjunction with the ETH–MB. If used in conjunction with ETH–MB the access card provides up to two Gigabit Ethernet Interface; in this configuration only the two upper interfaces present on the access card can be used for Gbit Ethernet application. For details on slot position refer to Table 25. on page 116.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The access card can be equipped with SFP Optical module. Refer to Figure 72. on page 161 for relationship between SFP modules and relevant Housing board.
ED
45
The board has 16 RJ45 interfaces at 10/100 Mbit/s. It is used in conjunction with the ISA–PR Card for data access.
46
The board has 2 plug–in interfaces at 1 Gbit/s (Refer to Figure 72. on page 161 for relationship between SFP modules and relevant Housing board) It is used in conjunction with the ISA–PR Card for data access.
47
A max of two Control and General interfaces can be used. Delivers two voltage levels to all the cards. Provides external connectors for housekeepings, remote alarms, rack lamps, Q interface, LAN interface. If two CONGI cards are inserted, they provide different interfaces.
48
Provides the connectors for the auxiliary , EOW channels and the synchronization interfaces.
49
The board is two slot wide
50
Up to 2 of these modules are inserted on the following cards : P4E4N, P4S1N and A2S1 to realize optical connections for a maximum of 2 STM–1 channels. Only one of these modules can be inserted in the ATM matrix 4X4. With the MM1 module must be ordered also the specific patch cord in order to reach the multimode characteristics (50um patch cord or 62 um patch cord).
51
Optical modules supplied with different connectors.
52
Optical modules to be used with the Booster
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
107 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
Explanation
53
Up to 2 of these modules are inserted on the following cards : P4E4N, P4S1N and A2S1 to realize electrical connections for a maximum of 2 STM–1 or 140 Mbit/s channels . Only one of these modules can be inserted in the ATM matrix 4X4.
54
Up of 2 of these modules are inserted on the P4S4N card to realize optical connections for a maximum of 2 STM–4 channels (one for module).Optical modules supplied with different connectors (SC/PC or FC/PC).
55
Used for: Fiber Channel, FICON, Gigabit Ethernet
56
Used for: Fast Ethernet, FDDI, ESCON, Digital Video.
57
Due to access limitation only two of this modules can be equipped when GETH–AG is used in conjunction with ETH–MB.
58
Refer to Figure 72. on page 161 for relationship between SFP modules and relevant Housing board.
59
Equipment Controller card provides the F interface for the Craft Terminal connection
60
Two MATRIX cards can be used in a 1+1 protected EPS configuration. The card performs connection and cross–connection functionalities and moreover synchronization functionalities.
61
It contains the equipment data base . To be used for running “SDH” and “ATM” software
62
It is essential to insert the relevant dummy plates on the spaces left by the port or access modules units not supplied in order to obtain the EMI/EMC performances.
63
Dummy plate for unequipped SERVICES I/F unit
64
Dummy plate for unequipped MATRIX unit
65
Optional telephone handset associated to the SERVICES I/F card.
66
Set needed to install in the S9 rack.
67
It is necessary when Optinex rack is employed
68
To be used with 3AL 78830 AD–– CONTROL AND GENERAL INTERFACE
69
To be used for external subrack protection when OPTINEX rack is used
70
To be used for external subrack protection when S9 rack is used
71
To be used in Optinex rack (TRU) to power the Fan Shelf
72
To be used in S9 rack (TRU) to power the Fan Shelf
73
Mechanical adaptor utilized to insert the subrack in “21” rack.
74
Protection cups to be used to respect the ESD precaution. At the end of the installation phase all the connectors not used for cabling must be covered with the relevant “protection caps”
75
To be used for EMC performance. One for each 140/155 ELECTRICAL INTERFACE (ICMI)
76
To be installed when 120 Ohm connector are used for 2Mbit/s signals.
77
Must be provided with optical boosters in order to perform connection with STM–4 or STM–16 ports.
78
Upgrade for ATM functionality.
79
Must be used in conjunction with “STM–1 MULTIMODE OPT SC/PC” Optical Module
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
108 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Note
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ED
Note
Explanation
80
Cable duct to be used during the installation phase. It allows the electrical cables separation from the optical cables.
81
Every kit contains #1 connectors for 7x2 Mbit/s interface 120 Ohm
82
To be used for the 2 Mbit/s connections and for the synchronism on SERVICES I/F card.
83
To be used for the 34/45 Mbit/s and STM–1 electrical connections
84
To be used only with SERVICES I/F port card. It allows the 75/120 Ohm conversion.
85
To be used with the relevant cable, in the installation phase for connections to Ethernet port.
86
Details concerning the software P/N are given in the Operator’s Handbook.
87
Can be used as alternative to the “Dust filter for fan shelf 19”; It doesn’t require maintenance.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
109 / 636
Table 19. Relationship between P63E1, P63E1N–M4 (63 X 2 Mbit/s unit) port card and A21E1 access card Port Card acronym
Port Card Slot
24
27
30
P63E1, P63E1N–M4
32 (spare)
33
36
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
39
ED
Access Card acronym
Access Card Slot
A21E1
1 (CH. 1–21)
A21E1
2 (CH. 22–42)
A21E1
3 (CH. 43–63)
A21E1
4 (CH. 1–21)
A21E1
5 (CH. 22–42)
A21E1
6 (CH. 43–63)
A21E1
7 (CH. 1–21)
A21E1
8 (CH. 22–42)
A21E1
9 (CH. 43–63)
––––––
––––––
A21E1
13 (CH. 1–21)
A21E1
14 (CH. 22–42)
A21E1
15 (CH. 43–63)
A21E1
16 (CH. 1–21)
A21E1
17 (CH. 22–42)
A21E1
18 (CH. 43–63)
A21E1
19 (CH. 1–21)
A21E1
20 (CH. 22–42)
A21E1
21 (CH. 43–63)
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
110 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2.3 Relationship between Port Card and Access Card
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 20. Relationship between P3E3T3 (3X34/45 Mbit/s Switchable unit) port card and A3E3 access card (3X34 Mbit/s) Port Card acronym
Port Card Slot
Access Card acronym
Access Card Slot
P3E3T3
24
A3E3
2 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
25
A3E3
3 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
26
A3E3
4 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
27
A3E3
5 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
28
A3E3
6 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
29
A3E3
7 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
30
A3E3
8 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
31
A3E3
9 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
32
A3E3
13 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
33
A3E3
14 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
34
A3E3
15 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
35
A3E3
16 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
36
A3E3
17 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
37
A3E3
18 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
38
A3E3
19 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
39
A3E3
20 (CH. 1–3)
One or more 1+N (N ≤15) EPS revertive protection scheme can be created (for more detail see point [3] of para. 3.13.1 on page 311). In case of EPS configuration the following configuration rules must be respected: –
Insert the protecting port card in a slot at the most left of of the protected port cards group.
–
Insert the special protection access card (HPROT) associated to the protecting port card following the rule reported in Table 20. on page 111 ( for example if the “protecting port card” has been inserted in slot 24, the ” protection access card HPROT” must be inserted in slot 2).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The max. number of EPS groups is 8 i.e. 8 cards each protected 1+1 revertive. For each group a HPROT access card is required therefore the max number of HPROT access cards is 8.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
111 / 636
Table 21. Relationship between P3E3T3 (3X34/45 Mbit/s Switchable unit) port card and A3T3 access card (3X45 Mbit/s) Port Card Slot
Access Card acronym
Access Card Slot
P3E3T3
24
A3T3
2 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
25
A3T3
3 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
26
A3T3
4 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
27
A3T3
5 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
28
A3T3
6 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
29
A3T3
7 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
30
A3T3
8 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
31
A3T3
9 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
32
A3T3
13 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
33
A3T3
14 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
34
A3T3
15 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
35
A3T3
16 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
36
A3T3
17 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
37
A3T3
18 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
38
A3T3
19 (CH. 1–3)
P3E3T3
39
A3T3
20 (CH. 1–3)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Port Card acronym
One or more 1+N (N ≤15) EPS revertive protection scheme can be created (for more detail see point [3] of para. 3.13.1 on page 311). In case of EPS configuration the following configuration rules must be respected: –
Insert the protecting port card in a slot at the most left of of the protected port cards group.
–
Insert the special protection access card (HPROT) associated to the protecting port card following the rule reported in Table 20. on page 111 ( for example if the “protecting port card” has been inserted in slot 24, the ” protection access card HPROT” must be inserted in slot 2).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The max. number of EPS groups is 8 i.e. 8 cards each protected 1+1 revertive. For each group a HPROT access card is required therefore the max number of HPROT access cards is 8.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
112 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 22. Relationship between P4S1N, P4E4N, P4OC3 port card and A2S1 access card
ED
Port Card acronym
Port Card Slot
Access Card acronym
Access Card Slot
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
24
A2S1
2 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
25
A2S1
3 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
26
A2S1
4 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
27
A2S1
5 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
28
A2S1
6 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
29
A2S1
7 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
30
A2S1
8 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
31
A2S1
9 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
32
A2S1
13 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
33
A2S1
14 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
34
A2S1
15 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
35
A2S1
16 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
36
A2S1
17 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
37
A2S1
18 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
38
A2S1
19 (CH. 3–4)
P4E4N, P4S1N, P4OC3 (CH. 1–2)
339
A2S1
20 (CH. 3–4)
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
113 / 636
Table 23. Relationship between P4ES1N (4xSTM–1 Electrical) port card and A4ES1 access card. Port Card Slot
Access Card acronym
Access Card Slot
P4ES1N
24
A4ES1
2 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
25
A4ES1
3 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
26
A4ES1
4 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
27
A4ES1
5 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
28
A4ES1
6 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
29
A4ES1
7 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
30
A4ES1
8 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
31
A4ES1
9 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
32
A4ES1
13 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
33
A4ES1
14 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
34
A4ES1
15 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
35
A4ES1
16 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
36
A4ES1
17 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
37
A4ES1
18 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
38
A4ES1
19 (CH. 1 to 4)
P4ES1N
39
A4ES1
20 (CH. 1 to 4)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Port Card acronym
One or more 1+N (N ≤15) EPS revertive protection scheme can be created (for more detail see point [3] of para. 3.13.1 on page 311). In case of EPS configuration the following configuration rules must be respected: –
Insert the protecting port card in a slot at the most left of of the protected port cards group.
–
Insert the special protection access card (HPROT) associated to the protecting port card following the rule reported in Table 20. on page 111 ( for example if the “protecting port card” has been inserted in slot 24, the ” protection access card HPROT” must be inserted in slot 2).
The max. number of EPS groups is 8 i.e. 8 cards each protected 1+1 revertive. For each group a HPROT access card is required therefore the max number of HPROT access cards is 8.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The STM–4 and STM–16 high speed port card does not need Access Card because the physical termination of the channel is on the port itself.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
114 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 24. Relationship between ETH–MB (11x10/100 Mb/s Ethernet) port card and ETH–ATX access card. Port Card acronym
Port Card Slot
Access Card acronym
Access Card Slot
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
24
ETH–ATX
2 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
25
ETH–ATX
3 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
26
ETH–ATX
4 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
27
ETH–ATX
5 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
28
ETH–ATX
6 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
29
ETH–ATX
7 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
30
ETH–ATX
8 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
31
ETH–ATX
9 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
32
ETH–ATX
13 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
33
ETH–ATX
14 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
34
ETH–ATX
15 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
35
ETH–ATX
16 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
36
ETH–ATX
17 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
37
ETH–ATX
18 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
38
ETH–ATX
19 (CH. 12 to 25)
ETH–MB (CH. 1 to 11)
39
ETH–ATX
20 (CH. 12 to 25)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
115 / 636
Port Card acronym
Port Card Slot
Access Card acronym
Access Card Slot (N.B.)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
24
GETH–AG
2 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
25
GETH–AG
3 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
26
GETH–AG
4 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
27
GETH–AG
5 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
28
GETH–AG
6 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
29
GETH–AG
7 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
30
GETH–AG
8 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
31
GETH–AG
9 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
32
GETH–AG
13 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
33
GETH–AG
14 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
34
GETH–AG
15 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
35
GETH–AG
16 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
36
GETH–AG
17 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
37
GETH–AG
18 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
38
GETH–AG
19 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
ETH–MB (10/100 Mb CH.1 to 11)
39
GETH–AG
20 (Gigabit CH. 1 and 2)
N.B.
The following channels are made available (max quantity) when GETH–AG is used in conjunction with ETH–MB:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
–
–
ED
up to two Gigabit Ethernet interface on the access card GETH–AG;in this configuration only the two upper interfaces present on the access card can be used for Gbit Ethernet application. up to eleven 10/100 Mbit Ethernet interfaces on the ETH–MB.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
116 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 25. Relationship between ETH–MB (10/100Mb) port card and GETH–AG (1.25 Gb/s) access card.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 26. Relationship between ISA ES–16 port card and and ETH–ATX access card.
ED
Port Card acronym
Port Card Slot
Access Card acronym
Access Card Slot
ISA ES–16
24
ETH–ATX
2
ISA ES–16
25
ETH–ATX
3
ISA ES–16
26
ETH–ATX
4
ISA ES–16
27
ETH–ATX
5
ISA ES–16
28
ETH–ATX
6
ISA ES–16
29
ETH–ATX
7
ISA ES–16
30
ETH–ATX
8
ISA ES–16
31
ETH–ATX
9
ISA ES–16
32
ETH–ATX
13
ISA ES–16
33
ETH–ATX
14
ISA ES–16
34
ETH–ATX
15
ISA ES–16
35
ETH–ATX
16
ISA ES–16
36
ETH–ATX
17
ISA ES–16
37
ETH–ATX
18
ISA ES–16
38
ETH–ATX
19
ISA ES–16
39
ETH–ATX
20
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
117 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Table 27. Relationship between ISA ES–16 port card and and GETH–AG access card.
ED
Port Card Slot
Access Card acronym
Access Card Slot
ISA ES–16
24
GETH–AG
2
ISA ES–16
25
GETH–AG
3
ISA ES–16
26
GETH–AG
4
ISA ES–16
27
GETH–AG
5
ISA ES–16
28
GETH–AG
6
ISA ES–16
29
GETH–AG
7
ISA ES–16
30
GETH–AG
8
ISA ES–16
31
GETH–AG
9
ISA ES–16
32
GETH–AG
13
ISA ES–16
33
GETH–AG
14
ISA ES–16
34
GETH–AG
15
ISA ES–16
35
GETH–AG
16
ISA ES–16
36
GETH–AG
17
ISA ES–16
37
GETH–AG
18
ISA ES–16
38
GETH–AG
19
ISA ES–16
39
GETH–AG
20
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Port Card acronym
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
118 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 28. Relationship between ISA–PR port card and 16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR access cards.
ED
Port Card acronym
Port Card Slot
Access Card acronym
Access Card Slot
ISA–PR
25–26
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
2 –3 3–4 4–5
left middle right
ISA–PR
26–27
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
3–4 4–5 5–6
left middle right
ISA–PR
27–28
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
4–5 5–6 6–7
left middle right
ISA–PR
28–29
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
5–6 6–7 7–8
left middle right
ISA–PR
29–30
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
6–7 7–8 8–9
left middle right
ISA–PR
30–31
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
7–8 8–9 9 – 10
left middle right
ISA–PR
31–32
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
8–9 9 – 10 13 –14
left middle right
ISA–PR
32–33
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
12 – 13 13 – 14 14 – 15
left middle right
ISA–PR
33–34
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
13 – 14 14 – 15 15 – 16
left middle right
ISA–PR
34–35
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
14 – 15 15 – 16 16 – 17
left middle right
ISA–PR
35–36
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
15 – 16 16 – 17 17 – 18
left middle right
ISA–PR
36–37
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
16 – 17 17 – 18 18 –19
left middle right
ISA–PR
37–38
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
17 – 18 18 – 19 19 – 20
left middle right
ISA–PR
38–39
16FEA–PR or 2GBA–PR
18 – 19 19 – 20 20 – 21
left middle right
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
119 / 636
The following paragraph show the access points (LEDs, switches etc.) present on each unit together with legenda and meaning. More in detail: Paragraph 2.4.1 on page 121 shows the Port cards front view Paragraph 2.4.2 on page 145 shows the Access cards front view
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Paragraph 2.4.3 on page 165 shows the Fans subrack cover front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
120 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2.4 Units front view
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2.4.1 Port cards front view
ACRONYM
SLOTS
P63E1
24,27,30,32,33,36,39
P63E1N–M4
24,27,30,32,33,36,39
P3E3T3
24 to 39
P4ES1N
24 to 39
Multicolor LED:
xxxxxx
(1)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – local unit alarm Green led – in service unit Orange led –unit in Stand–by (EPS schema)
3AL XXXXX AA
LEGENDA (1)
Figure 32. PDH, SDH electrical ports front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
121 / 636
SLOTS
P4S1N
24 to 39
P4E4N
24 to 39
P4OC3
24 to 39
LEGENDA
ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ ÑÑÑ
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
(1)
(2)
(1) Channel # 1 (N.B.) (2) Channel # 2 (N.B.)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
xxxxxx
Red led – local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
3AL XXXXX AA
(3) Bicolor LED:
(3)
N.B.– The unit can be equipped with electrical or optical modules (see Figure 70. and Figure 71. ) Figure 33. 4 x STM–1, 4 x OC3 port : front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
122 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
FC/PC
ACRONYM
SLOTS
S–4.1N
24 to 39
L–4.1N
24 to 39
L–4.2N
24 to 39
(2)
SC/PC
(2)
INPUT
INPUT
OUTPUT OUTPUT
LEGENDA (1) Laser restart Key
(1)
(1)
(2) Channel #1
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
xxxxxx
(3)
3AL XXXXX AA
xxxxxx
Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
3AL XXXXX AA
(3) Bicolor LED:
(3)
Figure 34. STM–4 optical port front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
123 / 636
P4S4N
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS 25–26 28–29 34–35 37–38
(1)
(2)
LEGENDA: (1) Channel # 1 (see NOTE) (2) Channel # 2 (see NOTE)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
3AL XXXXX AA
(3) Bicolor LED: (3)
NOTE: the unit can be equipped with optical modules (see Figure 70. on page 159). Figure 35. 4 x STM–4 port card – front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
124 / 636
FC/PC
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
S–16.1ND
SC/PC
SLOTS 25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38 (1)
(1)
L–16.1ND
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38
L–16.2ND
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38
INPUT OUTPUT
INPUT OUTPUT
(2)
(2)
LEGENDA
(3) Bicolor LED:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
(3)
xxxxxx xxxx 3AL XXXXX AA
(2) Channel #1
xxxxxx xxxx 3AL XXXXX AA
(1) Laser restart Key (3)
Figure 36. STM–16 optical front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
125 / 636
SLOTS
I –16.1ND
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38
(1)
INPUT
OUTPUT (2)
LEGENDA (1) Laser restart Key (2) Channel #1
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
xxxxxx xxxx 3AL XXXXX AA
(3) Bicolor LED:
(3)
Figure 37. I–16 PORT SFF (intra–office)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
126 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS
CO–16
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38
(1)
(2)
OUTPUT
INPUT
Note: the cavities must be equipped with SFP modules (refer to Figure 72. on page 161)
(1) Laser restart Key (2) Channel #1 (3) Bicolor LED:
xxxxxx xxxx 3AL XXXXX AA
LEGENDA
(3)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Figure 38. STM–16 SFP port optical front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
127 / 636
ACRONYM
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ATM4X4V2 ATM4X4D3
ATM4X4
SLOTS
ATM4X4 ATM4X4V2
(1)
24–39
ATM4X4D3
(2)
LEGENDA
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(1)
xxxxxx
(10)
3AL XXXXX AA
(9)
xxxxxx
Reset command Key Channel #1 (N.B.) Red LED – Urgent Alarm (Critical or Major) Red LED – Not Urgent alarm (Minor) Yellow LED – Alarm storing (Attended) Yellow LED – Abnormal condition Yellow LED – Indicative Alarm (Warning) Lamp test push–button Factory use only Multicolor LED: Red led – local unit alarm (INT) Green led – in service unit Orange led –unit in Stand–by (EPS schema)
3AL XXXXX AA
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10)
(3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8)
N.B.– The ATM4X4 unit can be equipped with electrical or optical STM–1 modules (see Figure 70. and Figure 71. ) Figure 39. ATM 4X4, ATM 4X4V2 and ATM4X4D3 cards – front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
128 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM ATM8x8
SLOTS 24 – 38 (1)
LEGENDA (1)
Reset command Key
(2)
Red LED – Urgent Alarm (Critical or Major)
(3)
Red LED – Not Urgent alarm (Minor)
(4)
Yellow LED – Alarm storing (Attended)
(5)
Yellow LED – Abnormal condition
(6)
Yellow LED – Indicative Alarm (Warning)
(7)
Lamp test push–button
(8)
Factory use only
(9)
Multicolor LED: Red led – local unit alarm (INT) Green led – in service unit Orange led –unit in Stand–by (EPS schema)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8)
(9)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 40. ATM 8X8 card – front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
129 / 636
SLOTS
ETH–MB
24 to 39
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
(1) (2) (3) (4)
(5) (6) (7) (8)
(9) (10) (11) Not used (12)
LEGENDA (1) to (11) Ethernet Channels (13)
(13) Bicolor LED
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Figure 41. ISA – Ethernet port front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
130 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS
GETH–MB
24 to 39
OUTPUT (1)
(2)
INPUT
(3)
(4) Note: the cavities must be equipped with SFP modules (refer to Figure 72. on page 161)
(6)
LEGENDA (1) to (4) are Gigabit Ethernet channels Note: the cavities must be equipped with Ethernet Optical Modules (refer toFigure 72. on page 161) (5)
(6): Factory use only
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(5) Bicolor LED: Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Figure 42. ISA– Gigabit ETHERNET board
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
131 / 636
SLOTS
ES4–8FE
24 to 39
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
(11) OUTPUT
(10)
INPUT
(9)
(1) Note: the cavities must be equipped with SFP modules (refer toFigure 72. on page 161)
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
LEGENDA
(7)
(1) to (8) 10/100 Ethernet channels
(8)
(9) Gigabit Ethernet channel SFP (12)
(10) Factory use only (11) Microprocessor restart Key (12) Bicolor LED: Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 43. ISA – ES4–8FE port front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
132 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS
ES1–8FE
24 to 39
(1) (2) (3) (4)
1 2 3
4
RJ45 connectors (5) (6) (7) (8)
5 6
7
8
12 34 56 78
(9)
LEGENDA (1) to (8) Ethernet channels (9) Channel status indicators: yellow : active channel yellow blinking: channel with traffic
(10) DBG
(11)
(10) Not used (11) Microprocessor restart Key (12)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(12) Bicolor LED: Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Figure 44. ISA – ES1–8FE port front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
133 / 636
SLOTS
ES1–8FX
24 to 39
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
(1)
(2)
OUTPUT
(3)
(4)
INPUT
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
LEGENDA
(9)
(1): Reset button (2 to 9): are cavity for Fast Ethernet optical SFP modules (Refer to Figure 72. on page 161)
(10)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(10) Bicolor LED: Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Figure 45. ISA ES–8FX front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
134 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS
ISA–ES16
24 to 39 (1)
MAJ MIN uP
(2) (3) (4)
(5) ETH (6) LEGENDA (1) Microprocessor reset key (2) Red LED – Urgent Alarm (Major) RS232 (3) Yellow LED – Not Urgent alarm (Minor) not used in current release
(7)
(4) Microprocessor bicolor LED (5) LED indicating the Ethernet port status (factory use only) (6) Ethernet debugger port (factory use only) (7) RS232 port (factory use only)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(8)
Bicolor LED: Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
(8)
Figure 46. ISA ES–16 front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
135 / 636
SLOTS
PREA4ETH
24 to 39
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
(1)
(2) (3)
(4)
EthPort63
(5)
EthPort62
(6)
EthPort61
(7)
EthPort60
RJ45 connectors LEGENDA (1) Factory use only (2) Microprocessor restart Key (3) Not used (4) to (7) Ethernet cahnnels
(8)
(8) Bicolor LED
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Figure 47. ISA– PRE_EA Matrix 4x Ethernet
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
136 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS
PREA1GBE
24 to 39
(1)
(2) (3)
(4) LEGENDA
(1) Factoy use only (2) Microprocessor restart Key (3) Not used (5)
(4) The slot can be equipped with a SFP Gigabit Ethernet optical module, see Figure 72. on page 161
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(5) Bicolor LED Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Figure 48. ISA– PRE_EA Matrix 1 x GB–ETH
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
137 / 636
SLOTS
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
OUTPUT
ISA–PR
25 to 38 INPUT
LEGENDA
(1)
(1) to (4) SFP optical connections for STM4 SDH ring interface. From top to bottom W1, W2 for West ring interface, E1, E2 for East ring interface. Note: the cavities must be equipped with STM4 optical modules (refer to Figure 72. on page 161) In the figure the four modules are included
(2)
(3)
(5) OK led Red led – Major / critical alarm (Major alarm on ISA–PR or slot alarms in access card or Major transmis– sion alarms on access card. Access card slot alarms stand for: Card Mismatch, Card unassigned, Card Failure on POST _ Power On Self Test) Red led blinking 50/50 – during POST failure (Power On Self Test) Red led blinking 20/80 – Card Mismatch
(4)
Yellow led – Minor alarm Yellow led blinking 50/50 – Maintenance in progress (loopbacks..)
(5)
Green led – OK status (no alarms) Green led blinking 50/50 – ISA–PR is in initialization process (following power–on or reset)
(6)
Led OFF – card not powered (7) (6) ETH– Ethernet management interface RJ45 connector For local Craft Terminal or Network Management System connections (8)
(7) RS 232 – RJ45 connector For internal factory use (8) Microprocessor restart key
(9)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(9) Active led Led OFF – card not powered Green led – card is powered
Figure 49. ISA– PR Matrix 4x4STM4 PLUG–IN
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
138 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS
COWLA2
24 to 39
(1)
1st Channel
(2)
(3)
2nd Channel
(4) LEGENDA (1) Slot for ”Black & White or ”Colored” SFP module (2) Slot for ”Black & White” or ”Colored” SFP module (3) Slot for ”Black & White” or ”Colored” SFP module (4) Slot for ”Black & White” or ”Colored” SFP module Note: the cavities must be equipped with SFP modules (refer toFigure 72. on page 161) (5)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(5) Active led Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Figure 50. COWLA2 front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
139 / 636
SLOTS
4XANYC
25+26 28+29 34+35 37+38 32+33
(3)
(1)
LEGENDA: (1) Channel #1 (Low speed 4XANY acronym modules: OL–IN, OL–MM)
(4)
(2) Channel #2 (Low speed 4XANY acronym modules: OL–IN, OL–MM) (3) Channel #3 (Low speed 4XANY acronym modules: OL–IN, OL–MM OR High speed 4XANY acronym modules: OH–I, OH–MM)
(2)
(4) Channel #4 (Low speed 4XANY acronym modules: OL–IN, OL–MM OR High speed 4XANY acronym modules: OH–I, OH–MM) (5)
(5) Bicolor LED: Red led – local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Note: The allowed mixed configuration are reported on paragraph 3.10 on page 282
Figure 51. 4xANY Host C
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
140 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS
MATRIXN
23,40
(1)
(2)
LEGENDA (1) Reset command key for factory use only xxxxxx
(3) Multicolor LED:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit Orange led – unit in Stand–by (EPS schema)
3AL XXXXX AA
(2) RJ45
(3)
Figure 52. Matrix card
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
141 / 636
EQUICO
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS 22
(1)
(2)
LEGENDA (3) Reset command key Personal Computer Connector (F interface) RJ45 for factory use only Red LED – Urgent Alarm (Critical or Major) Red LED – Not Urgent ( Minor) Yellow LED – Alarm storing (Attended)
(7) (8) (9) (10) (11)
Yellow LED – Abnormal condition Yellow LED – Indicative Alarm (Warning) Lamp test push–button Alarm storing push–botton (Attended) Green LED – When on it means active unit
(4) (5) (6) (7) (8)
(9) (10)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
xxxxxx
(12) Bicolor LED: Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
3AL XXXXX AA
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
(11) (12)
Figure 53. Equipment controller EQUICO
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
142 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS
CONGI
10, 12
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4) LEGENDA (1) Power (2) Housekeeping and remote alarm (5)
(3) Rack lamps (not used on CONGI in slot 12) (4) QMD (Q2) (not used on CONGI in slot 12) (5) I/O BNC for Q3 10 base 2 (not used on CONGI in slot 12)
(6)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
xxxxxx
(7) Bicolor LED: Red led – local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
3AL XXXXX AA
(6) RJ45 for Q3 10 base T (not used on CONGI in slot 12)
(7)
Figure 54. Control and General interface
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
143 / 636
SLOTS
SERVICE
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
11
(1)
J1
J5
J2
J6
J3
J7
J4
J8
LEGENDA (1) I/O auxiliary 2 Mbit/s Channels G.703 J1 – 2 Mbit/s Channel Output 1 J2 – 2 Mbit/s Channel Input 1 J5 – 2Mbit/s Channel Output 2 J6 – 2Mbit/s Channel Input 2 I/O 2 MHz Synchronous interfaces J3 – 2 MHz Output 1 (T4A) or 2 Mbit/s Output (T5A) J4 – 2 MHz Input 1 (T3A) or 2 Mbit/s Input (T6A) J7 – 2 MHz Output 2 (T4B) or 2 Mbit/s Output (T5B) J8 – 2 MHz Input 2 (T3B) or 2 Mbit/s Input (T6B) (2) Auxiliary channels: 4 channel RS–232 4 channel V.11 64 Kbit/s 4 channel G.703 64 Kbit/s
(2)
(3)
(4)
(3) Four wire telephone extension point (RJ45) Four wire telephone extension point (RJ11)
(5)
(5) Z1–Z8 EOW zone selection LEDs (N.B.1)
(6)
(4)
L1
L2
(6) L1–L2 LEDS status for selective call (N.B.2)
(7) (8)
(7) Telephone jack
(9)
(8) Line seizure Key (9) EOW zone selection (N.B.1) (10) Reset command Key
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
xxxxxx
(11) Bicolor LED: Red led – local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
3AL XXXXX AA
(10) (11)
N.B.1 Only one Zone is operative. N.B.2 For details see Table 56. on page 547 and Table 57. on page 547 Figure 55. SERVICE interface
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
144 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2.4.2 Access cards front view
ACRONYM
SLOTS
A21E1
1 to 9,13 to21
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) (14) (15) (16) (17) (18) (19)
LEGENDA
(20)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
INPUT
xxxxxx
(22) Bicolor LED: Red led – local unit alarm (INT) Green led – in service unit
(21) 3AL XXXXX AA
(1) – (21) 2 Mbit/s data signals
OUTPUT (22)
Figure 56. 21 x 2 Mbit/s 75 ohm access card 1.0/2.3 connectors
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
145 / 636
A21E1
SLOTS
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
1 to 9,13 to21
(1)
(2)
LEGENDA
(3)
(1) Channels # 1 to 7 connector (2) Channels # 8 to 14 connector
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – local unit alarm (INT) Green led – in service unit
xxxxxx
(4) Bicolor LED:
3AL XXXXX AA
(3) Channels #15 to 21 connector (4)
Figure 57. 21 X 2 Mbit/s 120 Ohm access card
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
146 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS
A3E3
2 to 9, 13 to 20
INPUT
(1)
OUTPUT
INPUT
(2)
OUTPUT
INPUT
(3)
OUTPUT
LEGENDA (1) Channel #1 (2) Channel #2
xxxxxx
(4) Bicolor LED:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – local unit alarm (INT) Green led – in service unit
3AL XXXXX AA
(3) Channel #3 (4)
Figure 58. 3 X 34 Mbit/s 75 ohm access card
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
147 / 636
SLOTS
A3T3
2 to 9, 13 to 20
INPUT
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
(1)
OUTPUT
INPUT
(2)
OUTPUT
INPUT
(3)
OUTPUT
LEGENDA (1) Channel #1 (2) Channel #2
(4) Bicolor LED:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
xxxxxx
Red led – local unit alarm (INT) Green led – in service unit
3AL XXXXX AA
(3) Channel #3
(4)
Figure 59. 3 X 45 Mbit/s 75 ohm access card
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
148 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM A4ES1
SLOTS 2 to 9, 13 to20
INPUT
(1)
OUTPUT
INPUT
(2)
OUTPUT
INPUT
(3)
OUTPUT
LEGENDA
INPUT (1) Channel #1
(4)
OUTPUT
(2) Channel #2
xxxxxx
(4) Channel #4 (5) Bicolor LED:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – local unit alarm (INT) Green led – in service unit
3AL XXXXX AA
(3) Channel #3 (5)
Figure 60. 4 X STM–1 access card
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
149 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED 2 to 9, 13 to20
(1) All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
HPROT
Red led – local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
xxxxxx
SLOTS
Bicolor LED:
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
3AL XXXXX AA
ACRONYM
LEGENDA
(1)
Figure 61. High Speed protection – front view
02
150 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS
A2S1
2 to 9, 13 to20
(1)
(2)
LEGENDA
(3) Bicolor LED:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – local unit alarm (INT) Green led – in service unit
xxxxxx
(2) Channel #4 (N.B.)
3AL XXXXX AA
(1) Channel #3 (N.B.)
(3)
N.B.– The unit can be equipped with electrical or optical modules (see Figure 70. and Figure 71. ) Figure 62. 2 x 140/STM–1 O/E adapter (access card)– front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
151 / 636
SLOTS
ETH–ATX
2 to 9, 13 to20
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
(1) (2) (3) (4)
(5) (6) (7) (8)
(9) (10) (11) (12)
(13) (14) LEGENDA (15)
(1) to (14) Ethernet channels
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(15) Bicolor LED Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Figure 63. ISA – Ethernet access front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
152 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS
GETH–AG 2 to 9, 13 to20
OUTPUT
INPUT
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
LEGENDA (1) to (4) are Gigabit Ethernet channels Note: the cavities must be equipped with Ethernet Optical Modules (refer to Figure 72. on page 161) Only the two upper cavities can be equipped when the GHETH–AG is used in cojunction with ETH–MB
(5)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(5) Bicolor LED Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Figure 64. ISA – Gigabit Ethernet access card front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
153 / 636
SLOTS
2GBA–PR
2 to 8 13 to 20
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
OUTPUT
INPUT
LEGENDA (1) and (2) are Gigabit ethernet channels Note: the cavities must be equipped with Ethernet Optical Modules (refer toFigure 72. on page 161) In the figure the two modules are included (3) and (4) Link led, one for each ethernet channel Red led – any port related alarm Green led – link up
(1)
(5) OK led Red led – Major / critical alarm Red led blinking 50/50 – during POST (Power On Self Test) failure Red led blinking 20/80 – Card Mismatch
(2)
Yellow led – Minor alarm Yellow led blinking 50/50 – maintenance Green led – OK status (no alarms) Green led blinking 50/50 – during init Green led blinking 20/80 – Card is Unassigned (i.e.not yet approved by NMS)
(3) (4) (5)
Led OFF – card not powered (6) (6) Active led
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Led OFF – card not powered Green led – card is powered
Figure 65. ISA PR 2XGBE 1000 access card front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
154 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(2)
ACRONYM
SLOTS
16FEA–PR
2 to 8 13 to 20
(3)
LEGENDA (1) 16 x 10/100 fast ethernet channels (2) Link led, one for each channel Green led – link up Led off – link down (3) Activity led, one for each ethernet channel Yellow led – Rx/Tx in progress Led off – link silent
(1)
(4) OK led Red led – Major / critical alarm Red led blinking 50/50 – during POST (Power On Self Test) failure Red led blinking 20/80 – Card Mismatch Yellow led – Minor alarm Yellow led blinking 50/50 – maintenance Green led – OK status (no alarms) Green led blinking 50/50 – during init Green led blinking 20/80 – Card is Unassigned (i.e.not yet approved by NMS) Led OFF – card not powered
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(5) Active led Led OFF – card not powered Green led – card is powered
(4) (5)
Figure 66. ISA PR16XETH 10/100 access card front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
155 / 636
SLOTS
COADM1
1 to 8 13 to 20
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
(1)
(2)
LEGENDA (3) (1) Line Side Fiber Connectors (2) Add/Drop Channel Fiber Connectors (4) (3) Pass–through Fiber Connectors
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(4) Bicolor LED Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Figure 67. COADM1 front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
156 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
SLOTS
COADM2
1 to 8 13 to 20
(1)
(3)
(2)
LEGENDA
(4)
(1) Line Side Fiber Connectors (2) Add/Drop Channel #1 Fiber Connectors (3) Add/Drop Channel #2 Fiber Connectors (5)
(4) Pass–through Fiber Connectors
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(5) Bicolor LED Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Figure 68. COADM2 front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
157 / 636
SLOTS
COMDX8
1 to 8 13 to 20
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM
(1)
LEGENDA
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(1) Line Side Fiber Connectors (2) Channel 1470 nm Fiber Connectors (3) Channel 1490 nm Fiber Connectors (4) Channel 1510 nm Fiber Connectors (5) Channel 1530 nm Fiber Connectors (6) Channel 1550 nm Fiber Connectors (7) Channel 1570 nm Fiber Connectors (10)
(8) Channel 1590 nm Fiber Connectors (9) Channel 1610 nm Fiber Connectors
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(10) Bicolor LED Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Figure 69. COMDX8 front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
158 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
STM–1 module EQUIPPED acronym on CARDS SC/PC
IS–1.1 IL–1.1 IL–1.2
P4S1N P4E4N ATM4X4 A2S1 P4OC3
INPUT OUTPUT
MM1 STM–4 module EQUIPPED acronym on CARDS
IS–4.1 IL–4.1
P4S4N Laser restart key
IL–4.2
STM–1 module EQUIPPED on CARDS acronym
IS–1.1 IL–1.1 IL–1.2
FC/PC
P4OC3 P4S1N P4E4N ATM4X4 A2S1
INPUT OUTPUT
STM–4 module EQUIPPED on CARDS acronym
IS–4.1 IL–4.1
P4S4N Laser restart key
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
IL–4.2
Figure 70. STM–1/STM–4 optical module front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
159 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ACRONYM
ICMI
ED P4OC3 P4S1N P4E4N ATM4X4 A2S1
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
EQUIPPED ON PORTS
INPUT
OUTPUT
Figure 71. STM–1 or 140 Mbit/s electrical module front view
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
160 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
SFP MODULE ACRONYM
EQUIPPED ON PORT/ACCESS
1000B
GETH–MB GETH–AG ES4–8FE 2GBA–PR PREA1GBE
100B
ES1–8FX
SS–161 SL–161 SL–162
CO–16 COWLA2
SS–162C SL–162C SS–41
ISA–PR SFP Module
OUTPUT
INPUT
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Optical cables
Figure 72. Relationship between SFP modules and housing boards
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
161 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
OH–I
OL–IN 4XANYC
OH–MM
OL–MM
ED All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
4XANY modules EQUIPPED acronym on CARDS
OUTPUT
INPUT
Figure 73. 4XANY plug–in module
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
162 / 636
ACRONYM
SLOTS
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
SC/PC
BST10
2 to 8 13 to 19
BST15
2 to 8 13 to 19
BST17
2 to 8 13 to 19
FC/PC INPUT OUTPUT
(2)
(2)
INPUT OUTPUT
(1)
(1)
LEGENDA: (1) Cover remove (2) IN / OUT Main Signal (3) Yellow LED: active Shut Down (4) Bicolor LED:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
Figure 74. Optical Booster card front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
163 / 636
ACRONYM
SLOTS FC/PC All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
SC/PC
2 to 8 13 to 19
PR16
INPUT OUTPUT
INPUT OUTPUT
(1)
(1)
(2) (2)
LEGENDA: (1) Cover remove (2) IN / OUT Main Signal (3) Yellow LED: active Shut Down (4) Bicolor LED:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – Local unit alarm Green led – in service unit
Not used
Not used
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
Figure 75. PREAMPLIFIER 2.5 GB/S front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
164 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2.4.3 FAN subrack cover front view
(1)
(2)
(4)
(5) (6)
(3)
LEGENDA (1)
MULTICOLOR LED:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Red led – local unit alarm Orange led – temperature major than 55 C Green led – in service unit (2)
Battery A connector
(3)
Battery B connector
(4)
Not used
(5)
Alarms connector for 1660SM
(6)
Not used
Figure 76. 19” Fans subrack cover front view
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
165 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
166 / 636 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION 3.1 General description From Figure 80. on page 178 to Figure 88. on page 186 illustrates, in block diagram form, the units employed in the 1660SM and the general operating functions: •
EQUICO unit The unit provides the following functionality:
•
–
Equipment Controller (EC) function
–
F interface for Local Craft Terminal
–
Communication with the Operation System (O.S) through different interface (DCC, QB3 etc.)
MATRIX unit The unit provides the following functionality:
•
–
Matrix that performs HPC, LPC and protection functions
–
Synchronization functions
–
Shelf Controller (SC) function
2 or 34/45 Mbit/s PDH Electrical unit Different PDH Electrical unit are available: –
”2 Mbit/s PDH Electrical unit” provides the interface for the asynchronous mapping G.703 2 Mbit/s signals into SDH VC12s. Each unit supports 63 interface. The unit is the same for 75 Ω and 120 Ω. applications; impedance match is performed at the “access card” level.
–
”34 Mbit/s / 45 Mbit/s unit” provides the interface for the asynchronous mapping of G.703 34 Mbit/s or 45 Mbit/s signals into SDH VC–3s. Each unit supports 3 interface . The selection of the working mode (3 x 34 Mb/s or 3 x 45 Mb/s) is controlled via software. Two different access module are used for the 34 Mb/s and 45 Mb/s applications.
For both units the Lower Order Interface (LOI) block includes PPI (physically on the Access Card), LPA, LPT functionality (see Figure 77. on page 167 and Figure 80. on page 178)
LOI
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
PPI
LPA
LPT
Figure 77. LOI block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
167 / 636
•
The unit provide four 140 PDH electrical or 155 Mbit/s STM–1 Electrical/Optical interfaces. The selection of the working mode (per port) is controlled via software: – When the 140 Mbit/s mode is selected, the port provides an interface for the asynchronous mapping of G.703 140 Mbit/s signals into SDH VC–4. The functions performed in the High Order Interface (HOI) block are: PPI (Physically on the Access Card), LPA, HPT(see Figure 78. on page 168 and Figure 80. on page 178. Two of the four PPI blocks are present on the board, the other two are on the Access Card. HOI PPI
LPA
HPT
Figure 78. HOI block diagram –
When the 155 Mbit/s STM–1 mode is selected, the VC–4 can either be unstructured or structured into lower order VCs. The functions performed are TTF and HOA (see Figure 79. on page 168). Two of the four SPI blocks are present on the board, the other two are on the Access Card. TTF SPI
RST
MST
MSP
MSA
HOA HPT
HPA
Figure 79. TTF and HOA block diagram •
4 x155 Mbit/s Electrical/Optical unit The unit provides four bidirectional STM–1 electrical or optical interfaces. For each STM–1, the VC–4 can either be unstructured or structured into lower order VCs. The function performed are TTF and HOA ( see Figure 79. on page 168 and Figure 80. on page 178.). Two of the four SPI blocks are present on the board, the other two are on the Access Card. Any combination of electrical or optical (short or long haul) is possible on the same unit.
•
4 x155 Mbit/s Electrical unit
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The unit provides four bidirectional STM–1 electrical interfaces. The four SPI blocks are available on Access Card. For each STM–1, the VC–4 can either be unstructured or structured into lower order VCs. The function performed are TTF and HOA ( see Figure 79. on page 168 and Figure 80. on page 178.).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
168 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
4 x 140 Electrical or 155 Mbit/s E/O unit
•
1 X STM–4 Optical unit
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The 1 x STM–4 optical unit provide one STM–4 optical interface; the function performed are TTF and HOA. Several short and long haul types are available. •
1 X STM–16 optical unit The 1 x STM–16 optical unit provide one STM–16 optical interface (on front panel); the function performed are TTF and HOA. Several short and long haul types and connectors are available. “Colored” versions are available for direct interworking with WDM equipment without intermediate wavelength adapters.
•
4 X OC3 AU3/TU3 Conversion unit This board can manage up to 4 x OC–3 (SONET) streams. The board hosts up to 2 interfaces into the front panel. The other two interfaces can be hosted in the Access area using the relevant access card that must be equipped in the slot associated to the corresponding traffic unit slot (refer to Table 22. on page 113). Each combination of interfaces (electrical, S.1.1,L.1.1,..) can be equipped in the same board. On OC–3 interface the Sonet mapping is mange so the RS and MS sections are terminated, the 3 AU3 are processed to extract or insert the 3 VC3. This unit performs the AU3/TU3 conversion , which allows the transport in SDH network of Sonet VC3 traffic. The conversion is performed on OC–3 interface: the 3 VC3 are extracted then re–mapped in SDH VC4 container and this container is passed to the matrix where it is managed as a structured VC4. The OH byte of RS and MS section are managed according SDH ITU standard.
•
ISA – ATM4X4, ATM4X4V2, ATM4X4D3 Three boards types are available: –
ATM4X4 with a max. number of 16 TPs configurable among SDH VC4, SDH VC3, SDH VC12, PDH 2M and PDH 34M.
–
ATM4X4V2 with a max number. of 252 TPs configurable among SDH VC4, SDH VC3, SDH VC12, PDH 2M, PDH 34M and PDH 45M.
–
ATM4X4D3 with a max number. of 16 TPs configurable among SDH VC4, SDH VC3, SDH VC12, PDH 2M, PDH 34M and PDH 45M.
They are a one slot wide boards that integrate an ATM switch functionality. Only the ATM4X4 BOARD also includes a STM–1 local access port on the front panel. For both throughput capacity towards backpanel is 622 Mbit/s. ATM traffic control functions, such as “Shaping” and “Policing” (which are needed to avoid network congestion) are supported.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
•
ISA – ATM MATRIX 8X8 It is a two slot wide board that integrate an ATM switch functionality. 16+16 TPs are configurable among SDH VC4,SDH VC4–C, SDH VC3, SDH VC12, PDH 2M and PDH 34M. The throughput capacity is 1.2 Gbit/s. ATM traffic control functions, such as “Shaping” and “Policing” (which are needed to avoid network congestion) are supported.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
169 / 636
•
1660SM can host two types of PR_EA matrix (generically ISA PR_EA board): – in the first version, it hosts a 4 x 10/100 BaseT Fast Ethernet module and the total traffic throughput is 1 Gb/s, in which 622Mb/s are contributed by the SDH matrix, and 400 Mb/s contributed by the 4 Fast Ethernet local ports. – in the second version, it hosts a 1 x 1Gigabit Ethernet module and the total traffic throughput is 1.8 Gb/s, in which 622Mb/s are contributed by the SDH matrix, and 1.25 Gb/s contributed by the Gb Ethernet local port. The following table summarizes the interfaces that can accede to the MPLS functions: TYPE OF INTERFACE
CONTAINER
NOTES
SDH
VC–12, VC–3, VC–4
PDH
E1, E3, T3
not available in current rel.
Ethernet (E, FE, GE)
MAC 802.3
also “802.1p/q Tagged”
Table 29. Interfaces acceding to the MPLS functions •
ISA – PR MATRIX 1660SM can host PR matrix (generically ISA–PR board) and relevant access cards: It provides a shared carrier–class Ethernet Packet Ring embedded, in a flexible manner over SDH VCs (with VC–4–nv framing), either physically or logically into the SDH infrastructure. The ISA–PR is a Layer 2 MPLS–based statistical packet switch with Ethernet and GBE interfaces operating a Resilient Packet Ring transported over multiple STM–4 standard interfaces. The ISA–PR port card is a RPR switch with four STM–4 interfaces providing 6.5 Gbps packet throughput with a provisionable trunk capacity of 1.2 Gbps both in East and West directions. On its front plate a RJ45 connector provides the connection toward the Local Craft Terminal or the Operation System. The following table summarizes the interfaces that can accede to the PR functions: TYPE OF INTERFACE SDH Ethernet (E, FE, GE)
CONTAINER
NOTES
VC–4 MAC 802.3
also “802.1p/q Tagged”
Two access card types are availale (also in mixed configuration):
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
–
16 FEA–PR – Fast ETHERNET access card 10/100 Ethernet Access card supporting sixteen (16) 10/100 Fast Ethernet interfaces. Up to four 16FEA–PR access cards can be equipped.
–
2 GBA–PR – GigaBit Ethernet access card GigaBit Ethernet Access card supporting two (2) GigaBit Ethernet interfaces.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
170 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ISA – PR_EA MATRIX
•
ISA – Fast ETHERNET unit
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The unit is able to provide 25 x 10/100 Mb/s Ethernet interfaces to allow LAN–to–LAN connections. In the main port are provided 11 connectors on the front panel of the unit. The main port can be used in conjunction with the relevant access module (ETH–ATX) which is able to provide 14 additional 10/100 Mb/s Ethernet interfaces. Ethernet frames are mapped over an SDH VC (VC–12, VC–3, VC–4) with a max. throughput of 622 Mbt/s toward the backplane. Each physical interface can independently be mapped into the relevant VC according to the required bit rate. N.B.
•
The Fast Ethernet unit 10/100 Mb/s can be also used in conjunction with the Gigabit Ethernet Access card (GETH–AG); in this configuration the Fast Ethernet unit can handle the following interfaces: –
two Gbit Ethernet interfaces (on the access card GETH–AG); Ethernet frames are mapped over a single SDH VC–4.
–
11 Interfaces 10/100 Mb/s Ethernet interfaces (on the Main board)
ISA – Gigabit ETHERNET unit The unit is able to manage 4 Gigabit Ethernet interfaces on the main board.
•
ISA ES1–8FE, ISA ES1–8FX and ISA ES4–8FE The boards mainly work as a LAN switching, and in particular they provide the service of connecting two LANs as point to point connection between two routers or switches through a SDH network. ISA ES1–8FE and ISA ES4–8FE units have eight 10/100 Mbit/s Ethernet interfaces on the front panel; the Ethernet traffic, opportunely mapped in the SDH transport structures, is then sent toward the SDH matrix via the back plane with a STM–1 equivalent throughput . ES1–8FX board has eight Small Form factor Pluggeable module supporting optical Fast Ethernet Interfaces on the front panel. ES4–8FE board has also one Small Form factor Pluggeable module supporting a Gigabit Ethernet Interface on the front panel. ISA–ES1 and ISA ES4 series module can classify ETH traffic according to a wide set of standard specified criteria in order to provide a feature reach set of capability. Each classified traffic is referred as a classified flow. Classification criteria are the following: – – – –
Port (Physical ETH or ETH over SDH) IEEE 802.1Q (VLAN tagging) IEEE 802.1p (ETH frame priority) IEEE 802.3 Source/Destination MAC address (also according to IEEE 802.1ad)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Hereafter are reported the available trunking capacity: – –
ED
ISA–ES1 ISA–ES4
has 1 VC–4 of bandwidth available has 4 VC–4 of bandwidth available
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
171 / 636
•
As for ISA ES1 and ISA ES4 the boards ISA ES16 mainly work as a LAN switching, and in particular they provide the service of connecting two LANs as point to point connection between two routers or switches through a SDH network. ISA–ES16 is a port less card that can use specific access modules: –
14 x FE access module: 14 x Fast Ethernet ports (10/100 Base T)
–
4 x GE access module:
4 x GB Ethernet ports with SFP plugs
ISA ES16 Classification criteria are the following: – – – – – –
Port (Physical ETH or ETH over SDH) IEEE 802.1Q (VLAN tagging) IEEE 802.1p (ETH frame priority) IEEE 802.3 Source/Destination MAC address (also according to IEEE 802.1ad) MPLS label (according to IETF Martini draft ETH over MPLS) IP–TOS/DSCP fields
Hereafter are reported the available trunking capacity: –
•
ISA–ES16 has up to 16 VC–4 of bandwidth available (depending on the subrack slot capacity of the 1660SM equipment)
4 x ANY HOST C unit The 4xANY board is a Time Division Multiplexer concentrator that performs a bidirectional interface between up to 4 clients data and the MATRIX board (via backpanel) through up to 16 VC–4. A mixing of SDH and Data Services is possible. Multiplexing scheme delivers a fully compliant SDH frame. The board is two slot wide and can be plugged in the enhanced slot( 25&26, 28&29, 34&35, 37&38) and not enhanced slot (30&31, 32&33), so the throughput toward MATRIX unit can be from 1.2 Gbit/s to 622 Mbit/s. Up to 4 client signals can be independently handled among the following types (for details and restriction refer to paragraph 3.10 on page 282) :
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
• • • • • • •
ED
Fast Ethernet FDDI (125Mbps) ESCON (200Mbps) Digital Video (270Mbps) Fiber Channel (1.0625Gbps) FICON (1.0625Gbps) Gigabit Ethernet (1.25Gbps)
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
172 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ISA ES16
•
Double channel multirate transponder (COWLA2) unit
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
This unit realizes both the ’wavelength assignment’ and the ’wavelength regeneration’ on the 2 separate channels supported, according to the type of optical interface (’colored’ CWDM or B&W) equipped. Pluggable CoarseWDM/B&W SFP optical modules are equipped in order to allow maximum flexibility in channel configuration. 8 possible Coarse WDM modules with SFP transceiver are available with a throughput up to 2.5Gb/s. CWDM transceiver are ITU–T grid compliant (1470–1490–1510– 1530–1550–1570–1590–1610 nm). The configuration of COWLA2 requires the operator to specify for each module the transported client signal and if the module is colored or B&W. The transponder unit supports the ’3R’ functionality for the following signal types: – – – – – – – – – – – – – •
FDDI (125 Mb/s); Fast Ethernet (125 Mb/s); STM1/OC3; Escon (200 Mb/s); Digital Video (270 Mb/s); STM4/OC12; Fiber Channel (1.0625 Gb/s); FICON (1.0625 Gb/s); Gb Ethernet (1.25 Gb/s); 2 Fiber Channel (2.125 Gb/s); STM16/OC48; 2 Gb Ethernet (2.5 Gb/s); STM16 w/ FEC (2.667 Gb/s)
not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release
OADM1 (COADM1) unit COADM1 unit realizes wavelengths multi–demultiplexing allowing to add/drop 1 channel out of the 8 supported according to CWDM grid and the pass–through of remaining WDM channels not terminated. One specific item per ITU–T channel is foreseen: 1470 – 1490 – 1510 – 1530 – 1550 – 1570 – 1590 – 1610 nm. The functionality of the board has to be considered for ring application, and performing ’one side’ channel termination: thus, two separate boards are required at a node of the ring in order to achieve the complete OADM functionality. ’Loss of Signal’ detection on CWDM optical signal received is provided in order to support the standard management of OMSN’s. The CWDM LOS detection allows the operator to realize an efficient and specific maintenance of the network in case of break of ring/linear cables carrying multiplexed signals.
•
OADM2 (COADM2) unit COADM2 board realizes wavelengths multi–demultiplexing allowing to add/drop 2 channels out of the 8 supported according to CWDM grid and the pass–through of remaining WDM channels not terminated.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Four specific items are foreseen, considering to support the termination of two adjacent wavelengths per item: – – – –
ED
1470 – 1490 nm; 1510 – 1530 nm; 1550 – 1570 nm; 1590 – 1610 nm.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
173 / 636
•
Mux/Demux 8 ch (COMDX8) unit MUX/DEMUX board realizes wavelengths multi–demultiplexing on the whole group of 8 CWDM channels supported. 8 CWDM ITU–T grid compliant filters are equipped on the MUX/DEMUX module: 1470, 1490, 1510, 1530, 1550, 1570, 1590, 1610 nm. The functionality of the board can be considered both for linear and ring application; contrary to COADMn boards, no ’pass–through’ link is provided, then pass–through of wavelengths not terminated must be realized on each single wavelength. In ’ring’ application, the board performs ’one side’ channels termination: thus, two separate boards are required at a node of the ring in order to achieve the complete functionality. ’Loss of Signal’ detection on CWDM optical signal received is provided in order to support the standard management of OMSN’s. The CWDM LOS detection allows the operator to realize an efficient and specific maintenance of the network in case of break of ring/linear cables carrying multiplexed signals.
•
SERVICE unit The unit provides the following functionality:
•
–
Auxiliary channels
–
Engineering Order Wire (EOW)
–
2 MHz Input/Output
CONGI unit The unit provides the following functionality:
•
–
Power Supply
–
QB3 Interface
–
Housekeeping and remote alarm
–
Q2/RQ2 interface
Access Cards They provides the physical interface for the different types of signals
•
Protection Card The unit allows the EPS protection for 34/45Mbit/s and 155 Mbit/s electrical unit.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
•
BOOSTER To improve the span length of STM–N interfaces for single channel application, the Optical booster unit can be used. This unit can be plug–in in the access area. Three integrated boosters are available, according to the relevant gain values: 10dbm, 15dBm and 17dBm.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
174 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The functionality of the board has to be considered for ring application, and performing ’one side’ channel termination: thus, two separate boards are required at a node of the ring in order to achieve the complete OADM functionality. ’Loss of Signal’ detection on CWDM optical signal received is provided in order to support the standard management of OMSN’s. The CWDM LOS detection allows the operator to realize an efficient and specific maintenance of the network in case of break of ring/linear cables carrying multiplexed signals.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
•
OPTICAL PREAMPLIFIER This unit can be plug–in in the access area. It is used in conjunction with the optical booster to improve the span length of STM–16 interfaces for single channel application.
The functions carried out by the unit can be splitted into the following sub–systems: [1]
Connections sub–system (refer to paragraph 3.2 on page 188)
[2]
Signal management sub–system (refer to paragraph 3.3 on page 190)
[3]
ISA (Integrated Service Adapter) sub–system ( refer to paragraph 3.4 on page 213)
[4]
4xANY HOST C subs–system (refer to paragraph 3.10 on page 282)
[5]
Coarse WDM sub–system (refer to paragraph 3.11 on page 289)
[6]
Controller sub–system (refer to paragraph 3.12 on page 304)
[7]
Protection sub–system (refer to paragraph 3.13 on page 310)
[8]
Synchronization sub–system (refer to paragraph 3.14 on page 351)
[9]
Auxiliary sub–system (refer to paragraph 3.15 on page 353)
[10] Power supply sub–system (refer to paragraph 3.16 on page 355) [11] Remote inventory sub–system (refer to paragraph 3.17 on page 358) On the following paragraphs a detailed description of each sub–system is given. Each logical function does not correspond necessarily to a physical card but can be distributed over more than one card. On the other side, one card can house more than one function. For each sub–system the list of the involved cards and a brief abstract of the function detailed on the following paragraphs is reported in Table 30. on page 176.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Notice that the On Board Power Supply (DC/DC converter in Figure 80. on page 178) is present on each card and that the Controller function is centralized ( EC and SC).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
175 / 636
Table 30. Sub–systems & involved cards Card involved
Connections
MATRIX and ports
Short description On the para. is explained how the signal is managed between the port and the MATRIXE
Signal management
all the ports (LS and HS) Access Modules
On the para. it is explained how the PDH, SDH and SONET signals are elaborated on the ports. The description in compliancy with the G.783 ITU–T Rec.
ISA boards management
ISA boards, relevant access modules and SDH MATRIX
On the paragraph are explained the ATM, Ethernet/Fast Ethernet/Gigabit Ethernet, MPLS, PR, connections types supported by the system.
4xANY management
Coarse WDM
Controller
4xANY HOST C and SDH MATRIX
On the paragraph are explained the 4xANY HOST C connections types supported by the system.
COADM1, COADM2, COMDX8, COWLA2 and SFP modules
On the paragraph is explained the integration of WDM tecnology inside the 1660SM in order to enhance the network capacity.
EQUICO and MATRIX
The control system is centralized. The EQUICO performs the Equipment Controller (EC) function and the MATRIX perform the Shelf Controller (SC) function. The following network protection are explained:
Network protections
all the ports (LS and HS)
– – – – – –
linear MSP MS SPRING SNCP/I and SNCP/N (among VC–4 only) Drop & Continue + insertion SNCP Collapsed single–node ring interconnection Collapsed dual–node ring interconnection
The MATRIX card manages all the protections. 63x2 Mbit/s port (N+1) 3x34/45 Mbit/s port (N+1) Protection 155 Mbit/s electrical port (N+1) ISA–ATM MATRIX (1+1) Equipment ISA–PR_EA MATRIX (1+1) protections
The SC on the MATRIX card controls the EPS protections.
ISA–ES 16 (1+1)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
CONGI supply)
(only for the power
MATRIXN HPROT
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
176 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Sub–system
(Table continues)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Sub–system
Short description The MATRIX performs the synchronization function therefore distributing the clock and synchronisms to all the equipment cards.
Synchronization
MATRIX
Auxiliary
HS ports, SERVICE, EQUICO
On the para. is explained how the OH bytes (DCC, EOW and AUX channels) are managed.
Power supply
all the cards, CONGI
The powering is distributed over the all equipment cards. The CONGI cards provides the 48 V and the service 3.3 V to power each card.
Remote Inventory
ED
Card involved
all the cards, access card and On the para is explained the Remote Inventory modules architecture
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
177 / 636
Prot. Link
63 x 2 Mbit/s PDH Electrical unit MAIN T2
Access cards
line clock
T∅
LOI
–Batt/Gnd Control
DC/DC Converter
G.703
Sw
Data
Electrical Interfaces
Vcc W Prot. Vcc W Control
PROT. CARD
TO/FROM MATRIX See Figure 85.
3 x 34/45 Mbit/s PDH Electrical unit
Prot. Link
Prot. Link
OH
Access cards
Electrical Data
T∅ –Batt/Gnd Control
G.703
LOI DC/DC Converter
Interfaces
Vcc X
Vcc X Control
PROT. CARD
4 x 155 Mbit/s electrical unit
Access cards
Control HOA
Data T∅ T1 DCC OH
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
–Batt/Gnd
SPI
TTF Prot. Link
DC/DC Converter
HOA
Prot. Link
Electrical Interfaces SPI
TTF
Vcc Y
Vcc Y Control
Figure 80. 1660SM Block diagram – (SDH and PDH boards)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
178 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
SPARE
–Batt/Gnd Control T∅ T1 DCC OH
DC/DC Converter
HOI
Vcc Z HOA HOA
Data
140 Mbit/s
PPI TTF
STM–1 SPI
TTF
SPI
TTF
SPI
HOA
STM–1
Optical/ Electrical Interfaces STM–1
Booster
Access card Vcc Z
Control
4 x 155 E/O Mbit/s unit TO/FROM MATRIX See Figure 85.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
4 x 140 Mb/s el.–155 E/O Mbit/s unit
–Batt/Gnd Control T∅ T1 DCC OH
DC/DC Converter
TTF
Booster
SPI
STM–1
HOA Vcc Z HOA
TTF
Optical/ Electrical Interfaces
STM–1 SPI STM–1
HOA
TTF
SPI
HOA
TTF
SPI
STM–1
Data
Access card Vcc Z
Control
1 x STM–4 SDH unit –Batt/Gnd Control T∅ T1 DCC
DC/DC Converter TTF
Data
STM–4
SPI
HOA
OH
Optical Interfaces
Booster
1 x STM–16 SDH unit Control T∅ T1 DCC
Data
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
OH
DC/DC Converter
Preamplifier TTF HOA
STM–16
SPI
(*)
Optical Interfaces
Booster
(*) – Removable SFP optical modules are available only on CO–16 port
Figure 81. 1660SM Block diagram – (SDH and PDH boards)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
179 / 636
Control T∅
DC/DC Converter Vcc Z
DCC OH
Data
AU3/TU3 conv.
SPI
AU3/TU3 conv.
SPI
OC3 OC3
AU3/TU3 conversion
SPI
AU3/TU3 conversion
SPI
OC3 Optical/ Electrical Interfaces OC3
Access card
TO/FROM MATRIX See Figure 85.
Vcc Z
Control
4 x ANY HOST C unit –Batt/Gnd
DC/DC Converter
Control
ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ CDR
T∅
RX TX
Low speed signals: Fast Ethernet FDDI ESCON Digital Video FDDI
Opt. module #1
2xAny
CDR
Data
RX TX
Opt. module #2
STM–16 Mapper
CDR
Low speed signals: Fast Ethernet FDDI ESCON Digital Video FDDI
RX TX
Opt. module #3
2xAny
CDR
RX TX
High speed signals: Fiber Channel FICON Gigabit Ethernet
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Opt. module #4
Figure 82. 1660SM Block diagram – (SONET and 4xANY HOSTC boards)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
180 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
4 x OC3 AU3/TU3 CONV. unit –Batt/Gnd
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
DOUBLE MULTIRATE TRANSPONDER unit Multirate CDR
SFP module
B&W TVC
CK Rx1 Data Rx1
Mx
SFP module
Data Recovery
Data Rx3
CWDM TVC
Data Rx2 Data Recovery
Data Rx4 CK Rx 1:4
B&W or CWDM SFP module
Multirate CDR
CWDM TVC
Data Rx 1:4
CK Multirate Rx3 CDR SFP module
Data Recovery
CK Rx2
Data Recovery
B&W or CWDM
CWDM TVC RS monitor #1
RS monitor
CK Rx4
Multirate CDR
#2
Alarm/Control Interface Remote Inventory EEPROM
RIBUS
ISPB bus
SPI bus
OUTPUT CHANNELS (from colored port or Transponder interface)
INPUT CHANNELS (to colored port or Transponder interface)
λ1 λ2 λ3 λ4 λ5 λ6 λ7 λ8 λ1 λ2 λ3 λ4 λ5 λ6 λ7 λ8
1470
output signal
1490
CWDM
1510 1530 1550
MUX
1570 1610 1590
1470 1490
LOS HANDLING
1510
1550
CWDM input signal
1530
DEMUX
1570 1610 1590
LOS DETECTION
MUX/DEMUX8 unit
Remote Inventory EEPROM
RIBUS
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
SPI bus
Figure 83. 1660SM Block diagram – (CWDM boards)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
181 / 636
To/From colored port or transponder 1xx0
λx
1xx0
output signal
CWDM λgrid – λx OADM CWDM input signal
CWDM λgrid – λx LOS DETECTION LOS HANDLING To/From OADM opposite side Remote Inventory EEPROM
RIBUS
COADM1 unit SPI bus
To/From colored port or transponder
CWDM λgrid – λx–λy
CWDM
λx λy
1xx0
λx λy
1xx0
output signal
1xx0
OADM CWDM λgrid – λx–λy
CWDM input signal
1xx0
LOS DETECTION LOS HANDLING To/From OADM opposite side Remote Inventory EEPROM
RIBUS
COADM2 unit
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
SPI bus
Figure 84. 1660SM Block diagram – (CWDM boards)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
182 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
CWDM
λx
See from Figure 86. on page 184 to Figure 88. on page 186 Data 2
See from Figure 80. to Figure 82.
1
TO/FROM PORT
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ISA boards
Data
Data
TO/FROM PORT See Figure 80. and Figure 81.
SDH matrix (HPC–LPC)
SERVICE unit
T∅ –Batt/Gnd
T1 T2
MATRIX Synchronization
T3/T6 a T3/T6 b
OH ports
T4/T5 a T4/T5 b
Control
OH add/drop
Control
Control
EQUICO
Shelf –Batt/Gnd
DC/DC Converter
DC/DC Converter
Controller
SC/EC Control
DCC add/drop
RS232
Aux RS232
G.703
Aux 2Mbit/s
G.703
Aux 64kbit/s
V.11
Aux 64kbit/s
Digital Party Line
Voice ext. Local phone Aux ext.
T3/T6 a T3/T6 b T4/T5 a T4/T5 b
G.703
T4a/T5a_ext. T4b/T5b_ext.
Control
CONGI unit
b
EQUICO –Batt/Gnd
Remote alarms & Housekeeping
DC/DC Converter
Equipment
F Interface
Controller
–Batt/Gnd Vcc Control
Filter & DC/DC
CONGI unit
Power B a
leds ports
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
SERVICE
DCC add/drop
T3a/T6a_ext. T3b/T6b_ext.
–Batt/Gnd Vcc
Filter & DC/DC
QB3 Remote alarms & Housekeeping Rack lamps Q2 Power A
Figure 85. 1660SM Block diagram – ( Common units and ISA boards)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
183 / 636
ISA – ATM MATRIX Control
DC/DC Converter Traffic Policing and Shapimg
CELL SWITCHING
T∅
Data
SDH TERMINATION E/O MODULE
STM–1
ISA – PR_EA MATRIX 1GBPS 1 X GB ETHERNET –Batt/Gnd Control
Gigabit Ethernet Optical Interfaces 1000 BASE–SX / LX /ZX
TO/FROM MATRIX See Figure 85.
STM–1 LOCAL PORT (*)
DC/DC Converter
T∅
OPTICAL MODULE #1 Data
MPLS ENGINE
Optical/Electrical Interface
ATM ENGINE
1000 BASE–SX/LX/ZX
Control
DC/DC Converter
T∅
ETHERNET #1
1
ETHERNET #2 ETHERNET #3
Data
MPLS ENGINE
ETHERNET #4
4
Ethernet Interface 10/100 Mbit/s Base T
ISA – PR_EA MATRIX 4X ETHERNET –Batt/Gnd
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
NOTE: (*) – Available only on ATM MATRIX 4X4
Figure 86. 1660SM Block diagram – (ISA boards)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
184 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–Batt/Gnd
Gigabit Ethernet Optical Interfaces 1000 BASE–SX / LX /ZX
ISA – ES1 Control
GBit ETH.
ISA – ES4
(*)
T∅
Physical Interface
1
ETH. 1 Data
Ethernet frame
SDH
mapping into
framer
Ethernet switcher
SDH VC ETH. 8 –Batt/Gnd
8
Ethernet Interfaces 10/100 Mbit/s Base T or 100 Mbit/s Base FX
See Figure 85. TO/FROM MATRIX
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Physical Interface
DC/DC Converter
ETHERNET #1
1
ETHERNET #14
14
Control T∅
10/100 ETH Access card
Data
SDH framer
Ethernet frame mapping into SDH VC
Ethernet switcher
Gigabit Ethernet Access card OPTICAL MODULE #1
–Batt/Gnd
DC/DC Converter
1
1000 BASE–SX/LX/ZX
OPTICAL MODULE #2 1000 BASE–SX/LX/ZX 1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Ethernet Interfaces 10/100 Mbit/s Base T
ISA – ES16
4
Gigabit Ethernet Optical Interfaces 1000 BASE–SX / LX / ZX
TO/FROM MATRIX
See Figure 85.
(*) GIGABIT ETHERNET interface is available only on ES4–8FE board;
Figure 87. 1660SM Block diagram – (ISA – ES boards)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
185 / 636
TO/FROM MATRIX
Control
DC/DC Converter
1
ETHERNET #14
14
Access card
ISA – ETHERNET PORT (10/100 Mb/s)
1
ETHERNET #1
T∅
11
ETHERNET #11 Data
Ethernet frame mapping into SDH VC OPTICAL MODULE #1
Gigabit Ethernet Optical Interfaces 1000 BASE–SX /LX /ZX
See Figure 85.
–Batt/Gnd
ETHERNET #1
1
1000 BASE–SX /LX/ZX
OPTICAL MODULE #2
2
1000 BASE–SX /LX/ZX –Batt/Gnd
Control
DC/DC Converter
Gigabit Ethernet Access card
ISA – GBIT ETHERNET PORT
T∅
Data
Ethernet frame mapping into SDH VCxc
OPTICAL MODULE #1
1
1000 BASE–SX /LX/ZX
OPTICAL MODULE #4
4
1000 BASE–SX /LX/ZX
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
DC/DC Converter
Figure 88. 1660SM Block diagram – (ISA – ETHERNET boards)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
186 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Ethernet frame mapping into SDH VC
Data
Ethernet Interfaces 10/100 Mbit/s Base T
11
ETHERNET #11
Ethernet Interfaces 10/100 Mbit/s Base T
T∅
Ethernet Interfaces
1
ETHERNET #1
10/100 Mbit/s Base T
ISA – ETHERNET PORT (10/100 Mb/s)
Gigabit Ethernet Optical Interfaces 1000 BASE–SX /LX /ZX
Control
1 ETHERNET #1
NETWORK PROCESSOR
16
STM4 1 STM4 2 STM4 3
ETHERNET #16 STM4 FRAME & INTERFACE
MPLS ENGINE TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT
STM4 4
OPTICAL MODULE #1
1
1000 BASE–SX /LX/ZX NETWORK PROCESSOR
–Batt/Gnd from Congi
Ethernet Interfaces 10/100 Mbit/s Base T
ISA – PR MATRIX
OPTICAL MODULE #2
DC/DC Converter
1000 BASE–SX /LX/ZX
Control PR Controller
from/to Matrix
2 GBA–PR Access card
2
Gigabit Ethernet Optical Interfaces 1000 BASE–SX /LX /ZX
TO/FROM STM4 LINE OR PORT CARD
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
16FEA–PR Access card
Craft Terminal
RJ45
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
or NMS
Figure 89. 1660SM Block diagram – (ISA–PR board)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
187 / 636
This sub–system allows connections between any SDH, SONET, PDH or ISA (Integrated Service Adapter) ports (see Figure 90. on page 189). The connections can be realized at VC–12, VC–3, and VC–4 level using a not blocking matrix present on the MATRIX unit. Several types of connections may be established, such as: •
Unidirectional Point to Point
•
Unidirectional Point to Multipoint
•
Bidirectional Point to Point
The maximum matrix cross connection capability can be 96 x 96 STM–1 equivalent port at VC–4 level or 64x64 STM–1 equivalent port at VC–12 / VC–3 level + 32x32 equivalent port at VC–4 level. The following table illustrates the connections for each unit: Table 31. High Order/Low Order connections for 1660SM STM–1, STM–4, STM–16 ports
OC3 ports
140 Mbit/s ports
34 Mbit/s 45 Mbit/s ports
2 Mbit/s ports
PORTS
Structure
AU–4
TU–3
TU–12
AU–3
VC–4
VC–3
VC–12
STM–1,
AU–4
Yes
–
–
–
Yes
–
–
STM–4,
TU–3
–
Yes
–
Yes
–
Yes
–
STM–16
TU–12
–
–
Yes
–
–
–
Yes
OC3
AU–3
–
Yes
–
Yes
–
–
–
140 Mbit/s
VC–4
Yes
–
–
–
Yes
–
–
34Mbit/s 45Mbit/s
VC–3
–
Yes
–
–
–
Yes
–
2Mbit/s
VC–12
–
–
Yes
–
–
–
Yes
The above connections allows the 1660SM to realize Multi Line Terminal configuration, Add/Drop configuration and Mini Cross–Connect configurations in linear links, rings, and mashed network as describe in Chapter 1 on page 65. AU4–4C and AU4–16C concatenated signals can also be cross connected between any STM–4 and STM–16 ports.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Example of connections types are shown in Figure 90. on page 189 : • • • • • • • • •
ED
connections between 2 Mbit/s ports and STM–1 ports connections between 34 Mbit/s ports and STM–1 ports connections between 45 Mbit/s ports and STM–1 ports connections between 140 Mbit/s ports and STM–1 ports VCn connections between STM–1 ports and STM–4 ports VCn connections between STM–1 ports and STM–16 ports VCn connections between STM–4 ports and STM–16 ports VCn connections between ports of the same type etc. 02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
188 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.2 Connections sub–system
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The maximum quantity of interconnections depends on the matrix capacity and shelf composition.
STM–4
STM–16 STM–16
ÁÁÁ ÁÁÁ
ÁÁÁ ÁÁÁ ÁÁ ÁÁ
MATRIX spare
(1)
(2)
(1)
(3) (4) (5)
(6)
4xANY
(1)
(7)
4xOC3
MATRIX main
ÁÁ ÁÁÁ ÁÁ ÁÁÁ
(1)
(1)
ÁÁÁ ÁÁÁ
ÁÁ ÁÁ
(1)
access card
(1)
”Spare”
63x2 Mbit/s ”Main”
access card
34/45 Mbit/s
access card
4X 140 Mbit/s
4X STM–1
access card
access card
ISA units
access card
ÁÁÁ ÁÁÁ (1)
2 Mbit/s to 2 Mbit/s connections, 34Mbit/s to 34 Mbit/s connections, 45 Mbit/s to 45 Mbit/s connections, 140 Mbit/s to 140 Mbit/s, 155 Mbit/s to 155 Mbit/s STM–4 to STM–4, STM–16 to STM–16, 4xANY to 4xANY, OC3 to OC3.
(2)
STM–1 to STM–4/STM–16 connections; ISA to STM–1/STM–4/STM–16
(3)
140 Mbit/s to STM–1/STM–4/STM–16 connections
(4)
34 or 45 Mbit/s to STM–1/STM–4/STM–16 connections
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
NOTES:
(5)
2 Mbit/s to STM–1/STM–4/STM–16 connections
(6)
4xANY to STM–4/STM–16 connections
(7)
OC3 to STM–1/STM–4/STM–16 connections ISA = ATM Matrix, PR_EA Matrix, ES and Ethernet boards Figure 90. High Order/Low Order connections for 1660SM
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
189 / 636
3.3.1 Signal management referred to ”G.783 1994” In the next paragraphs will be explained the SDH and PDH port signal management. The functional blocks in this description are similar to that utilized in the Craft Terminal application. For each port the description is subdivided in two part: –
Signal management from Side B (high bit rate signal) to Side A (low bit rate signal).
–
Signal management from Side A (low bit rate signal) to Side B (high bit rate signal).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Anyway a signal may not transit through all the functional blocks (e.g. from side A to side B) but it comes back to the source side by means of the matrix (LPC, HPC) thus realizing a cross connection.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
190 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.3 SIGNAL MANAGEMENT SUB–SYSTEM
3.3.1.1 SDH port signal management (For STM–1, STM–4 and STM–16 see Figure 91. on page 193)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Side B to Side A description:
ED
•
SPI (Synchronous Physical Interface) It interface the physical transmission medium, regenerates and decodes line signal and detect the LOF alarm.
•
RST (Regenerator Section Termination) It manages the section overhead bytes for the Regeneration Section; it performed frame alignment detection, regenerator section trace recovery and mismatch detection, B1 BIP–8 errored block count.
•
MST (Multiplex Section Termination) It manages the section overhead bytes for the Multiplexing section; performs BIP–24 errored block count, MS–REI recovery, MS–RDI and MS–AIS detection.
•
MSP (Multiplex Section Protection) and MSPC (Multiplex Section Protection Connection) It provides protection for the STM–N signal against failures within a multiplex section, by using a bit oriented protocol for the MSP bytes K1,K2 and P, B1.
•
MSA (Multiplex Section Adaptation) It performs AU4 pointer interpretation, LOP and AIS detection, pointer justification.
•
HPOM (High Order Path Overhead Monitoring) It monitors the higher order VC–n for errors, and recover the trail termination status. it extract the payload independent overhead bytes J1, G1, B3.
•
HPC (High Order Path connection) This function assign higher order VCs of level n at its input port to higher order VCs of level n at its output port.
•
HSUT (Higher Order Supervisory Unequipped Termination) It performs the termination of an unequipped path recovering path trace information, REI and detecting HP–RDI (Path status monitoring),VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count.
•
HPT (High Order Path Termination) This function recover the trail termination status. It extract the payload independent overhead bytes/bits (J1, G1, B3) from the VCn layer ;
•
HPA (High Order Path Adaptation) This functions provide VC–4 disassembly TU pointer interpretation, LOP and TU–AIS detection;
•
LPOM (Lower Order Path Monitor) It is used for performance monitoring purpose and for lower order SNCP/n.
•
LPC (Low Order Path Connection) It assigns lower order VCs of level m at its input ports to lower order VCs of level m at its output ports. The process does not affect the nature of the characteristic information of the signal.
•
LSUT (Lower Order Supervisory Unequipped Termination) It is used to monitor unequipped path trace, recovering VC–m unequipped signal label, BIP–2 recovery.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
191 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
•
LSUT (Lower Order Supervisory Unequipped Termination) It is used to monitor unequipped path trails; it inserts VC–m unequipped signal label, path trace, BIP–2, REI and RDI.
•
LPC (Low Order Path Connection) It assigns lower order VCs of level m at its input ports to lower order VCs of level m at its output ports. The process does not affect the nature of the characteristic information of the signal.
•
LPOM (Lower Order Path Monitor) It is used for performance monitoring purpose and for lower order SNCP/n.
•
HPA (High Order Path Adaptation) This function provides VC–4 assembly, TU pointer generator, TU–AIS.
•
HPT (High Order Path Termination) It performs path trace identification insertion, RDI and REI insertion VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion, signal label insertion.
•
HPOM (High Order Path Overhead Monitoring) It monitors the higher order VC–4 for errors, and recover the trail termination status. it extract the payload independent overhead bytes J1, G1, B3.
•
HPC (High Order Path connection) This function assign higher order VCs of level n at its input port to higher order VCs of level n at its output port.
•
HSUT (Higher Order Supervisory Unequipped Termination) It generates and inserts an unequipped container, trail trace identifier, RDI and REI, VC–4 BIP–8.
•
MSA (Multiplex Section Adaptation) It performs AUG assembly, AU–4 pointer generation, AU–AIS generation
•
MSP (Multiplex Section Protection) and MSPC (Multiplex Section Protection Connection) It provides protection for the STM–N signal against failures within a multiplex section, by using a bit oriented protocol for the MSP bytes K1,K2 and P, B1.
•
MST (Multiplex Section Termination) It performs BIP–24 calculation and insertion, MS–REI, MS–RDI and MS–AIS insertion.
•
RST (Regenerator Section Termination) It performs frame alignment insertion , regenerator section path trace insertion BIP–8 (B1) calculation and insertion.
•
SPI (Synchronous Physical Interface) Signal conditioning for transmission medium
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
192 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Side A to Side B description:
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Side A To point Y1 Figure 92.
From point Y2 Figure 92. X2
X1
LSUT
LSUT
Low Order Path Layer
LPC LPOM
HSUT
LPOM
HPA
HPA
HPT
HPT
To point W1 Figure 93. Z1
From point W2 Figure 93.
HSUT
Z2
High Order Path Layer
HPC HPOM
HPOM
MSA
MSA
MSP
MSPC
Multiplex Section Layer
MSP
MST
MST
RST
RST
SPI
SPI
Regenerator Section Layer
SDH Physical Layer
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Side B
Figure 91. SDH signal management block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
193 / 636
Ports managed are: 2Mbit/s (mapped into VC–12), 34Mbit/s (VC–3), 45Mbit/s (VC–3) and 140Mbit/s (VC–4). The following functions are associated with each PDH port. 2Mbit/s, 34 Mbit/s and 45 Mbit/s port management ( See Figure 92. on page 194 ) Side B to Side A description: •
PPI This block provides the interface between the physical transmission medium and the internal unit format. The received line signal is HDB3 coded. A decoder on the physical interface decodes the signal to NRZ (no return–to–zero) format.
•
LPA This block adapts user data for transport in the synchronous domain. For asynchronous user data, lower order path adaptation involves bit justification. The 2.048 Mbit/s is inserted into a VC–12, which is synchronized (stuffing) with the correspondent TU–12. The 34 Mbit/s or 45 Mbit/s is inserted into a VC–3, which is synchronized with the correspondent TU–3.
•
LPT For the 2.048 Mbit/s the LPT function creates a VC–12 by generating and adding POH to a C–12. The POH formats are defined in Recommendations G.708 and G.709. For the 34 Mbit/s and 45 Mbit/s the LPT functions creates a VC–3 by generating and adding POH to a C–3.
Side A to Side B description: •
LPT The LPT function terminates and processes the POH to determine the status of the defined path attributes.
•
LPA It extracts the POH from the VC–12 (2 Mbit/s) or VC–3 (34 Mbit/s and 45 Mbit/s) .
•
PPI This block provides the interface between the internal unit format and the physical transmission medium. It encodes HDB3 the signal to be sent on line. Side B
PPI
PPI
LPA
LPA
LPT
LPT
Y1
Y2
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
From point X1 Figure 91.
To point X2 Figure 91. Side A
Figure 92. 2Mbit/s, 34 Mbit/s, 45 Mbit/s signal management block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
194 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.3.1.2 PDH port signal management
140 Mbit/s port management ( See Figure 93. on page 195 ) All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Side B to Side A description: •
PPI This block provides the interface between the physical transmission medium and the internal unit format. The received line signal is CMI coded. A decoder on the physical interface decodes the signal to NRZ (no return–to–zero) format.
•
LPA The 140 Mbit/s plesiochronous stream is inserted in a C4 container to be adapted so as to be transported into the synchronous network.
•
HPT The Virtual Container (VC–4) is formatted. The VC–4 is structured so that its octets are distributed within a 125 µs. interval and consist of the C4 container and POH.
Side A to Side B description: •
HPT The HPT extract and processes the POH to determine the status of the defined path attributes.
•
LPA It extracts the 140 Mbit/s signal from the container C4 .
•
PPI This block provides the interface between the internal unit format and the physical transmission medium. It encodes CMI the signal to be sent on line.
Side B
PPI
PPI
LPA
LPA
HPT
HPT
w1
w2
From point Z1 Figure 91.
To point Z2 Figure 91. Side A
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 93. 140Mbit/s signal management block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
195 / 636
3.3.2 SIGNAL MANAGEMENT referred to ”G. 783”
This paragraph has been introduced as an aid to the understanding of the terms used for the Termination Point (T.P.). These TPs can be accessed and managed by the operator for performance monitoring purpose . In the following will be explained the atomic functions naming conventions and the signal processing in the SDH and PDH port . 3.3.2.1 ATOMIC FUNCTION NAMING CONVENTIONS Each characteristic layer of the SDH network is splitted into different atomic functions : –
trail termination function : •
Source (So): additional information is added to the characteristic information to allow trail monitoring.
•
Sink (Sk): the information related to the trail monitoring is extracted
If a signal fail condition of the associated data signal is detected, a TSF signal is generated to inform the next downstream function. TSF is use in the HPOM (Snm) function to drive the SNCP/MSP protection. –
adaptation function : •
Source (So):the characteristic information is adapted from the client to the server layer
•
Sink (Sk): the characteristic information is adapted from the server to the client layer
The processes present in an adaptation function can be : encoding, rate changing, alignment, justification, multiplexing. If a signal fail condition of the associated data signal is detected, a SSF signal is generated to inform the next downstream function. –
connection function : it represents the connection functions inside the network ( link connection, sub–network network connection) and it is performed by the matrix functional block
Each atomic function is represented by a different symbol and named as follow: –
trail termination TT : triangle Source
Sink naming rules: _TT[ _]
–
example: _TT[ _]
adaptation A : trapezium Sink
Source
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
naming rules: /_A[] –
connection C: circle or ellipse
naming rules: _C
ED
example: /_A[]
example: _C
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
196 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The ITU–T G.783 Recommendation describe the SDH characteristic in terms of atomic functions.
3.3.2.2 SDH PORT FUNCTIONAL BLOCKS
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(For STM–1 , STM–4 and STM–16 see Figure 94. on page 206) The received signal is either electrical STM–1 CMI coded (ITU–T G.703 Rec.) or optical STM–N (ITU–T G.957 Rec.). The SDH frame format is compliant with ITU_T G.707 Rec. In this paragraph will be explained the SDH and PDH port signal management referred to atomic function. For each port the description is subdivided in two part: –
Signal management from Side B (high bit rate signal) to Side A (low bit rate signal).
–
Signal management from Side A (low bit rate signal) to Side B (high bit rate signal).
Side B to Side A description: a)
SDH Physical layer (SPI)
It is the interface between the physical transmission medium and the Regeneration Section. The function performed are describe below: •
Optical or Electrical Section layer Trail Termination: OSn_TT_Sk or ESn_TT_Sk •
•
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
b)
ED
input LOS detection.
Optical or Electrical Section layer Adaptation to Regenerator Section layer: OSn/RSn_A_Sk and ESn/Rsn_A_Sk •
descrambler.
• • •
A1, A2: frame alignment detection. OOF count and LOF detection. AIS or SSF insertion if LOF is detected
Regenerator Section layer (RST) •
Regenerator Section layer Trail Termination: RSn_TT_Sk • J0: regenerator section trace recovery and mismatch detection (TIM) (not managed in this release) • B1: BIP–8 Errored Block count: even bit parity is computed and compared with B1 recovered from the current frame. • AIS insertion if TIM is detected
•
Regenerator Section layer to Multiplex Section layer Adaptation: RSn/MSn_A_Sk • AIS insertion on AIS detection
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
197 / 636
Multiplex Section layer : •
Multiplex Section layer Trail Termination (MST): MSn_TT_Sk • • • •
•
Multiplex Section layer MSn/MSnP_A_Sk • •
–
•
the K1–K2 information (APS protocol) is recovered . AIS or SSF insertion
AIS or SSF detection TSF insertion (on SSF detection)
Multiplex Section layer Adaptation to the High Order Path layer (MSA): MSn/Sn_A_Sk • • • • •
AU–4 Pointer interpreter. LOP detection AU–AIS detection AIS or SSF insertion (on LOP and AU–AIS detection) PJE (Pointer Justification Event) count.
High Order Path layer: •
High Order Path Overhead Monitoring Function (HPOM) –
High Order Path Overhead Trail Termination: Snm_TT_Sk • • • • • • •
•
J1: Path Trace information is recovered. G1[1–4]: The REI information is recovered. G1[5]: Path Status monitoring ––> HP–RDI detection. C2: Signal Label Monitoring ––> UNEQ and VC–AIS detection. B3: VC–4 BIP–8 Errored Block Count ––> Ex–BER and Signal Degrade alarm TSF insertion TSD insertion TSF and TSD are used for SNCP switch
High Order Supervisory Unequipped Termination –
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
to the Multiplex Section Protection Sub–layer Adaptation:
Multiplex Section Protection Sub–layer Trail Termination: MSnP_TT_Sk • •
High Order Supervisory Unequipped Trail Termination (HSUT): Sns_TT_Sk • • • • •
ED
BIP–24N Errored Block count ––>Ex–BER, Signal Degrade alarm MS–REI recovery. MS–RDI detection. MS–AIS detection.
Multiplex Section Sub–layer Protection function (MSP): –
d)
B2: M1: K2[6–8]: K2[6–8]:
J1: G1[1–4]: G1[5]: C2: B3:
Path Trace information is recovered. The REI information is recovered. Path Status monitoring ––>HP–RDI detection. Signal Label Monitoring ––> UNEQ and VC–AIS detection. VC–4 BIP–8 Errored Block Count.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
198 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
c)
•
High Order Path Tandem Connection Trail Termination (according to Option 2 TC described in Recc. ITU–T G.707)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
High Order Path Tandem Connection Termination (HTCT): SnD_TT_Sk • • • • • •
•
•
N1[1–4]: VC–4 BIP–8 extraction and EDC calculation. N1[8][73]: RDI extraction. N1[5]: REI extraction. N1[7][74]: ODI extraction (Outgoing Defect Indication). N1[6]: OEI extraction (Outgoing Error Indication) N1[7–8]: extraction from the multiframed channel N1[7–8] of: FAS (Frame Alignment Signal) in frames 1 to 8. trace identifier in frames 9 to 72. TC RDI and ODI in frames 73 to 76. B3: BIP–8 compensation.
High Order Path Tandem Connection Adaptation (according to Option 2 TC described in Recc. ITU–T G.707) –
High Order Path Tandem Connection Adaptation (HTCA): SnD/Sn_A_Sk this function will restore the invalid Frame Start condition if that existed at the iput of the tandem connection. AIS insertion.
•
High Order Path Tandem Connection Monitoring (according to Option 2 TC described in Recc. ITU–T G.707) –
High Order Path Tandem Connection Monitoring (HTCM): SnDm_TT_Sk
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
• • • • • •
ED
N1[1–4]: VC–4 BIP–8 extraction and EDC calculation. N1[8][73]: RDI extraction. N1[5]: REI extraction. N1[7][74]: ODI extraction (Outgoing Defect Indication). N1[6]: OEI extraction (Outgoing Error Indication) N1[7–8]: extraction from the multiframed channel N1[7–8] of: FAS (Frame Alignment Signal) in frames 1 to 8. trace identifier in frames 9 to 72. TC RDI and ODI in frames 73 to 76.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
199 / 636
•
• • • • • •
Low Order Path Overhead Monitoring Function (LPOM) –
Low Order Path Overhead Trail Termination: Smm_TT_Sk • • • • • • •
•
J2: Trace Identifier Monitoring. V5[8]: RDI information is recovered and reported. V5[3]: REI bit is recovered and the derived performance primitives are reported. V5[5–7]: Signal Label Monitoring ––> VC–AIS detection. V5[1,2]: VC–m BIP–2 Errored Block Count ––>Ex–BER, Signal Degrade alarm AIS or SSF detection––>SSF alarm TSF insertion (used for SNCP switch)
Low Order Supervisory Unequipped Termination (LSUT) –
Low Order Supervisory Unequipped Trail Termination: Sms_TT_Sk • • • • •
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
VC–4 disassembly. TU pointer interpretation. LOP detection. TU–AIS detection. C2: HP–SLM (signal label mismatch) detection. H4: LOM (Loss of Multiframe) detection.
Low Order Path layer: •
ED
Path Trace information is recovered ––> TIM detection. The REI information is recovered. Path Status monitoring ––>HP–RDI detection. UNEQ detection. VC–4 BIP–8 Errored Block Count ––> Ex–BER, Signal Degrade alarm
High Order Path layer Adaptation to Low Order Path layer (HPA): Sn/Sm_A_Sk • • • • • •
e)
J1: G1[1–4]: G1[5]: C2: B3:
V5[5–7]: J2: V5[1,2]: V5[3]: V5[8]:
signal label is recovered from the VC–m. 000 (unequipped) is expected. trail trace identifier is recovered. BIP–2 is recovered. REI bit is recovered and the derived performance primitives is reported. RDI information is recovered and reported.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
200 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
High Order Path layer Trail Termination Function (HPT): Sn_TT_Sk
•
Low Order Path Tandem Connection Trail Termination (according to Option 2 TC described in Recc. ITU–T G.707)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
Low Order Path Tandem Connection Termination (LTCT): SmD_TT_Sk • • • • • •
• • •
N2[1–2]: VC–12 BIP–2 extraction and EDC calculation. N2[8][73]: RDI extraction. N2[5]: REI extraction. N2[7][74]: ODI extraction (Outgoing Defect Indication). N2[6]: OEI extraction (Outgoing Error Indication) N2[7–8]: extraction from the multiframed channel N2[7–8] of: FAS (Frame Alignment Signal) in frames 1 to 8. trace identifier in frames 9 to 72. TC RDI and ODI in frames 73 to 76. N2[4]: AIS detection V5[1–2]: BIP–2 compensation.
Low Order Path Tandem Connection Adaptation (according to Option 2 TC described in Recc. ITU–T G.707) –
Low Order Path Tandem Connection Adaptation (LTCA): SmD/Sm_A_Sk this function will restore the invalid Frame Start condition if that existed at the iput of the tandem connection. AIS insertion.
•
Low Order Path Tandem Connection Monitoring (according to Option 2 TC described in Recc. ITU–T G.707) –
Low Order Path Tandem Connection Monitoring (LTCM): SnDm_TT_Sk • • • • • •
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
•
ED
N2[1–2]: VC–12 BIP–2 extraction and EDC calculation. N2[8][73]: RDI extraction. N2[5]: REI extraction. N2[7][74]: ODI extraction (Outgoing Defect Indication). N2[6]: OEI extraction (Outgoing Error Indication) N2[7–8]: extraction from the multiframed channel N2[7–8] of: FAS (Frame Alignment Signal) in frames 1 to 8. trace identifier in frames 9 to 72. TC RDI and ODI in frames 73 to 76. N2[4]: AIS detection
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
201 / 636
Side A to Side B description: Low Order Path layer: •
Low Order Supervisory Unequipped Termination (LSUT) –
Low Order Supervisory Unequipped Trail Termination: Sms_TT_So • • • • •
•
V5[5–7]: J2: V5[1,2]: V5[3]: V5[8]:
signal label 000 (unequipped) is inserted in the VC–m. trail trace identifier is generated. BIP–2 is calculated and transmitted. the number of errors is encoded in REI. RDI indication is inserted.
Low Order Path Overhead Monitoring Function (LPOM) –
Low Order Path Overhead Trail Termination: Smm_TT_Sk • • • • •
•
J2: V5[8]: V5[3]: V5[5–7]: V5[1,2]:
Trace Identifier Monitoring. RDI information is recovered and reported. REI bit is recovered and the derived performance primitives are reported. Signal Label Monitoring ––> VC–AIS detection. VC–m BIP–2 Errored Block Count ––> Ex–BER, Signal Degrade alarm
Low Order Path Tandem Connection Adaptation (according to Option 2 TC described in Recc. ITU–T G.707) –
Low Order Path Tandem Connection Adaptation (LTCA): SmD/Sm_A_Sk this function will restore the invalid Frame Start condition if that existed at the iput of the tandem connection. AIS insertion.
•
Low Order Path Tandem Connection Trail Termination (according to Option 2 TC described in Recc. ITU–T G.707) –
Low Order Path Tandem Connection Termination (LTCT): SmD_TT_So • • • • •
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
• •
ED
N2[8][73]: RDI insertion N2[5]: REI insertion N2[7][74]: ODI insertion (Outgoing Defect Indication) N2[6]: OEI insertion (Outgoing Error Indication) N2[7–8]: insertion in the multiframed channel N1[7 –8] of: FAS (Frame Alignment Signal) in frames 1 to 8 trace identifier in frames 9 to 72 TC RDI and ODI in frames 73 to 76 N2[1–2]: BIP–2 calculation and insertion V5[1–2]: BIP–2 compensation
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
202 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
a)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
•
Low Order Path Tandem Connection Monitoring (according to Option 2 TC described in Recc. ITU–T G.707) –
Low Order Path Tandem Connection Monitoring (LTCM): SnDm_TT_Sk • • • • • •
• b)
High Order Path layer: •
Low Order Path layer to High Order Path layer Adaptation (HPA): Sn/Sm_A_So • • • • •
•
•
J1: G1: B3:
path trace identifier is inserted. insertion of RDI[5] and/or REI[1–4] information. VC–4 Bip–8 calculation and insertion.
High Order Path Overhead Monitoring Function –
High Order Path Overhead Trail Termination (HPOM): Snm_TT_Sk • • • • • •
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
VC–4 assembly. TU pointer generator. TU–AIS generator. C2: Signal label insertion. H4: Multiframe indicator
High Order Path layer Trail Termination Function (HPT): Sn_TT_So • • •
ED
N2[1–2]: VC–12 BIP–2 extraction and EDC calculation. N2[8][73]: RDI extraction. N2[5]: REI extraction. N2[7][74]: ODI extraction (Outgoing Defect Indication). N2[6]: OEI extraction (Outgoing Error Indication) N2[7–8]: extraction from the multiframed channel N2[7–8] of: FAS (Frame Alignment Signal) in frames 1 to 8. trace identifier in frames 9 to 72. TC RDI and ODI in frames 73 to 76. N2[4]: AIS detection
J1: Path Trace information is recovered. G1[1–4]: The REI information is recovered. G1[5]: Path Status monitoring ––> HP–RDI detection. C2: Signal Label Monitoring ––> UNEQ and VC–AIS detection. B3: VC–4 BIP–8 Errored Block Count. AIS or SSF detection ––> SSF alarm
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
203 / 636
High Order Supervisory Unequipped Trail Termination (HSUT): Sns_TT_So • • • • •
•
Generation of an unequipped container and frame offset. C2: “unequipped” insertion. J1: trail trace identifier is generated. G1: insertion of RDI and/or REI information. B3: VC–4 Bip–8 calculation and insertion.
High Order Path Tandem Connection Adaptation (according to Option 2 TC described in Recc. ITU–T G.707) –
High Order Path Tandem Connection Adaptation (HTCA): SnD_A_So this function will replace the incoming Frame Start signal by a local generated one if all–ONEs VC is received.
•
High Order Path Tandem Connection Trail Termination (according to Option 2 TC described in Recc. ITU–T G.707) –
High Order Path Tandem Connection Termination (HTCT): SnD_TT_So • • • • •
• •
•
High Order Path Tandem Connection Monitoring (according to Option 2 TC described in Recc. ITU–T G.707) –
High Order Path Tandem Connection Monitoring (HTCM): SnDm_TT_Sk
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
• • • • • •
ED
N1[8][73]: RDI insertion N1[5]: REI insertion N1[7][74]: ODI insertion (Outgoing Defect Indication) N1[6]: OEI insertion (Outgoing Error Indication) N1[7–8]: insertion in the multiframed channel N1[7 –8] of: FAS (Frame Alignment Signal) in frames 1 to 8 trace identifier in frames 9 to 72 TC RDI and ODI in frames 73 to 76 N1[1–4]: BIP–8 calculation and insertion B3: BIP–8 compensation
N1[1–4]: VC–4 BIP–8 extraction and EDC calculation. N1[8][73]: RDI extraction. N1[5]: REI extraction. N1[7][74]: ODI extraction (Outgoing Defect Indication). N1[6]: OEI extraction (Outgoing Error Indication) N1[7–8]: extraction from the multiframed channel N1[7–8] of: FAS (Frame Alignment Signal) in frames 1 to 8. trace identifier in frames 9 to 72. TC RDI and ODI in frames 73 to 76.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
204 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
c)
Multiplex Section layer:
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
•
Multiplex Section layer Adaptation to the High Order Path layer (MSA): MSn/Sn_A_So • • •
•
Multiplex Section Sub–layer Protection function (MSP) –
Multiplex Section Protection Sub–layer Termination: MSnP_TT_So •
–
•
generation of K1–K2 information (APS protocol).
Multiplex Section layer Trail Termination: MSn_TT_So • • • •
B2: M1: K2[6–8]: K2[6–8]:
BIP–24N calculation and insertion. MS–REI insertion. MS–RDI insertion. MS–AIS insertion.
Regenerator Section layer (RST) •
Multiplex Section layer to Regenerator Section layer Adaptation : RSn/MSn_A_So •
•
RS–AIS insertion.
Regenerator Section layer Trail Termination: RSn_TT_So • • •
e)
no information is inserted.
Multiplex Section layer Adaptation to the Multiplex Section Protection Sub–layer: MSn/MSnP_A_So •
d)
AUG assembly and byte interleaving. AU–4 Pointer generator. AU–AIS generator.
A1, A2: J0: B1:
frame alignment insertion. regenerator section trace insertion (not managed in this release) BIP–8 calculation and insertion.
SDH Physical layer (SPI)
It is the interface between Regeneration Section and the physical transmission medium. The function performed are describe below: •
Optical or Electrical Section layer Adaptation to Regenerator Section layer: OSn/RSn_A_So and ESn/Rsn_A_So: • •
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
•
ED
scrambler. AIS generator (on LOS or LOF).
Optical or Electrical Section layer Trail Termination: OSn_TT _So or ESn_TT _So • signal conditioning for transmission medium (e.g. electrical/optical conversion etc.)
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
205 / 636
Side A
LPOM Smm
LTCM SmDm
LTCT SmD
To point Y1 From point Y2 Figure 95. Figure 95. Figure 96. Figure 96. LSUT
X1
X2
Sms
Low Order Path Layer
LTCA SmD/Sm
LSUT Sms
LTCM SmDm
LTCT SmD
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
LTCA SmD/Sm
LPOM Smm
Sm LPC
Sn/Sm
HTCA SnD/Sn
HTCT Snd
HPOM Snm
HSUT Sns
Sn/Sm HPT
HPT
Sn
High Order Path Layer
HPA
HPA
HTCA SnD/Sn
Sn
To point W1 From point W2 Figure 97. Figure 97. Z2 Z1
HSUT Sns
HPOM Snm
HTCT Snd
Sn HPC
HTCM SnDm
HTCM SnDm
MSA (*)
MSn/Sn
MSn/Sn
MSnP
MSnP
MSP
MSP
MSnPC MSn/MSnP
MST
MSn
MSn
RSn/MSn
RSn/MSn
RSn
RSn
MST
RST
OSn/RSn or ESn/RSn OSn or ESn
Multiplex Section Layer
MSn/MSnP
RST
SPI
MSA (*)
OSn/RSn or ESn/RSn OSn or ESn
SPI
Regeneration Section Layer
SDH Physical Layer
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Side B (*) – 1,4,16,64 MSn/Sn are multiplied in STM–n
Figure 94. 1660SM Block Diagram: signal management (SDH port)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
206 / 636
3.3.2.3 PDH PORT FUNCTIONAL BLOCKS
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
In LC–NG PDH Low Order ports managed are 2Mbit/s (mapped into VC–12), 34Mbit/s (VC–3), 45Mbit/s (VC–3) and 140Mbit/s (VC–4). The following functions are associated with each PDH port. 2 MBIT/S PORT MANAGEMENT (See Figure 95. on page 208 ) Side B to Side A description: a)
Low Order Path layer: •
Low Order Path layer Trail Termination Function (LPT): S12_TT_Sk • • • • •
•
Low Order Path layer Adaptation to PDH Section layer (LPA): S12/P12x_A_Sk or S12/P12s_A_Sk • •
b)
J2: trail trace identifier is recovered ––> TIM detection. V5[1,2]: BIP–2 is recovered ––> Ex–BER, Signal Degrade alarm V5[3]: REI bit is recovered and the derived performance primitives is reported. V5[8]: RDI information is recovered and reported. AIS or SSF detection ––> SSF alarm
V5[5–7]: Signal label detection in the byte V5[5–7] ––> Signal label Mismatch detection AIS or SSF is applied if Signal label Mismatch is detected
Electrical PDH Physical Section layer (PPI) •
Adaptation to PDH section layer: E12/P12x_A_So or E12/P12s_A_So •
•
It convert the internal signal code to the line code.
Trail Termination: E12_TT_So •
signal conditioning for transmission medium ( e.g. electrical level, etc.)
Side A to Side B description: a)
Electrical PDH Physical Section layer (PPI) •
Trail Termination: E12_TT_Sk • •
•
PDH physical adaptation layer: E12/P12x_A_Sk or E12/P12s_A_Sk • • •
b)
PDH Section layer S12/P12s_A_So •
• 1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
timing is extracted. data are decoded. AIS insertion if LOF or AIS is detected.
Low Order Path layer: •
to Low Order Path layer Adaptation
(LPA): S12/P12x_A_So or
V5[5–7]: Signal label insertion in the byte V5[5–7].
Low Order Path layer Trail Termination function (LPT): S12_TT_So • • • •
ED
input LOS detection. AIS insertion if LOS is detected
J2: V5[1,2]: V5[3]: V5[8]:
trail trace identifier is generated. BIP–2 is calculated and transmitted. the number of errors is encoded in REI. RDI indication is inserted.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
207 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Side A
PPI
PPI E12
E12
E12/P12
E12/P12
LPA
LPA S12/P12
Low Order Path
S12/P12
Layer
LPT
S12
LPT
S12
Y2
Y1
To point X2
From point X1
Figure 94.
Figure 94.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Side B
Figure 95. 1660SM Block Diagram: signal management ( 2Mbit/s PDH ports)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
208 / 636
34 MBIT/S AND 45 MBIT/S PORT MANAGEMENT
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 96. on page210 ) Side B to Side A description: a)
Low Order Path layer: •
Low Order Path layer Trail Termination Function (LPT): S3_TT_Sk • • • • • •
•
Low Order Path layer Adaptation to PDH Section layer (LPA): S3/P3x_A_Sk or S3/P3s_A_Sk • •
b)
J1: Path Trace information is recovered ––> TIM detection. G1[1–4]: The REI information is recovered. G1[5]: Path Status monitoring ––>HP–RDI detection. C2: UNEQ detection. B3: VC–3 BIP–8 Errored Block Count ––> Ex–BER, Signal Degrade SSF detection ––> SSF alarm
C2: Signal label detection in the byte C2 –> Signal label Mismatch detection. AIS or SSF is applied if TSF or Signal label Mismatch is detected
Electrical PDH Physical Section layer (PPI) •
Adaptation to PDH section layer: E3/P3x_A_So or E3/P3s_A_So •
•
It convert the internal signal code to the line code (HDB3)
Trail Termination: E3_TT_So •
signal conditioning for transmission medium ( e.g. electrical level, etc.).
Side A to Side B description: a)
Electrical PDH Physical Section layer (PPI) •
Trail Termination: E3_TT_Sk •
•
PDH physical Adaptation layer: E3/P3x_A_Sk or E3/P3s_A_Sk • • • •
b)
PDH Section layer to Low Order Path layer Adaptation (LPA): S3/P3x_A_So or S3/P3s_A_So •
• 1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
timing is extracted. data are decoded. AIS detection and insertion. LOF detection (only in case of E3/P3x_A_Sk)
Low Order Path layer: •
The signal label is inserted in C2
Low Order Path layer Trail Termination Function (LPT): S3_TT_So • • •
ED
Input LOS detection.
J1: G1: B3:
path trace identifier is inserted. insertion of RDI[5] and/or REI[1–4] information. VC–3 Bip–8 calculation and insertion.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
209 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Side A
PPI
PPI E3
E3
E3/P3
E3/P3
LPA
LPA S3/P3
Low Order Path Layer
S3/P3
LPT
LPT S3
S3
Y1
Y2
From point X1 Figure 94.
To point X2 Figure 94.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Side B
Figure 96. 1660SM Block Diagram: signal management ( 34 Mbit/s and 45 Mbit/s PDH ports)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
210 / 636
140 MBIT/S PORT MANAGEMENT
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 97. on page 212) Side B to Side A description: a)
High Order Path layer: •
High Order Path layer Trail Termination Function (HPT): S4_TT_Sk • • • • • •
•
Low Order Path layer Adaptation to PDH Section layer (LPA): S4/P4x_A_Sk or S4/P4s_A_Sk • •
b)
J1: Path Trace information is recovered ––> TIM detection. G1[1–4]: The REI information is recovered. G1[5]: Path Status monitoring ––>HP–RDI detection. C2: UNEQ detection. B3: VC–4 BIP–8 Errored Block Count––> Ex–BER, Signal Degrade alarm SSF detection ––> SSF alarm
C2: Signal label detection in the byte C2 –> Signal label Mismatch detection. AIS or SSF is applied if TSF or Signal label Mismatch is detected
Electrical PDH Physical Section layer (PPI) •
Adaptation to PDH section layer:E4/P4x_A_So or E4/P4s_A_So •
•
It convert the internal signal code to the line code (CMI)
Trail Termination: E4_TT_So •
signal conditioning for transmission medium ( e.g. electrical level, etc.).
Side A to Side B description: a)
Electrical PDH Physical Section layer (PPI) •
Trail Termination: E4_TT_Sk •
•
PDH physical Adaptation layer: E4/P4x_A_Sk or E4/P4s_A_Sk • • • •
b)
PDH Section layer to Low Order Path layer Adaptation (LPA): S4/P4x_A_So or S4/P4s_A_So •
• 1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
timing is extracted. data are decoded. AIS detection and insertion. LOF detection (only in case of E4/P4x_A_Sk)
Low Order Path layer: •
The signal label is inserted in C2
High Order Path layer Trail Termination Function (HPT): S4_TT_So • • •
ED
Input LOS detection.
J1: G1: B3:
path trace identifier is inserted. insertion of RDI[5] and/or REI[1–4] information. VC–4 Bip–8 calculation and insertion.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
211 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Side A
PPI
PPI E4
E4
E4/P4
E4/P4
LPA
LPA S4/P4
S4/P4
High Order Path Layer HPT
S4
HPT
W1
S4
W2
From point Z1
To point Z2
Figure 94.
Figure 94.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Side B
Figure 97. 1660SM Block Diagram: signal management ( 140 Mbit/s PDH ports)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
212 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.4 ISA (Integrated Service Adapter) introduction Today’s metropolitan and regional optical transmission networks need the flexibility to support new and existing services. As new data services overcome traditional voice services in terms of global traffic volume, telecommunication operators face a host of challenges. These include finding the optimal solution with the bandwidth to handle increasing data traffic, keeping infrastructure updating investments to a minimum and protecting their high revenues on traditional voice services. Whereas core networks have to provide traffic with huge bandwidth capacity, metro and regional networks need to focus on better aggregating traffic with refined dimensioning and improved network resource allocation. Integrated ”data–aware” features distributed along the optical transmission nodes of today’s metro networks enable multi–service and multi–technology transmission of data services. They optimize the network infrastructure and bandwidth allocation, giving carriers the twofold benefit of reducing the need for extra investments in dedicated data equipment and safeguarding their high revenues on traditional voice services. Alcatel’s Integrated Service Adapter (ISA) series of plug–in cards are specially designed for the Optical Multi–Service Nodes (OMSN) family (1660SM is part of this family) . They enhance the optical transport network by adding data–aware features that are easy to introduce, allowing carriers to efficiently and cost–effectively aggregate, switch and transport the expanding amount of data services in their metropolitan network. 1660SM equipped with ISA plug–in cards give telecom operators a new generation modular platform for multi–service SDH transport and further strengthen Alcatel’s leading position in the supply of optical multi–technology transmission networks. Whenever and wherever it is needed in the metro network, OMSNs extend their multi–service functionality by integrating ISA plug–in ATM switching and Ethernet/Gigabit Ethernet rate–adaptive transport capabilities into a single optical network element efficiently and cost–effectively. The ISA plug–ins bring metro networks the switching intelligence needed to aggregate and groom mixes of different packet–based data protocols and traditional TDM services (refer to Figure 98. on page 214). ATM and Ethernet ISA cards are able to provide services such as ATM Virtual Private Networks, Broadband Virtual Leased Lines and TLS. The OMSN product family allows operators of SDH transport networks to introduce a wide variety of data managed services including top–level differentiated QoS capabilities, variable service rates and traffic congestion management. Different types of ISA cards can be easily and quickly plugged into 1660SM. The system is modular and the plug–ins can be chosen according to the specific application the optical multi–service equipment needs to manage.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
In the following will be explained the different ISA boards type and their application in the network: –
ISA – ATM (Asynchronous Transfer Mode) refer to paragraph 3.5 on page 215.
–
ISA – PR_EA (Packet Ring Edge Aggregator) refer to paragraph 3.6 on page 224
–
ISA – PR (Packet Ring) refer to paragraph 3.7 on page 235
–
ISA – ETHERNET/FAST ETHERNET/GIGABIT ETHERNET refer to paragraph 3.8 on page 253
–
ISA – ES (Ethernet Switch) refer to paragraph 3.9 on page 270
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
213 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
SAN
UMTS
ISP1 ISP2 RNC
DWDM
ATM
POS Radio
ATM
LMDS
Optical Ring Eth
OMSN
DWDM/OMSN
Enterprise ATM
DWDM
DSL DSL
CORE
GbE
EDGE
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ACCESS
Residential
Enterprise
Figure 98. Example of technology convergency with ISA boards in OMSN
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
214 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.5 ISA – ATM management sub–system 3.5.1 ATM ( Asynchronous Transfer Mode) basic Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM) is an International Telecommunication Union Telecommunication Standardization Sector (ITU–T) standard for cell relay wherein information for multiple service types, such as voice, video, or data, is conveyed in small, fixed–size cells. ATM networks are connection oriented. This chapter provides summaries of ATM protocols, services, and operation. According to ITU–T Recommendation I.311, an ATM transport network has two layers: the ATM layer and the physical layer as shown in Table 32. . Table 32. ATM transport network layered model Higher layer ATM layer
VC (Virtual Channel) level VP (Virtual Path) level
ATM Transport network Physical Layer
Transmission Path Level Transmission Media Level
The ATM layer is subdivided into two levels: the VP level and the VC level. The relations between the Virtual Channel, the Virtual Path and the Transmission Path are shown in Figure 99. on page 215.
VP
VC VC VC
ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ
VP
VP
VP
Transmission Path
VP
VP
VC VC VC
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 99. Relationship between the VC, the VP and the TP
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
215 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ATM transfers information in fixed –size unit called cells ; each cell consist of 53 octets, or bytes. The first 5 bytes contain cell–header information and the remaining 48 contain the “payload” (user information). Figure 100. on page 216 illustrates the basic format of an ATM cell.
8 Bits
HEADER (5 bytes)
53 Bytes PAYLOAD (48 bytes)
Figure 100. Basic format of an ATM cell An ATM network is made up of an ATM switch and ATM endpoints. An ATM switch is responsible for cell transit through an ATM network. An ATM switch accepts the incoming cell from an ATM endpoint or another ATM switch. It then reads and updates the cell–header information and quickly switches the cell to an output interface toward its destination. An ATM endpoint (or end system) contains an ATM network interface adapter. Examples of ATM endpoints are workstations, routers etc.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
An ATM network consists of a set of ATM switches interconnected by point–to–point ATM links or interfaces. ATM switches support two primary types of interfaces: UNI and NNI. The UNI connects ATM end systems (such as hosts and routers) to an ATM switch. The NNI connects two ATM switches. Depending on whether the switch is owned and located at the customers premises or publicly owned and operated by the telephone company, UNI and NNI can be further subdivided into public and private UNIs and NNIs. A private UNI connects an ATM endpoint and a private ATM switch. Its public counterpart connects an ATM endpoint or private switch to a public switch. A private NNI connects two ATM switches within the same private organization. A public one connects two ATM switches within the same public organization (see Figure 101. on page 217).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
216 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Public ATM Network
Private ATM Network ATM Switch
Public UNI Public NNI
ATM Switch
ED Pivate NNI ATM Switch
ATM Switch UNI UNI
Private UNI UNI
Figure 101. ATM network interface
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
217 / 636
8 Bits
HEADER (5 Bytes)
8 Bits VPI
GFC VPI
VPI VCI
VCI PT
PT
CLP
HEC
PAYLOAD (48 Bytes)
53 Bytes
HEC
CLP
ATM UNI cell
ATM NNI cell
GFC (Generic Flow Control) Generic Flow Control field permits multiplexing the transmission of several terminals on the same user interface. It is used for the traffic from the users to the network VPI/VCI (Virtual Path Identifier / Virtual Channel Identifier) The VPI/VCI field contains 24 bits on the UNI interface and 28 bits on the NNI interface. The VPI field is 8 to 12 Bits, allowing 256 to 4096 virtual paths. Each path can consist of 64.000 VCIs. VPI/VCI identifies the next destination of a cell as it passes through a series of ATM switches on the way to its destination. PT (Payload Type) Payload Type field id used to indicate different types of payload for OAM. It also indicates ”end of packet” wich is used with ATM Adaptation Layer 5 CLP (Cell Loss Priority) Cell Loss Priority bit is used for buffer managementin conjunction with congestion control If it is set to 1, then the cell within a buffer could be discarded. When the CLP bit is set to 0, the cell could not be discarded
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
HEC (Header Error Control) Header Error Control field allows to either correct single bit errors or detect multiple bit errors. If multiple bit errors are detected the cell is dropped.
Figure 102. UNI and NNI ATM cell header and payload
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
218 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
An ATM cell header can be one of two formats: UNI or the NNI. The UNI header is used for communication between ATM endpoints and ATM switches in private ATM networks. The NNI header is used for communication between ATM switches. Figure 102. on page 218 depicts the basic ATM cell format, the ATM UNI cell–header format, and the ATM NNI cell–header format.
3.5.2 ATM in1660SM
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1660SM can integrate ATM switch functionality through dedicated plug–in board. Three ATM switch boards are available: –
ATM MATRIX 4X4 that provide a 622 Mb/s throughput (4xSTM–1 equivalent capacity); this board includes a local STM–1 access port on the front panel. Up to 16 TPs can be configured among VC–4, VC–3, VC12, E3 and E1.
–
ATM MATRIX 4X4V2 that provide a 622 Mb/s throughput (4xSTM–1 equivalent capacity); Up to 252 TPs can be configured among VC–4, VC4–C, VC–3, VC12, E3, T3 and E1.
–
ATM MATRIX D3 that provide a 622 Mb/s throughput (4xSTM–1 equivalent capacity); Up to 16 TPs can be configured among VC–4, VC4–C, VC–3, VC12, E3, T3 and E1.
–
ATM MATRIX 8X8 that provide a 1.2 Gb/s throughput (8xSTM–1 equivalent capacity) Up to 32 TPs can be configured among VC–4, VC4–C, VC–3, VC12, E3 and E1.
If more capacity is needed more than one ATM board in a single 1660SM can be used. The overall ATM Switch functional model is compliant to ITU–T I.731, I.732, ETSI EN 300 417–1–1/2–1, af–tm–0010.002. The board provide ATM traffic control functions, such as shaping (Input and Output) and policing (UPC, NPC) which are needed to avoid network congestion (SCD, EPD, TPD). The standard PDH and SDH ports of 1660SM can be used to transport ATM traffic streams. The ATM traffic can be mapped on the VC–12, VC–3, VC–4 and VC–4–4c SDH Virtual Containers and on E1, E3 PDH signals, in accordance with relevant ITU–T recommendations (G.804 and G.832 for ATM over PDH and G.707 for ATM over SDH). The following ATM connection types are supported: •
Permanent Virtual Connections (PVCs): Virtual Path Connections (VPCs) and Virtual Channel Connections (VCCs ) provisioned by the TMN.
•
Switched Virtual Connections (SVCs): VPCs or VCCs set–up end–to–end in real–time by signaling procedures. Virtual Channel Connections (VCC) can be transparently tunnelled via a Hard or Soft VP tunnel. (Note: UNI signalling is not supported).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Two instances of Permanent Virtual Connections (PVCs) are defined on network level:
ED
•
Hard PVC: Virtual Path Connections (VPC) and Virtual Channel Connections (VCC); it is a PVC established/released upon a request initiated by a management request procedure (all the nodes involved by the connections need to be configured by the Network Management).
•
Soft PVC: Virtual Path Connections (Soft–VPC) and Virtual Channel Connections (Soft–VCC). The P–NNI signalling and routing is supported according to af–pnni–0055.000, af–pnni–0066.000 and af–pnni–0081.000. In the scope of Soft–PVC the two connecting points contiguous to the connection end–points are defined as calling end–point and called end–point: the former is responsible to start the signaling process in order to establish the Soft–PVC and to restore the connection in case of failures. It is provisioned by the ATM–OS only in the calling and called endpoints and setup by means of a signaling protocol, e.g. the PNNI, in all the other intermediate connecting points as if it is a SVC. The routing of the soft–PVC is done by the calling endpoint by means of the PNNI Routing Algorithm presenting every ATM board together with some network topology knowledge.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
219 / 636
Uni–directional and bi–directional point–to–point ATM connections (VPC and VCC) are supported. Uni–directional (for broadcast or drop&continue usages) point–to–multipoint ATM connections (VPC and VCC) are also supported. The uni–directional point–to–multipoint ATM connection is supported via the Spatial (cell copy to different interfaces) and Logical (cell copy to different flows on the same interface) Multicast feature of the ATM switch. 3.5.2.2 ATM traffic management According to ITU–T I.358 terminology (ATM–Forum TM4.1) the following ATM Transfer Capabilities (ATC) are supported on all connections (see Table 33. on page 220). Table 33. ATM traffic contracts. ATM FORUM
ITU–T
CBR
DBR class 1
PCR0+1, CDVTPCR
CTD, CDV, CLR0+1
––
DBR class 2
PCR0+1, CDVTPCR
CLR0+1
UBR
DBR class U
PCR0+1, CDVTPCR
––
rt–VBR.1
SBR.1 class 1
PCR0+1, CDVTPCR, SCR0+1, CDVTSCR
CTD, CDV, CLR0+1
nrt–VBR.1
SBR.1 class 2
PCR0+1, CDVTPCR, SCR0+1, CDVTSCR
CLR0+1
nrt–VBR.2
SBR.2 class 3
PCR0+1, CDVTPCR, SCR0+1, CDVTSCR
CLR0
nrt–VBR.3
SBR.3 class 3
PCR0+1, CDVTPCR, SCR0+1, CDVTSCR
CLR0
GFR.2
GFR.2
PCR0+1, CDVTPCR, MCR0, MBS, MFL
minimum CLR/FLR for high priority cells/frame
Notes: PCR: CDVT: SCR: MCR: MBS: CLR:
Traffic type parameter
QoS class parameter
Peak Cell Rate Cell Delay Variation Tolerance Sustainable Bit Rate Minimum Cell Rate Maximum Burst Size Cell Loss Ratio
ATC and example of applications CBR (Constant Bit Rate) / DBR (Deterministic Bit Rate): Static amount of bandwidth that has to be reserved. Used for real–time application very sensitive to cell delay variation like circuit emulation, video and voice at constant rate.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
VBR (Variable Bit Rate ) / SBR ( Statical Bit Rate): – Real Time ( rt ): those listed above but at variable rate – Non –real–time ( nrt ) with bursty traffic: Banking transactions, Frame Relay services UBR (Unspecified Bit Rate): Non real–time application, best effort: Banking transactions, World Wide Web (WWW) E–mail, LAN interconnection GFR (Guaranteed Frame Rate) : Non –real–time application with minimum throughput guarantee. Traffic sent beyond this rate ( extra traffic) will receive fair share of resource.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
220 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.5.2.1 ATM point to point and point to multipoint connections
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The traffic contract is used as input to the Connection Admission Control (CAC) or Global CAC (GCAC) for Soft–PVC in order to accept/reject the ATM connection. Usage Parameter Control (UPC) can be performed at User–Network Interface (UNI) while Network Parameter Control (NPC) can be performed at Network–Network Interface (NNI) or Inter–Carrier Interface (ICI); UPC/NPC can be performed at VP and VC level. Input Shaping can be performed in order to guarantee that incoming traffic is coherent with the resource allocation performed by the CAC. Output Shaping can be performed in order to guarantee that outgoing VPC is coherent with the resource allocation performed by the CAC when several VCC are multiplexed in the outgoing VPC. Congestion control and queues management are performed and alarms are generated accordingly. Traffic and Congestion management is according to ITU–T I.371, ATM Forum af–tm–0056.000. 3.5.2.3 ATM OAM F4 and F5 flows The ATM Switch board support the following OAM functionality at F4 (VP level) and F5 (VC level): •
Fault Management functions supported for all the supported ATM connections are Alarm Indication Signal / Remote Defect Indication (AIS/RDI), Continuity Check (CC) defects and Loop–back. Defects and possible subsequent failures are detected and reported.
•
Performance Management (PM) functions are Forward Monitoring and reporting. The supported ATM cell transfer outcomes are successful cell transfer, tagged cell transfer, errored cells, lost cells, mis–inserted cells and severely errored cell–block. The supported ATM performance parameters are Cell Loss Ratio, Cell mis–insertion Rate, Severely Errored Cell Block Ratio, Cell Transfer Delay, and Cell Delay Variation; moreover, the availability/unavailability status and parameters and the Severely Errored Second are determined.
•
Activation and De–activation of Performance Management (PM) and Continuity Check (CC) are supported.
•
Cell Insertion, extraction, non–intrusive monitoring and loop–back functions and the related processing can be performed at F4 and F5 levels depending on the setting of VPC/VCC end–points and segment end–points before and after the ATM Switching Matrix.
•
OAM is performed according to ITU–T I.610. Performance and Availability according to I.356 and I.357.
3.5.2.4 ATM Virtual Path Group Protection (VPG) The ATM VPG Protection is supported (on Hard–PVC) in order to facilitate fast ATM layer protection switching in cases where the under–laying SDH protection mechanism is not used. The uni–directional and bi–directional 1+1 and 1:1 VPG protection schemes are supported to allow high–priority traffic protection eventually dropping in 1:1 scheme the low–priority traffic. The Signal Fail is used as a switching trigger mechanism. VPG Protection follows ITU–T I.630. 3.5.2.5 ATM switching modules architecture
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The ATM switch is cascaded to the SDH matrix via back–panel connection (see Figure 103. on page 222) In a given node, SDH VCs or PDH flows carrying ATM cells that do not require switching in the ATM layer, at virtual path (VP) / virtual channel (VC) can be cross–connected transparently by the SDH matrix directly, without unnecessarily loading the ATM switch (pass through functionality).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
221 / 636
OMSN Port
Pass–through traffic
RX
TX
TX
RX
STM– STM–4
STM– STM–4
OMSN Port
STM– STM–1
SDH Xconnection
OMSN Port
RX
TX
TX
RX
STM– STM–1 OMSN Port
STM– STM–1
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
OMSN Port
Traffic consolidation
OMSN Port
RX
TX
SDH MATRIX
STM– STM–1
TX
RX
OMSN Port
STM– STM–1
–Cell switching
RX TX
SDH termination Traffic policing and shaping
Local Port (*)
ATM ENGINE –
TX RX
STM– STM–1 port
ATM Matrix
NOTES: (*) Available only on ATM MATRIX 4X4
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 103. 1660SM with ATM Matrix architecture
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
222 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.5.2.6 ATM switching modules application The main application of the ATM board is to consolidate ATM traffic collected from different sources onto shared SDH VCs (virtual containers) in STM–n rings and to switch the ATM traffic, as needed at VP and /or VC level, into the network.
Wasted bandwidth
SDH circuits E3
E3 E3
E3
E3
SDH VC–4 [3 X VC–3]
E3
ADM
ADM
Free bandwidth Consolidation E3
Data flows
E3
E3
STM–1 E3
SDH VC–4 [3 X VC–3] E1
1660SM
1660SM ATM board
Figure 104. Leased line service versus Data transport service Typical applications of the atm board concept are ADSL, UMTS and LMDS metropolitan networks.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
In all those scenarios the Provider can take great advantage of the distributed switching functionality for optimizing the transmission resources avoiding wasting capacity not effectively used by the paying traffic. The switch can also be used in FTTB scenarios and as CPE where a mix of TDM and ATM services in the same box results in benefits for both the Provider and the Customers.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
223 / 636
3.6.1 PR_EA (MPLS) generalities The MPLS (Multi Protocol Label Switching) technique is used in Alcatel transport systems in order to distribute and route data packets originated by the network layer (level 3 of the protocol stack) and encapsulated into the Ethernet 802.3 frame; it can be seen as a “server” layer for the Ethernet “client” layer (called “MPLS over SDH”). The data may also be “MPLS–packed” at the network edge, and transported over Ethernet; this transport modality is called “MPLS over Ethernet”. MPLS operates at the level 2 of the protocol stack and uses the SDH as its physical layer to transport and aggregate the various streams of data packets (MPLS over SDH); see Table 34. on page 224. The “MPLS over Ethernet” layering is illustrated in Table 35. page 224. The MPLS technique consists of binding one or more “Labels” to the packets, in this way permitting the forwarding of a packet to the other nodes of the network without inspecting the level 3 header, only the look up of the attached label(s) is needed. The classification of the incoming packets are performed only once, at the edge of the MPLS network; the inner MPLS routers have only to select the “next hop” to which forwarding the incoming packets, by looking the top label. PR_EA (Packet Ring Edge Aggregator) is an Alcatel mark indicating a system that is able to aggregate, at the edge of the MPLS network (ring topology), many mpls packets communications. It is a “path oriented” connection–less service; all the packets belonging to the same stream and assigned to the same class of service are all treated the same way by a router. In other words, when they enter the network, the packets are assigned to a “Forwarding Equivalence Class” (FEC); the subsequent packets with the same destination and the same quality of service are assigned to the same FEC; also other packets belonging to different streams can be assigned to the same FEC, in this way aggregating various packets streams to a common path. This common path is called LSP (Label Switched Path) and can be treated by the intermediate nodes as a tunnel. The intermediate inner nodes have in charge the only forwarding of the packets, and all the incoming packets within the same LSP will be forwarded toward the same direction. For more information about MPLS refer to RFC_3031, RFC_3032, RFC_3209, RFC_3270, ITU–T_ Y1311, etc. 3
NETWORK
2
DATA LINK
any network “packetized” data service ETHERNET MPLS
1
PHYSICAL
SDH
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Table 34. MPLS layer stack over SDH 3
NETWORK
any network “packetized” data service
2
DATA LINK
MPLS
1
PHYSICAL
ETHERNET
Table 35. MPLS layer stack over ETHERNET
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
224 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.6 ISA – PR_EA (MPLS) sub–system
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The Alcatel MPLS system can manage packets data streams transported over “local” Ethernet FE or GE (Fast Ethernet, Gigabit Ethernet) and “remotized” ethernet over GFP/SDH; the packets are identified and classified with a first label (by inspecting the ethernet frame header), marked again by the label switching router with a second label, and then sent into the MPLS network, aggregated and encapsulated into PPP/HDLC/SDH frames. If coming from the MPLS network, the packets can be terminated towards the ethernet ports or routed towards other routers, if possible they are also aggregated into a common FEC; the routing operation is performed by the swapping of the top label. The protocol stacking is illustrated in the figure below (Figure 105. ). The MPLS framing among the various protocols is illustrated in Figure 106. A generic example of MPLS tunnelling is illustrated in Figure 113. page 229. A generic scheme of MPLS classification and aggregation is illustrated in Figure 114. page 230. The label and frames formats are illustrated in Figure 107. , Figure 108. , Figure 109. , Figure 110. ; the GFP frame is reported in the “Ethernet” description, para. 3.8.2.1, page 255.
3
3
any
2
Eth 1 FE or GE local Ethernet
Eth MPLS
2
FE,GE Proc.
3
any 3
2
C&I
Eth MPLS
2
MPLS PPP HDLC
MPLS 1
3
any
3
Eth GFP
2 1
remote Ethernet
2
any
MPLS ROUTING
any Eth MPLS
any
SDH/HDLC Proc.
SDH MPLS over SDH
Eth MPLS
SDH SDH/GFP Proc.
C&I
over SDH
CLASSIFICATION & IDENTIFICATION
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 105. MPLS subsystem, protocol stacking
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
225 / 636
PRE FS DA SA DFL
Ethernet Payload
FCS
DA SA DFL
Ethernet Payload
FCS
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Ethernet
Ethernet Packet
GFP
Ethernet Packet
GFP Header
Ethernet Packet
MPLS
Label Label 1 2
Ethernet Packet
Labelled Packet (MPLS)
PPP
HDLC
PPP PAD
MPLS packet
PPP Header
Flag Addr Control
PPP frame
FCS
HDLC frame SDH VC4 or VC3 or VC12 frame
POH
SDH payload
GFP frame
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
POH
SDH VC4 or VC3 or VC12 frame
SDH payload
Figure 106. Framing for MPLS
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
226 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
A generic MPLS label is illustrated below (refer to RFC 3032):
0 0 1 2
3 4 5 6
1 7 8 9 0 1 2
3 4 5 6
2 7 8 9 0 1 2
Label
Label:
Label Value (20 bits)
Exp:
Experimental (3 bits)
S:
Bottom of Stack (1 bit)
TTL:
Time To Live (8 bits)
Exp
3 4 5 6
3 7 8 9 0 1
S
TTL
Figure 107. MPLS label format
Protocol 8/16 bits
Information a*
Padding b*
a* + b* 0, EIR = 0, CoS = Medium • voice – CIR > 0, EIR = 0, CoS = High • broadcast TV – CIR > 0, EIR = 0, CoS = Low • residential internet access – CIR > 0, EIR = 0, CoS = Low • VPN for multiple applications – CIR > 0, EIR = 0, CoS = High/Medium/Low (derived from priority indication within the packet) In addition to the standard settind ISA–PR implements a proprietary bunding feature. The use of bunding is optional and does not contradict any of the MEF applications. It improves the performance of the per EVC policing by protecting a higher CoS traffic from undesirable effects of bursts of lower CoS traffic. This allows the customer to better utilise his bandwith by using a single service for all of his VPN applications. Policing attributes the granularity • CIR, EIR – 100 Kbps (or 1% of bandwidth, wichever is larger) • CBS, EBS – 1 Kbyte Policed packets are passed to the Buffer Manager which places them at appropriate queue/s.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
243 / 636
Buffer Management maintains packet memory, structured into multiple queues each queue serving a particular destination and CoS; i.e. three queues per destination. It also maintains various queue fill level thresholds to maintain priorization between CoS, prevent any queue from monopolizing the memory and provide triggers for load balancing. Load balancing packets are issued after a fixed number of yellow bytes is delivered from a channel. Upon reaching the first stress level, indicated by queue depth increasing beyond a threshold, buffer management issues a stress signal to local policers that is increasing in queue depth. Upon reaching a higher threshold it starts discarding the yellow packets. Upon reaching a yet higher threshold, which indicates maximum queue occupancy, it discards all arriving packets. Shaping Shaping controls the rate and the order at which packets are injected into the ring. The total Bandwidth per destination may be determined to either wide NMS as fixed number or dynamically changed by the load balancing mechanism. Selection between the two modes is performed by NMS. The bandwidth per destination is shared between the various queues in decreasing CoS order; i.e. High packets are forwarded first, Medium next and Low last. ADM
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The ADM function maps packets into the synchronous SDH payload. The applicable payloads are VC4–4v, VC4–5v, VC4–6v, VC4–7v, VC4–8v.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
244 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Buffer Management
Ingress summary
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Figure 120. summarises ingress processing.
MEF policer CIR
EIR
Discard Packets output to ring: Packets are output onto the ring into the appropriate Virtual trunk (VT) for the CoS & Destination node/port
Packet analysis(A): Classified by service Based on header and port info
Packet analysis(B): Policing: Packets are put into queues MEF policing with CIR+ based on header priority and EIR SLS. Either per UNI destination port Per EVC Per EVC.CoS Destination A NN proprietary bundling High
SDH out
Queues
Medium
Packet Labeling Martini Labels are stripped, and internal MPLS Labels are added
Low Scheduler
Destination B High Medium Low Aggregate Shapers
Stress
SDH in
Queue filling feedback Similar to R.E.D
Access card NP
Port card Policer
BM
ADM
Figure 120. ISA–PR Traffic Management Overview
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Every packet is assigned an identifier detailing customer, SLA and traffic flow. i.e. where is the packet to be delivered, which priority is the packet given internally. These classified or tagged packets are then managed at wire speed, creating a breakthrough in service agility. Service providers can now market and deliver differentiated services – and importantly, more than one data service per customer interface – to hundreds of customers over a single, shared fibre or wavelength of capacity. ISA–PR functions as a Layer 2 device, so the Ethernet connectivity it provides is transparent to the customer. Therefore any L2 protocol used by the customer, such as spanning tree, can be delivered unaffected, unless explicitly provisioned to filter them out. Sophisticated traffic–engineering algorithms ensure that, on a per–flow, per–node and per–ring basis, all SLAs configured on all network elements are met.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
245 / 636
Egress processing is much simpler than Ingress processing. It involves no extensive classification and no policing. ADM The ADM function selectively drops packets into the node, based on their MPLS labels and identifiers their EVC and CoS. Per packet decision by ADM may result in either: – drop – drop and forward – forward – discard. Buffer Management Buffer management maintains packet memory, structured into queues, each queue serving a 1Gbps interface between Port and Access card and CoS; i.e. three queues per every one of the 4 interfaces. It also maintains various queue fill level thresholds to maintain prioritisation between CoS, prevent any queue from monopolizing the memory and provide triggers for load balancing. Upon reaching the load balancing threshold buffer management issues a flow control packet. Upon reaching a higher threshold it starts discarding the yellow packets. Upon reaching a yet higher threshold, which indicates maximum queue occupancy it discards all arriving packets. Buffer Management forwards packets to the Access cards as long as the interface between the cards is free to do so; i.e. without any shaping. Editing Egress Editing may be provisioned to append an MPLS header, if any of the Ethernet ports on that Access card is configured as a Martini interface. Editing is applied by the Network Processor. L2 Switching Egress L2 Switching comprises MAC based filtering and MAC learning. L2 Switching is applied by the Network Processor. Egress Buffering
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Egress Buffer Management maintains packet memory, structured into queues, each queue serving an Ethernet port and CoS; i.e. three queues per every one of the 16 Fast Ethernet in ISA–16FEA card or 2 Gigabit Ethernet in ISA–2GBA card. Egress Buffer Management forwards packets across the Ethernet ports as long as the interface between the ports are available; no failure and no flow control applied by the connected device. Egress Buffering is applied by the Network Processor.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
246 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.7.2.2 Egress processing
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Load Balancing In order to prevent congestion in the ring each ISA–PR monitors the traffic, identifies congestion conditions, communicates its status to other ISA–PR and responds to congestion reports by other ISA–PR. This set of functions is collectively referred to as ”Load Balancing”. Both ADM and Buffer Manager participate in Load Balancing. Communicating the congestion status is done using OAM–like packets, called LB–OAM. Each ISA–PR generates LB–OAM packets that traverse all the paths, originating at that ISA–PR. While traversing the ring LB–OAM packets are stamped with the congestion levels of the bottlenecks encountered in the path. At the end of the path the packets are sent back to their source ISA–PR. In response to the congestion in the path, the originating ISA–PR adjusts the channel BW in order to reduce the load of traffic in congested bottlenecks. Adjusting the channel BW takes into account the relative SLA satisfaction of the affected services and hence achieves fairness. Channels Channels are virtual pipes that aggregate traffic in the ring. Each channel aggregates traffic that originates from a single ISA–PR and goes to one or more destinations. The total BW of the services in a channel is limited by the channel BW. The originating ISA–PR controls the BW of each channel. Traffic management uses channels to adjust ring traffic so the total forwarded traffic does not exceed the available resources in any point in the ring. In case of congestion the BW of channels that contribute to the congestion will be reduced and the congestion will be relieved. Reducing the bandwidth of a channel will cause the originating network element to forward less traffic through the services of that channel. The reduction in bandwidth will take into consideration the SLA of services in the channel and maintain fairness between customers. Traffic in the physical network is divided into channels.
Each channel carries traffic of multiple services.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 121. Channels
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
247 / 636
Each ISA–PR monitors the traffic traversing it on a number of ”bottlenecks”. Bottlenecks are convergence points in the ring that might be congested when traffic load increases. There are both Ingress and Egress bottlenecks.
Figure 122. Bottlenecks Congestion Indications Whenever a bottleneck is congested the node will notify the other nodes in the ring of the congestion by sending a ”congestion indication”. The congestion indication reports the location of the congestion. In reaction, each node reduces the allocated bandwidth to the channels that send traffic toward the congested bottleneck, thereby relieving the congestion. In case of severe congestion, the congested network element will send repeating congestion indications causing larger bandwidth reduction in the relevant channels. Fairness
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Even in times of congestion on the ring, the ISA–PR assures that – CIR is not affected – EIR is affected in a fair manner Reduction will be relative to the amount of BW the customer bought. Maintaining fairness will be done by balancing the level of ”satisfaction” of channels in the network. The level of satisfaction of a channel represents the difference between the amount of forwarded EIR traffic and the amount of conforming EIR traffic, submitted by the customers. ”Non–conforming” traffic; i.e. traffic exceeding SLA BW, is marked Red by the Policer and not taken into consideration for ”satisfaction” purposes. The load balancing mechanism increases the BW of channels, which are more affected by the traffic load while reducing BW of other channels, which are more ”satisfied”. The bandwidth of each channel will be reduced whenever it gets a congestion indication. If a congestion indication is not received during a period of time the channel bandwidth will be increased.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
248 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Bottlenecks
3.7.2.3 Protection sub–system
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The following protection mechanisms are provided: –
native packet ring protection, refer to point [1] on page 249
–
Dual Attach, refer to point [2] on page 250.
–
Customer Edge (CE) Dual Homing, refer to point [3] on page 251.
[1]
Packet ring protection
The packet protection is provided by the MPLS–based Resilient Packet Ring (RPR) technology, via “Wrapping” mechanism (see Figure 123. on page 249). RPR is currently being standardized by the IEEE 802.17 Working Group and specifies a technology for packet–based transport in ring topologies defining special functions that offer fast fault location and trigger fast switchover at packet level. RPR is used to optimize and manage the portion of bandwidth dedicated to packet traffic in SDH networks. An RPR topology consists of two counter rotating fiber rings (or portion of SDH fiber rings bandwidth) in which multiple nodes share the whole bandwidth (see Figure 123. on page 249) Negotiation for bandwidth occurs among the nodes through specific fairness mechanism that guarantees fair bandwidth allocation for customer traffic per each node. Nodes can send packets to other nodes either by utilizing unicast (point–to–point) or multicast (multipoint) destinations, which enables multipoint Ethernet VPN and Ethernet aggregation services be implemented over RPR. When sending a packet, the node determines which ring direction to use, so the spans in the opposite direction remains free for other customer traffic sent by other nodes. A packet traveling on the ring is stripped by the destination node. This means that the packet does not use all the ring bandwidth but only the span that it requires to go from source to destination. This features is called “spatial reuse” as the bandwidth of the other span of the ring can be used by other paying traffic. RPR protection protocol provides sub–50msec resilience for traffic in case of fiber or node failure. Specific control packets are exchanged among the nodes to keep the ring constantly monitored. “Wrapping” mechanisms is provided for packet protection switch accomplished by merging the frames destined at the failed segment, into payload destined at the opposite direction by node adjacent to the failed segment. Additionally, RPR provides ring–wide QoS assurance mechanisms and three different CoS.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
1660SM
1660SM
Figure 123. RPR protection mechanism
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
249 / 636
The Martini MPLS encapsulation is used to provide an end–to–end reliable support to Ethernet networking. It specifies a technique by which Layer 2 Protocol Data Units (PDUs) such as Ethernet may be tunneled through an MPLS enabled network. End–to–end Ethernet connectivity relations are transported over specific MPLS Label Switched Paths (LSPs) that are switched through the network. This allows for the provisioning of multiple, segregated customer networks over the Service Provider infrastructure, creating a Virtual Private Network (VPN) for each customer. 1660SM
1660SM
Figure 124. Packet protection (and QoS assurance) in multiring network : MPLS over RPR [2]
Dual Attach protection
Refer to Figure 124. and Figure 21. on page 75.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The Dual Attach protection is a redundant connection to another ring or hub providing aggregate protection. It offers a mechanism that expands the protection capabilities of RPR to multi–ring architectures enabling network–wide resilience. Two RPR rings are interconnected in two points (nodes) so that networking is resilient to both node and link failures. In addition, dual attach allows for multiple node or link failures across multiple RPR structures. Considering Figure 124. , if either Node A fails or the link between Node A and the other ring fails, Node B can forward packets to the other ring through its attachment keeping QoS and SLA levels unaltered.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
250 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
MPLS–based RPR technology. To extend the packet protection (and end–to–end QoS...) to a multiring network, it is necessary to put MPLS as the “upper layer” on top of RPR. MPLS provides the technology to handle traffic in multiring networks thus ensuring end–to–end resilience and QoS for carrier–class Ethernet services across such a network. In Figure 124. each ring is responsible of providing RPR protection while the MPLS upper layer working on top of RPR guarantees end–to–end resilience and networking. This is achieved by using two techniques: – Martini MPLS encapsulation – Dual attach protection (described in the following paragraph [2])
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[3]
Customer Edge (CE) Dual Homing protection
The CE dual homing consists in a CE connection to two nodes in a ring for protection of the access interfaces. This protection is described in the following Figure 125. and in Figure 21. on page 75
1660SM 1660SM
1660SM 1660SM
1660SM 1660SM 1660SM
Figure 125. Customer Edge Dual Homing
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Alcatel ISA Card Interworking ISA–PR supports interworking with other OMSN’s portfolio’s ISA card types as for the following Figure 126.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
251 / 636
3.7.2.4 Alcatel ISA Card Interworking
Core MPLS Switch/Router
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Core Router
FX, FE FX, FE GbE
GbE
B ayN etw orks
B ayN etw orks
ISA PR
B ayN etw orks
ISA PR
1660SM SDH Ring
EMX3660 Overlay Packet Ring VC–4–Xv B ayN etw orks
B ayN etw orks
B ayN etw orks
ISA PR
ISA PR
ISA PR
CO
ISA PR
GbE
GbE GbE
FE ISA PR_EA
B ayN etw orks
ISA PR_EA
1650
ISA PR_EABayNetworks
B ayN etw o rks
STM–n
1650 Ring 1640
16x0 B ayN etw o rks
B ayN etw o rks
B ayN etw o rks
FE/GbE B ayN etw o rks
1640 ISA Eth
ISA Eth
FE
FE
ISA Eth
FE
B ayN etw o rks
B ayN etw o rks
B ayN etw orks
ISA GbE
GbE
ISA Eth
ISA Eth
ISA GbE
FE
GbE
CE FE
Figure 126. Relationship with other ISA Cards Inter–working with the following ISA cards is supported: – – –
ISA Eth ISA GbE ISA PR_EA
The ISA–PR is designed to be deployed in conjunction with ISA Eth, ISA GbE and ISA PR_EA cards deployed in OMSN node types. Customer deployment will often involve the use of some or all of these ISA card types in an ”overlay” network, which may consist of point–to–point links, aggregation functions and Packet Rings. The ISA–PR_EA card is used to aggregate different ETH traffic flow, while guaranteeing per flow QoS, coming from ISA–Eth or ISA–Gbe into GBE interface that can be connected to the ISA–PR. Customer segregation and traffic management is provided by MPLS traffic segregation on the link between the two ISA–PR and ISA–PR_EA cards.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The ISA PR_EA cards attaching to the ISA PR may utilize Dual Attach for protection.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
252 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.8 ISA – ETHERNET management sub–system 3.8.1 Generalities 3.8.1.1 LAN to LAN transport service OMSNs can be equipped with Ethernet units to allow LAN to LAN service as a point to point connection between two routers or switches through a SDH network, as depicted Figure 137. on page 266. The board acts as a gateway towards the SDH network. In order to guarantee the end to end transparency each Ethernet stream/interface of the board is mapped in a specific SDH VC (by means of “GFP” encapsulation algorithms, according to ITU–T G.7041 Rec.) performing a one to one Ethernet traffic mapping into the SDH network. A transport network based on OMSNs equipment provides flexible link service among remote LANs carrying Ethernet traffic, as shown on Figure 127.
OMSN
STM–N
STM–N
OMSN
STM–N STM–N
OMSN Ethernet LAN A over SDH
OMSN
STM–N
OMSN Ethernet over SDH
STM–N
STM–N
LAN B
STM–N
STM–N
OMSN
STM–N
OMSN
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 127. Example of an Ethernet stream transport through a SDH network –
Transparency The Ethernet frames are forwarded to the output port with no protocol termination. This cause no impact on service management architecture due to transport network insertion
–
Low latency The transport network provides a very low end–to–end delay; the removal of store&forward need in the intermediate nodes using continuous data flow is another consequence of transparency
–
High availability The LAN–to–LAN service makes use of the same resources and infrastructures of the other transported services (ATM, MPLS, PDH and SDH streams...); so availability is very high
–
High quality All the features of the transport network, like very low BER, synchronization, alarms management, performance monitoring, protection mechanisms, ... are used providing so high quality service.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
253 / 636
The functional block diagram of a LAN to LAN service is shown in Figure 128. The client sink termination function adapts the client interface; all the payload frames received are stored into input buffer queue. The source SDH adaptation function draws the frames from the memory emptying the cluster and making it available again; then maps the frame into SDH Virtual Container applying the GFP encapsulation procedure. SDH paths are considered as traffic pipes carrying a continuous data flow. At the output port the dual operation is performed: the output buffer queue is written with payload frames received from SDH line and then the client source termination draws from memory and forwards these frames to the client according to the interface characteristics. = 80 frames Input buffer size Output buffer size = 80 frames, without concatenation 528 frames, VC–3 concatenation (N x VC–3) 2064 frames, VC–12 concatenation (N x VC–12)
Port A
Client sink
Port B
SDH source input buffer
Client A
Client source
SDH pipe – A to B
SDH sink output buffer
Bidir. SDH pipe (N x path)
SDH sink
SDH pipe – B to A
Client source
SDH source
output buffer
Client B
Client sink input buffer
Figure 128. LAN to LAN service block diagram
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Three types of Ethernet interfaces are provided – 10 Mbit/s – Ethernet – 100 Mbit/s – Fast Ethernet – 1000 Mbit/s – Giga Ethernet
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
254 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.8.1.2 LAN to LAN functional description
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Different Ethernet interfaces types can be used at the termination ends: e.g. an Ethernet client interface in one side and a Fast Ethernet one in the other side. A SDH pipe can be configured as – a single SDH path or – a concatenation of paths: • N x VC–12 • N x VC–3 • N x VC–4 Depending on client types and SDH pipe a bandwidth limit can occur. A flow control mechanism is used to adapt the client rate to the transport pipe. 3.8.2 Main features description 3.8.2.1 Encapsulation All the types of client – Ethernet – Fast Ethernet – GigaBit Ethernet are mapped into SDH Virtual Containers using encapsulation algorithms for variable length packets, according to ITU–T G.7041 Recommendation “Generic framing procedure (GFP)”. GFP has been adopted to solve the incompatibility between the Ethernet traffic, based on discontinuous data, and the SDH traffic needing a continuous data stream. GFP is able to map length–variable data. The Ethernet frames are GFP encapsulated, to be then mapped into SDH Virtual Containers. In this application the client signals are Ethernet MAC (PDU oriented) type. The GFP encapsulation is shown on Figure 130. on page 258. For each pipe three different GFP frame formats can be configured, as shown on Figure 129. on page 256: – GFP without FCS – GFP with FCS – Extended GFP.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
255 / 636
PLI
PLI
PLI
PLI
cHEC
cHEC
cHEC
cHEC
cHEC
PTI+PFI+EXI
PTI+PFI+EXI
TYPE
PLI cHEC
UPI
Core Header
UPI
Path Status
tHEC
Circuit Status
tHEC
tHEC
Circuit Status
Ethernet data
Ethernet data
Link Status
Ethernet data
Ethernet data
Link Status
Ethernet data
pcHEC
tHEC
Ethernet data
Payload Header
Client Payload Field
Core Header
Payload Header
pcHEC Ethernet data Ethernet data Ethernet data
Ethernet data
Client Payload Field
Ethernet data pFCS FCS Field
pFCS pFCS Ethernet data
pFCS
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
GFP without FCS
GFP with FCS
Extended GFP
Figure 129. GFP frame format
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
256 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
PLI
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
According to the type, the GFP frame format consists of a Core Header, a Payload Header, a Client Payload field and FCS field. The Core Header, made up of 4 octets, supports frame delineation procedures and essential data link operations functions independent of the higher layer PDUs (Protocol Data Unit). The GFP Core Header consists of the following fields – PLI: it is the PDU Length Indicator field 16 bits length, containing a binary number representing the number of octets in the GFP Payload Area. Zero length means no payload area, i.e. idle frame; this is intended for use as a filler frame for the adaptation process – cHEC: it is the Core Header Error Control field 16 bits length, containing a CRC–16 generated sequence that protects the integrity of the contents of the Core Header by enabling both single–bit error correction and multi–bit error detection. The Payload Header, is a variable–length area, made up of – 4 octets in GFP without FCS and GFP with FCS frame format – 8 octets in Extended GFP frame format, provides payload information like GFP type; when Extended GFP is used this area provides also information used in Packet Concatenation. According to the frame format, in the following are described the various types of fields: –
GFP without FCS and GFP with FCS frame format • the first two octets constitute the GFP type field of the Payload Header, indicating the content and format of the GFP Payload field. The Type field distinguishes between services in a multi–service environment. This field consists of – PTI, Payload Type Identifier, a 3–bit field • PTI=0 for GFP user frame conveying client data • PTI=1 for GFP user frame conveying far–end Client Signal Fail indications – PFI, Payload FCS Indicator, 1–bit field • PFI=0, Payload FCS is present • PFI=1, Payload FCS is absent – EXI, Extension Header Identifier, 4–bit field – UPI, Used Payload Identifier, 8–bit field • tHEC: the 3rd and 4th octets constitute the Type Header Error Control field containing a CRC–16 generated sequence that protects the integrity of the contents of the Type Field by bit error detection.
–
Extended GFP • the first octet is made up of the TYPE fields that provides format and frame type • from 2nd to 6th octet the information about Path Status, Circuit Status and Link Status are given • in the last two octets, the FCS type information are given, in pcFCS fields.
The Payload Field contains the Ethernet frames; this variable–length area may include from 64 to 1574 bytes. The client user/control PDU is always transferred into the GFP Payload field as an octet–aligned packet stream.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The payload Frame Check Sequence (pFCS) is an optional field, 4–bytes long. If selected, it’s a frame check sequence containing a CRC–32 sequence used to detect any packet corruption inside the transport network.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
257 / 636
Ethernet MAC frame Octets
GFP frame
7
Preamble
1
Start of frame delimiter
6
Destination Address (DA)
6
Source Address (SA)
2
Length/Type MAC client data
4 4 8
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Octets Core Header Payload Header
Client Payload Field
Pad Frame check sequence (FCS)
4
Bit # 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Ethernet MAC Frame fields: –
Preamble: the preamble is a 7–octet field that is used to allow the PLS (Physical Signaling) circuitry to reach its steady–state synchronization with the received frame’s timing.
–
Start of Frame Delimiter: the SFD field is the sequence 10101011. It immediately follows the preamble pattern and indicates the start of a frame.
–
Destination Address (DA): the Destination Address field specifies the station(s) for which the frame is intended.
–
Source Address (SA): the Source Address field specifies the station sending the frame.
–
Length/Type: this two–octet field takes one of two meanings, depending on its numeric value: – If the value of this field is less than or equal to the value of max Valid Frame, then the Length/Type field indicates the number of MAC client data octets contained in the subsequent data field of the frame (Length interpretation). – If the value of this field is greater than or equal to 1536 decimal (equal to 0600 hexadecimal), then the Length/Type field indicates the nature of the MAC client protocol (Type interpretation). The Length and Type interpretations of this field are mutually exclusive.
–
MAC client data and PAD: The data field contains a sequence of n octets; full data transparency is provided. If the length of the data field is less than the minimum required for proper operation of the protocol, a PAD field (a sequence of octets) will be added at the end of the data field but prior to the FCS field.
–
Frame check sequence (FCS): a cyclic redundancy check (CRC) is used by the transmit and receive algorithms tp generate a CRC value for the FCS field. The frame check sequence (FCS) field contains a 4–octet (32–bit) cyclic redundancy check (CRC) value. This value is computed as a function of the contents of the source address, destination address, length, LLC data and Pad (that are all the fields except the preamble, SFD, FCS and extension). Figure 130. GFP encapsulation of the MAC frames
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
258 / 636
3.8.2.2 Flow control
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
To avoid buffer saturation problems at the termination end, flow management is very important. When an excessive traffic is received, a control mechanism can be used to slow down the transmitter avoiding a packets loss. Three different control options are used: – input control – output control – external control. In the following the relative actions are described. As you can see from Figure 131. on page 259, the input control is performed at the input port; it is always enabled regardless the GFP type. When the input buffer of Port A crosses a fixed threshold of 48 frames, a pause request is sent back to the transmitter; no input frame is thrown away till 80 frames filling occurrence. The pause request message is defined in IEEE 802.3x; the transmitter is asked to be paused for 32 quanta. The transmitter will be re–qualified (pause request stopped) when the input buffer of Port A crosses the 44 frames threshold.
Port A
Client A Client sink
SDH source
Client source
pause request
input buffer
100 Mbps
+
Port B
SDH sink
3 x VC–12
3 x VC–12
SDH source
output buffer
control+ data flow
Client source output buffer
Bidir. SDH pipe (N x path)
SDH sink
Client B
100 Mbps
Client sink input buffer
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 131. Flow control mechanism: input control
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
259 / 636
If the received client throughput is higher than SDH pipe capacity, idle frames are sent to fill the SDH virtual container.
Port A
SDH source
input buffer
100 Mbps
SDH sink
1 x VC–3
output buffer
Bidir. SDH pipe control+ (N x path) data flow
+ Client source
SDH sink
1 x VC–3
Client B
Client source
SDH source
output buffer
pause request
Client sink
Port B
pause request
Client A
10 Mbps
Client sink
input buffer
Figure 132. Flow control mechanism: output control See Figure 133. on page 261. The external control is performed at the output port. When a pause activity is requested from the external client, the output transmitter is stopped for the relative period. The external control is planned for future releases.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
This fact could cause first the queue filling of the output buffer of Port B activating the output control previously described, and then the queue filling of the input buffer of Port A activating the input control.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
260 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
As you can see from Figure 132. on page 260, the output control is performed at the output port only when Extended GFP is used. When the output buffer of Port B crosses a fixed threshold of – 272 frames, when VC–3 concatenation is used (N x VC–3) – 1040 frames, when VC–12 concatenation is used (N x VC–12) a flow control action is performed to reduce the traffic received from the SDH network: a pause request is sent back to the SDH source of Port B and then, by means of the SDH pipe, to the SDH source of Port A. This fact could cause the queue filling of the input buffer of the Port A: in this case the input control previously described is applied. The transmitter will be re–qualified (pause request stopped) when the input buffer of Port B crosses the – 240 frames threshold, when VC–3 concatenation is used (N x VC–3) – 1008 frames threshold, when VC–12 concatenation is used (N x VC–12)
Client sink
100 Mbps
Port B
SDH source
Bidir. SDH pipe (N x path)
input buffer
Client source
SDH sink
1 x VC–3
SDH sink
1 x VC–3
Client B
Client source output buffer
SDH source
output buffer
Client sink
10/100 Mbps
Client sink input buffer
Client source output buffer pause request
Port A
pause request
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Client A
Client source
+
Client sink
input buffer
control+ data flow
Figure 133. Flow control mechanism: External control 3.8.2.3 Concatenation Two different VC–n concatenation mechanisms are employed in OMSN Lan to Lan transport service: –
Virtual Concatenation for VC–4 concatenation in Gigabit Ethernet clients
–
Packet Concatenation for VC–12 and VC–3 concatenation in Ethernet/Fast Ethernet clients
In both cases differential delay of the network is compensated at path Termination Sink. When Virtual Concatenation is used each Ethernet frame is sent by dispatching one byte per VC in rotation mode. Thus the message to be transmitted by means of the SDH network is splitted byte per byte among the paths making up the Pipe. The Virtual Concatenation Termination feature is according to ITU–T G.707 and G.783 Recs.
Transmission Network 33 2 11 VC–4
Client A
Client B
33 2 21 VC–4 Message
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
3
Message 2
Message
Message
Message
Message
1
3
2
1
33 2 21 VC–4 Figure 134. Messages dispatching via Virtual Concatenation
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
261 / 636
Transmission Network Message 1 VC–12 or VC–3
Client A
Client B
Message 2 VC–12 or VC–3 Message
Message
3
Message
Message
Message
Message
1
3
2
1
2
Message 3 VC–12 or VC–3 Figure 135. Messages dispatching via Packet Concatenation
3.8.3 Technical specification Latency data [1]
GigaBit Ethernet board latency •
[2]
1 x VC–4
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
64 bytes
=
205 µs
–
512 bytes
=
201 µs
–
1518 bytes
=
193 µs
Fast Ethernet board latency •
ED
–
1 x VC–4 –
64 bytes
=
101 µs
–
512 bytes
=
125 µs
–
1518 bytes
=
178 µs
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
262 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
When the Packet Concatenation is used, each Ethernet frame is not shared among different paths (VCs) of a certain pipe as in Virtual Concatenation mode; but each message is dispatched on a single path/VC of a certain pipe. When a failure occurs inside the network, unavailable paths are not used and traffic is kept by using the remaining available paths. The bandwidth can be increased/decreased with no impact on traffic (hitless link adjustment). Obviously the messages can be sent through different ways and have to be realigned in reception to restore the proper sequence.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
•
1 x VC–3
•
–
64 bytes
=
72 µs
–
512 bytes
=
147 µs
–
1518 bytes
=
317 µs
1 x VC–12
•
–
64 bytes
=
517 µs
–
512 bytes
=
2108 µs
–
1518 bytes
=
5841 µs
2 x VC–3
•
–
64 bytes
=
277 µs
–
512 bytes
=
1462 µs
–
1518 bytes
=
3997 µs
8 x VC–12 –
64 bytes
=
657 µs
–
512 bytes
=
3452 µs
–
1518 bytes
=
5824 µs
Herebelow is given an example of the end to end delay; it is the sum of the following values: – physical line delay = 5 µs/Km – delay for each OMSN pass through = 5 10 µs/NE – latency. In a 1000 Km long network (5us/Km) and made up of 100 OMSNs equipment (5 10 µs/NE) using a Fast Ethernet board 8 x VC–12 / 512 bytes mapped, the end to end delay is equal to: (1000 Km x 5 µs) + (100 x 10 µs) + 3452 µs = 9452 µs
Allowed differential delay in case of concatenation
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
VC–12 concatenation = 35 ms VC–3 concatenation =
3 ms
VC–4 concatenation =
256 ms
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
263 / 636
3.8.4 Ethernet boards
–
10/100 Mb/s Ethernet unit (refer to paragraph 3.8.4.1 on page 264)
–
Gbit Ethernet (rate adaptive) unit (refer to paragraph 3.8.4.2 on page 268)
3.8.4.1 10/100 Mbit/s Ethernet unit 1660SM can also be equipped with 10/100 Mb/s Ethernet unit to allow LAN to LAN connections as a point to point connection between two routers or switches through an SDH network, as depicted Figure 137. on page 266. The board acts as a gateway towards the SDH network. If the customer has N sites to be interconnected, each Customer Box uses N–1 Point to Point Ethernet interfaces. The 10 or 100 Mb/s Ethernet traffic flows are mapped into VC12, VC3, or VC4 SDH transport structures, more precisely each Ethernet traffic interface of the board is mapped in a specific VCn (n=12, 3, 4), one to one Ethernet traffic mapping in the SDH network is performed, in order to guarantee the transparency end to end. In fact the Ethernet traffic is transported transparently in the SDH Network and it is terminated in the ADMs nodes where Ethernet traffic is dropped towards switches or routers without terminating the Ethernet frames. Mapping Ethernet flow inside VC–12/3/4 implies a compression of the total available bandwidth of the physical ethernet protocol. The IEEE802.3 is the standard algorithm used to adapt each customer flow inside an independent VC. Main functional aspects: Ethernet frames are mapped over a SDH VC using Generic Framing Procedure (GFP) encapsulation (see Figure 130. on page 258, and Recc. ITU–T G. 7041 for details). All the Ethernet access connectors are on the front panel of the unit. The architecture of the board is represented in Figure 136. on page 265. It is constituted by two cards, an access card that provides 14 Ethernet interfaces 10BaseT or 100BaseT, and a main board that provides 11 Ethernet interfaces 10BaseT or 100BaseT (the physical connector is always the same). The Ethernet traffic, opportunely mapped in the SDH transport structures, is then sent toward the SDH matrix through the back–Plane which has 4 STM–1 equivalent throughput. –
The board allows the mapping provisioning between the Ethernet (10 Mbit) or Fast Ethernet (100 Mbit) interfaces and the SDH VC as follows: •
Ethernet interface to a single: – –
•
Fast Ethernet interfaces to a single: – – –
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
VC–12 or VC–3;
VC–12 or VC–3 VC–4
The back–Panel can support a maximum throughput of 622 Mb/s divided in 4 STM–1 flows. This constitutes a constraint respect to, for example, a configuration of the board with 25 Fast Ethernet interfaces mapped into 25 VC–4 (not possible because overcome the throughput).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
264 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Two types of ETHERNET boards are foreseen for 1660SM :
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
This is a typical problem of resource allocation where in one side there are up to 25 VC–n transport structures on the other side there are 4 tubes of STM–1 capacity, and the Operator has to find the mapping VCn–tube which best fits the available resources (622 Mbit/s). Summarizing, the operator first provisions the board defining the interface types, second he creates the VCx defining in the mapping between the interface and VC, since the relationship between interface and VC is one to one. More complex is the association between the VC–n and STM–1 back–Plane flow in order to best fit the resources. –
One Ethernet Interface is mapped in one SDH VC: no grooming of Ethernet frames in the SDH network
–
No Virtual Concatenation of Lower Order SDH VCs
–
Protection occurs at SDH level
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 136. Board Ethernet 10/100: System architecture
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
265 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 137. Example of Ethernet service application
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
266 / 636
1660SM with LAN to LAN board
Customer box: either LAN Switch or Router
Legenda: protection
SDH level
Ethernet frames are mapped in SDH VC–12. VC–3, VC–4
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The LAN to LAN board is present only at each terminating node
SDH RING NETWORK
mapped on a dedicated SDH VC
Site to Site Traffic is
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Ethernet MAC Frame and GFP Frame fields: –
Preamble: the preamble is a 7–octet field that is used to allow the PLS (Physical Signaling) circuitry to reach its steady–state synchronization with the received frame’s timing.
–
Start of Frame Delimiter: the SFD field is the sequence 10101011. It immediately follows the preamble pattern and indicates the start of a frame.
–
Destination Address (DA): the Destination Address field specifies the station(s) for which the frame is intended.
–
Source Address (SA): the Source Address field specifies the station sending the frame.
–
Length/Type: this two–octet field takes one of two meanings, depending on its numeric value: – If the value of this field is less than or equal to the value of max Valid Frame, then the Length/Type field indicates the number of MAC client data octets contained in the subsequent data field of the frame (Length interpretation). – If the value of this field is greater than or equal to 1536 decimal (equal to 0600 hexadecimal), then the Length/Type field indicates the nature of the MAC client protocol (Type interpretation). The Length and Type interpretations of this field are mutually exclusive.
–
MAC client data and PAD: The data field contains a sequence of n octets; full data transparency is provided. If the length of the data field is less than the minimum required for proper operation of the protocol, a PAD field (a sequence of octets) will be added at the end of the data field but prior to the FCS field.
–
Frame check Sequence (FCS): a cyclic redundancy check (CRC) is used by the transmit and receive algorithms to generate a CRC value for the FCS field. The frame check sequence (FCS) field contains a 4–octet (32–bit) cyclic redundancy check (CRC) value. This value is computed as a function of the contents of the source address, destination address, length, LLC data and pad (that is, all fields except the preamble, SFD, FCS, and extension).
–
PLI: the two–octet PLI field contains a binary number representing the number of octets in the GFP Payload Area.
–
cHEC: the two–octet Core Header Error Control field contains a CRC–16 generated sequence that protects the integrity of the contents of the Core Header by enabling both single–bit error correction and multi–bit error detection.
–
Type: the GFP Type field is a mandatory 2–octet field of the Payload Header that indicates the content and format of the GFP Payload field
–
tHEC: The two–octet Type Header Error Control field contains a CRC–16 generated sequence that protects the integrity of the contents of the Type Field by enabling both single–bit error correction and multi–bit error detection.
–
GFP Extension Header: a 0–to–60 octets extended field that supports technology specific data link headers such as virtual link identifiers, source/destination addresses, port numbers, Class of Service, extended header error control, etc.
–
GFP Payload: The GFP Payload Area consists of all octets in the GFP frame after the GFP Core Header. This variable length area may include from 4 to 65 535 octets.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
267 / 636
The task of the Gigabit Ethernet functionality inside 1660SM is to carry Gigabit Ethernet packets over SDH Virtual Containers. It can be achieved in two different ways using : [1]
“Gigabit Access card” + “10/100 Mbit Ethernet board”: only two Gigabit interfaces are supported.
[2]
“Gigabit Ethernet rate adaptive board”: up to 4 Gigabit interfaces are supported.
[1] “Gigabit Access card” + “10/100 Mbit Ethernet board” This functionality is achieved using the 10/100 Mbit/s Ethernet board (Fast Ethernet) in conjunction with the Gigabit Ethernet Access Card as depicted in Figure 138. The function performed by the Access card is the interfacing on one side with the 1 Gigabit line and on the other side with the 10/100 Mbit/s Ethernet board ( where the signal is processed) through two 1.2 Gbit/s serial busses. Only two of the four interfaces ( pluggable module alternatively 1000 BASE–LX , 1000 BASE–SX, 1000 BASE–ZX) on the Gigabit Access card can be used . Gigabit interface are mapped through Generic Frame Protocol in one VC–4. with a compression ratio of 1:7; 802.3 Ethernet Flow Control is supported. The Ethernet traffic mapped in the SDH transport structures, is then sent toward the SDH matrix through the back–Plane which has 4 STM–1 equivalent throughput. In the configuration depicted in Figure 138. the 10/100 Mbit Ethernet interfaces present on the ETHERNET board can also be used taking into account the limit of the backplane.
Gigabit Eth
1
Gigabit Eth not used
Gigabit Access Card
not used 4
2 x 1.2 Gibit/s busses (through backplane)
10/100 Mbit Eth 1
10/100 Mbit Eth
10/100 ETHERNET BOARD
SDH
SDH
Matrix
Port
10/100 Mbit Eth 11
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Backplane : 622 Mbit/s throughput
Figure 138. Gigabit Ethernet System architecture: Gigabit access with Fast Ethernet board
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
268 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.8.4.2 Gbit Ethernet (rate adaptive) unit
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[2] “Gigabit Ethernet rate adaptive board” The board, named Gb Ethernet with GFP mapping (mnemonic label GETH–MB), supports up to four Gb Ethernet interfaces in the main boards as depicted in the following Figure 139.
Ethernet Modules: 1000 Base LX 1000 Base SX 1000 Base ZX
Gbit ETH Main board
1660SM (Slot not Enhanced) Figure 139. Gigabit Ethernet System architecture:Gigabit Ethernet main board The Gb Ethernet interfaces (pluggable module) plugged in main board, are named Small Formfactor Pluggable (SFP) Transceivers and they can be considered as independent items hardware, in fact they have an own Remote Inventory. At the moment three types of Small Formfactor Pluggable Transceivers are provided: 1. Gb Ethernet Long Haul optical interface 1000BASE–LX 2. Gb Ethernet Short Haul optical interface 1000BASE–SX 3. Gb Ethernetl optical interface 1000BASE–ZX Each Gb Ethernet interface can be mapped through the Generic Frame Protocol (GFP) into 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 or 7 VC4s. The mapping determines the rate of compression of the data throughput that can be respectively from 1:7 to 1:1. As for the Fast Ethernet this compression is allowed thanks to the flow control algorithm and considering the Ethernet traffic profile is typically bursty and the mean throughput is less than the peak rate. If the board is into an enhanced slot of 1660SM the back panel throughput is of 1.2 Gb/s instead of 622Mb/s, this determines that the maximum number of VC–4 mappable to the Gb/s Ethernet Interfaces is 8 instead of 4. This, for example, allows the transparent (without compression) transport of a Gb Ethernet interface into the SDH network.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
In order to provide for the Gb Ethernet a rate compression less than 1/7, more than one VC4 can be used to transport the Ethernet traffic, until a maximum of 7 VC4 where the transparent transport is obtained, in fact 7 times 150Mb/s (VC4 payload rate) is 1050Mb/s. Note, if no compression is configured (i.e. mapping on 7 VC4s), also another Gb/s interface can be mapped on a single VC4 (maximum compression level), in order to use all the backpanel bandwidth (8 VC–4 equivalent). The possibility of configuring more VC–4s, referring to the same client, is obtained by High Order virtual concatenation, where the level, the number of VC4s virtual concatenated, is provisioned by the operator.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
269 / 636
3.9.1 General Today’s evolving telecommunications services environment is highly competitive. There is a growing demand from Enterprise customers for simple, wide–area Broadband Data services which meet their needs for plentiful, competitively priced and flexible connectivity. Historically the success of Ethernet as the predominate technology within the Enterprise infrastructure, has been driven by very low capital and operational costs, the high degree of flexibility offered by the technology and importantly its easy of use – the plug and play model. Thus enterprises are now looking for data services outside of the building (in the WAN), which match the Ethernet technology used internally for LAN based services, without the need for expensive conversion equipment. These new services offered by the public network in the Wide Area are referred to a Metro Ethernet services. Similarly network operators and service providers are looking to new services like Metro Ethernet in order to develop new high–value revenue streams. An example of which is enhancing basic Ethernet connectivity this through the use of value added capabilities such as Layer 2 VPNs and multiple Qualities of Service (QoS) per connection. Deployment of Ethernet as a simplistic point–to–point technology will only result in canalization of existing Leased Line, Frame Relay and ATM based services. Only through the provision of Value–Added Services (VAS) of basic Ethernet connectivity to provide differentiation will Metro Ethernet services deliver incremental revenues and ultimately profitability. The ISA–ES series modules can deliver a full set of Ethernet services that are described in the next points [1] to [4]. [1]
Ethernet Private Line EPLine service connects two ports of a client between each other in a transparent fashion (using transparent mode). Traffic originating from one Customer Port is forwarded to the other one without any filtering and maximum level of security possible (physical segregation through different SDH infrastructure). The service emulates an Ethernet ”wire” which actual bandwidth is determined by the SLA and by network load. EPLine does not require MAC learning or MAC–based forwarding.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 140. Ethernet Private Line service
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
270 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.9 ISA – ES (Ethernet Switch)
[2]
Ethernet Virtual Private Line
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
EVP–Line service connects two ports of a client between each other (using bridging mode). Traffic originating from one Customer Port is classified and forwarded accordingly to the other end. The service emulates an Ethernet ”wire” which actual bandwidth is determined by the SLA and by network load. Thanks to the available Eth Multiplexing Function provided by the ISA–ES series modules, different Virtual Private Line services can be defined on the same UNI belonging to different applications and with different QoS SLA. EVPLine adopts MAC learning and MAC–based forwarding according to the need.
Figure 141. Ethernet Virtual Private Line service [3]
Ethernet Virtual LAN EVP–LAN service connects two or more ports of a client between each other (using bridging mode).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Traffic originating from one Customer Port is classified and forwarded accordingly to the other end. The service emulates an Ethernet LAN which actual bandwidth is determined by the SLA and by network load. EVP–LAN adopts MAC learning and MAC–based forwarding with aging timeout.
Figure 142. Ethernet Virtual LAN
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
271 / 636
Broadband access In this service, a number of customers are connected to a common Aggregate Port (e.g. typically connected to an ISP point of presence) Traffic is only delivered from individual Customer Ports to the Aggregate Port. Broadband Access can distinguish between various customers’ traffic at the Aggregate Port using VLAN tags. For each customer that is attached to the BA service it is possible to define a specific QoS SLA.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 143. Broadband Access service
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
272 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[4]
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.9.2 ISA–ES series modules ISA–ES series modules provide ETH 10/100/1000 interfaces connectivity for LAN based clients premises inside the metro area. Beyond mapping ETH flows onto the SDH metro network by means of standard mechanisms (as specified in ITU G.7071, ITU G.7042 and ITU G.707) the ISA–ES series cards introduce wire speed classifying, policing and scheduling capability empowered by carrier class Ethernet switching engine. Per customer traffic flow management with low bandwidth granularity, segregation and QoS are just few of the value added arguments that these series of modules offer to the carrier operators at a competitive price. ISA–ES series is composed by: –
ISA–ES1 module
–
ISA–ES4 module
–
ISA–ES16 module
The ISA–ES series modules are modules that can be plugged according to the bandwidth and interface count demand inside the OMSN product family. Some of the resources available in the SDH infrastructure can be utilized in order to realize a converged multi service network into which different streams (e.g. TDM, ETH, ATM) can travel together in fat big pipes reducing capital and operational expenses for the operator. The major benefits that can be experienced utilizing an ISA–ES card in the SDH networks are: –
Interfaces cost reduction
–
Bandwidth policing according to clients needs and operator’s policy
The interface cost reduction is achieved thanks to the native ETH interfaces provided from the equipment that allow a cost effective replacement of useless and expensive up–link ports an external devices to connect to the public network (e.g. POS (Packet Over SDH/SONET) or FR uplinks). This leads to an infrastructure’s optimization for the operator and an induced cost reduction for the end–user devices. Furthermore bandwidth can be allocated and consequently controlled by the operator (through CIR, PIR and burstiness specification) to the end users in accordance with the real need, independently from the (physical) interface type used case by case. Operators are, as such, enabled to offer more services with enhanced flexibility and granularity, optimizing the bandwidth through the SDH network and opening new value added services from a common set of equipments being the technology TDM, ATM or ETH. As for the other ISA modules the ISA–ES series modules are connected to the main SDH matrix via specific back–panel wires.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The capacity available from the card to the back panel gives the overall card trunking capacity that is available for traffic to flow from and to the SDH resources (e.g. SDH ports that carry ETH traffic into SDH VC).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
273 / 636
–
ISA–ES1
has 1 VC–4 of bandwidth available
–
ISA–ES4
has 4 VC–4 of bandwidth available
–
SA–ES16
has up to 16 VC–4 of bandwidth available (depending on the back panel capacity of the OMSN equipment)
Each of the ISA–ES series modules has specific ETH access ports and SDH trunks. –
ETH access ports may reside on the card itself of may be provided through other access cards.
–
SDH trunks are connections (SDH VCs) through the back panel to the SDH matrix and to SDH ports (STM–n).
ETH access ports on the ES series modules are: –
ISA–ES1 8FE
has 8 Ethernet ports (10/100 Base T) on the front of the card
–
ISA–ES1 8FX
has 8 Ethernet ports (100 Base FX) on the front of the card
–
ISA–ES4 8FE+1GE
has 8 Ethernet ports (10/100 Base T) and 1 GB Ethernet port (1000 Base SX/LX/ZX SFP) on the front of the card
–
ISA–ES16
is a port less card that can use specific access modules:
•
14 x FE access module: 14 x Fast Ethernet ports (10/100 Base T)
•
4 x GE access module:
4 x GB Ethernet ports with SFP plugs (Optical SX, LX, ZX)
Different ISA–ES series modules can be equipped in the same equipment. In this case it is also possible to realize back–to–back trunking between them via specific cross connections inside the SDH matrix (without the need of cabling). Traffic can flow between two or more cards and the amount of it can be specified according to the need (refer to Figure 144. on page 274). ISA–ES1
ISA–ES16
Access card
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
SDH
Figure 144. ISA–ES access port
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
274 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The number to the right of the ISA–ES series card gives that amount in VC–4 equivalents. Hereafter are reported the available trunking capacity for each of the ISA_ES series cards:
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Figure 145. provides an high level overview of the traffic flow and processing in the ISA–ES series modules. The pipeline is composed of five main processing steps that are described in the next paragraphs.
De–mapping
Classifier
Policer
Forwarding
Scheduler
Mapping frame
Encap packet
Ports
PIR
Header De– assembly
=
CIR
Frame/packet
Bridge
mapping
+ reassembly
?
=
Figure 145. Traffic flow and processing in ISA–ES series [1]
Mapping
ISA–ES series modules are a family of Ethernet switching modules that provides native ETH access to an SDH infrastructure. Beyond just providing the physical ETH connectivity this family of modules has a full carrier class set of functionality for optimal and efficient handling of ETH traffic flows with QoS. An ISA–ES module receives and sends ETH traffic through two kinds of ports (refer to Figure 146. ): •
ETH physical interfaces (10/100 Base T , 100 BASE FX or 1000 Base SX/LX/ZX)
•
ETH over SDH (also referred as trunk ports)
These ports are connected to a carrier class Ethernet switching engine that processes each flow and takes care of the frame forwarding.
Eth I/O ETH ports
Eth Switch ETH Over SDH ports
Back Panel N x VC
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 146. ISA–ES series ports
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
275 / 636
•
IEEE 802.3 10BASE–T Ethernet (twisted–pair copper)
•
IEEE 802.3u 100BASE–TX Fast Ethernet (twisted–pair copper)
•
IEEE 802.1z (Gigabit Ethernet)
•
ANSI/IEEE 802.3 Auto–negotiation
•
IEEE 802.3x Flow Control
•
Data transfer rate from client equipment is limited in accordance with the specified traffic characteristics by the standard IEEE 802.3x flow control mechanism.
Flow control frames are used to prevent congestion of the network that may cause packet discarding at the egress of the network; the flow control mechanism stops the client source until the bandwidth allocated to the service is able to absorb the extra traffic. The result is that no packets are lost even in case of congestion. Flow control can be disabled according to the operator’s choice. The following standards apply to the ETH over SDH ports: •
ITU–T G.7041 GFP (Generic Framing Procedure)
•
ITU–T G.7042 LCAS (Link Connection Adjustment Scheme)
•
G.707 (SDH VC Virtual Concatenation at Low and High Order VC–12, VC–3 and VC–4 nv)
The Ethernet mapping scheme on the trunk ports adheres to the Generic Framing Procedure (ITU–T G. 7041). The Ethernet traffic, opportunely mapped in the SDH transport structures, is then sent by the trunk ports toward the SDH matrix from the back–plane and than to the corresponding SDH port. A trunk port is realized by a bundle of SDH VCs (VC–12, VC–3, VC–4) grouped together according to ITU–T G.707 (Virtual Conc) and ITU–T G.7042 (LCAS).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The bandwidth of the trunk port in normal operational mode corresponds to the available bandwidth of the grouped VCs (e.g. 5xVC–12 equals 10 Mbps).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
276 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The following standards apply to ETH physical ports:
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[2]
Traffic classification
ISA–ES series module can classify ETH traffic according to a wide set of standard specified criteria in order to provide a feature reach set of capability. Each classified traffic is referred in the next paragraphs as a classified flow. Classification criteria are the following: •
Port (Physical ETH or ETH over SDH)
•
IEEE 802.1Q (VLAN tagging)
•
IEEE 802.1p (ETH frame priority)
•
IEEE 802.3 Source/Destination MAC address (also according to IEEE 802.1ad)
The ISA–ES16 module expands the classification criteria by means of also supporting:
[3]
•
MPLS label (according to IETF Martini draft ETH over MPLS)
•
IP–TOS/DSCP fields
Policing and metering traffic with QoS
ISA–ES series modules allow service providers and carrier operators to specify per flow traffic QoS. ETH flows quality of service is enforced at the ingress of the network and inside the network by traffic conformance check made by the policing function. Policing is performed by means of a token bucket algorithm (dual rate on the ISA–ES16). Traffic QoS is specified by a set of parameters that control its max, mean rate and the relative burst window size in bytes. Policing parameters are specified per classified flow according to: CIR = committer information rate CBS = burst window size at the CIR PIR = excess information rate PBS = burst window size at the PIR
Burst window size (bytes) PBS Yellow EBS CBS EIR
Green
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Rate (bps) CIR
PIR
Figure 147. ISA–ES series traffic parameters
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
277 / 636
a)
Guaranteed SLA Typically serves High priority traffic for mission critical applications that require loss–less delivery and minimal delay. Guaranteed SLA denotes BW (CIR = PIR > 0 in 100Kbps increments), which is always available regardless of any congestion conditions. Traffic delivered using Guaranteed BW, is policed to the CIR value with a burst window equal to the CBS. Guaranteed traffic is always composed of green packets and gets the highest priority in the processing chain.
b)
Regulated SLA Typically serves Medium priority traffic, which relies on transport layer protocol (per OSI stack) to recover from occasional loss and requires moderate delay; e.g. client–server applications. Regulated SLA denotes BW (PIR > CIR >0 in 100Kbps increments), which may be overbooked per network operator’s overbooking policy. The portion of bandwidth between CIR and PIR (aka EIR) may therefore be partially available under congestion conditions. This SLA is available only from the ISA–ES16 card. Regulated traffic is composed of green and yellow (Excess of CIR) packets.
c)
Best–Effort SLA Typically serves Low priority traffic, which relies on transport layer protocol (per OSI stack) to recover from loss and tolerates large delay; e.g. email and file transfer applications. Best Effort denotes BW (PIR > CIR = 0 in 100Kbps increments), which may or may not be available per network operator’s reservation for Best Effort policy. It may therefore be unavailable under congestion conditions. Regulated traffic is composed of yellow packets.
[4]
Congestion avoidance and Scheduling
Congestion avoidance techniques serve to anticipate and avoid network congestion conditions wile maximizing network utilization and good–put of the traffic flows. Congestion avoidance in ISA–ES series modules is based on a combination of Tail Dropping and WRED (Random Early Detection); these techniques are designed to provide preferential treatment for premium (CIR) class traffic under congestion situations while concurrently maximizing network throughput and capacity utilization and minimizing packet loss and delay.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
a)
Tail drop Tail drop treats all traffic equally and does not differentiate between classes of service. Queues fill during periods of congestion. When the output queue is full and tail drop is in effect, packets are dropped until the congestion is eliminated and the queue is no longer full.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
278 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Through the specification of per flow traffic parameters the ISA–ES series modules can support the following SLAs:
b)
WRED
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The packet drop probability is based on the minimum threshold, maximum threshold, and mark probability denominator. When the average queue depth is above the minimum threshold, RED starts dropping packets. The rate of packet drop increases linearly as the average queue size increases until the average queue size reaches the maximum threshold. The mark probability denominator is the fraction of packets dropped when the average queue depth is at the maximum threshold. For example, if the denominator is 512, one out of every 512 packets is dropped when the average queue is at the maximum threshold. When the average queue size is above the maximum threshold, all packets are dropped. WRED is applied to yellow packets (Regulated (traffic beyond CIR) and Best Effort traffic quality). 1
Mark probability
0 Minimum threshold
Maximum threshold
Average queue size Figure 148. WRED Congestion avoidance mechanisms c)
Scheduling Scheduling of packets is performed on egress ports combining HOL (FIFO queue) and DRR (Deficit Round Robin) queues. HOL is used for Guaranteed traffic that gets highest priority.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
DRR is applied to Regulated and Best Effort traffic
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
279 / 636
Switching and forwarding
ISA–ES series modules are based onto a carrier class Ethernet switching engine with auto learning bridges according to IEEE 802.1ad. This engine is either wire speed performing (all the functions are performed in hw) and highly flexible and configurable. On a per port basis it can be used in two modes: Transparent mode: the engine forwards all the traffic incoming from one port to another without inspection at the specified rate. Bridging mode with Stacked VLAN capability: a group of configured ports (ETH phy or ETH over SDH) are bridged together with MAC auto learning function according to IEEE 802.1ad. Transparent Mode
Back Panel N x VC–4
Eth I/O Bridge Mode
Figure 149. ISA–ES series operational modes a)
Multiple service per UNI port ISA–ES series modules allow multiple services to be deployed from a single UNI Ethernet port. Thanks to the Ethernet Multiplexing Function capability different traffics can coexist on the same port and be differentiated between them by the classification process thus get the desired QoS per flow. CUSTOMER SITE B
CUSTOMER SITE C ETH UNI
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
CUSTOMER SITE A
EMF CUSTOMER SITE D
Figure 150. Ethernet Multiplexing Function
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
280 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[5]
b)
Multiple customers per NNI port
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The ISA–ES series modules allow a single NNI interface to be used for different customers while guaranteeing high levels of segregation, security and per customer QoS ability. ISA–ES series modules allow ETH frames to be tagged before being sent at the NNI interface. The modules have full VLAN tag agility in the sense that VLAN tags can be pushed, swapped and popped by the cards. The provider is able to add its own tags to the customer flows in order to segregate different customers inside common network resources. This taggagility functionality allow service providers to spread the capital expenditures among different customers and as a consequence to offer highly competitive price levels for the offered services to their customers.
CUSTOMER
CUSTOMER B
A
ETH UNI SVLAN 1 SVLAN 2 SVLAN 3
CUSTOMER C
Figure 151. Multiple customers on a single NNI c)
Customer traffic Isolation All ISA–ES series modules ports and services provide customer traffic isolation, such that traffic belonging to a given customer is isolated from traffic of any other customer using an identical or different service.
d)
Customer Address Space Isolation All ISA–ES series modules ports and services provide isolation customer of customer specific addresses, such that VLAN tags and MAC addresses belonging to a given customer are isolated from VLAN tags and MAC addresses of any other customer using an identical or different service.
e)
VLAN Uniqueness
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
VLAN at the access interfaces need not be unique. Same value can be used at different ports of the same node or at different nodes. The guarantee of VLAN uniqueness within a port in the ISA PR EA comes from the encapsulation of the Ethernet frames in MPLS LSP’s that segregate Ethernet traffic.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
281 / 636
The unit is able to perform time division multiplex/demultiplex of client channels. The client streams are mapped in 16 virtually concatenated VC–4s according to a proprietary–mapping algorithm. Provisioning parameters and alarm collection are managed through two control interfaces. The board has a highly modular fabric consisting of a housing card that can accommodate up to 4 modules, one for each aggregated traffic. The client data rates that the module can manage are reported in Table 37. : Table 37. Relationship between 4xANY optical modules and client type Client type
Fast Ethernet FDDI
Bit rate
@125 Mb/sec @125 Mb/sec
ESCON Digital Video Fiber Channel FICON Gigabit Ethernet
@200 Mb/sec @270 Mb/sec @1.0625 Gb/sec @1.0625 Gb/sec @1.25 Gb/sec
Associated module Type
Wavelength
Acronym
Low Speed
1310 nm
OL–IN
850 nm
OL–MM
1310 nm
OL–IN
850 nm
OL–MM
1310 nm
OL–IN
850 nm
OL–MM
1310 nm
OL–IN
850 nm
OL–MM
1310 nm
OH–IN
850 nm
OH–MM
1310 nm
OH–IN
850 nm
OH–MM
1310 nm
OH–IN
850 nm
OH–MM
Low Speed Low Speed Low Speed High Speed High Speed High Speed
The 4xANYC modules configuration requires the operator to specify the client type to be transported on each module.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The Table 38. below reports the number of VC–4 istantiated to manage a data stream of each client type
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
282 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.10 4 x ANY HOST C subsystem
Table 38. 4xANY HOST C client type
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Client type
Number of istantiated VC4
Fiber Channel
8
FICON
8
Gigabit Ethernet
8
Digital Video
2
ESCON
2
Fast Ethernet
1
FDDI
1
The max throughput made available by the 4xANY HOSTC port is STM16 (2.5 Gb/s). The capability to handle the whole throughput in terms of cross–connectivity depends on the equipment of the port in “Enhanced H.S slots” rather than in “H.S. slots” of 1660SM shelf as explained on points [1] and [2]. Insertion of the board across hybrid slot (“Enhanced H.S slots” + “H.S. slots”) is not allowed.
[1]
4 x ANY inserted in enhanced slot (25&26, 28&29, 34&35, 37&38)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
In ’Enhanced H.S.’ slot, the connection port matrix can exploit two NGI links per type (i.e. 2 ’H’ / 2 ’X’ / 2 ’L” links), each one operating at 622 Mb/s (equivalent 4xSTM1’s), with a total connection bandwidth of 1.2 Gb/s per slot; then, the port equipped in two ’Enhanced’ slots, allows the user to use up to 2.5 Gb/s throughput according to the client allocation grid showed in Figure 152.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
283 / 636
Modules configured
Links towards MATRIX
Client allocation inside 4xANY board
#1
#3
#2
#4
AU4 #1 AU4 #2 AU4 #3 AU4 #4 AU4 #5
GE, FE, FDDI
FC, FICON
AU4 #6 AU4 #7 AU4 #8
FE, FDDI
AU4 #9 AU4 #10 AU4 #11
FE, FDDI
AU4 #12 AU4 #13 AU4 #14
ESCON, DV
NGI link #0
NGI link #1
ESCON, DV ESCON, DV
GE,
NGI link #2
FC, FE, FDDI
FICON
ESCON, DV
NGI link #3
AU4 #15 Figure 152. 4xANY HOST–C: Client allocation grid in “enhanced” slot Consequently, module configuration allowed are as reported in the following Figure 153.
#1
FE, FDDI, ESCON, DV
#3
FE, FDDI, ESCON, DV
#4
#1
#2
#3
FE, FDDI, ESCON, DV
#3
FE, FDDI, ESCON, DV
#2
FE, FDDI, ESCON, DV
#4
Not eq.
#1
FE, FDDI, ESCON, DV Not eq.
#3
Not eq.
GE, FC, FICON,
Not eq.
Not eq.
Not eq.
Not eq.
GE, FC, FICON,
GE, FC, FICON,
#4
#2
Not eq.
#4
Not eq.
Not eq. 1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
GE, FC, FICON, Not eq.
Not eq.
Not eq.
FE, FDDI, ESCON, DV
#1
Not eq.
Not eq.
Not eq.
#2
FE, FDDI, ESCON, DV
Figure 153. 4xANY HOST–C: module configuration in “enhanced” slot Same considerations of Figure 153. are showed in Table 39. :
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
284 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
AU4 #0
Table 39. Modules configuration in “Enhanced HS” slot
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Module number #3
Module type
Client configured by operator
OH–MM, OH–IN
Fiber Channel FICON Gigabit Ethernet
OL–MM, OL–IN
Digital Video ESCON
Configuration Constraints In conjunction with this clients on module#3, the module#1cannot be used
Fast Ethernet FDDI #1
OH–MM, OH–I cannot be configured in module#1 OL–MM, OL–IN
Digital Video ESCON Fast Ethernet FDDI
#4
OH–MM, OH–IN
Fiber Channel FICON Gigabit Ethernet
OL–MM, OL–IN
Digital Video ESCON
In conjunction with this clients on module#4, the module#2 cannot be used
Fast Ethernet FDDI #2
OH–MM, OH–I cannot be configured in module#2 OL–MM, OL–IN
Digital Video ESCON
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Fast Ethernet FDDI
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
285 / 636
4 x ANY inserted in not enhanced slot (30&31 and 32&33) In ’H.S.’ slot, the same connectivity is based on one NGI link per type (i.e. ’H’ / ’X’ / ’L’); with a total connection bandwidth of 622 Mb/s per slot; then, the equipment of the port in two ’H.S.’ slots, allows the user to use up to 1.2 Gb/s throughput. In Figure 154. , the client allocation, concerning Gb Ethernet, Fiber Channel, FICON and the relationship with NGI links available for connecting Matrix card, are showed.
Client allocation inside 4xANY board AU–4 optimization AU4 #0 Modules AU4 #1 configured AU4 #2 AU4 #3 AU4 #4 AU4 #5 #1 #3 AU4 #6 AU4 #7 AU4 #8 #2 #4
AU4 #0 GE, FE, FDDI
ESCON, DV
FICON FE, FDDI
ESCON,
AU4 #6 AU4 #7 AU4 #8
DV ESCON,
AU4 #9 FE, FDDI AU4 #10 AU4 #11
DV
AU4 #12 FE, FDDI AU4 #13 AU4 #14
ESCON,
AU4 #15
FC,
GE, FC,
DV
AU4 #1 AU4 #2 AU4 #3 AU4 #4 AU4 #5
FICON
AU4 #9 AU4 #10 AU4 #11 AU4 #12 AU4 #13 AU4 #14
GE, FC, FICON AU4’s not available GE, FC, FICON AU4’s not available
Links towards MATRIX
NGI link #0
NGI link #1 not available
NGI link #2
NGI link #3 not available
AU4 #15
Figure 154. Client allocation grid in “HS slots” with GE/FC/FICON
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
In Figure 155. , the ’optimized’ client allocation, concerning Fast Ethernet, FDDI, ESCON, Digital Video, , and the relationship with NGI links available for connecting Matrix card, are showed.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
286 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[2]
Client allocation inside 4xANY board
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
AU–4 optimization AU4 #0 Modules AU4 #1 configured AU4 #2 AU4 #3 AU4 #4 AU4 #5 #1 #3
#2 #4
AU4 #6 AU4 #7 AU4 #8
AU4 #0 GE, ESCON, DV FE, FDDI
AU4 #1 AU4 #2 AU4 #3 AU4 #4 AU4 #5
FC, FICON
FE, FDDI ESCON, DV ESCON,
AU4 #9 FE, FDDI DV AU4 #10 AU4 #11 AU4 #12 FE, FDDI ESCON, AU4 #13 AU4 #14
DV
FE, FDDI
AU4 #9 AU4 #10 AU4 #11
FC,
AU4 #15
NGI link #0
ESCON FE, FDDI
DV
AU4’s not available
NGI link #1 not available
ESCON FE, FDDI FE, FDDI
AU4 #12 AU4 #13 AU4 #14
FICON
ESCON DV
AU4 #6 AU4 #7 AU4 #8 GE,
Links towards MATRIX
DV
NGI link #2
ESCON DV
AU4’s not
NGI link #3 not available
available
AU4 #15
Figure 155. Client allocation grid in “HS slots” with FE/FDDI/ESCON/DV
Consequently, module configuration allowed are as reported in the following Figure 156.
#1
FE, FDDI, ESCON, DV
#3
FE, FDDI, ESCON, DV Not eq.
#1
Not eq.
#3
#4
FE, FDDI, ESCON, DV
GE, FC, FICON, Not eq.
Not eq.
Not eq.
#2
FE, FDDI, ESCON, DV
Not eq.
Not eq.
#2
#4
Not eq.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 156. module configuration in “HS” slots
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
287 / 636
Same considerations of Figure 156. are showed in Table 40.
Module number #3
Module type
Client configured by operator
OH–MM, OH–I
Fiber Channel FICON Gigabit Ethernet
OL–MM, OL–IN
Digital Video ESCON
Configuration Constraints In conjunction with this clients on module#3, all other 3 modules cannot be used
Fast Ethernet FDDI #1
OH–MM, OH–I cannot be configured in module#1 OL–MM, OL–IN
Digital Video ESCON Fast Ethernet FDDI
#4
OH–MM, OH–I cannot be configured in module#4 OL–MM, OL–IN
Digital Video ESCON Fast Ethernet FDDI
#2
OH–MM, OH–I cannot be configured in module#2 OL–MM, OL–IN
Digital Video ESCON
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Fast Ethernet FDDI
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
288 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 40. Modules configuration in “HS” slot
3.11 Coarse WDM sub–system
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The following items are considered: –
STM16 colored port (2 two slots wide) to be equipped in “Enhanced H.S.” slots and supporting the 8 channels ’CWDM’ ITU–T grid;
–
COADM 1ch unit (2 two slots wide) to be equipped in “Access area”, supporting the 8 channels ’CWDM” ITU–T grid;
–
COADM 2ch unit (2 two slots wide) to be equipped in “Access area”, supporting the 8 channels ’CWDM” ITU–T grid;
–
MUX/DEMUX 8ch unit (2 two slots wide) to be equipped in “Access area”, supporting the 8 channels ’CWDM” ITU–T grid;
–
Double channel ’multirate’ Transponder unit (100 Mb/s B 2.7 Gb/s) (one slot wide) to be equipped in every slot of “Basic area”, supporting both wavelength assignment function (B/W to ’col’) and wavelength regeneration function (’colored’ to ’colored’) and performing the transparent transport of the following ’client’ signals:
ED
•
FDDI, (not operative in current release)
•
Fast Ethernet, (not operative in current release)
•
STM1/OC3, (not operative in current release)
•
ESCON, (not operative in current release)
•
Digital Video, (not operative in current release)
•
STM4/OC12, (not operative in current release)
•
Fiber Channel, (not operative in current release)
•
FICON, (not operative in current release)
•
Gb Ethernet, (not operative in current release)
•
2 Fiber Channel, (not operative in current release)
•
STM16/OC48,
•
2 Gb Ethernet, (not operative in current release)
•
STM16 w/ FEC (not operative in current release)
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
289 / 636
3.11.1 Equipment facilities
The example below reported, shows the equipment with COADM 1(2) channels unit, as for NE’s belonging to network with limited traffic demand (supported by 1 or 2 wavelengths). For this kind of use, also the equipment is supposed to be limited to one shelf only.
ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÊÊ ÔÔ ÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÊÊ ÊÊ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÊÊ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÊÊ ÔÔ ÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÊÊ ÊÊ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔÊÊÊ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔ Ê ÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔ Ê Ê ÔÔÔÔÔ Ê ÔÔ ÔÔÔ Ê ÔÔÔÔÔ Ê ÔÔ ÔÔÔ Ê ÔÔÔÔÔ Ê ÔÔÔÔÔ Ê ÔÔ ÔÔÔ Ê ÔÔÔÔÔ Ê ÔÔÔÔÔ Ê
MATRIX B (spare)
Port LS–HS
4 X ANY
Port HS
SMT–16 ”col”
CONGI B Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS
SERVICE
TPD Port HS Port LS Spare – HS Port LS–HS
Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS CONGI A STM–16 –B&W
COADM 1/2 ch.
Port HS
Access Card LS/HS
SMT–16 ”col”
COADM 1/2 ch.
Port LS–HS
MATRIX A (main)
Access Card LS Access Card LS/HS
EQUICO
Basic
Area
Access
Area
Equipment example with COADM 1/2 CHANNELS for Ring application
ÁÁÁÁÁÁÖÖ ÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ Ö ÁÁÁÁ ÁÁÁÁ ÁÁÖÖ ÖÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁ ÁÁ Ö ÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÁÖÖ ÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁ ÁÁ Ö ÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÁÖÖ ÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ Ö ÁÁÁÁ ÁÁÁÁ ÁÁÖÖ ÖÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁ ÁÁ Ö ÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÁÖÖ ÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÁÖÖ ÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁÖÖ ÁÁÖÖÖ ÁÁÖÖ ÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁÁ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁÁÁÁ ÁÁÁÖÖ ÖÖÖÖÖ ÖÖÖÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁÁ ÖÖ ÖÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁÁ ÖÖ ÖÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁÁ ÖÖ ÖÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 157. COADM functionality: example of equipment shelf
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
290 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The shelf layout of resulting equipment is showed in the following figure.
MATRIX B (spare)
Port LS–HS
SMT–16 ”col”
Port HS
Equipment example with MUX/DEMUX 8 Channels handling 4 CWDM FOR RING APPLICATON (2 SEPARATE SHELVES REQUIRED)
MATRIX B (spare)
Port LS–HS
SMT–16 ”col”
Port HS
SMT–16 ”col”
CONGI B Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS
SMT–16 ”col”
CONGI B Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS
SERVICE SERVICE
Port LS–HS Port HS Port LS Spare – HS Port LS–HS
SMT–16 ”col”
Port HS
ÁÁ Á ÁÁÁÁ ÁÖÖ ÁÁ ÖÖÖÖ ÖÖÖÖ ÖÖÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁ Á ÁÁ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁ ÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁÁÁ ÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ Á ÁÁ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁ ÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁÖÖ ÁÁÁÁ ÁÁ ÖÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁÁ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÁÁÁÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁÁ ÖÖ ÁÁÁ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÁÁÁÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁÁ ÖÖ ÁÁÁ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÁÁÁÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÁÁÁÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÁÁÁÖÖ ÁÁÁÁ ÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ Á ÁÁ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁ ÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁÁÁ ÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ Á ÁÁ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁ ÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ Á ÁÁ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁ ÁÖÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁÖÖ ÁÁÁÁ ÁÁ ÖÖÖÖÖÖÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁÁ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÁÁÁÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁÁ ÖÖ ÁÁÁ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÁÁÁÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÁÁÁÖÖ ÁÁ ÁÁÁ ÖÖ ÁÁÁ ÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÁÁÁÖÖ ÁÁÁÁÁÖÖÁÁÁÖÖ
Port LS–HS Port HS Port LS Spare – HS Port LS–HS
Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS CONGI A SMT–16 ”col”
MUX / DEMUX 8 Channels Port HS
MUX / DEMUX 8 Channels
Access Card LS/HS
SMT–16 ”col”
SMT–16 ”col”
MATRIX A (main)
Port LS–HS
Port LS–HS
Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS Access Card LS/HS CONGI A
Access Card LS Access Card LS/HS
EQUICO
Access Card LS Access Card LS/HS
MATRIX A (main)
Basic Area
EQUICO
Basic Area
Access Area
ÔÔ ÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÊÊ ÊÊ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÊÊ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔ ÊÊ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÊÊ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÊÊ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÊÊ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔ ÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÊÊ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÊÊ ÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔ ÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ
Access Area
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
A further example, shows the equipment with” MUX/DEMUX 8 channels units”.
Figure 158. MUX/DEMUX functionality: example of shelf equipment
In this case 4 wavelengths are supposed to be terminated by the node in ’ring’ application; two shelves are then required in order to host the needed amount of STM16 ’CWDM’ interfaces.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The capability to host within the single shelf, the items required for ’OADM’ application (STM16 ’colored’ interface, 4xANY, double TPD, etc.) is the same in both equipment facilities.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
291 / 636
1660SM with WDM signal flow is functionally based, both in ’ring’ and ’linear’ application, on three directions:
1660SM interfacing
1660SM function
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 159. 1660SM signal flow diagram with WDM application [1]
“client” signals groomed by SDH matrix and carried by ’CWDM’ wavelengths;
[2]
“client” signals not groomed by SDH matrix and carried, transparently, by ’CWDM” wavelengths (wavelength assignment on B/W signals);
[3]
“server” signals not groomed by SDH matrix and regenerated on same or different wavelength.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
292 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.11.2 Functional description
3.11.3 “Ring” node functional scheme
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
In the following, different examples of 1660SM (WDM application) configured as a ’ring’ node are showed. In every hypothesis, all the items involved (represented in gray color) are hosted in a 1660SM shelf.
Figure 160. 1660SM (WDM application) ’ring’ node functional scheme (1)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Specifically, the node represented in Figure 160. terminates on each side, two channels on STM 16 ’colored’ interfaces. The wavelengths multi/demultiplexing is supposed to be performed by MUX/DEMUX 8 channels
Figure 161. 1660SM (WDM application) ’ring’ node functional scheme (2)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
293 / 636
Optical multi/demultiplexing is, anyway, performed through MUX/DEMUX card. Channels terminated into STM16 interfaces can be processed and cross–connected by SDH blocks till the LO granularity; while channels terminated into ’Transponder’ are not groomed at any level but either adapted to the transmission technique or recovered from line degradation. Next Figure 162. and Figure 163. , show the functionality of a ’ring’ node using COADM 1 (2) ch. for wavelengths multi/demultiplexing.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 162. 1660SM (WDM application) ’ring’ node functional scheme (3)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
294 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
In Figure 161. the node realizes the wavelengths termination by using also ’Double channel transponder’ unit.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Figure 163. 1660SM (WDM application) ’ring’ node functional scheme (4)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
It can be noticed that there is no difference with respect the use of MUX/DEMUX device as regards the processing of terminated channels (both in SDH matrix and in ’Transponder’ unit); as a difference, the COADM structure include a specific link for by–passing those channels of the grid not locally terminated.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
295 / 636
As already considered for ’ring’ application, the following figures shows the functionality of 1660SM (WDM application) configured as the end of a ’linear’ network (i.e. point–to–point connection). Both cases of MUX/DEMUX unit (Figure 164. ) and COADM unit (Figure 165. ) used in ’end’ node are depicted.
Figure 164. 1660SM (WDM application)’end’ node functional scheme (Mux/Demux) Also in this application all the physical parts involved (showed in gray color) are hosted in 1660SM shelf.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
No difference, with respect termination channels functionality, already depicted for ’ring’ application, exists.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
296 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.11.4 “Terminal” node functional scheme
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 165. 1660SM (WDM application) ’end’ node functional scheme (COADM)
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
297 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The aim of this paragraph is defining the optical performances of 1660SM based on CWDM technology. The optical performances definition bases on the optical characteristics related to CWDM devices supported by the equipment (Transceivers, Mux/Demux, OADM) and on the fiber cable characteristics supposed. The CWDM technology is characterized by channel spacing wider than Dense WDM and allows to realize cost–effective applications, through a combination of un–cooled lasers (huge λ deviation versus temperature range, e.g. 8 nm), relaxed laser wavelength selection tolerances (e.g. ± 2 nm) and wide pass–band filters (e.g. 14 nm) inside the optical passive functions. The following paragraphs concern: [1]
CWDM channels used
[2]
the optical functions characteristics in terms of structures and insertion losses ( Mux/Demux/OADM optical operations: structures and insertion losses);
[3]
the fiber attenuation coefficient and fiber chromatic dispersion profile
[4]
the transceiver optical characteristics necessary for power budget calculation
[1] CWDM channels table The set of wavelengths used in the 1660SM equipment is a subset of the nominal central wavelengths grid defined in the ITU–T G.694.2 Recommendation for coarse WDM systems. The complete CWDM wavelengths grid range is from 1270 nm to 1610 nm with spacing of 20 nm. This spacing is the trade–off between the coarse technological aspects and the need to maximize the number of channels available. Table 41. CWDM channels grid supported by 1660SM Nominal central wavelengths (nm) used in the CWDM 1660SM 1470 1490 1510 1530 1550 1570 1590
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
1610
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
298 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
3.11.5 Optical span design
[2] Mux/Demux/OADM optical operations: structures and insertion losses
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1660SM supports the following WDM functions: –
multiplexing and demultiplexing of 8 CWDM channels without ’channels pass–through’ link through COMDX8;
–
multiplexing and demultiplexing of 2 CWDM channels with ’channels pass–through’ link through COADM2;
–
multiplexing and demultiplexing of 1 CWDM channel with ’channels pass–through’ link through COADM1.
Figure 166. shows a generic application of the optical functions listed above with the definitions used in the following paragraphs. Table 42. shows the maximum insertion losses (dB) between: –
demux ’In’ and generic channel ’Drop’;
–
generic channel ’Add’ and mux ’Out’;
–
demux ’In and mux ’Out’ (’Pass–through’ connection).
Note – Channel loop insertion–loss is given by adding demux ’In’ and generic channel ’Drop’ to generic channel ’Add’ and mux ’Out’.
In
Mux
Fiber
Demux
Pass–through
Loop
Drop
Fiber
Out
Add
West
East
Out
Loop
Add
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Board #1
Demux
Fiber
Mux
Pass–through
In
Fiber
Drop Board #2
Figure 166. Passive optical operation
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
299 / 636
Note – Contribution of Chromatic Dispersion related to Mux/Demux/OADM optical operations has been considered equals 0 ps/nm (range currently considered in devices specification is ± 30 ps/nm). Table 42. Boards insertion loss Optical function
Add Ch. Out insertion Loss (dB) Channels (um)
Pass.–th I.L. (dB)
1.47 1.49 1.51 1.53 1.55 1.57 1.59 1.61 MUX (COMDX8)
1.05 1.35 1.65 1.95 2.25 2.55 2.85 3.15
COADM2
1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 2.5
COADM1
1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 2.1
Optical function
In – Drop Ch. Insertion Loss (dB) Channels (um)
Pass.–th I.L. (dB)
1.47 1.49 1.51 1.53 1.55 1.57 1.59 1.61 DEMUX (COMDX8)
1.05 3.15 2.85 2.55 2.25 1.95 1.65 1.35
COADM2
1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 1.55 2.5
COADM1
1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 2.1
Figure 167. , Figure 168. , Figure 169. highlight the ’Insertion loss’ values as regards COMDX8, COADM2, COADM1.
In the 8 ch.s Mux/Demux operation (COMDX8), the specific equalization (to be considered for device implementation) of the channel loop ’Insertion loss’ versus channels, can be noticed: the result is a constant channel loop insertion loss from 1.49 to 1.61 um wavelength, while a minor value occurs at 1.47 um. This solution allows to optimize ’span length’ performance, considering both ’typical’ attenuation profile of the Standard SMF, wavelength and number of intermediate nodes within a referenced span: the benefits are in terms of possible longer distances between the nodes or greater power margins between the optical interfaces.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
In 2 ch.s Mux/Demux operation (COADM2) the channel loop insertion loss has the same value for every couple of wavelengths.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
300 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Note – Insertion loss values related to ’In – Drop’ channel and ’Pass–through’ includes an assumed 0.5 dB insertion loss due to ’CWDM LOS detection stage’ equipped in Mux/Demux/OADM boards
2.1
5.5
1.05 1.35 1.65 1.95 2.25 2.55 2.85 3.15
Fiber
Out
Mux
In
Demux
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Fiber
1.05 3.15 2.85 2.55 2.25 1.95 1.65 1.35
West 1.05 2.1 1.35 1.65 1.95 2.25 5.5 2.55 2.85 3.15
1.05 3.15 2.85 2.55 2.25 1.95 1.65 1.35
Board #1
Demux
Out
Mux
Fiber
East
In
Fiber
Board #2
Figure 167. COMDX8 insertion loss
In
2.5
1.25
1.55 3.1 1.55 1.55
Out
Mux
Fiber
Demux
1.25
1.55
West
East 2.5
1.25
Out
Mux
1.55 3.1 1.55
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Board #1
1.55
1.55
Demux
1.25
Fiber
Fiber
In
Fiber
Board #2
Figure 168. COADM2 insertion loss
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
301 / 636
1.25 2.5
1.25
1.05 2.1
1.05
1.25 2.5
1.25
Out
West Out
Board #1
Demux
East Mux
Fiber
Fiber
In
Fiber
Board #2
Figure 169. COADM1 insertion loss [3] Fiber Technical Data The referenced fiber for span length evaluation is the Standard Single Mode (SSMF) ITU–T G. 652. The parameters in Table 43. and they are based on data coming from ITU–T G.957 Recommendation. The column ’Typical Attenuation Coefficient’ includes losses due to installation splices, repair splices, and the operating temperature range. The column ’Maximum Attenuation Coefficient’ is obtained by considering a maximum attenuation coefficient of about 0.3 dB/Km1. in the 1500 ÷ 580 nm and, in general, assuming a +30% tolerance over the whole wavelength range supported by the equipment.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Table 43. Fiber technical data Lambda (um)
Typical Attenuation Coefficient (dB/Km)
Max. Attenuation Coefficient (dB/Km)
Max. Chromatic Dispersion Coefficient (ps/nm/Km)
1.47
0.28
0.36
13.10
1.49
0.24
0.31
14.50
1.51
0.22
0.29
15.80
1.53
0.21
0.27
17.30
1.55
0.21
0.27
18.50
1.57
0.22
0.28
19.60
1.59
0.22
0.29
20.50
1.61
0.23
0.30
21.50
1. The 0.3 dB/Km value is in compliance with the system calculation purposes indicated in the ITU–T G.957 Recommendation.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
302 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
In
1.05
Mux
Demux
Fiber
1.05 2.1
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[4] Line transceivers and optical interface power budget (Tx–Rx) The optical interfaces considered for power budget, span power budget and span length calculation have the main optical characteristics showed in Table 44. These optical interfaces are realized through ’2R’ transceivers integrated in SFP MSA device. Three specific devices allows to achieve the best ’performance/cost’ ratio, matching specific network characteristics. The two modules are: –
SFP with PIN detection, consistent with span length around 40 Km (called hereafter BRONZE version);
–
’standard’ SFP with APD detection, consistent with span length around 70 Km (called hereafter SILVER version);
Table 44. Optical transceiver characteristics
Transmitter
PARAMETER
Unit
Symbol
Output Optical power (EOL)
dBm
POUT
BRONZE
SILVER
0
0
Max.
5
5
Min.
REFERENCE
Typ.
Receiver
Chromatic dispersion
ps/ nm
D*Km
Min.
1000
1600
Average Rx Sensitivity@OC–48+FEC
dBm
RSENS
Max.
–18
–28
Maximum input power
dBm
PMAX
Min.
–3
–9
Optical Path Penalty
dB
Max.
1
2
1
REFERENCE:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
1 – Worst–case extinction ratio (8.2dB). Measured with a PRBS 223–1 test pattern, @2.67Gb/s, BER TIM detection. • V5[1,2]: BIP–2 is recovered ––> Ex–BER, Signal Degrade alarm • V5[3]: REI bit is recovered and the derived performance primitives is reported. • V5[8]: RDI information is recovered and reported. • AIS or SSF detection ––> SSF alarm
•
LPA (S12/P12x_A_Sk): It extracts the VC12–POH and processes the TU12 pointer. • V5[5–7]: Signal label detection in the byte V5[5–7] ––> Signal label Mismatch detection • AIS or SSF is applied if Signal label Mismatch is detected
•
PPI (E12/P12x_A_So and E12_TT_So):This block provides the interface between the internal unit format and the physical transmission medium. It encodes into HDB3 code the signal to be sent on line.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Other functions implemented are :
ED
•
Clock Reference Selection Block (on G.A): provides six 2 MHz clock links towards the MATRIX cards for synchronization purposes. The selection among the 63 flows is made via software.
•
TIMING (on G.A): receives the reference clock (38.88 MHz) and synchronism pulse (500 Hz) from the MATRIX cards and extracts the local clocks used by the G.A. The Tx clock is locked, by means of a PLL to the system clock or, when in free running, to a local oscillator with a +–50ppm drift: (51 MHz OSC) block.
•
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” stream, to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. It is powered by the + 3.3 Vdc supply by CONGI boards.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure.
•
DC/DC CONVERTER It converts the 48/60 V power supply to the 3.3 V used to supply all the components in the board. The DC/DC converter is synchronized with a synchronization clock at 288 MHz (signal Power–Sync, generated by G.A.) in order to avoid EMI problems.
•
STEP DOWN It uses the 3.3 V power supply from DC/DC Converter block to obtain the 2.5 V used to power the Gate Array (G.A.). 02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
414 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
•
Input side
2Mb/s #1
PPI sink
LPA source
from Access Card
ckr1
LTCT source
ckrx
STM4 BPF I/F
#63
2Mb/s outputs
Access Card
#1
ckr1
2Mb/s #63
ckr63
ckr63
to
LPT source
ckrx
cktx
6x
Output side
2Mb/s #1
PPI source
Clock Reference Selection
LPA sink
LTCT sink
LPT sink
ckt1
STM4 BPF I/F
EPS
2Mb/s #63
#63
cktx
ckt63
ckt1
ckt63
Local Clocks
Power Sync
2.5 V
CONGI A & B
DC/DC CONV.
Config. & Status
51MHz OSC
CMISS
Bus–OFF F
Management Bus
3.3 V
+ 3.3 Vdc
Remote Inventory
63 x 2 MBIT/S PORT CARD
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
M–BUS Driver
to/from MATRIX
from
STEP DOWN
ck–system a ck–system b
TIMING
ckrx cktx
G.A.
48/60 V
to MATRIX Main and Spare
#1
ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ .. ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ .. .. .. ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ .. .. .. ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ .. ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ .. ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ .. .. .. . ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ .. . ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ
from MATRIX Main and Spare
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2Mb/s inputs
RIBUS I/F
RIBUS
ID
Unit Failure
Figure 245. 63 x 2 Mbit/s card – Block Diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
415 / 636
4.19 63 x 2 Mbit/s / G703 / ISDN–PRA port card (P63E1N–M4)
The 63 x 2 Mbit/s /G.703/ISDN–PRA port is similar to the basic 63 x 2 Mbit/s port, described in the previous paragraph 4.18 on page 413, with the difference that the present board implements also the NT functionality on ISDN Primary Rate Access (PRA) and the “Retiming function” on the 2 Mbit/s interfaces. The Retiming function applies the Equipment Clock to the outgoing 2Mb/s signal that therefore becomes synchronized with the SDH network synchronization reference . The additional circuit that allows this implementation consists in an elastic buffer that is able to absorb the jitter and wander that is transferred to the PDH signal when SDH pointer justification occurs. This feature is programmable via SW, in order to include or exclude the Retiming for each single port. The same P63E1N unit can mix ports that apply or not the retiming. In this paragraph is reported the description of the NT ISDN–PRA function, all the other blocks functionalities are described in the previous paragraph 4.18 on page 413. The ISDN–PRA (Integrated Services Digital Network – Primary Rate Access) is a facility to carry a number of synchronous digital communication channels to the user over a 2048 kbit/s structured signal; the ISDN–PRA structure is defined in recommendation ETS 300 233. The sample frames are reported in paragraph 3.18.1, page 367 up to para. 3.18.1.2, page 369. The 2048 kbit/s signals can be structured or non–structured: in this latter case, the PRA functionality must be disabled from Craft–Terminal. The selection among structured/non–structured and basic–frame/multiframe options is achieved by means of Craft–Terminal, for individual signals. It performs standard PRA functionality as well as some custom Leased Line functions (settable from C.T.). Figure 247. on page 420 illustrates the NT ISDN–PRA block, that performs the following functions:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
UPSTREAM DIRECTION (from user to SDH network: incoming signal SY2Min, outgoing signal UP2Mout) –
Loopback2: by means of command LB2, sent by the controller, or detected in the Sa6 message coming from the SDH network (UP2Min signal); this command sends back to the source the upstream signal.
–
AIS Detection: the AIS alarm (AIS2M) is detected after the reception of 512 bits containing less than 3 zeroes.
–
Frame Alignment (FA): it performs basic–frame and multi–frame alignment according to ITU–T G.706, presettable from the controller (commands BF and MF); the LOF2M alarm is declared in case of non alignment .
–
Failure Condition: the Failure Condition FC2M alarm is the “OR” of LOS2M, LOF2M , AIS2M alarms.
–
REI alarm detection (E): the REI2M alarm is detected if E=0.
–
RAI alarm detection (A): the RAI2M alarm is detected if active for 5 consecutive frames.
–
Data Error detection (CRC–4): errors integrity check on the incoming data, according to CRC–4 procedure (Cyclic Redundancy Check), as defined in G.706. In case of errors, the alarm ERR2M is arised.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
416 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 246. on page 419).
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
E bit insertion (E): the outgoing E bit is set to 0 when • a failure condition (FCU) is detected on signal from SDH network (UP2Min); • errors (ERRU) are detected on data from SDH network (UP2Min); • the E insertion may be inhibited from controller, in this case E=1. • E=1 in other cases.
–
A bit insertion (A): the outgoing A bit is set to • ’0’ when a failure condition (FC2M) is detected on signal from user (SY2Min); • ’1’ when Loopback2 (LB2) is activated; • passed transparently in other cases; • the A bit may be forced from controller. • set to ’1’ (*) when a failure condition (FCU) is detected on signal from SDH network (UP2Min); N.B. (*): this option is enabled only in case of Leased Line applications;
–
Sa5, Sa6 Messages: • the outgoing Sa6 message is inserted in 4 Sa6 bits of 4 consecutive frames, with the following significance (listed in order of their priority/severity): – 1000 ––> power fail – 1111 ––> SSF or AUXPU/AISU on signal from SDH network (UP2Min); – 1110 ––> LOFU on signal from SDH network (UP2Min); – 1100 ––> FC2M on signal from user (SY2Min); – 0000 ––> loopback2 (LB2) activated – 0001 ––> alarm REI2M from user – 0010 ––> CRC–4 errors (ERR2M) from user – 0011 ––> simultaneous occurrence of both previous (REI2M and ERR2M) – 0011 ––> only basic–frame alignment on SY2Min signal, when in automatic search – 0000 ––> normal operations. • the outgoing Sa5 bit is set to: – ’0’ ––> when loopback2 (LB2) is activated – ’1’ ––> in other cases.
–
CRC–4 bits insertion: the CRC–4 on data is performed and the result is inserted on bits C1 to C4, according to G.706.
–
Frame Word insertion (FW): the basic–frame and multi–frame alignment words are inserted on the frame.
–
Substituted Frames insertion: the substituted frames are inserted, in case of occurrence of a failure condition (FC2M) on incoming signal from user. N.B. Substituted frame is a frame with Sa4, Sa5, Sa7, Sa8 as well as all the bits in time slots 1 to 31 set to ’1’, and with A bit set to ’0’.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
DOWNSTREAM DIRECTION (from SDH network to user: incoming signal UP2Min, outgoing signal SY2Mout) –
Loopback–RX: by means of command LB–RX, sent by the controller; this command sends back to the source the downstream signal.
–
AIS Detection: the AIS alarm (AISU) is detected after the reception of 512 bits containing less than 3 zeroes.
–
AUXP Detection: the AUXPU alarm is detected after the reception of 512 bits containing the pattern ...010101... with less than 3 deviation from the pattern itself. It can be enabled from the controller.
–
Frame Alignment (FA): it performs basic–frame and multi–frame alignment according to ITU–T G.706, presettable from the controller (commands BF and MF); the LOFU alarm is declared in case of non alignment.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
417 / 636
Failure Condition: the Failure Condition FCU alarm is the “OR” of SSF, LOFU , AISU, AUXPU alarms. N.B. SSF =Server Signal Fail, from upstream.
–
REI alarm detection (E): the REIU alarm is detected if E=0.
–
RAI alarm detection (A): the RAIU alarm is detected if active for 5 consecutive frames.
–
Sa6: the Sa6 bit is read for every 4 consecutive frames, to check the presence of the loopback2 command, when 4XSa6=1010, for 8 consecutive times.
–
Data Error detection (CRC–4): errors integrity check on the incoming data, according to CRC–4 procedure (Cyclic Redundancy Check), as defined in G.706. In case of errors, the alarm ERRU is arised.
–
A* insertion: the A bit is • passed transparently in standard applications • set to ’1’ (*) when a failure condition (FC2M) is detected on signal from user (SY2Min); • set to ’1’ (*) when forced from the controller; N.B. (*): this option is enabled only in case of Leased Line applications.
–
E bit insertion (E): the outgoing E bit is set to 0 when • a failure condition (FC2M) is detected on signal from user (SY2Min); • errors (ERR2M) are detected on data from user (SY2Min); • the E insertion may be inhibited from controller, in this case E=1. • E=1 in other cases. • set to ’0’ (*) when Power Fail alarm (PWF) is active; N.B. (*): this option is enabled only in case of Leased Line applications.
–
Sa4* insertion: the bits Sa4 to Sa8 are passed transparently in standard applications, • Sa4 is set to ’0’ (*) when Power Fail alarm (PWF) is active, passed transparently otherwise. N.B. (*): this option is enabled only in case of Leased Line applications.
–
CRC–4 bits insertion: the CRC–4 on data is performed and the result is inserted on bits C1 to C4, according to G.706.
–
Frame Word insertion (FW): the basic–frame and multi–frame alignment words are inserted on the frame.
–
AIS insertion: a continuous bitstream of all ’ONES’ is inserted, in case of occurrence of • force command from the controller; • a failure condition (FCU) on signal from SDH network (UP2Min); • (*) a failure condition (FC2M) on signal from user (SY2Min). N.B. (*): this option is enabled only in case of Leased Line applications.
ALARMS, STATUS AND COMMANDS CONVEYED FROM/TO CONTROLLER Every alarm, status and errors counting results are reported to the controller, for monitoring purposes: –
LOS, REI, RAI, FC, ERR(CRC–4), SSF detected either in upstream and in downstream signal directions N.B. LOS = Loss of user Signal; SSF= upstream Server Signal Fail.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The controller sends the following commands, in order to enable the relevant functions: –
ED
LB–2, LB–RX, BF, MF, ForceA, InhibitE, etc. N.B. BF= Basic Frame; MF = Multi Frame.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
418 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
from Access Card
#1
ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ.. ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ . .. ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ .. . .. ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ .. . ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ .. .. . ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ .. .. ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ ÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎÎ Input side
2Mb/s #1
PPI sink
2 Mb/s POM
NT ISDN PRA source
LPA source
ckr1
#63
LPT source
LTCT source
STM4 BPF I/F
ckrx
ckr1
2Mb/s #63
Clock Reference Selection
ckr63
ckr63
ckrx
6x
Output side
#1
2Mb/s #1
PPI source
2 Mb/s POM
NT ISDN PRA sink
cktx
LPA sink
LPT sink
LTCT sink
STM4 BPF I/F
ckt1
EPS
2Mb/s #63
cktx
ckt63
ckt1
ckt63
Local Clocks
Power Sync
2.5 V
48/60 V
DC/DC CONV.
Config. & Status
51MHz OSC
M–BUS Driver
3.3 V CMISS
Bus–OFF F
Management Bus
to/from MATRIX
from CONGI A & B
STEP DOWN
ck–system a ck–system b
TIMING
ckrx cktx
G.A.
from MATRIX Main and Spare
Access Card
to
2Mb/s outputs
#63
+ 3.3 Vdc
Remote Inventory
63 x 2 MBIT/S PORT CARD
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
to MATRIX Main and Spare
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2Mb/s inputs
RIBUS I/F
RIBUS
ID
Unit Failure
Figure 246. 63 x 2 Mbit/s G.703/ISDN–PRA, Block Diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
419 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 247. Functional Diagram of the NT ISDN–PRA block
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
420 / 636
AIS
FCU (*) FC2M
LB 2
FROM/TO CONTROLLER EQUICO
SY2Mout
PWF
LOS2M
SY2Min
To User (downstream)
FC2M
+
FW
AIS 2M
AIS
REI 2M
+
A
REI U
+
A*
RAIU
ALARMS & STATUS
FC U
+
E
FC 2M (*)
ERR U
FCU
E
+
(*) FCU
LB
CRC–4
ERR U
FC2M
A
+
ERR U
CONVEYED FROM/TO CONTROLLER
RAI2M ERR 2M
+
Sa4*
FC 2M
ERR2M
ERR2M
CRC–4
PWF (*)
RAI2M
(*)
PWF
REI 2M
E
FC 2M
CRC–4
LOF2M
FA
BF MF
Sa6
LB2
BF
Sa5, Sa6 Messages
+
MF
E
REIU
BF MF
FA
LOFu
AUXP
FC2M
AIS
AISu
FC U
SUBST FRAMES
AUXPu
FW
+
LBRX
UP2Min
SSF
UP2Mout
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
A
RAIU
CRC–4
+
To SDH Network (upstream)
4.20 3 x 34/45 Mbit/s port card (P3E3T3)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 248. on page 423) The P3E3T3 port card is a bidirectional interface from/to three PDH streams at 34 Mbit/s or at 45 Mbit/s switchable and the STM4–BPF (BPF=backpanel format ). Due to the back panel format, the 3 plesiochronous 34 or 45 Mbit/s signals that can be housed in an STM–1 frame, are dropped/inserted in the AU4#4 of the STM–4 frame. It realizes the functions required by the ITU–T G.783 rec. i.e. : •
maps the payload into a C–3
•
add/extracts the VC3 POH
•
processes the TU3 pointer
•
adapts the VC3 to the VC4
•
assembles/disassembles the STM–1 format
The SDH functions are preformed by four Gate Array, one for each port and one that is common to the three ports: –
34/45 Mbit/s interface
The G.A. performs a fully bidirectional interface for a 34 Mbit/s PDH flow or for a 45 Mbit/s PDH flow in compliance with the ITU–T G.783. A G.A. can manage only one stream, therefore three G.A. are necessary to process the 3 streams on the port card. The PPI functions is performed by the access card ( two separated according to the bit rate) according to the ITU–T G.703 Rec. INPUT side •
LPA (S3/P3_A_So) Asynchronous mapping of 3x34 /45 Mbit/s into the VC–3 C2 insertion
•
LPT ( S3_TT_So) J1 path trace insertion G1 (path status) insertion : REI and RDI insertion B3 calculation and insertion (VC3, BIP8) F2 and F3 bytes insertion (coming from OH bus and DCC bus)
•
LTCA (Low order tandem connection adaptation) Frame start signal generation on VC_AIS detection
•
LTCT (Low order tandem connection termination)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
N1processing and insertion (TC–RDI, REI, ODI, OEI ..)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
421 / 636
OUTPUT side •
LPA (S3/P3_A_Sk)
•
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
VC3 demapping and desynchronization C2 monitoring AIS generation LPT ( S3_TT_Sk) LP–TIM detection (J1 monitoring) LP–SLM and UNEQ detection (C2 monitoring) RDI detection REI recovery B3 BIP–8 count and error detection F2 and F3 bytes extraction and sending to AUX* bus and DCC* bus •
LTCA (Low order tandem connection adaptation) Invalid frame start condition restoration
•
LTCT (Low order tandem connection termination) N1 monitoring and processing B3 insertion (VC–3 BIP–8 compensation )
–
STM–4 & timing G.A. The G.A. provides the following functions: •
to connect the three ”34/45 Mbit/s interface” to the backpanel . In fact the frame format leaving the ”34/45 Mbit/s interface” is a 4 wire bus at 38.88 Mbit/s while the backpanel format is STM–4*.
•
Timing: it receives the 622 MHz System clock from the two MATRIX and generates the clock at 38.88 MHz for the ”34/45 MBit/s interface”.
Other functions implemented are : •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” stream, to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. It is powered by the + 3.3 Vdc supply by CONGI boards.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure. DC/DC CONVERTER It converts the 48/60 V power supply to the 3.3 V used to supply all the components in the board. The DC/DC converter is synchronized with a synchronization clock at 288 MHz (signal Power–Sync, generated by G.A.) in order to avoid EMI problems. STEP DOWN It uses the 3.3 V power supply from DC/DC Converter block to obtain the 2.5 V used to power the Gate Array (G.A.).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
•
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
422 / 636
Input side
From/To Access Card
Data IN LOS
LPA
LPT
LTCA
LTCT
AU4 ASSEMBLY
STM4 BPF 622 Mbit/s I/F
4 X 38.88 Mbit/s
Output side
Data OUT
LPA
LPT
LTCA
LTCT
STM–4 & TIMING G.A.
AU4 DISASS.
CK 38.88
TIMING CK syst.
AUX DCC CK 38.88 34/45 Mb/s #2 Input side
Data IN From/To Access Card
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
AUX
34/45 Mb/s #3
To/From MATRIX Main and Spare
DCC
CK 38.88
From MATRIX Main and Spare
AUX DCC
LOS
LPA
LPT
LTCA
LTCT
AU4 ASSEMBLY
Power Sync
Output side LPT
LTCA
LTCT
AUX DCC
Input side LPA
LPT
LTCA
LTCT
AU4 ASSEMBLY
Output side
Data OUT
LPA
LPT
LTCA
LTCT
+ 3.3 Vdc
Configuration and Status
From/To Access Card
Data IN LOS
2.5 V STEP DOWN
CK 38.88
34/45 Mb/s #1
DC/DC 48/60 V CONV.
3.3 V
AU4 DISASS.
AU4 DISASS.
Unit Failure
Management bus
M–BUS Driver
CMISS Bus–off RIBUS
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
3 x 34/45 MBIT/S PORT CARD
REMOTE INVENTORY
F
RIBUS I/F
from CONGI A & B
LPA
To/From MATRIX Main and Spare
Data OUT
Id + 3.3 Vdc
Figure 248. 3x34/45 port card –Block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
423 / 636
4.21 4 x STM–1 electrical/optical port card (P4S1N)
The 4 x STM–1 port processes up to four STM–1 streams. A max. of two electrical or optical modules can be housed on the card to give physical access to the STM–1 signal. The remaining two physical accesses are on the relevant access card . The SDH functions required to manage STM–1 signal are implemented by the G.A. mounted on the board. It interfaces the two MATRIX card via backpanel. Referring to the ITU–T G.783 Recommendation , the G.A. performs the following functions : –
TTF
–
HOA
–
LPOM /LSUT (the last is not available in this release)
–
HPOM /HSUT (the last is not available in this release)
Cross connection functions (MSP, HPC and LPC) are performed by the two MATRIX boards (working in 1+1 configuration). The TTF block is connected to the MATRIX boards (main and spare) through 1+1 bidirectional links at 622 Mbit/s , STM–4 equivalent capacity. HOA block is connected both to the HPC matrices and to the LPC matrices on the two MATRIX boards through a couple of 1+1 links at 622 MBit/s working in protection, STM–4 equivalent capacity. Backpanel interface supply a system–clock to the G.A. internal circuits. In the following block description, the new naming convention of the G.783 is reported. Refer to para. 3.3.2 on page 196 for details. The G.A. send and receive four STM–1 signals (data + clock) at 155 Mbit/s to/from each SPI. An external LOS is received from each input line interface. Each optical transmitter provides its status by means of two input signals: Laser Degrade and Laser Failure. The ALS algorithm is hardware implemented : the G.A. provides the Laser shut Down command (LASER OFF). In the following will be described the signal processing of only one STM–1 interface; the other three interfaces process the signal in the same way. The PISO & SIPO (Parallel–In Serial–Out; Serial–in Parallel–out) blocks allow the unit to interface with the back panel at of 622 Mbit/s bit rate, mapping the STM–1 signals over a STM–4 internal equivalent frame. TTF BLOCK ( SPI, RST, MST, MSA)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
This block performs the Transport Terminal Functions (sink on Input side, source on Output side) for STM–1 signals. TTF block provides the T1 timing references at 2 MHz , derived from the STM–1 input signals.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
424 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 249. on page 428 )
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
INPUT side : from line to MSP block on MATRIX SPI (OSn/RSn_A_Sk) : it descramblers the incoming signal , counts the OOF and reveals the LOF alarm. RST (RSn_TT_Sk) : performs frame alignment detection (A1, A2) , regenerator section trace recovery (J0) and mismatch detection, BIP–8 Errored Block count. J0 is not managed in this release. MST (MSn_TT_Sk) : performs BIP–24 errored block count, MS–REI recovery, MS–RDI and MS–AIS detection. TSD is applied in case of MS–DEG (signal degrade), TSF is applied if MS–AIS is detected. MSA (MSn/Sn_A_Sk) : performs AU4 pointer interpretation, LOP and AIS detection, pointer justification. Moreover the following functions are performed on the Rx side : SOH BYTE extraction (Rx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) are dropped and serialized in a DCC frame. Two DCC frames are generated working in 1+1 protection. OUTPUT side : from MATRIX to line MSA (Ms/Sn_A_So) : it performs AUG assembly, AU–4 pointer generation, AU–AIS generation. MST (MSn_TT_So) : it performs BIP–24 calculation and insertion, MS–REI MS–RDI and MS–AIS insertion. RST (RSn_TT_So) : it performs frame alignment insertion, regenerator section path trace insertion, BIP–8 calculation and insertion. SOH BYTE insertion (Tx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) coming from the DCC frames are inserted into the SOH section. SPI (OSn/RSn_A_So) :it scramblers the outgoing signals and insert AIS in alarm condition. HOA BLOCK (HPT, HPA) From HPC matrix to LPC matrix HPT (Sn_TT_Sk) : path trace information is recovered, REI information is recovered, HP–RDI and UNEQ are detected, VC4 BIP–8 errored count block. TSF is applied if SSF or UNEQ or TIM or AIS is detected. TSD is applied if a condition of signal degrade is detected. Moreover : F2 F3 byte extraction (Rx side) : both F2 and F3 bytes are extracted from the received flow and serialized on a DCC frame . N1 byte extraction (Rx side) : for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
HPA (Sn/Sm_A_Sk) : VC–4 disassembly, TU pointer interpretation, LOP and TU–AIS detection, HP–SLM and LOM detection.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
425 / 636
HPA (Sn/Sm_A_So) : VC4 assembly, TU pointer generation, TU–AIS generation , signal label insertion, HPT (Sn_TT_So) : path trace identification insertion, RDI and REI indications insertion, VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion. Moreover: F2 and F3 byte insertion (Tx side) : F2/F3 bytes are inserted on the DCC frame N1 byte insertion (Tx side) : for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM). The G.A. provides also the HSUT, HPOM, (alternative) and LSUT, LPOM functions (alternative) both in Rx and Tx side. The main task of HSUT are: RX side (from MSA to HPC matrix): • • • • •
path trace information recovery REI recovery HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count
Tx side: (from HPC matrix to MSA) • • • •
generation of an unequipped container ”unequipped” insertion, trail trace identifier generation RDI and /or REI information generation VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion
The main task of HPOM are: RX and TX side: • • • • • • •
signal termination J1 path recovering REI information recovering HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count TSF is generated in case of SSF , UNEQ, TIM , AIS . TSD is generated in case of SD
The main tasks of LSUT are :
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
RX side (from HPA to LPC matrix): • • • •
ED
recovering of VC–m unequipped signal label path trace recovering BIP–2 recovery REI and RDI recovery
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
426 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
From LPC matrix to HPC matrix
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Tx side (from LPC matrix to HPA ): • • • •
insertion of VC–m unequipped signal label path trace insertion BIP–2 insertion REI and RDI insertion
LSUT is used to monitor unequipped path trails . The main tasks of LPOM are : • • • •
trace identifier monitoring RDI and REI recovering and deriving for performance primitives signal label monitoring VC–m BIP–2 errored block count
LPOM is used for performance monitoring purposes. Other functions implemented are : •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” stream, to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 Vdc supply by CONGI boards.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure. DC/DC CONVERTERS
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
This block converts the 48/60 V power supply 3.3 V and 2.5 V used to supply all the components in the board. The DC/DC converter is synchronized with a synchronization clock at 300 MHz (signal Power–Sync, generated by G.A.) in order to avoid EMI problems.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
427 / 636
F2, F3 Optical or Electrical Plug–in Module
Optical Input/ Output 1
SPI
HPOM HSUT (*)
TTF
STM–1 RST LOS LASER D. DCCR RSOH LASER F. LASER OFF
T1 (3a) (3b) (3c) (3d)
MSA
MST
(4a)
DCCM MSOH
Optical Input/ Output 3
3 rd INTERFACE
SPI ( )
Optical Input/ Output 4
4 th INTERFACE SPI ( )
AUX
PISO & SIPO
(5b) (5c) (5d)
2nd INTERFACE
DCC
PISO & SIPO
(4b) (4c) (4d) (5a)
F2, F3 Optical Input/ Output 2
to/from HPC matrix (H Link)
PISO & SIPO
(1b) (2b) (3b) (4b) (5b)
T1
(1c) (2c) (3c) (4c) (5c)
T1
(1d) (2d) (3d) (4d) (5d)
T1
Config. & Status
622 MHz OSC
Management Bus
M–BUS Driver
CMISS Bus–OFF Remote Inventory RIBUS I/F
Power Sync Unit Failure 3.3 V 2.5 V ACCESS CARD
RIBUS
FROM/TO SERVICE
LPOM LSUT (*)
to/from LPC matrix (L link)
PISO & SIPO
(2b) (2c) (2d)
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
(2a)
HPA
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
HPT HOA
to/from HPC matrix (X Link)
PISO & SIPO
(1b) (1c) (1d)
FROM/TO MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
1st INTERFACE
(1a)
ID F
+3.3 Vdc 48/60 V
DC/DC CONVERTERS
FROM CONGI A & B
G.A.
4 x STM–1 ELECTRICAL/OPTICAL PORT
Notes: (*) –
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
( )–
HSUT and LSUT are not available in the current release THE ” SPI” ASSOCIATED TO THE 3rd AND 4th INTERFACES ARE PHISICALLY ON THE ACCESS CARD
Figure 249. 4 x STM–1 Electrical/Optical port block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
428 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
System–clock a System–clock b
4.22 4 X 140/STM1 switchable O/E port card (P4E4N)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 250. on page 434 and Figure 251. on page 435) The 4 X 140/STM1 switchable O/E port card is a bidirectional unit which interfaces up to four plesiochronous 140 Mbit/s (E4) or Synchronous 155 Mbit/s (STM–1) with STM4–BPF (BPF=backpanel format ). The choice among the two possible different interfaces is flexible and mixed configuration are allowed. For each P4E4N port card there are four electrical (75 Ohm) or optical module( Short and Long Haul) ;two of the four module are hosted directly on the port card , the other two are hosted in the relevant access card (A2S1). The description that follows explains the two operating mode of each interface (140 Mbit/s PDH or 155 Mbit/s SDH) on the port card.
155 Mbit/s STM–1 The SDH functions required to manage STM–1 signal are implemented by the G.A. mounted on the board. It interfaces the two MATRIX cards via backpanel. The “Mapper/Demapper 140–PDH/155–STM–1” block is internally by–passed through the EN 140/155 signal when the interface is programmed as 155 Mbit/s. Referring to the ITU–T G.783 Recommendation , the G.A. performs the following functions : –
TTF
–
HOA
–
LPOM /LSUT (the last is not available in this release)
–
HPOM /HSUT (the last is not available in this release)
Cross connection functions (MSP, HPC and LPC) are performed by the matrices present on the two MATRIX boards (working in 1+1 configuration). The TTF block is connected to the MATRIX boards (main and spare) through 1+1 bidirectional links at 622 Mbit/s , STM–4 equivalent capacity. HOA block is connected both to the HPC matrices and to the LPC matrices on the two MATRIX boards through a couple of 1+1 links at 622 MBit/s working in protection, STM–4 equivalent capacity. Backpanel interface supply a system–clock to the G.A. internal circuits. In the following block description, the new naming convention of the G.783 is reported. Refer to para. 3.3.2 on page 196 for details. The G.A. send and receive four STM–1 signals (data + clock) at 155 Mbit/s to/from each SPI. An external LOS is received from each input line interface. Each optical transmitter provides its status by means of two input signals: Laser Degrade and Laser Failure.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The ALS algorithm is hardware implemented : the G.A. provides the Laser shut Down command (LASER OFF). In the following will be described the signal processing of only one STM–1 interface; the other three interfaces process the signal in the same way.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
429 / 636
TTF BLOCK ( SPI, RST, MST, MSA) This block performs the Transport Terminal Functions (sink on Input side, source on Output side) for STM–1 signals. TTF block provides the T1 timing references at 2 MHz , derived from the STM–1 input signals. INPUT side : from line to MSP block on MATRIX SPI (OSn/RSn_A_Sk) : it descramblers the incoming signal , counts the OOF and reveals the LOF alarm. RST (RSn_TT_Sk) : performs frame alignment detection (A1, A2) , regenerator section trace recovery (J0) and mismatch detection, BIP–8 Errored Block count. J0 is not managed in this release. MST (MSn_TT_Sk) : performs BIP–24 errored block count, MS–REI recovery, MS–RDI and MS–AIS detection. TSD is applied in case of MS–DEG (signal degrade), TSF is applied if MS–AIS is detected. MSA (MSn/Sn_A_Sk) : performs AU4 pointer interpretation, LOP and AIS detection, pointer justification. Moreover the following functions are performed on the Rx side : SOH BYTE extraction (Rx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) are dropped and serialized in a DCC frame. Two DCC frames are generated working in 1+1 protection. OUTPUT side : from MATRIX to line MSA (Ms/Sn_A_So) : it performs AUG assembly, AU–4 pointer generation, AU–AIS generation. MST (MSn_TT_So) : it performs BIP–24 calculation and insertion, MS–REI MS–RDI and MS–AIS insertion. RST (RSn_TT_So) : it performs frame alignment insertion, regenerator section path trace insertion, BIP–8 calculation and insertion. SOH BYTE insertion (Tx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) coming from the DCC frames are inserted into the SOH section. SPI (OSn/RSn_A_So) :it scramblers the outgoing signals and insert AIS in alarm condition. HOA BLOCK (HPT, HPA) From HPC matrix to LPC matrix HPT (Sn_TT_Sk) : path trace information is recovered, REI information is recovered, HP–RDI and UNEQ are detected, VC4 BIP–8 errored count block. TSF is applied if SSF or UNEQ or TIM or AIS is detected. TSD is applied if a condition of signal degrade is detected.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Moreover : F2 F3 byte extraction (Rx side) : both F2 and F3 bytes are extracted from the received flow and serialized on a DCC frame .
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
430 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The PISO & SIPO (Parallel–In Serial–Out; Serial–in Parallel–out) blocks allow the unit to interface with the back panel at of 622 Mbit/s bit rate, mapping the STM–1 signals over a STM–4 internal equivalent frame.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
N1 byte extraction (Rx side) : for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM). HPA (Sn/Sm_A_Sk) : VC–4 disassembly, TU pointer interpretation, LOP and TU–AIS detection, HP–SLM and LOM detection. From LPC matrix to HPC matrix HPA (Sn/Sm_A_So) : VC4 assembly, TU pointer generation, TU–AIS generation , signal label insertion, HPT (Sn_TT_So) : path trace identification insertion, RDI and REI indications insertion, VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion. Moreover: F2 and F3 byte insertion (Tx side) : F2/F3 bytes are inserted on the DCC frame N1 byte insertion (Tx side) : for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM). The G.A. provides also the HSUT, HPOM, (alternative) and LSUT, LPOM functions (alternative) both in Rx and Tx side. The main task of HSUT are: RX side (from MSA to HPC matrix): • • • • •
path trace information recovery REI recovery HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count
Tx side: (from HPC matrix to MSA) • • • •
generation of an unequipped container ”unequipped” insertion, trail trace identifier generation RDI and /or REI information generation VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion
The main task of HPOM are: RX and TX side:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
• • • • • • •
signal termination J1 path recovering REI information recovering HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count TSF is generated in case of SSF , UNEQ, TIM , AIS . TSD is generated in case of SD
The main tasks of LSUT are : RX side (from HPA to LPC matrix): •
ED
recovering of VC–m unequipped signal label 02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
431 / 636
• • •
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
path trace recovering BIP–2 recovery REI and RDI recovery
Tx side (from LPC matrix to HPA ): • • • •
insertion of VC–m unequipped signal label path trace insertion BIP–2 insertion REI and RDI insertion
LSUT is used to monitor unequipped path trails . The main tasks of LPOM are : • • • •
trace identifier monitoring RDI and REI recovering and deriving for performance primitives signal label monitoring VC–m BIP–2 errored block count
LPOM is used for performance monitoring purposes.
140 Mbit/s PDH The functions required to manage 140 Mbit/s PDH signal are implemented by the “Mapper/Demapper 140–PDH/155–STM–1” block and G.A. mounted on the board. The last interfaces the two matrix on the MATRIX cards via backpanel. INPUT side : from line to MSP block on MATRIX The circuits concerned are: PPI (E4_TT_Sk and E4/P4s_A_Sk) : it interfaces the line extracting the timing, decoding data and AIS detecting. It is also performed the PDH LOS processing. The Data flow is than sent to the LPA block after a serial to parallel conversion (SIPO). LPA (S4/P4s_A_So) The 140 Mbit/s plesiochronous stream is inserted in a C4 container to be adapted so as to be transported into the synchronous network. HPT (S4_TT_So) The Virtual Container (VC4) is formatted. The VC4 is structured so that its octets are distributed within a 125 msec. interval (i.e., one STM–1 period), and consists of the C4 container and POH. The latter containing nine octets equally distributed within the frame. Figure 217. on page 363 depicts the structure of a VC4 and of the POH bytes: J1, B3. C2, G1, F2, H4, Z3–Z5. Bytes F2, Z3–Z5 .
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
PG ( Pointer Generator) A fixed pointer value is inserted in the AUOH to structure the AU4 signal. MST and RST This two functions are necessary to create a proprietary STM–1 signal in order to interface the “Mapper/Demapper 140–PDH/155–STM–1” block with the G.A. Data are sent to the G.A. in a serial way through the PISO block. In the G.A. the complementary function are made (RST, MST, MSA).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
432 / 636
OUTPUT side : from MATRIX to line
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The circuits concerned are: MSA (inside the G.A.): It performs AUG assembly, AU–4 pointer generation, AU–AIS generation MST and RST (inside the G.A.):this two functions are necessary to create a STM–1 signal in order to interface the G.A with the “Mapper/Demapper 140–PDH/155–STM–1” block . Data are sent from G.A. to Mapper/Demapper 140–PDH/155–STM–1” block in serial way and than converted in parallel through a SIPO. ALIGNER: it searches the frame alignment word and checks the alignment conditions. HPT ( S4_TT_Sk): Extracts the POH bytes from the VC4 structure and manages them accordingly (see Figure 217. on page 363). LPA (S4/P4s_ASk) Restructures the 140 Mbit/s PDH signal by extracting it from Container C4 . The signal is than sent in serial way (through PISO) to the PPI block. PPI (E4/P4s_A_So and E4_TT_So ) : it convert the internal signal code to the line code.
Other functions implemented are : •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to: – – – – – –
read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” stream control the LED on the unit to release the Management–bus in case of power failure read remote inventory data enable 155Mbit/ or 140 Mbit/s operating mode ( EN 140/155) separately send Internal Loop and External Loop commands to each interface separately
RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 Vdc supply by CONGI boards. •
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure. DC/DC CONVERTERS
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
This block converts the 48/60 V power supply 5V, 3.3 V, 2.5 V and 1.8 V used to supply all the components in the board. The DC/DC converter is synchronized with a synchronization clock at 300 MHz (signal Power–Sync, generated by G.A.) in order to avoid EMI problems.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
433 / 636
HPT
SPI or PPI
Data
MAPPER/DEMAPPER 140–PDH/155–STM1
LOS
TTF
RST
MST
(3a) (3b) (3c) (3d)
Data DCCR RSOH
LASER D. LASER F. LASER OFF O/E Input/ Output 2
MSA DCCM MSOH
3 rd INTERFACE EN 140/155 4 th INTERFACE
SPI ( ) EN 140/155
622 MHz OSC Power Sync.
Config. & Status
Remote Inventory
DCC
PISO & SIPO
(5b) (5c) (5d)
2nd INTERFACE
O/E Input/ Output 4
PISO & SIPO
(4b) (4c) (4d) (5a)
EN 140/155
SPI ( )
to/from HPC matrix (H Link)
(4a)
F2, F3
O/E Input/ Output 3
PISO & SIPO
AUX
(1b) (2b) (3b) (4b) (5b)
T1
(1c) (2c) (3c) (4c) (5c)
T1
(1d) (2d) (3d) (4d) (5d)
T1
Management Bus
M–BUS Driver
CMISS
Bus–OFF
RIBUS EN 140/155 1–4 Line Loop 1–4 Int. Loop 1–4
1.8 V 5V 3.3 V
DC/DC CONVERTERS
RIBUS I/F
FROM/TO SERVICE
O/E LOS Module
T1
HPOM HSUT(*)
F2, F3
to/from LPC matrix (L link)
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
O/E Input/ Output 1
LPOM (*) LSUT EN 140/155
PISO & SIPO
(2b) (2c) (2d)
FROM/TO MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
Line Loop
(2a)
HPA
Int. Loop
to/from HPC matrix (X Link)
ID F
Unit failure
FROM CONGI
1st INTERFACE
PISO & SIPO
(1b) (1c) (1d)
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
(1a)
HOA
+3.3 Vdc 48/60 V
2.5 V ACCESS CARD
4 X 140/STM–1 ELECTRICAL/OPTICAL PORT
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Notes: (*) –
HSUT and LSUT are not available in the current release
( )–
THE ” SPI” ASSOCIATED TO THE 3rd AND 4th INTERFACES ARE PHISICALLY ON THE ACCESS CARD
Figure 250. 4 x 140/STM–1 Electrical / Optical port block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
434 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
System–clock a System–clock b
G.A.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
EN 140/155
MAPPER/DEMAPPER 140–PDH/155–STM1
EN 140/155 DATA to G.A.
155 Mbit/s PISO Data In
LPA Insert into C4
SIPO
HPT
PDH AIS Detector
Pointer Generation
MST
RST
C3,B3 SDH LOS
LOS
TO G.A.
PDH LOS processing EN 140/155
Data Out
OH MANAGEMENT
LPA 140 Mbit/s Reconstruction
PISO
HPT POH EXTRACTION
ALIGNER
SIPO
DATA from G.A.
155 Mbit/s
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
EN 140/155
Figure 251. Mapper /Demapper 140–PDH / 155–STM1 block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
435 / 636
4.23 4 x STM–1 port (P4ES1N)
The 4 x STM–1 port processes up to four STM–1 streams. The physical accesses to the four STM–1 signals are available on the relevant access card. The SDH functions required to manage STM–1 signal are implemented by the G.A. mounted on the board. It interfaces the two MATRIX card via backpanel. Referring to the ITU–T G.783 Recommendation , the G.A. performs the following functions : –
TTF
–
HOA
–
LPOM /LSUT (the last is not available in this release)
–
HPOM /HSUT (the last is not available in this release)
Cross connection functions (MSP, HPC and LPC) are performed by the two MATRIX boards (working in 1+1 configuration). The TTF block is connected to the MATRIX boards (main and spare) through 1+1 bidirectional links at 622 Mbit/s , STM–4 equivalent capacity. HOA block is connected both to the HPC matrices and to the LPC matrices on the two MATRIX board through a couple of 1+1 links at 622 MBit/s working in protection, STM–4 equivalent capacity. Backpanel interface supply a system–clock to the G.A. internal circuits. In the following block description, the new naming convention of the G.783 is reported. Refer to para. 3.3.2 on page 196 for details. The G.A. send and receive four STM–1 signals (data + clock) at 155 Mbit/s to/from each SPI. An external LOS is received from each input line interface. In the following will be described the signal processing of only one STM–1 interface; the other three interfaces process the signal in the same way. The PISO & SIPO (Parallel–In Serial–Out; Serial–in Parallel–out) blocks allow the unit to interface with the back panel at of 622 Mbit/s bit rate, mapping the STM–1 signals over a STM–4 internal equivalent frame. TTF BLOCK ( SPI, RST, MST, MSA) This block performs the Transport Terminal Functions (sink on Input side, source on Output side) for STM–1 signals.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
TTF block provides the T1 timing references at 2 MHz , derived from the STM–1 input signals.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
436 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 252. on page 440 )
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
INPUT side : from line to MSP block on MATRIX SPI (OSn/RSn_A_Sk) : it descramblers the incoming signal , counts the OOF and reveals the LOF alarm. RST (RSn_TT_Sk) : performs frame alignment detection (A1, A2) , regenerator section trace recovery (J0) and mismatch detection, BIP–8 Errored Block count. J0 is not managed in this release. MST (MSn_TT_Sk) : performs BIP–24 errored block count, MS–REI recovery, MS–RDI and MS–AIS detection. TSD is applied in case of MS–DEG (signal degrade), TSF is applied if MS–AIS is detected. MSA (MSn/Sn_A_Sk) : performs AU4 pointer interpretation, LOP and AIS detection, pointer justification. Moreover the following functions are performed on the Rx side : SOH BYTE extraction (Rx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) are dropped and serialized in a DCC frame. Two DCC frames are generated working in 1+1 protection. OUTPUT side : from MATRIX to line MSA (Ms/Sn_A_So) : it performs AUG assembly, AU–4 pointer generation, AU–AIS generation. MST (MSn_TT_So) : it performs BIP–24 calculation and insertion, MS–REI MS–RDI and MS–AIS insertion. RST (RSn_TT_So) : it performs frame alignment insertion, regenerator section path trace insertion, BIP–8 calculation and insertion. SOH BYTE insertion (Tx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) coming from the DCC frames are inserted into the SOH section. SPI (OSn/RSn_A_So) :it scramblers the outgoing signals and insert AIS in alarm condition.
HOA BLOCK (HPT, HPA) From HPC matrix to LPC matrix HPT (Sn_TT_Sk) : path trace information is recovered, REI information is recovered, HP–RDI and UNEQ are detected, VC4 BIP–8 errored count block. TSF is applied if SSF or UNEQ or TIM or AIS is detected. TSD is applied if a condition of signal degrade is detected. Moreover : F2 F3 byte extraction (Rx side) : both F2 and F3 bytes are extracted from the received flow and serialized on a DCC frame .
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
N1 byte extraction (Rx side) : for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM). HPA (Sn/Sm_A_Sk) : VC–4 disassembly, TU pointer interpretation, LOP and TU–AIS detection, HP–SLM and LOM detection.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
437 / 636
HPA (Sn/Sm_A_So) : VC4 assembly, TU pointer generation, TU–AIS generation , signal label insertion, HPT (Sn_TT_So) : path trace identification insertion, RDI and REI indications insertion, VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion. Moreover: F2 and F3 byte insertion (Tx side) : F2/F3 bytes are inserted on the DCC frame N1 byte insertion (Tx side) : for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM). The G.A. provides also the HSUT, HPOM, (alternative) and LSUT, LPOM functions (alternative) both in Rx and Tx side. The main task of HSUT are: RX side (from MSA to HPC matrix): • • • • •
path trace information recovery REI recovery HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count
Tx side: (from HPC matrix to MSA) • • • •
generation of an unequipped container ”unequipped” insertion, trail trace identifier generation RDI and /or REI information generation VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion
The main task of HPOM are: RX and TX side: • • • • • • •
signal termination J1 path recovering REI information recovering HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count TSF is generated in case of SSF , UNEQ, TIM , AIS . TSD is generated in case of SD
The main tasks of LSUT are :
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
RX side (from HPA to LPC matrix): • • • •
ED
recovering of VC–m unequipped signal label path trace recovering BIP–2 recovery REI and RDI recovery
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
438 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
From LPC matrix to HPC matrix
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Tx side (from LPC matrix to HPA ): • • • •
insertion of VC–m unequipped signal label path trace insertion BIP–2 insertion REI and RDI insertion
LSUT is used to monitor unequipped path trails . The main tasks of LPOM are : • • • •
trace identifier monitoring RDI and REI recovering and deriving for performance primitives signal label monitoring VC–m BIP–2 errored block count
LPOM is used for performance monitoring purposes. Other functions implemented are : •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” stream, to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 Vdc supply by CONGI boards.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure. DC/DC CONVERTERS
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
This block converts the 48/60 V power supply 3.3 V and 2.5 V used to supply all the components in the board. The DC/DC converter is synchronized with a synchronization clock at 300 MHz (signal Power–Sync, generated by G.A.) in order to avoid EMI problems.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
439 / 636
System–clock a (1a) (1b) (1c) (1d)
HPT HOA
(2a)
HPA
RST
MST
(3a) (3b) (3c) (3d)
MSA
PISO & SIPO
to/from HPC matrix (H Link)
LOS (4a)
(5b) (5c) (5d)
F2, F3 2nd INTERFACE
SPI
Optical Input/ Output 3
3 rd INTERFACE
SPI Optical Input/ Output 4
4 th INTERFACE SPI
PISO & SIPO
PISO & SIPO
AUX
(1b) (2b) (3b) (4b) (5b)
T1
(1c) (2c) (3c) (4c) (5c)
T1
(1d) (2d) (3d) (4d) (5d)
T1
Config. & Status
622 MHz OSC
DCC
Management Bus
M–BUS Driver
CMISS Bus–OFF Remote Inventory
ID RIBUS
RIBUS I/F
Power Sync Unit Failure
F
3.3 V
+ 3.3 Vdc 48/60 V
DC/DC 2.5 V CONVERTERS ACCESS CARD
FROM/TO SERVICE
(4b) (4c) (4d) (5a)
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
DCCM MSOH
FROM/TO MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
DCCR RSOH
Optical Input/ Output 2
to/from LPC matrix (L Link)
FROM CONGI A & B
SPI
PISO & SIPO
to/from HPC matrix (X Link)
T1
HPOM HSUT (*)
TTF STM–1
(2b) (2c) (2d)
LPOM LSUT (*)
F2, F3 Optical Input/ Output 1
PISO & SIPO
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
G.A. 1st INTERFACE
4 x STM–1 ELECTRICAL PORT
Notes:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(*) –
HSUT and LSUT are not available in the current release
Figure 252. 4 x STM–1 Electrical port block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
440 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
System–clock b
4.24 4 x OC3 AU3/TU3 CONVERSION port (P4OC3)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(Refer to Figure 253. on page 447) This board can manage up to 4 x OC–3 (SONET) streams. The board hosts up to 2 interfaces into the front panel, which can be equipped with Electrical (ICMI) or Optical plug–in modules (IS–1.1, IL–1.1, IL–1.2, MM1). The other two interfaces can be hosted in the Access area using the A2S1 access card. Each combination of electrical/optical modules can be equipped in the same board. On OC–3 interface the Sonet mapping is manage so the RS and MS sections are terminated, the 3 AU3 are processed to extract or insert the 3 VC3. This unit performs the AU3/TU3 conversion , which allows the transport in SDH network of Sonet VC3 traffic. The conversion is performed on OC–3 interface: the 3 VC3 are extracted then re–mapping in SDH VC4 container and this container is passed to the matrix where it is managed as a structured VC4. Figure 212. on page 359 depicts the AU3/TU3 conversion mechanism achieved by 4xOC3 board. The Sonet interface (OC3) have not to be configured as Synchronization source. The OH byte of RS and MS section are managed according SDH ITU standard. The configuration is done by Craft Terminal or Network Management. No EPS is supported by this board. The description of the board has been divided in two parts; the first is the “AU3/TU3 conversion block” thath implement the SONET functionality, the second is the “G.A.” that implement the SDH functionality.
AU3/TU3 conversion block The functions required to manage OC3 signal are implemented by the “AU3/TU3 conversion block that interface the G.A. mounted on the board. The last interfaces the two matrix on the MATRIX cards via backpanel. INPUT side : from plug–in module to G.A. The circuits concerned are: SIPO :this block performs the Serial to Parallel conversion (SIPO) of the SONET STS3/OC3 (155 Mb/s) serial stream coming from the line. ALIGNER (SDH/SONET standard Frame Aligner) The Frame Aligner Word (FAW) extracted by the incoming frame is inserted by the MST/RST* source function into the outgoing frame: in this way G.A. is able to detect a possible OOF (Out Of Frame) condition as well.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
RST/MST Sk This block performs: • •
Standard SDH/SONET Descrambler extraction of all SOH bytes of the SONET stream that are inserted in RST/MST* source functions to be processed by G.A. B1 and B2 calculation and checking in order to send error information downstream
•
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
441 / 636
AU3–TU3 Rx
• • • •
time–division Pointer Interpreter of the 3 AU3s Pointer buffer Pointer Generator of the 3 TU3 multiplexed inside the AU4 Pointer Generator of the AU4
HPT* So This block performs: • •
calculation and insertion of B3 byte in AU4 POH insertion of C2 byte in AU4 POH
MST/RST* So This block performs: • •
insertion of extracted and stored SOH bytes compensation of B1 and B2 bytes by usage of error information collected by RST/MST sink function
PISO: this block performs the towards G.A.
Parallel to Serial conversion (PISO) of the SDH STM–1 stream
On the Input side the LOS alarm is buffered and sent to the G.A.
OUTPUT side : from G.A. to Plug–in module SIPO :this block performs the Serial to Parallel conversion (SIPO) of the SDH STM–1 stream coming from G.A. ALIGNER* Alignment to SDH STM–1 stream coming from G.A. is performed RST/MST* Sk This block performs: • extraction of all SOH bytes of the SDH stream that are inserted in RST/MST source functions • B1 calculation and checking for internal use. HPT* Sk It implements the “Path Label Mismatch“ algorithm; the C2 byte from the incoming AU4 frame is extracted and its content is written into a register. If the value is different than expected, a “Path Label Mismatch” alarm is raised
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
AU3–TU3 Tx: • • • • •
ED
Pointer Interpreter of the AU4 time–division Pointer Interpreter of the 3 TU3s Pointer buffer Pointer Generator of the 3 AU3 multiplexed inside the OC3 pointer justifications and buffer overflow alarms are reported Equipment Controller (EC)
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
442 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The AU3 to TU3 conversion block contains:
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
MST/RST So This block performs: • • •
insertion of extracted and stored SOH bytes calculation and insertion of B1 and B2 bytes standard SONET scrambler
PISO: this block performs the Parallel to Serial conversion (PISO) of the SONET STS3/OC3 stream towards the line.
G.A. (Gate Array) The SDH functions are implemented by the G.A. mounted on the board. It interfaces the two MATRIX cards via backpanel. Referring to the ITU–T G.783 Recommendation , the G.A. performs the following functions : –
TTF
–
HOA
–
LPOM /LSUT (the last is not available in this release)
–
HPOM /HSUT (the last is not available in this release)
Cross connection functions (MSP, HPC and LPC) are performed by the matrices present on the two MATRIX boards (working in 1+1 configuration). The TTF block is connected to the MATRIX boards (main and spare) through 1+1 bidirectional links at 622 Mbit/s , STM–4 equivalent capacity. HOA block is connected both to the HPC matrices and to the LPC matrices on the two MATRIX boards through a couple of 1+1 links at 622 MBit/s working in protection, STM–4 equivalent capacity. Backpanel interface supply a system–clock to the G.A. internal circuits. In the following block description, the new naming convention of the G.783 is reported. Refer to para. 3.3.2 on page 196 for details. The G.A. send and receive four signals (data + clock) to/from the four “AU3/TU3 CONVERSION block” An external LOS is received from each input line interface. Each optical transmitter provides its status by means of two input signals: Laser Degrade and Laser Failure. The ALS algorithm is hardware implemented : the G.A. provides the Laser shut Down command (LASER OFF). In the following will be described the signal processing of only one signal from/to “AU3/TU3 CONVERSION block”; the other three interfaces process the signal in the same way.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The PISO & SIPO (Parallel–In Serial–Out; Serial–in Parallel–out) blocks allow the unit to interface with the back panel at of 622 Mbit/s bit rate, mapping the signals over a STM–4 internal equivalent frame.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
443 / 636
This block performs the Transport Terminal Functions (sink on Input side, source on Output side) for the 155 Mbit/s signals. INPUT side : from line to MSP block on MATRIX SPI* (OSn/RSn_A_Sk) : it descramblers the incoming signal , counts the OOF and reveals the LOF alarm. RST (RSn_TT_Sk) : performs frame alignment detection (A1, A2) , regenerator section trace recovery (J0) and mismatch detection, BIP–8 Errored Block count. J0 is not managed in this release. MST (MSn_TT_Sk) : performs BIP–24 errored block count, MS–REI recovery, MS–RDI and MS–AIS detection. TSD is applied in case of MS–DEG (signal degrade), TSF is applied if MS–AIS is detected. MSA (MSn/Sn_A_Sk) : performs AU4 pointer interpretation, LOP and AIS detection, pointer justification. Moreover the following functions are performed on the Rx side : SOH BYTE extraction (Rx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) are dropped and serialized in a DCC frame. Two DCC frames are generated working in 1+1 protection. OUTPUT side : from MATRIX to line MSA (Ms/Sn_A_So) : it performs AUG assembly, AU–4 pointer generation, AU–AIS generation. MST (MSn_TT_So) : it performs BIP–24 calculation and insertion, MS–REI MS–RDI and MS–AIS insertion. RST (RSn_TT_So) : it performs frame alignment insertion, regenerator section path trace insertion, BIP–8 calculation and insertion. SOH BYTE insertion (Tx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) coming from the DCC frames are inserted into the SOH section. SPI* (OSn/RSn_A_So) :it scramblers the outgoing signals and insert AIS in alarm condition. HOA BLOCK (HPT, HPA) From HPC matrix to LPC matrix HPT (Sn_TT_Sk) : path trace information is recovered, REI information is recovered, HP–RDI and UNEQ are detected, VC4 BIP–8 errored count block. TSF is applied if SSF or UNEQ or TIM or AIS is detected. TSD is applied if a condition of signal degrade is detected. Moreover : F2 F3 byte extraction (Rx side) : both F2 and F3 bytes are extracted from the received flow and serialized on a DCC frame .
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
N1 byte extraction (Rx side) : for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM). HPA (Sn/Sm_A_Sk) : VC–4 disassembly, TU pointer interpretation, LOP and TU–AIS detection, HP–SLM and LOM detection.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
444 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
TTF BLOCK ( SPI*, RST, MST, MSA)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
From LPC matrix to HPC matrix HPA (Sn/Sm_A_So) : VC4 assembly, TU pointer generation, TU–AIS generation , signal label insertion, HPT (Sn_TT_So) : path trace identification insertion, RDI and REI indications insertion, VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion. Moreover: F2 and F3 byte insertion (Tx side) : F2/F3 bytes are inserted on the DCC frame N1 byte insertion (Tx side) : for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM). The G.A. provides also the HSUT, HPOM, (alternative) and LSUT, LPOM functions (alternative) both in Rx and Tx side. The main task of HSUT are: RX side (from MSA to HPC matrix): • • • • •
path trace information recovery REI recovery HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count
Tx side: (from HPC matrix to MSA) • • • •
generation of an unequipped container ”unequipped” insertion, trail trace identifier generation RDI and /or REI information generation VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion
The main task of HPOM are: RX and TX side: • • • • • • •
signal termination J1 path recovering REI information recovering HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count TSF is generated in case of SSF , UNEQ, TIM , AIS . TSD is generated in case of SD
The main tasks of LSUT are :
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
RX side (from HPA to LPC matrix): • • • •
ED
recovering of VC–m unequipped signal label path trace recovering BIP–2 recovery REI and RDI recovery
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
445 / 636
Tx side (from LPC matrix to HPA ): • • • •
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
insertion of VC–m unequipped signal label path trace insertion BIP–2 insertion REI and RDI insertion
LSUT is used to monitor unequipped path trails . The main tasks of LPOM are : • • • •
trace identifier monitoring RDI and REI recovering and deriving for performance primitives signal label monitoring VC–m BIP–2 errored block count
LPOM is used for performance monitoring purposes.
Other functions implemented are : •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to: – – – – –
read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” stream control the LED on the unit to release the Management–bus in case of power failure read remote inventory data send Internal Loop and External Loop commands to each interface separately
RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 Vdc supply by CONGI boards. •
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure. DC/DC CONVERTERS
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
This block converts the 48/60 V power supply 5V, 3.3 V, 2.5 V and 1.8 V used to supply all the components in the board. The DC/DC converter is synchronized with a synchronization clock at 300 MHz (signal Power–Sync, generated by G.A.) in order to avoid EMI problems.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
446 / 636
System–clock a System–clock b
1st INTERFACE
HPT
(2a)
HPA
Int. Loop
Data
AUE/TU3
(3a) (3b) (3c) (3d)
TTF
Data
CONVERSION
SPI*
RST
MSA
MST
PISO & SIPO
to/from HPC matrix (H Link)
block
O/E Input/ Output 2
DCCM MSOH
(4a)
(1d) (2d) (3d) (4d) (5d)
4 th INTERFACE
622 MHz OSC Power Sync.
Config. & Status
Remote Inventory
AUX
(1c) (2c) (3c) (4c) (5c)
3 rd INTERFACE
SPI ( )
DCC
(1b) (2b) (3b) (4b) (5b)
2nd INTERFACE
SPI ( )
PISO & SIPO
(5b) (5c) (5d)
F2, F3
O/E Input/ Output 3
PISO & SIPO
(4b) (4c) (4d) (5a)
Management Bus
M–BUS Driver
CMISS
Bus–OFF
RIBUS Line Loop 1–4 Int. Loop 1–4
1.8 V 5V 3.3 V
DC/DC CONVERTERS
FROM/TO SERVICE
DCCR RSOH
LASER D. LASER F. LASER OFF
O/E Input/ Output 4
to/from LPC matrix (L link)
RIBUS I/F
FROM/TO MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
SPI
LOS
to/from HPC matrix (X Link)
HPOM HSUT(*)
F2, F3 O/E LOS Module
PISO & SIPO
(2b) (2c) (2d)
LPOM (*) LSUT
Line Loop O/E Input/ Output 1
PISO & SIPO
(1b) (1c) (1d)
ID F
Unit failure
FROM CONGI
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(1a)
HOA
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
G.A.
+3.3 Vdc 48/60 V
2.5 V ACCESS CARD
4xOC3 AU3/TU3 CONVERSION PORT
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Notes: (*) –
HSUT and LSUT are not available in the current release
( )–
THE ” SPI” ASSOCIATED TO THE 3rd AND 4th INTERFACES ARE PHISICALLY ON THE ACCESS CARD
Figure 253. 4 x OC3 AU3/TU3 conversion port(P40C3)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
447 / 636
RSOH bytes SOH BYPASS
MSOH bytes
B1 error for compensation Data from plug–in module
B2 error for compensation
OOF
AU3–TU3 Rx SIPO
Aligner
RST sk
MST sk
PI PB PG TU3 AU3
PG AU4*
HPT* So
MST* So
RST* So
PISO
DATA to G.A.
B3, C2 LOS
LOS
LOS BUFFERING
RSOH bytes SOH BYPASS
Data to plug–in module
TU3–AU3 Tx PISO
RST So
MST So
PG AU3
PI PI PB TU3 AU4
C2 check
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
MSOH bytes
MST* sk
RST* sk
Aligner *
SIPO
DATA from G.A.
HPT* Sk
Figure 254. AU3/TU3 conversion block
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
448 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
AU3/TU3 CONVERSION block
4.25 STM–4 optical ports
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 255. on page453) The STM–4 port processes an optical STM–4 stream. Different STM–4 optical port are available according to the connector type (FC/PC or SC/PC) and wave length (S–4.1, L–4.1 and L–4.2); in the following a generic description is given. The SDH functions required to manage STM–4 signal are implemented by the G.A. mounted on the board. It interfaces the two MATRIX boards via backpanel. Referring to the ITU–T G.783 recommendation, the G.A. performs the following functions : –
TTF
–
HOA
–
LPOM /LSUT (the last is not available in this release)
–
HPOM /HSUT (the last is not available in this release)
Cross connection functions (MSP, HPC and LPC) are performed by the two MATRIX boards (working in 1+1 configuration). The TTF block is connected to the two MATRIX boards through 1+1 bidirectional links at 622 Mbit/s , STM–4 equivalent capacity. HOA block is connected both to the HPC matrices and to the LPC matrices on the two MATRIX boards through a couple of 1+1 links at 622 MBit/s working in protection, STM–4 equivalent capacity. Backpanel interface supply a system–clock to the G.A. internal circuits. In the following block description, the new naming convention of the G.783 is reported. Refer to para. 3.3.2 on page 196 for details. The G.A. send and receive one STM–4 signal (data + clock) at 622 Mbit/s to/from the SPI The SPI can detect an external LOS from the input line . The optical transmitter provides to the G.A. its status by means of two input signals: Laser Degrade and Laser Failure. The ALS algorithm is hardware implemented and the G.A. provides the Laser shut Down command. On the front panel of the unit a push–button is available for manual laser restart. TTF BLOCK (SPI, RST, MST, MSA) This block performs the Transport Terminal Functions (sink on Input side, source on Output side) for the STM–4 signal. TTF block provides the T1 timing references at 2 MHz , derived from the STM–4 input signals
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
INPUT side : from line to MSP MATRIX SPI (OSn/RSn_A_Sk) : it descramblers the incoming signal , counts the OOF and reveals the LOF alarm. RST (RSn_TT_Sk) : performs frame alignment detection (A1, A2) , regenerator section trace recovery (J0) and mismatch detection, BIP–8 Errored Block count.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
449 / 636
MSA (MSn/Sn_A_Sk) : performs AU4’s pointer interpretation, LOP and AIS detection, pointer justification. Moreover the following functions are performed on the Rx side : SOH BYTE extraction (Rx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) are dropped and serialized in a DCC frame. Two DCC frames are generated working in 1+1 protection. TP byte insertion (Rx side) : since the cross connection functions are centralized , for protection purpose TSD (Trail Signal Degrade) and TSF (Trail Signal Failure) are transmitted towards the two MATRIX board. K BYTES insertion and extraction (Rx side) : this block provides the in–band transmission of K1,K2, bytes towards the MATRIX board. For each of the 4 STM–1 streams, the bytes are extracted form the line when a TSF is received and transmitted towards the two MATRIX board. OUTPUT side : from MATRIX to line MSA (Ms/Sn_A_So) : it performs AUG assembly, AU–4 pointer generation, AU–AIS generation. The four AUG structure are byte interleaved in the STM–4 structure with fixed phase relationship vs. the same multiple signal. MST (MSn_TT_So) : it performs BIP–24 calculation and insertion, MS–REI MS–RDI and MS–AIS insertion. RST (RSn_TT_So) : it performs frame alignment insertion, regenerator section path trace insertion, BIP–8 calculation and insertion. SOH BYTE insertion (Tx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) coming from the DCC frames are inserted into the SOH section. K BYTES insertion and extraction (Tx side) : K1, K2 bytes are extracted from the frame coming from backpanel and re–inserted on the same output line frame . HOA BLOCK (HPT, HPA) From HPC matrix to LPC matrix HPT (Sn_TT_Sk) : path trace information is recovered, REI information is recovered, HP–RDI and UNEQ are detected, VC4 BIP–8 errored count block. TSF is applied if SSF or UNEQ or TIM or AIS is detected. TSD is applied if a condition of signal degrade is detected. Moreover : F2 F3 byte extraction (Rx side) : both F2 and F3 bytes are extracted from the received flow and serialized on a DCC frame .
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
N1 byte extraction (Rx side) : for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM). HPA (Sn/Sm_A_Sk) : VC–4 disassembly, TU pointer interpretation, LOP and TU–AIS detection, HP–SLM and LOM detection.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
450 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
MST (MSn_TT_Sk) : performs BIP–24 errored block count, MS–REI recovery, MS–RDI and MS–AIS detection. TSD is applied in case of MS–DEG (signal degrade), TSF is applied if MS–AIS is detected.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
From LPC matrix to HPC matrix HPA (Sn/Sm_A_So) : VC4 assembly, TU pointer generation, TU–AIS generation , signal label insertion, HPT (Sn_TT_So) : path trace identification insertion, RDI and REI indications insertion, VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion. Moreover: F2 and F3 byte insertion (Tx side) : F2/F3 bytes are inserted on the DCC frame N1 byte insertion (Tx side) : for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM). The G.A. provides also the HSUT, HPOM, (alternative) and LSUT, LPOM functions (alternative) both in Rx and Tx side. The main task of HSUT are: RX side (from MSA to HPC matrix): • • • • •
path trace information recovery REI recovery HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count
Tx side: (from HPC matrix to MSA) • • • •
generation of an unequipped container ”unequipped” insertion, trail trace identifier generation RDI and /or REI information generation VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion
The main task of HPOM are: RX and TX side: • • • • • • •
signal termination J1 path recovering REI information recovering HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count TSF is generated in case of SSF , UNEQ, TIM , AIS . TSD is generated in case of SD
The main tasks of LSUT are :
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
RX side (from HPA to LPC matrix): • • • •
ED
recovering of VC–m unequipped signal label path trace recovering BIP–2 recovery REI and RDI recovery
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
451 / 636
Tx side (from LPC matrix to HPA ): • • • •
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
insertion of VC–m unequipped signal label path trace insertion BIP–2 insertion REI and RDI insertion
LSUT is used to monitor unequipped path trails . The main tasks of LPOM are : • • • •
trace identifier monitoring RDI and REI recovering and deriving for performance primitives signal label monitoring VC–m BIP–2 errored block count
LPOM is used for performance monitoring purposes. Other functions implemented are : •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” stream, to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 Vdc supply by CONGI boards.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
DC/DC CONVERTERS This block converts the 48/60 V power supply to the following voltages:
ED
•
3.3 V and 2.5 V used to supply all the components in the board.
•
–5.2 V to supply the optical module The DC/DC converter is synchronized with a synchronization clock at 300 MHz (signal Power–Sync, generated by G.A.) in order to avoid EMI problems.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
452 / 636
System–clock a
G.A. HOA
to/from LPC matrix (L Link)
HPA
LPOM LSUT (*)
F2, F3
OPTICAL INTERFACE
OPTICAL INPUT/ OUPUT
TTF K1,K2 Tx side Insertion
STM–4 SPI
HPOM HSUT (*)
LOS LASER D. LASER F. LASER OFF
RST
to/from HPC matrix (H Link)
MST
DCCR RSOH
FROM/TO MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
to/from HPC matrix (X Link)
HPT
K1,K2,TP Rx side Insertion
MSA
DCCM MSOH
T1
DCC AUX F2, F3
FROM/TO SERVICE
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
System–clock b
Config. & Status
CMISS
Bus–OFF Remote Inventory
Power Sync –5.2 V 3.3 V 2.5 V
RIBUS
RIBUS I/F
ID
Unit Failure
+3.3 Vdc
48/60 V
DC/DC CONVERTERS
FROM/TO MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
Laser Restart
Management Bus
M–BUS Driver
FROM CONGI A & B
622 MHz OSC
STM–4 OPTICAL PORT
Notes:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(*) –
HSUT and LSUT are not available in the current release
Figure 255. STM–4 –block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
453 / 636
4.26 4 x STM–4 optical port (P4S4N)
The 4 x STM–4 port can processes up to four STM–4 streams but only two can be terminated so only two can be used. A maximum of two optical modules can be housed on the card to give physical access to the STM–4 signal. The SDH functions required to manage STM–4 signal are implemented by the GAs mounted on the board. It interfaces the two MATRIX cards via backpanel. For simplicity the following description is related only to one of the four STM–4 interfaces that can be process by the card . Referring to the ITU–T G.783 Rec., the GA performs the following functions: TTF and HPOM / HSUT . Cross connection functions (MSP, HPC) are performed by the two MATRIX boards (working in 1+1 configuration). The TTF block is connected to the two MATRIX boards through 1+1 bidirectional links at 622 Mbit/s, STM–4 equivalent capacity. In the following block description, the new naming convention of the G.783 is reported.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The G.A. send and receive STM–4 signals (data + clock) at 622 Mbit/s to/from the SPI. The SPI can detect an external LOS from the input line. The optical transmitter provides to the G.A. its status by means of two input signals: Laser Degrade and Laser Failure.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
454 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Note: this board does not support Low Order traffic termination
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
TTF BLOCK (SPI, RST, MST, MSA) This block performs the Transport Terminal Functions (sink on Rx side, source on Tx side) for the STM–4 signal. TTF block provides the T1 timing references at 2 MHz, derived from the STM–4 input signals. INPUT side : from line to MSP MATRIX SPI (OSn/RSn_A_Sk) : it descramblers the incoming signal, counts the OOF and reveals the LOF alarm. RST (RSn_TT_Sk) : performs frame alignment detection (A1, A2), regenerator section trace recovery (J0) and mismatch detection, BIP–8 Errored Block count. MST (MSn_TT_Sk) : performs BIP–24 errored block count, MS–REI recovery, MS–RDI and MS–AIS detection. TSD is applied in case of MS–DEG (signal degrade), TSF is applied if MS–AIS is detected. MSA (MSn/Sn_A_Sk) : performs AU4’s pointer interpretation, LOP and AIS detection, pointer justification. Moreover the following functions are performed on the Rx side: SOH BYTE extraction (Rx side) : DCC bytes (DCCR D1 BD3 and DCCM D4 BD12) are dropped and serialized in a DCC frame. Two DCC frames are generated working in 1+1 protection. TP byte insertion (Rx side) : since the cross connection functions are centralized, for protection purpose TSD (Trail Signal Degrade) and TSF (Trail Signal Failure) are transmitted towards the two HCMATRIX boards. K BYTES insertion and extraction (Rx side) : this block provides the in–band transmission of K1, K2, bytes towards the MATRIXE board. For each of the 4 STM–1 streams, the bytes are extracted form the line when a TSF is received and they are overwritten into the SOH section. OUTPUT side : from MATRIX to line MSA (Ms/Sn_A_So) : it performs AUG assembly, AU–4 pointer generation, AU–AIS generation. The four AUG structure are byte interleaved in the STM–4 structure with fixed phase relationship vs. the same multiple signal. MST (MSn_TT_So) : it performs BIP–24 calculation and insertion, MS–REI MS–RDI and MS–AIS insertion. RST (RSn_TT_So) : it performs frame alignment insertion, regenerator section path trace insertion, BIP–8 calculation and insertion. SOH BYTE insertion (Tx side) : DCC bytes (DCCR D1BD3 and DCCM D4 BD12) coming from the DCC frames are inserted into the SOH section.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
K BYTES insertion and extraction (Tx side) : K1, K2 bytes are extracted from the frame coming from backpanel and re–inserted on the same output line frame.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
455 / 636
HPOM, HSUT block
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The GA provides also the HSUT, HPOM (alternative) both in RX and TX side. The main task of HSUT are: RX side (from MSA to HPC matrix): • • • • •
path trace information recovery REI recovery HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count
TX side (from HPC matrix to MSA): • • • •
generation of an unequipped container ”unequipped” insertion, trail trace identifier generation RDI and /or REI information generation VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion
The main task of HPOM are: RX and TX side:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
• • • • • • •
ED
signal termination J1 path recovering REI information recovering HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count TSF is generated in case of SSF, UNEQ, TIM, AIS. TSD is generated in case of SD.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
456 / 636
Other functions
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Other functions implemented are: •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” stream, to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure.
•
DC/DC CONVERTERS This block converts the –48/–60 V power supply to the following voltages: •
3.3V and 2.5V used to supply all the components in the board
•
–5.2Vto supply the optical module
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The DC/DC converter is synchronized with a synchronization clock at 300 MHz (signal Power–Sync, generated by GA) in order to avoid EMI problems.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
457 / 636
System–clock a
OPTICAL INPUT/ OUPUT #1
OPTICAL INTERFACE
TTF #1 K1,K2 Tx side Insertion
STM–4 SPI
LOS LASER D. LASER F.
OPTICAL INPUT/ OUPUT #2
HPOM HSUT
RST
DCCR RSOH
MST
.
MSA
DCCM MSOH
to/from HPC matrix K1,K2,TP Rx side Insertion
TTF #2 TTF #3 (not used)
DCC
from/to SERVICE
TTF #4 (not used)
Config. & Status Laser Restart
from/to MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
Management Bus
M–BUS Driver
Bus–OFF Remote Inventory
Power Sync –5.2 V 3.3 V 2.5 V
DC/DC CONVERTERS
RIBUS
RIBUS I/F
ID
Unit Failure
48/60 V
from CONGI A & B
622 MHz OSC
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
4xSTM–4 OPTICAL PORT
Figure 256. 4xSTM–4 optical port block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
458 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
G.A.
from/to MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
System–clock b
4.27 STM–16 optical port
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 257. on page 464) The description is applicable to all the STM–16 optical ports of this release; up to four STM–16 optical port can be inserted in 1660SM. The units can be distinguished by letters L, S and I defining their dependance on optical components used for Long distance, Short distance or Intra Office. The Input/output unit optical connectors can be accessed from the unit’s front coverplate. The units which operate in the second window are indicated with 16.1, those operating in the third window with 16.2. The units are identified by the type of connector used: –
SFF
–
SFP plug–in module (”colored” or “Black and White”)
–
FC/PC
–
SC/PC
–
SC/SPC
The units identified by JE (Joint engineering) have better optical characteristics, typically for the dispersion values and sensitivity (see Table 66. on page 595). The STM–16 with ”192.3 to 195.7” indication (also defined ”colored”), are used when interfaced with WDM equipment. That number indicates the central frequency (in Thz) of the carrier optical signal, related to the wavelength. These sixteen units are independently characterized by different wavelength. The WDM equipment must receive up to sixteen different wavelength signals from sixteen different STM–16 optical port. The SDH functions required to manage STM–16 signal are implemented by four G.A. ( G.A#1 to G.A.#4 in Figure 257. on page 464) mounted on the board. They interface the two MATRIX boards via backpanel.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Another G.A. (G.A.#5 in Figure 257. on page 464) is present with MUX/DEMUX and loop functions. This G.A. interface the line side with one stream at 2488 Mbit/s an the equipment side with four stream at 622 Mbit/s.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
459 / 636
• •
Line loop Internal loop
Referring to the ITU–T G.783 recommendation, the four G.A. performs the following functions : –
TTF (only the G.A. #1 )
–
HOA (all G.A. from 1 to 4)
–
LPOM /LSUT (all G.A. from 1 to 4). The last is not available in this release
–
HPOM /HSUT ( only the G.A.#1). The last is not available in this release
Cross connection functions (MSP, HPC and LPC) are performed by the two MATRIX boards (working in 1+1 configuration). The TTF block is connected to the two MATRIX boards through four bidirectional links at 622 Mbit/s in 1+1 configuration (H link). HOA block is connected both to the HPC matrices and to the LPC matrices on the two MATRIX boards through two bidirectional link at 622 MBit/s each in 1+1 configuration (”X link” and “L link” respectively) . Backpanel interface supply a system–clock (SYST CK) to the G.A. internal circuits In the following block description, the new naming convention of the G.783 is reported. Refer to para. 3.3.2 on page 196 for details. The G.A.#1 send and receive four 622 Mbit/s signal (data + clock) to/from the G.A.#5 The SPI can detect an external LOS from the input line . The optical transmitter provides to the G.A. its status by means of two input signals: Laser Degrade and Laser Failure. The ALS algorithm is hardware implemented and the G.A. provides (LASER OFF).
the Laser shut Down command
On the front panel of the unit a push–button is available for manual laser restart. TTF BLOCK (SPI, RST, MST, MSA) This block performs the Transport Terminal Functions (sink on Input side, source on Output side) for the STM–16 signal. TTF block provides the T1 timing references at 2 MHz , derived from the STM–16 input signals INPUT side : from line to MSP MATRIX SPI (OSn/RSn_A_Sk) : it descramblers the incoming signal , counts the OOF and reveals the LOF alarm.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
RST (RSn_TT_Sk) : performs frame alignment detection (A1, A2) , regenerator section trace recovery (J0) and mismatch detection, BIP–8 Errored Block count. MST (MSn_TT_Sk) : performs BIP–24 errored block count, MS–REI recovery, MS–RDI and MS–AIS detection. TSD is applied in case of MS–DEG (signal degrade), TSF is applied if MS–AIS is detected.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
460 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Two types of loops are possible inside G.A.#5:
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
MSA (MSn/Sn_A_Sk) : performs AU4’s pointer interpretation, LOP and AIS detection, pointer justification. Sixteen MSA blocks are present. Moreover the following functions are performed on the Input side : SOH BYTE extraction (Rx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) are dropped and serialized in a DCC frame. Two DCC frames are generated working in 1+1 protection. TP byte insertion (Rx side) : since the cross connection functions are centralized , for protection purpose TSD (Trail Signal Degrade) and TSF (Trail Signal Failure) are transmitted towards the two MATRIX board. K BYTES insertion and extraction (Rx side) : this block provides the in–band transmission of K1,K2, bytes towards the MATRIX board. The bytes are extracted from the line when a TSF is received and they are transmitted towards the two MATRIX board. OUTPUT side : from MATRIX to line MSA (Ms/Sn_A_So) : it performs AUG assembly, AU–4 pointer generation, AU–AIS generation. The sixteen AU4 structure are byte interleaved in the STM–16 structure with fixed phase relationship vs. the same multiple signal. MST (MSn_TT_So) : it performs BIP–24 calculation and insertion, MS–REI MS–RDI and MS–AIS insertion. RST (RSn_TT_So) : it performs frame alignment insertion, regenerator section path trace insertion, BIP–8 calculation and insertion. SOH BYTE insertion (Tx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) coming from the DCC frames are inserted into the SOH section. K BYTES insertion and extraction (Tx side) : K1, K2 bytes are extracted from the frame coming from backpanel and re–inserted on the same output line frame . HOA BLOCK (HPT, HPA) From HPC matrix to LPC matrix HPT (Sn_TT_Sk) : path trace information is recovered, REI information is recovered, HP–RDI and UNEQ are detected, VC4 BIP–8 errored count block. TSF is applied if SSF or UNEQ or TIM or AIS is detected. TSD is applied if a condition of signal degrade is detected. Moreover : F2 F3 byte extraction (Rx side) : both F2 and F3 bytes are extracted from the received flow and serialized on a DCC frame . N1 byte extraction (Rx side) : for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
HPA (Sn/Sm_A_Sk) : VC–4 disassembly, TU pointer interpretation, LOP and TU–AIS detection, HP–SLM and LOM detection.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
461 / 636
HPA (Sn/Sm_A_So) : VC4 assembly, TU pointer generation, TU–AIS generation , signal label insertion, HPT (Sn_TT_So) : path trace identification insertion, RDI and REI indications insertion, VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion. Moreover: F2 and F3 byte insertion (Tx side) : F2/F3 bytes are inserted on the DCC frame N1 byte insertion (Tx side) : for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM). The G.A. provides also the HSUT, HPOM, (alternative) and LSUT, LPOM functions (alternative) both in Rx and Tx side. The main task of HSUT are: RX side (from MSA to HPC matrix): • • • • •
path trace information recovery REI recovery HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count
Tx side: (from HPC matrix to MSA) • • • •
generation of an unequipped container ”unequipped” insertion, trail trace identifier generation RDI and /or REI information generation VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion
The main task of HPOM are: RX and TX side: • • • • • • •
signal termination J1 path recovering REI information recovering HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring) VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count TSF is generated in case of SSF , UNEQ, TIM , AIS . TSD is generated in case of SD
The main tasks of LSUT are :
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
RX side (from HPA to LPC matrix): • • • •
ED
recovering of VC–m unequipped signal label path trace recovering BIP–2 recovery REI and RDI recovery
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
462 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
From LPC matrix to HPC matrix
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Tx side (from LPC matrix to HPA ): • • • •
insertion of VC–m unequipped signal label path trace insertion BIP–2 insertion REI and RDI insertion
LSUT is used to monitor unequipped path trails . The main tasks of LPOM are : • • • •
trace identifier monitoring RDI and REI recovering and deriving for performance primitives signal label monitoring VC–m BIP–2 errored block count
LPOM is used for performance monitoring purposes. Other functions implemented are : •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to: – read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” stream – control the LED on the unit – release the Management–bus in case of power failure – read remote inventory data. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 Vdc supply by CONGI boards.
•
TONE MODULATOR MANAGEMENT This block is used by the STM–16 optical port with ”192.3 to 195.7” indication. In this block is present a”WDM tone generator”, which starting from the data written in the remote inventory, fix the appropriate wavelength transmitted to the WDM equipment.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details) and additional data for operation of the board in WDM application.
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure.
•
DC/DC CONVERTERS This block converts the 48/60 V power supply to the following voltages:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
– – – –
+ 2.5 V + 3.3 V –5V +5V
The DC/DC converter is synchronized with a synchronization clock at 300 MHz (signal Power Sync) , generated by G.A.#1) in order to avoid EMI problems.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
463 / 636
SYST CK A/B
G.A.#1 HPT
CK Power Sync
to/from LPC matrix
HOA HPA
4 x 622 Mbit/s
G.A.#5 MUX / DEMUX
K1,K2 Tx side Insertion
F2, F3
RST
MST
HPOM (*) HSUT K1,K2,TP Rx side Insertion
MSA
DCCR DCCM RSOH MSOH
to/from HPC matrix (H link) to/from HPC matrix (H link)
MSA
Line loop Internal loop
to/from HPC matrix
(H link)
to/from HPC matrix
(H link)
MSA
LOS LASER D. LASER F. LASER OFF
AUX F2, F3 Tone
G.A.#2 HPT HOA CK
HPA
SYST CK A/B to/from HPC matrix ( X link) to/from LPC matrix (L link) LPOM (*) LSUT
F2, F3
G.A.#3 HPT
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Notes: (*) – HSUT and LSUT are not operative in current release
CK HOA
HPA
SYST CK A/B to/from HPC matrix ( X link) to/from LPC matrix (L link)
Tone
LPOM (*) LSUT F2, F3
Tone modulator management
G.A.#4
Line loop Internal loop
HOA HPA
AUX
F2, F3
SYST CK A/B to/from HPC matrix ( X link) to/from LPC matrix (L link) LPOM (*) LSUT
Bus–OFF
F2, F3
F2, F3
AUX
from/to SERVICE
from/to SERVICE
from/to SERVICE
ID RIBUS I/F
RIBUS +3.3 Vdc
Unit Failure
HPT
CK M–BUS Driver
Remote Inventory
AUX
F2, F3
from/to MATRIX main and spare
DCC
from/to SERVICE
MSA
from/to MATRIX main and spare
O/E SPI
LPOM (*) LSUT
TTF
from/to MATRIX main and spare
2488 Mbit/s OPTICAL INPUT/ OUPUT
(L link)
STM–16 OPTICAL PORT
2.5 V 3.3 V 5V –5 V
Power Sync DC/DC CONVERTERS
48/60 V +3.3 Vdc
from CONGI
Figure 257. STM–16 optical port block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
464 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Laser Restart
T1 to/from HPC matrix ( X link)
from/to MATRIX main and spare
622 MHz OSC
4.28 ISA – ATM MATRIX 4X4 (ATM4X4)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 258. on page 471) This unit realize an ATM switching matrix with a total bandwidth of 622Mbit/s. The board is able to manage up to 16 LT where LT is a physical or logical channel where is mapped an ATM flow (E1, E3, VC12, VC3, VC4). On the board a local STM–1 access carrying an unstructured VC4 is managed. The card perform the following functions: [1]
SDH signal processing
[2]
ATM signal processing
[3]
MATRIX
[4]
MICROPROCESSOR
[5]
Common part
[1] SDH signal processing One STM–1 interface is available on the card. The stream can be optical or electrical according to the modules available (electrical–STM1 or optical–STM1) inserted into the front cover cavity of the ATM MATRIX 4X4. The proprietary function of ”Bidirectional working on single fiber” is provided, by presetting. This function uses the BMD (bad media dependent) byte. The BMD alarm is considered as an external LOS. The ALS algorithm is provided by hardware implementation (Laser–Shut–Down command). The line–interface (SPI) is performed by the pluggable module (line–module). LOS, Laser–Degrade, Laser–fail alarms and Laser–Shut–Down commands are comprised in the Alarms&Commands group in the figure. The SDH functions required to manage STM–1 signals are: – – –
SPI, RST, MST, MSA HPT, LPT and LPA. SOH bytes
Cross connection functions (MSP, HPC and LPC) are performed by the matrices present on the two MATRIXN board (working in 1+1 configuration). The MSA block is connected to the MATRIXN boards (main and spare) through 1+1 bidirectional links at 622 Mbit/s , STM–4 equivalent capacity. SPI, RST, MST, MSA BLOCK
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
These blocks performs the Transport Terminal Functions (sink on Rx side, source on Tx side) for STM–1 signals.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
465 / 636
SPI (OSn/RSn_A_Sk) : it descramblers the incoming signal , counts the OOF and reveals the LOF alarm. RST (RSn_TT_Sk) : performs frame alignment detection (A1, A2) , regenerator section trace recovery (J0) and mismatch detection, BIP–8 Errored Block count. J0 is not managed in this release. MST (MSn_TT_Sk) : performs BIP–24 errored block count, MS–REI recovery, MS–RDI and MS–AIS detection. TSD is applied in case of MS–DEG (signal degrade), TSF is applied if MS–AIS is detected. MSA (MSn/Sn_A_Sk) : performs AU4 pointer interpretation, LOP and AIS detection, pointer justification. Moreover the following functions are performed on the Rx side : SOH BYTE extraction (Rx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) are dropped and serialized in a DCC frame. Two DCC frames are generated working in 1+1 protection. Tx side : from matrix on the MATRIXN to line MSA (Ms/Sn_A_So) : it performs AUG assembly, AU–4 pointer generation, AU–AIS generation. MST (MSn_TT_So) : it performs BIP–24 calculation and insertion, MS–REI MS–RDI and MS–AIS insertion. RST (RSn_TT_So) : it performs frame alignment insertion, regenerator section path trace insertion, BIP–8 calculation and insertion. SOH BYTE insertion (Tx side): DCC bytes (DCCR D1–D3 and DCCM D4–D12) coming from the DCC frames are inserted into the SOH section. SPI (OSn/RSn_A_So) :it scramblers the outgoing signals and insert AIS in alarm condition.
HPT, LPT and LPA blocks Two data stream at frequency of 622 MHz are connected to the block called SWITCH in Figure 258. on page 471, one coming from HPC matrix ( L link) and one from LPC matrix (X link). Rx side: from matrix on MATRIXN to LPA or HPT The task of the SWITCH block is to select one of the two busses coming from the matrices according to the type of signal to be connected ( L if is structured or X if unstructured). If the signal is structured the incoming signal (L Link) is sent through the SWITCH to the LPT and LPA block.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
•
ED
LPT (S12_TT_Sk): The LPT function terminates and processes the POH to determine the status of the defined path attributes. • J2: trail trace identifier is recovered ––> TIM detection. • V5[1,2]: BIP–2 is recovered ––> Ex–BER, Signal Degrade alarm • V5[3]: REI bit is recovered and the derived performance primitives is reported. • V5[8]: RDI information is recovered and reported. • AIS or SSF detection ––> SSF alarm
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
466 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Rx side : from line to MSP matrix on the MATRIXN board
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
•
LPA (S12/P12x_A_Sk): It extracts the VC12–POH and processes the TU12 pointer. • V5[5–7]: Signal label detection in the byte V5[5–7] ––> Signal label Mismatch detection • AIS or SSF is applied if Signal label Mismatch is detected
If the signal is unstructured the incoming signal (L Link) is sent through the SWITCH to the HPT block. HPT (Sn_TT_Sk) : path trace information is recovered, REI information is recovered, HP–RDI and UNEQ are detected, VC4 BIP–8 errored count block. TSF is applied if SSF or UNEQ or TIM or AIS is detected. TSD is applied if a condition of signal degrade is detected. N1 byte extraction (Rx side): for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM).
Tx side: from LPA or HPT to matrix on MATRIXN The task of the SWITCH block is to sent the signal coming from HPT or LPT block towards the matrices on the MATRIXN. The selection is made according to the type of signal to be connected ( L if is structured or X if unstructured). If the signal is structured the datas coming from ATM MAPPING block are sent through the LPT and LPA blocks towards the SWITCH block. •
LPA (S12/P12x_A_So) : This block adapts user data for transport in the synchronous domain. For asynchronous user data, lower order path adaptation involves bit justification. The 2.048 Mbit/s is inserted into a C–12 container (by means of asynchronous mapping), which is synchronized (stuffing) with the correspondent TU–12. • V5[5–7]: Signal label insertion in the byte V5[5–7].
•
LPT (S12_TT_So) : The LPT function creates a VC–12 by generating and adding POH to a C–12. The POH formats are defined in Recommendations G.708 and G.709. • J2: trail trace identifier is generated. • V5[1,2]: BIP–2 is calculated and transmitted. • V5[3]: the number of errors is encoded in REI. • V5[8]: RDI indication is inserted.
If the signal is unstructured the datas coming from ATM MAPPING block are sent through the HPT block to the SWITCH block. HPT (Sn_TT_So) : path trace identification insertion, RDI and REI indications insertion, VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion, signal label insertion. N1 byte insertion (Tx side): for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM).
HPOM, HSUT BLOCK (HSUT is not operative in this release) HPOM performs the monitoring of an equipped path while HSUT performs the termination of an unequipped path. 1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
From HPOM and HSUT are recovered : • •
the primitives used for Performance Monitoring (Errored block count, Defect seconds) switching criteria for SNCP/N protection
The two functions are alternative.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
467 / 636
Snm_TT_Sk : signal termination , J1 path recovering , REI information recovering, HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring) , UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring), VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count. TSF is generated in case of SSF , UNEQ, TIM , AIS . TSD is generated in case of SD. HSUT (Higher order Supervisory Unequipped termination) Sns_TT_Sk : path trace information recovery, REI recovery, HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring), UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring), VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count. Sns_TT_So : generation of an unequipped container , ”unequipped” insertion, trail trace identifier generation, RDI and /or REI information generation, VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion.
[2] ATM signal processing
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
RX side from SDH to MATRIX: –
ATM DEMAPPING: this block extract the ATM cells from the transmission path payload E1, E3, VC3, VC4, VC4c; ATM DEMAPPING BLOCK receive the E1 and E3 frames contained in VC3 and VC4 payload for the processing performed in the equipment boards.
–
CELL DELINEATION : cell delineation is the process which allow the identification of the cell boundaries. It is performed on the cell stream extracted from the PDH/SDH frames
–
DESCRAMBLER:for SDH and PDH the information field of each cell is descrambled with a self synchronizing scrambler polynomial; descrambler is enable for a number of bit s equal to the length of the information field, and again disabled for the following assumed header.
–
HEC VERIFICATION AND CORRECTION: in this block HEC field in the cell header is checked; HEC is used to achieved cell delineation. The algorithm used can recover a single–bit error or detect headers with single and multi–bit errors.
–
CELLs DECOUPLING: idle cells are extracted from the cell stream. Idle cells has been inserted in the far end adaptation source function to reach the synchronous container capacity.
–
HEADER VERIFICATION: this function verifies that the first four octets of the ATM cell header are recognizable as being a valid header pattern. Cells with unrecognized header patterns are discarded. An indication of invalid header cell discard event is provided to the microprocessor interface where are counted.
–
UPC/NPC:this function (policing) checks that the incoming traffic from a VPC is not violating the agreed traffic contract. UPC (User Parameter Control) and NPC (Network Parameter Control) perform the same function but in different parts of the network (respectively at User Network Interface and Network Node Interface )
–
OAM: operations and maintenance function is done by using dedicated cells. Typically function are cells monitoring, cells reporting, faults localization etc.
–
HEADER TRANSLATION: this block performs on each virtual connection an header translation which consist in a conversion of the external identification number (LTI/VPI/VCI) into an an internal identification number for the user to network direction
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
468 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
HPOM (Higher order path overhead monitoring)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT is the block that in the event of congestion is responsible to assure that cell with loss priority will be discarded before than cell with high priority.
–
TRAFFIC SHAPING:this function enhances the utilization of the buffer and matrix providing better switch performance, especially for burst data.
TX side from MATRIX to SDH: –
RATE REDUCTION: The purpose of this block is to smooth the average 622 Mbits/s traffic entering with bursts up to 1,2 Gb/s. This function uses four waiting queues, called Rate Reduction FIFOs, used to manage four priority levels fixed on a per connection basis. They are written at 1,2 Gbits/s and read at 622 Mbits/s.
–
MULTICAST: it is a replication function of the incoming cell towards n outgoing directions; a new connection identifier is used for each replication.
–
ROUTING:The purpose of this function is to guide the cells towards their target LT
–
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT: is the block that in the event of congestion is responsible to assure that cell with loss priority will be discarded before than cell with high priority.
–
TRAFFIC SHAPING: the traffic shaping function modifies the characteristics of cells stream in a VCP in order to improve network efficiency. It allows for meeting traffic contract at the egress of the equipment. The shaping function can correct the Cell Delay Variation generated by the buffer and the matrix.
–
HEADER TRANSLATION:this block performs on each virtual connection an header translation which consist in a conversion of the internal identification number into the external identification number (LTI/VPI/VCI)for the network to user direction.
–
OAM:operations and maintenance function is done by using dedicated cells.
–
CELLs RATE DECOUPLING: idle cells are inserted into cell stream to match the rate of the container.
–
HEC PROCESSING: the Header Error Control value is calculated on the entire ATM cell header and inserted in the appropriate field.
–
SCRAMBLER: information field of each cell is scrambled in order to improve security and robustness of the HEC cell delineation mechanism. In addition it helps randomizing the data in the information field for possible improvement of the transmission performance.
–
ATM MAPPING: the cell stream is inserted into transmission path payload E1, E3, VC3, VC4, VC4c; the E1 and E3 frames are sent to the output of the board mapped in VC12 and VC3 payload because of the processing that will be done in the equipment boards.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
469 / 636
The matrix is in charged of cross connect the incoming and outgoing cells according to the information received by the microprocessor. In case of Soft Permanent Virtual Connection ( Soft–PVC) the P–NNI signalling is supported. [4] MICROPROCESSOR The microprocessor present on the board performs the following functionality: –
configuration, alarm and status gathering of the ATM devices present on the board
–
handling of the signalling packet receive from the matrix in case of Soft–PVC
–
communication with the EC on the EQUICO (SNMP Link); using this channel performance and management date are encapsulated and sent to the EC and from there to the Craft Terminal or O.S.
All the LEDS (except that for Unit–Failure) are driven by the microprocessor. The meaning of the LEDs and Push–Button is reported in Figure 258. on page 471. [5] Common part •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” stream, to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 Vdc supply by CONGI boards.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure. DC/DC CONVERTERS Starting from the 48/60 V power supply the following voltages are generated:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
– –
ED
+ 5 Vdc used by the optical module +1.5 Vdc, –3.3 Vdc, –3.3 Vdc, –3.3 Vdc, +2.5 Vdc used to supply all the components in the board.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
470 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[3] MATRIX
System clock a System clock b
HPOM HSUT(*)
MODULE STM–1 (D+CK)
H
LOS
MST
MSA HPT
622 MHz OSC
DCCR RSOH
ÉÉ ÉÉ ÉÉ
DCCM MSOH from/to
LPT
CELLs RATE DECOUPLING
HEADER VERIFICATION
HEC PROCESSING
OAM
HEADER TRANSLATION
OAM
HEADER TRANSLATION
ÉÉ ÉÉ ÉÉ
Struct/unstruct
ATM MAPPING
HEC VERIFICATION DESCRAMBLER & CORRECTION
CELLs DECOUPLING
UPC/NPC
SCRAMBLER
CELL DELINEATION
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT
TRAFFIC SHAPING
ÉÉÉÉ É ÉÉ
S W I T C H
ATM DEMAPPING
TRAFFIC SHAPING
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT
X
SPATIAL MATRIX
ROUTING
RATE REDUCTION
MULTICAST
SDRAM FLASH EPROM
LEDS(X5)
PNNI Signalling
LED TEST RESET
L
LPA
Struct/unstruct
ÉÉÉÉ ÉÉÉÉ É
MICROPROCESSOR
SNMP
Configuration & Status (ATM)
Management Bus M–BUS Driver
Configuration & Status (SDH)
CMISS Bus–OFF Remote Inventory
– 3.3V 3.3 V
DC/DC
Unit Failure
RIBUS RIBUS I/F
CONVERTERS
F
+3.3 Vdc
48/60 V
2.5 V 1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ID
FROM CONGI
5V 1.5 V
ATM MATRIX 4X4
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
RST
from/to EQUICO
I/O
from/to SERVICE
from/to
E/O
AUX
SOH bytes
RSOH, MSOH, F2, F3
LASER D. LASER F. LASER OFF
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
L I N E
ÉÉÉÉ ÉÉÉÉ ÉÉÉÉ ÉÉÉÉ ÉÉÉÉ ÉÉÉÉ
Figure 258. ATM 4X4 card – Block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
471 / 636
The functional description of the board is similar to ISA ATM4X4V2 (refer to paragraph 4.30); the only differences between the two boards is the number of TPs managed. As a matter of fact ATM4X4D3 board can manage up to 16 TPs among E1, E3, VC12, VC3, VC4, T3, E1 IMA group.
4.30 ISA – ATM MATRIX 4X4 ENHANCED (ATM4X4V2) (See Figure 259. on page and 477 ) This unit realize an ATM switching matrix with a total bandwidth of 622Mbit/s. The board is able to manage up to 252 LT where LT is a physical or logical channel where is mapped an ATM flow (E1, E3, VC12, VC3, VC4, T3, E1 IMA group) On the board a local STM–1 access carrying an unstructured VC4 is managed. The card perform the following functions: [1]
SDH signal processing
[2]
ATM signal processing
[3]
MATRIX
[4]
MICROPROCESSOR
[5]
Common part
[1] SDH signal processing The SDH functions required are:
–
HPT, LPT and LPA. SOH bytes
Cross connection functions (MSP, HPC and LPC) are performed by the matrices present on the two MATRIXN board (working in 1+1 configuration). The MSA block is connected to the MATRIXN boards (main and spare) through 1+1 bidirectional links at 622 Mbit/s , STM–4 equivalent capacity.
HPT, LPT and LPA blocks Two data stream at frequency of 622 MHz are connected to the block called SWITCH in Figure 258. on page 471, one coming from HPC matrix ( H link) and one from LPC matrix (L link). Rx side: from matrix on MATRIXN to LPA or HPT
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The task of the SWITCH block is to select one of the two busses coming from the matrices according to the type of signal to be connected ( L if is structured or H if unstructured). If the signal is structured the incoming signal (L Link) is sent through the SWITCH to the LPT and LPA block.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
472 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
4.29 ISA – ATM MATRIX 4X4 ENHANCED (ATM4X4D3)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
•
LPT (S12_TT_Sk): The LPT function terminates and processes the POH to determine the status of the defined path attributes. • J2: trail trace identifier is recovered ––> TIM detection. • V5[1,2]: BIP–2 is recovered ––> Ex–BER, Signal Degrade alarm • V5[3]: REI bit is recovered and the derived performance primitives is reported. • V5[8]: RDI information is recovered and reported. • AIS or SSF detection ––> SSF alarm
•
LPA (S12/P12x_A_Sk): It extracts the VC12–POH and processes the TU12 pointer. • V5[5–7]: Signal label detection in the byte V5[5–7] ––> Signal label Mismatch detection • AIS or SSF is applied if Signal label Mismatch is detected
If the signal is unstructured the incoming signal (H Link) is sent through the SWITCH to the HPT block. HPT (Sn_TT_Sk) : path trace information is recovered, REI information is recovered, HP–RDI and UNEQ are detected, VC4 BIP–8 errored count block. TSF is applied if SSF or UNEQ or TIM or AIS is detected. TSD is applied if a condition of signal degrade is detected. N1 byte extraction (Rx side): for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM).
Tx side: from LPA or HPT to matrix on MATRIXN The task of the SWITCH block is to sent the signal coming from HPT or LPT block towards the matrices on the MATRIXN. The selection is made according to the type of signal to be connected ( L if is structured or H if unstructured). If the signal is structured the datas coming from ATM MAPPING block are sent through the LPT and LPA blocks towards the SWITCH block. •
LPA (S12/P12x_A_So) : This block adapts user data for transport in the synchronous domain. For asynchronous user data, lower order path adaptation involves bit justification. The 2.048 Mbit/s is inserted into a C–12 container (by means of asynchronous mapping), which is synchronized (stuffing) with the correspondent TU–12. • V5[5–7]: Signal label insertion in the byte V5[5–7].
•
LPT (S12_TT_So) : The LPT function creates a VC–12 by generating and adding POH to a C–12. The POH formats are defined in Recommendations G.708 and G.709. • J2: trail trace identifier is generated. • V5[1,2]: BIP–2 is calculated and transmitted. • V5[3]: the number of errors is encoded in REI. • V5[8]: RDI indication is inserted.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
If the signal is unstructured the datas coming from ATM MAPPING block are sent through the HPT block to the SWITCH block. HPT (Sn_TT_So) : path trace identification insertion, RDI and REI indications insertion, VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion, signal label insertion. N1 byte insertion (Tx side): for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
473 / 636
HPOM performs the monitoring of an equipped path while HSUT performs the termination of an unequipped path. From HPOM and HSUT are recovered : • •
the primitives used for Performance Monitoring (Errored block count, Defect seconds) switching criteria for SNCP/N protection
The two functions are alternative. HPOM (Higher order path overhead monitoring) Snm_TT_Sk : signal termination , J1 path recovering , REI information recovering, HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring) , UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring), VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count. TSF is generated in case of SSF , UNEQ, TIM , AIS . TSD is generated in case of SD. HSUT (Higher order Supervisory Unequipped termination) Sns_TT_Sk : path trace information recovery, REI recovery, HP–RDI detection (path status monitoring), UNEQ and VC–AIS detection (signal label monitoring), VC4 BIP–8 Errored Block count. Sns_TT_So : generation of an unequipped container , ”unequipped” insertion, trail trace identifier generation, RDI and /or REI information generation, VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion.
[2] ATM signal processing
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
RX side from SDH to MATRIX: –
ATM DEMAPPING: this block extract the ATM cells from the transmission path payload E1, E3, T3, VC3, VC4, VC4c; ATM DEMAPPING BLOCK receive the E1 and E3/T3 frames contained in VC3 and VC4 payload for the processing performed in the equipment boards.
–
CELL DELINEATION : cell delineation is the process which allow the identification of the cell boundaries. It is performed on the cell stream extracted from the PDH/SDH frames
–
DESCRAMBLER:for SDH and PDH the information field of each cell is descrambled with a self synchronizing scrambler polynomial; descrambler is enable for a number of bit s equal to the length of the information field, and again disabled for the following assumed header.
–
HEC VERIFICATION AND CORRECTION: in this block HEC field in the cell header is checked; HEC is used to achieved cell delineation. The algorithm used can recover a single–bit error or detect headers with single and multi–bit errors.
–
CELLs DECOUPLING: idle cells are extracted from the cell stream. Idle cells has been inserted in the far end adaptation source function to reach the synchronous container capacity.
–
IMA (Inverse Multiplexing over ATM) RX: NxE1 stream are bundled in a single high speed cell stream; E1 stream are collected in a cyclical fashion among physical links preserving sequence( for details on IMA refer to AF–PHY–0086.001).
–
HEADER VERIFICATION: this function verifies that the first four octets of the ATM cell header are recognizable as being a valid header pattern. Cells with unrecognized header patterns are discarded. An indication of invalid header cell discard event is provided to the microprocessor interface where are counted.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
474 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
HPOM, HSUT BLOCK (HSUT is not operative in this release)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
UPC/NPC:this function (policing) checks that the incoming traffic from a VPC is not violating the agreed traffic contract. UPC (User Parameter Control) and NPC (Network Parameter Control) perform the same function but in different parts of the network (respectively at User Network Interface and Network Node Interface )
–
OAM: operations and maintenance function is done by using dedicated cells. Typically function are cells monitoring, cells reporting, faults localization etc.
–
HEADER TRANSLATION: this block performs on each virtual connection an header translation which consist in a conversion of the external identification number (LTI/VPI/VCI) into an an internal identification number for the user to network direction
–
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT is the block that in the event of congestion is responsible to assure that cell with loss priority will be discarded before than cell with high priority.
–
TRAFFIC SHAPING:this function enhances the utilization of the buffer and matrix providing better switch performance, especially for burst data.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
TX side from MATRIX to SDH: –
RATE REDUCTION: The purpose of this block is to smooth the average 622 Mbits/s traffic entering with bursts up to 1,2 Gb/s. This function uses four waiting queues, called Rate Reduction FIFOs, used to manage four priority levels fixed on a per connection basis. They are written at 1,2 Gbits/s and read at 622 Mbits/s.
–
MULTICAST: it is a replication function of the incoming cell towards n outgoing directions; a new connection identifier is used for each replication (not operative in current release).
–
ROUTING:The purpose of this function is to guide the cells towards their target LT
–
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT: is the block that in the event of congestion is responsible to assure that cell with loss priority will be discarded before than cell with high priority.
–
TRAFFIC SHAPING: the traffic shaping function modifies the characteristics of cells stream in a VCP in order to improve network efficiency. It allows for meeting traffic contract at the egress of the equipment. The shaping function can correct the Cell Delay Variation generated by the buffer and the matrix.
–
HEADER TRANSLATION:this block performs on each virtual connection an header translation which consist in a conversion of the internal identification number into the external identification number (LTI/VPI/VCI)for the network to user direction.
–
OAM:operations and maintenance function is done by using dedicated cells.
–
CELLs RATE DECOUPLING: idle cells are inserted into cell stream to match the rate of the container.
–
IMA (Inverse Multiplexing over ATM) TX: high speed stream of ATM cells is broken up in the multiple E1 links( for details on IMA refer to AF–PHY–0086.001)
–
HEC PROCESSING: the Header Error Control value is calculated on the entire ATM cell header and inserted in the appropriate field.
–
SCRAMBLER: information field of each cell is scrambled in order to improve security and robustness of the HEC cell delineation mechanism. In addition it helps randomizing the data in the information field for possible improvement of the transmission performance.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
475 / 636
ATM MAPPING: the cell stream is inserted into transmission path payload E1, E3, VC3, VC4, VC4c; the E1 and E3 and T3 frames are sent to the output of the board mapped in VC12 and VC3 payload because of the processing that will be done in the equipment boards.
[3] MATRIX The matrix is in charged of cross connect the incoming and outgoing cells according to the information received by the microprocessor. In case of Soft Permanent Virtual Connection ( Soft–PVC) the P–NNI signalling is supported. [4] MICROPROCESSOR The microprocessor present on the board performs the following functionality: –
configuration, alarm and status gathering of the ATM devices present on the board
–
handling of the signalling packet receive from the matrix in case of Soft–PVC
–
communication with the EC on the EQUICO (SNMP Link); using this channel performance and management date are encapsulated and sent to the EC and from there to the Craft Terminal or O.S.
All the LEDS (except that for Unit–Failure) are driven by the microprocessor. The meaning of the LEDs and Push–Button is reported in Figure 258. on page 471. [5] Common part •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” stream, to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 Vdc supply by CONGI boards.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure. DC/DC CONVERTERS Starting from the 48/60 V power supply the following voltages are generated:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
–
ED
+1.5 Vdc, +3.3 Vdc, , +2.5 Vdc used to supply all the components in the board.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
476 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
ICP CELL
CELL STREAM
GENERATION
INSERTION
SPLITTING
IMA TX
HPT
É ÉÉÉ
LPT
CELLs RATE DECOUPLING
HEADER VERIFICATION
HEC PROCESSING
CELLs DECOUPLING
SCRAMBLER
L
LPA
Struct/unstruct
Struct/unstruct
ATM MAPPING
HEC VERIFICATION DESCRAMBLER & CORRECTION
CELL DELINEATION
S W I T C H
ATM DEMAPPING
from/to
IMA FRAME
INSERTION
H
IMA RX
UPC/NPC
OAM
HEADER TRANSLATION
OAM
HEADER TRANSLATION
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT TRAFFIC SHAPING
SPATIAL MATRIX
TRAFFIC SHAPING
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
FILLING CELL
622 MHz OSC
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
IMA TX
ROUTING
RATE REDUCTION
MULTICAST
IMA RX FILLING CELL
INVALID CELL
ICP CELL
IMA
CELL STREAM
DISCARD
DISCARD
REMOVE
SYNC
RECONSTUCTION
SDRAM FLASH EPROM
LEDS(X5)
Configuration & Status (ATM)
from/to EQUICO
ÉÉÉÉ ÉÉÉÉ É
SNMP
Management Bus from/to
M–BUS Driver
Configuration & Status (SDH)
CMISS Bus–OFF Remote Inventory
– 3.3V
ATM MATRIX 4X4
3.3 V
DC/DC
Unit Failure
RIBUS I/F
CONVERTERS
F
+3.3 Vdc
48/60 V
2.5 V 1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ID
FROM CONGI
5V 1.5 V
RIBUS
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
RESET
PNNI Signalling
MICROPROCESSOR
LED TEST
Figure 259. ATM4X4V2 and ATM4X4D3 card – Block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
477 / 636
4.31 ISA – ATM MATRIX 8X8 (ATM8X8)
This unit realize an ATM switching matrix with a total bandwidth of 1.2 Gbit/s. As a matter of fact the unit is two slot wide and it is connected with the SDH Matrix (MATRIXN) through two link at 622 Mbit/s. The block diagram of the board has been been divided in two part depicted in Figure 260. on page 483 and Figure 261. on page 484; the part A describe the common part (microprocessor, led, DC/DC converter) and the signal processing (ATM and SDH) of the first 622Mbit/s link, the part B describe the signal processing (ATM and SDH) of the second 622Mbit/s link. The board is able to manage up to 32 LT where LT is a physical or logical channel where is mapped an ATM flow (E1, E3, VC12, VC3, VC4 and VC4–4c). The card perform the following function: [1]
SDH signal processing
[2]
ATM signal processing
[3]
MATRIX
[4]
MICROPROCESSOR
[5]
Common part
[1] SDH signal processing The SDH functions are: –
HPT
–
LPT and LPA.
Cross connection functions (MSP, HPC and LPC) are performed by the matrices present on the two MATRIXN board (working in 1+1 configuration). HPT, LPT and LPA blocks Two data stream at frequency of 622 MHz are connected to the block called SWITCH in Figure 260. on page 483 , one coming from HPC matrix ( L link) and one from LPC matrix (X link); the same description can be applied to Figure 261. on page 484 that depict the part B of the board. Rx side: from matrix on MATRIXN to LPA or HPT The task of the SWITCH block is to select one of the two busses coming from the matrices according to the type of signal to be connected ( L if is structured or X if unstructured). If the signal is structured the incoming signal (L Link) is sent through the SWITCH to the LPT and LPA block.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
•
ED
LPT (S12_TT_Sk): The LPT function terminates and processes the POH to determine the status of the defined path attributes. • J2: trail trace identifier is recovered ––> TIM detection. • V5[1,2]: BIP–2 is recovered ––> Ex–BER, Signal Degrade alarm • V5[3]: REI bit is recovered and the derived performance primitives is reported. • V5[8]: RDI information is recovered and reported. • AIS or SSF detection ––> SSF alarm 02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
478 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 260. on page 483 and Figure 261. on page 484)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
•
LPA (S12/P12x_A_Sk): It extracts the VC12–POH and processes the TU12 pointer. • V5[5–7]: Signal label detection in the byte V5[5–7] ––> Signal label Mismatch detection • AIS or SSF is applied if Signal label Mismatch is detected
If the signal is unstructured the incoming signal (L Link) is sent through the SWITCH to the HPT block. HPT (Sn_TT_Sk) : path trace information is recovered, REI information is recovered, HP–RDI and UNEQ are detected, VC4 BIP–8 errored count block. TSF is applied if SSF or UNEQ or TIM or AIS is detected. TSD is applied if a condition of signal degrade is detected. N1 byte extraction (Rx side): for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM).
Tx side: from LPA or HPT to matrix on MATRIXN The task of the SWITCH block is to sent the signal coming from HPT or LPT block towards the matrices on the MATRIXN. The selection is made according to the type of signal to be connected ( L if is structured or X if unstructured). If the signal is structured the datas coming from ATM MAPPING block are sent through the LPT and LPA blocks towards the SWITCH block. •
LPA (S12/P12x_A_So) : This block adapts user data for transport in the synchronous domain. For asynchronous user data, lower order path adaptation involves bit justification. The 2.048 Mbit/s is inserted into a C–12 container (by means of asynchronous mapping), which is synchronized (stuffing) with the correspondent TU–12. • V5[5–7]: Signal label insertion in the byte V5[5–7].
•
LPT (S12_TT_So) : The LPT function creates a VC–12 by generating and adding POH to a C–12. The POH formats are defined in Recommendations G.708 and G.709. • J2: trail trace identifier is generated. • V5[1,2]: BIP–2 is calculated and transmitted. • V5[3]: the number of errors is encoded in REI. • V5[8]: RDI indication is inserted.
If the signal is unstructured the datas coming from ATM MAPPING block are sent through the HPT block to the SWITCH block.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
HPT (Sn_TT_So) : path trace identification insertion, RDI and REI indications insertion, VC–4 BIP–8 calculation and insertion, signal label insertion. N1 byte insertion (Tx side): for the network Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring function (TCT/TCM).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
479 / 636
N.B.
The description that follows can be applied to both Figure 260. on page 483 and Figure 261. on page 484
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
RX side from SDH to MATRIX: –
ATM DEMAPPING: this block extract the ATM cells from the transmission path payload E1, E3, VC3, VC4, VC4c; ATM DEMAPPING BLOCK receive the E1 and E3 frames contained in VC3 and VC4 payload for the processing performed in the equipment boards.
–
CELL DELINEATION : cell delineation is the process which allow the identification of the cell boundaries. It is performed on the cell stream extracted from the PDH/SDH frames
–
DESCRAMBLER:for SDH and PDH the information field of each cell is descrambled with a self synchronizing scrambler polynomial; descrambler is enable for a number of bit s equal to the length of the information field, and again disabled for the following assumed header.
–
HEC VERIFICATION AND CORRECTION: in this block HEC field in the cell header is checked; HEC is used to achieved cell delineation. The algorithm used can recover a single–bit error or detect headers with single and multi–bit errors.
–
CELLs DECOUPLING: idle cells are extracted from the cell stream. Idle cells has been inserted in the far end adaptation source function to reach the synchronous container capacity.
–
HEADER VERIFICATION: this function verifies that the first four octets of the ATM cell header are recognizable as being a valid header pattern. Cells with unrecognized header patterns are discarded. An indication of invalid header cell discard event is provided to the microprocessor interface where are counted.
–
UPC/NPC:this function (policing) checks that the incoming traffic from a VPC is not violating the agreed traffic contract. UPC (User Parameter Control) and NPC (Network Parameter Control) perform the same function but in different parts of the network (respectively at User Network Interface and Network Node Interface )
–
OAM: operations and maintenance function is done by using dedicated cells. Typically function are cells monitoring, cells reporting, faults localization etc.
–
HEADER TRANSLATION: this block performs on each virtual connection an header translation which consist in a conversion of the external identification number (LTI/VPI/VCI) into an an internal identification number for the user to network direction
–
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT is the block that in the event of congestion is responsible to assure that cell with loss priority will be discarded before than cell with high priority.
–
TRAFFIC SHAPING:this function enhances the utilization of the buffer and matrix providing better switch performance, especially for burst data.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
480 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[2] ATM signal processing
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
TX side from MATRIX to SDH: –
RATE REDUCTION: The purpose of this block is to smooth the average 622 Mbits/s traffic entering with bursts up to 1,2 Gb/s. This function uses four waiting queues, called Rate Reduction FIFOs, used to manage four priority levels fixed on a per connection basis. They are written at 1,2 Gbits/s and read at 622 Mbits/s.
–
MULTICAST: it is a replication function of the incoming cell towards n outgoing directions; a new connection identifier is used for each replication.
–
ROUTING:The purpose of this function is to guide the cells towards their target LT
–
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT: is the block that in the event of congestion is responsible to assure that cell with loss priority will be discarded before than cell with high priority.
–
TRAFFIC SHAPING: the traffic shaping function modifies the characteristics of cells stream in a VCP in order to improve network efficiency. It allows for meeting traffic contract at the egress of the equipment. The shaping function can correct the Cell Delay Variation generated by the buffer and the matrix.
–
HEADER TRANSLATION:this block performs on each virtual connection an header translation which consist in a conversion of the internal identification number into the external identification number (LTI/VPI/VCI)for the network to user direction.
–
OAM:operations and maintenance function is done by using dedicated cells.
–
CELLs RATE DECOUPLING: idle cells are inserted into cell stream to match the rate of the container.
–
HEC PROCESSING: the Header Error Control value is calculated on the entire ATM cell header and inserted in the appropriate field.
–
SCRAMBLER: information field of each cell is scrambled in order to improve security and robustness of the HEC cell delineation mechanism. In addition it helps randomizing the data in the information field for possible improvement of the transmission performance.
–
ATM MAPPING: the cell stream is inserted into transmission path payload E1, E3, VC3, VC4, VC4c; the E1 and E3 frames are sent to the output of the board mapped in VC12 and VC3 payload because of the processing that will be done in the equipment boards.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
481 / 636
The matrix is in charged of cross connect the incoming and outgoing cells according to the information received by the microprocessor. In case of Soft Permanent Virtual Connection ( Soft–PVC) the P–NNI signalling is supported. [4] MICROPROCESSOR The microprocessor present on the board performs the following functionality: –
configuration, alarm and status gathering of the ATM devices present on the board
–
handling of the signalling packet receive from the matrix in case of Soft–PVC
–
communication with the EC on the EQUICO (SNMP Link); using this channel performance and management date are encapsulated and sent to the EC and from there to the Craft Terminal or O.S.
All the LEDS (except that for Unit–Failure) are driven by the microprocessor. The meaning of the LEDs and Push–Button is reported in Figure 258. on page 471. [5] Common part •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” stream, to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 Vdc supply by CONGI boards.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure. DC/DC CONVERTERS Starting from the 48/60 V power supply the following voltages are generated:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
– –
ED
+ 5 Vdc used by the optical module +1.5 Vdc, –3.3 Vdc, –3.3 Vdc, –3.3 Vdc, +2.5 Vdc used to supply all the components in the board.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
482 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[3] MATRIX
System clock a
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
System clock b
622 MHz OSC
LPT from/to
ÉÉ ÉÉ HEADER VERIFICATION
UPC/NPC
HEC PROCESSING
CELLs DECOUPLING
OAM
SCRAMBLER
HEC VERIFICATION DESCRAMBLER & CORRECTION
HEADER TRANSLATION
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT
HEADER TRANSLATION
ÉÉ ÉÉÉ ÉÉÉÉÉÉÉÉ É ÉÉÉÉÉÉÉÉ É É
OAM
Struct/unstruct
ATM MAPPING
TRAFFIC SHAPING
CELL DELINEATION
MULTICAST
ATM DEMAPPING
TRAFFIC SHAPING
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT
S W I T C H
X
ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ SPATIAL MATRIX
ROUTING
RATE REDUCTION
SDRAM
PNNI Signalling
ÉÉ
FLASH EPROM
LEDS(X5) LED TEST
ÉÉ ÉÉ ÉÉ É ÉÉÉÉÉ ÉÉ ÉÉ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ
MICROPROCESSOR
RESET
Configuration & Status (ATM)
See Figure 261. on page 484
SNMP
from/to EQUICO
CELLs RATE DECOUPLING
L
LPA
Struct/unstruct
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
HPT
Management Bus from/to
M–BUS Driver
Configuration & Status (SDH)
CMISS Bus–OFF Remote Inventory
– 3.3V
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ATM MATRIX 8x8 (part A)
3.3 V
DC/DC
Unit Failure
RIBUS I/F
CONVERTERS
ID F
+3.3 Vdc
48/60 V
2.5 V
FROM CONGI
5V 1.5 V
RIBUS
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
See Figure 261. on page 484
Figure 260. ATM 8X8 card – Block diagram part A
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
483 / 636
622 MHz OSC
LPT from/to
ÉÉ ÉÉ CELLs RATE DECOUPLING
HEADER VERIFICATION
HEC PROCESSING
CELLs DECOUPLING
UPC/NPC
ÉÉ ÉÉÉ ÉÉ
SCRAMBLER
OAM
HEADER TRANSLATION
OAM
HEADER TRANSLATION
Struct/unstruct
ATM MAPPING
HEC VERIFICATION DESCRAMBLER & CORRECTION
CELL DELINEATION
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT
TRAFFIC SHAPING
ÉÉ É ÉÉ ÉÉÉÉ É
L
LPA
Struct/unstruct
ATM DEMAPPING
X
TRAFFIC SHAPING
CONGESTION MANAGEMENT
MULTICAST
S W I T C H
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
HPT
ROUTING
RATE REDUCTION
ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÉÉÉÉ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ to /from
Configuration & Status (ATM)
SPATIAL MATRIX
See Figure 260. on page 483
Configuration & Status (SDH)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ATM MATRIX 8x8 (part B)
Figure 261. ATM 8X8 card – Block diagram part B
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
484 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
System clock a System clock b
4.32 ISA–Packet Ring Edge Aggregator Unit (PREA1GBE, PREA4ETH)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 263. on page 491.) There are two types of PR_EA: a)
in the first version (PREA4ETH), it hosts a 4 x 10/100 BaseT Fast Ethernet module and the total traffic throughput is 1 Gb/s, in which 622Mb/s are contributed by the SDH matrix, and 400 Mb/s contributed by the 4 Fast Ethernet local ports.
b)
in the second version (PREA1GBE), it hosts a 1 x 1Gigabit Ethernet module and the total traffic throughput is 1.8 Gb/s, in which 622Mb/s are contributed by the SDH matrix, and 1.25 Gb/s contributed by the GbEthernet local port.
The unit allows the management of packets data services over Ethernet and their transportation over the SDH network. The ethernet packets are labelled and then mapped onto SDH frames via PPP/HDLC framing. The ethernet access is possible either local and remote, this latter via GFP/SDH framing; ethernet links can be type E, FE, GE (10Mb/s, 100Mb/s, 1Gb/s). The SDH containers used for data transportation are VC–12, VC–3, VC–4. The MPLS traffic can be connected to 63 logical ports. The functions implemented on the board are the following: 4 x Ethernet Module (case of MPLS+4FE board): –
It implements four Ethernet transceiver interfaces, compliant to IEEE 802.3 standard, Carrier Sense Multiple Access with Collision Detection (CSMA/CD), that can be connected to Local Area Networks (LAN) conveying data packets over Ethernet. The interface type is 10/100Base–T, operating at rates 10 or 100Mb/s, using baseband communication on a twisted pair cable, connected by means of RJ45 connector. Its main functions are: • line isolation • operations auto–negotiation, about the following options: 10Mbps or 100Mbps, full–duplex • receive data and clock recovery, transmit pulse shaping • carrier sensing for collision detection • transmission conflicts management.
1 x GigaEthernet Module (case of MPLS+1GE board):
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
–
ED
It is a pluggable, small–form factor pluggable module (SFP), implementing the optical to electric conversion, and viceversa, to accomplish a full–duplex Gigabit Ethernet interface at 1.25 Gb/s, as specified in IEEE802.3. For its description refer to para. 4.16, page 411 (”Gbit Eth. i/f Module”).
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
485 / 636
–
SWITCH: The task of the SWITCH block is to send the signals coming from HPT or LPT block towards the matrices on the MATRIX unit. The selection is made according to the type of signal to be connected (L if it is structured, X if unstructured). The “L” signals are sent to LPT – LPA blocks, the “X” to the HPT.
–
HPT: this block adds/removes the high order POH bytes to the C–4 unstructured payloads (bulks).
–
LPT: The LPT function terminates a VC–12 or a VC–3 by adding or removing the relevant POH bytes to a C–12 or a C–3.
–
LPA: This block adapts the low order payloads C12 or C3 to the higher order containers used for transportation in the SDH (TU–12 or TU–3). The adaptation includes timing synchronization and frame offset with pointers movements.
–
Struct/Unstr: this selector sends the bulk signals (unstructured) to HPT, while the structured signals are sent to LPA–LPT.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Framing: –
PREAMBLE: it provides to remove (toward MPLS direction) the “preamble” and “start–of–frame–delimiter” fields from the ethernet MAC 802.3 header (Medium Access Control), and to reinsert them toward ethernet direction; then it recalculates the FCS value. ( Moreover it decodes the “Tag” fields of the MAC client header (if present): 802.1p and 802.1q, to read the user priority and the VLAN identifier. The in/out ethernet data are 2–bit paralleled at 50Mb/s in case of E or FE; 8–bit at 125 Mb/s in case of GE.
–
BUF: it is a buffer in which the ethernet data are written by means of a smooth ethernet clock, as they are ready, and are then read by the MPLS mapper (PUSH). In case that the buffer is near to full the mechanism of flow–control is started, in order to slow down the ethernet data source.
–
PUSH: it provides to “push in” the first label to the ethernet packet (the second label is pushed by the MPLS router), after having inspected the ethernet header, identified the destination and the class of service. It classifies the packets according to the 802.1p/q “VLAN–Tag” and “User Priority” fields, if configured. Depending on the type of decoded ethernet SLA (Service Level Agreement) the stream can be associated with one of three types of QoS (Quality of Service): Best Effort bandwidth (BE–BW), or Min–BW with regulated bursts, or Guaranteed constant BW.
–
POP: It provides to “pop out” the label from the packet, returning the bare ethernet frame.
–
GFP: it provides to deassemble (toward MPLS direction) the GFP frames (Generic Framing Procedure), removing the GFP header, and to assemble them toward SDH direction. It supports un–concatenated ethernet frames over unstructured VC4 payloads.
–
HDLC: it provides (refer to rec. RFC 1662 and RFC 2615): • to deassemble (MPLS direction) the HDLC frames (High–Level Data Link Control), removing the HDLC header, and to assemble them in SDH direction; • FCS calculation (Frame Check Sequence); • byte stuffing/destuffing: flag sequence or other header octets are encoded by a 2–octet sequence, in the data field, in order to avoid erroneous simulations of the header; • inter–frame filling, by means of the “flag–sequence” (hex 0x7e) repetition; • X^43 +1 data scrambling/descrambling.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
486 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
SDH termination:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
PPP: it provides to deassemble (in MPLS direction) the PPP frames (Point–to–Point Protocol), removing the PPP header, and to assemble them in SDH direction. It carries out, optionally, the “Martini encapsulation”, removing the FCS field from the ethernet frame and inserting a checksum value for the MPLS packet.
–
A: this block provides to adapt the serial bus from the back–panel bus format to the intra–board bus format, for SNMP messaging between the microprocessor and the EC (equipment controller), for MPLS network configuration.
–
SMAP: it provides, toward MPLS direction, to “unload” the data packets from the SDH frames, and to “load” them in SDH direction; the packets are then switched toward GFP or HDLC processing, according to the logical ports configurations.
MPLS Router: It performs the routing functions by looking the top MPLS label, it can forward the packets streams to up to 63 SDH or ethernet ports. In the MPLS network, it provides to inspect the top label of the MPLS packet in order to identify the incoming FEC and LSP; if possible, it aggregates the packet to other packets streams on a common path, then it selects the forwarding to a next hop by swapping the top label. At the edge of the MPLS network (originating node), on receiving packets from the local or remote ethernet interfaces, it provides to push the top label reporting information for the routing procedure (LSP and FEC). At the edge of the MPLS network (destination node), on receiving packets from the network, it provides to pop out the top label and drops them to the destination end port. At the beginning of a packets stream introduction, the microcontroller starts the RSVP–TE signalling (Resource Reservation Protocol – Traffic Engineered Tunnel) in order to search and establish a path with a certain band capacity and a given priority, between the destination and the source node; this path can be treated as a tunnel and is called LSP (Label Switched Path); once the LSP has been established, the RSVP signalling finishes and starts the Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) signalling, that informs all the nodes of the network to maintain the label bindings for the relevant established LSP. The RSVP and LDP signalling are in–band communications between the local and remote microcontrollers.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
487 / 636
–
It provides to monitor the load of traffic in the local router, and to take measures for preventing the congestions, supported by the intra–board microcontroller, such as: management of many different queues and relative priorities, packets queuing, packets discarding, packets lifetime management, etc. It implements, mainly, for this function, the following mechanisms: • 256 queues for each “logical” port (the logical ports number is 63) • scheduling, by means of HOL or WC–WFQ or WNC–WFQ methods • congestion avoidance via W–RED method (Weighed–Random Early Discarding): in occurrence of congestion conditions signals, a random packets discarding is started, in order to prevent the traffic worsening. • The priority management is based on the ethernet SLA (Service Level Agreement), by means of CIR and PIR values of the traffic contract. • Three types of QoS (Quality of Service) are available: Best Effort bandwidth (BE–BW), Min–BW with regulated bursts, Guaranteed constant BW. • A “Dual–Rate Leaky–Bucket” police mechanism is used (it can be seen as two cascaded leaky buckets, the first based on PIR value, the second on CIR). • In case of congestion, only the low priority traffic will be cut–off, while the high priority traffic maintains the guaranteed BW. • The Best–Effort traffic deployed in ring topology can be associated to a “Fixed Share” of the total available band, or to a “Variable&Proportional Share”. In case of congestion the BE excess traffic will be cut–off via W–RED. • Packets shorter than the minimum ethernet frame are silently discarded. Packets longer than the maximum frame are silently discarded. The discarded packets are counted by the PM function. • Note: the priority and the BW parameters are marked on the first label, at the “PUSH1” function of the ingress node.
Microprocessor:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
–
ED
It is a local microcontroller managing and supporting the MPLS functionalities, such as: The RSVP–TE and LDP communications between the destination and the origination nodes, in order to establish the routing and the LSP tunnelling. Management of communications with the EC and the network Operations System (OS), by means of SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) messaging, for MPLS network configuration. Configuration of the MPLS functions implemented by the devices on the board, by means of ICMP (Internet Control Message Protocol) messaging. Collection of alarms and status of the MPLS functions. Management of the Performance Monitoring (PM) function for MPLS. Management of Multicast traffic. Management of OSPF (Open Shortest Path First) routing (not operative). Furthermore it aids the congestion control function, supporting the “Queuing Manager” Communications with the EC, by means of the ISSB–EC bus, for software data transfer. It is provided with relevant SDRAM and Flash EPROM devices, for data and software storage.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
488 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Queuing management:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Other functions implemented on the board are: •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” serial stream, to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 VS supplied by the rear access panel.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details about Remote Inventory information).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the parallel Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure. DC/DC CONVERTERS This block converts the 48/60 V power supply, to obtain the voltages used to supply all the components in the board. The DC/DC converter is synchronized with a synchronization clock at 300 MHz (signal Power–Sync, generated by the SDH asic) in order to avoid EMI problems.
ED
•
LEDS and Push–buttons The board presents, on its front panel, some LEDS and push–buttons; the meaning of these LEDs and Push–Buttons is reported in Figure 47. page 136 and Figure 48. page 137.
•
Buses The main buses on the board are: SNMP: serial bus to carry SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) messages between the EC and the intra board controller, for information about MPLS network configuration. This link is implemented by means of the DCC–EC bus from EC on EQUICO unit. ISSB–EC: Intra–Shelf–Serial–Bus from the EC, to communicate software data (download, etc.). ISSB–SPARE: serial bus to the spare MPLS unit (if any) to communicate EPS information (. SDH–CS: from the EC, after derivation from the parallel “Management–bus” (M–bus), for configuration and status information of SDH components. MPLS–CS: from microprocessor, for configuration and status information of MPLS components, it conveys ICMP packets. RIBUS: serial bus from the SC (shelf controller on MATRIX unit), to communicate inventory and peripheral data. M–BUS: called also ISPB (Intra Shelf Parallel Bus), from the SC (shelf controller on MATRIX unit), to communicate data about asics configuration, SDH alarms collection, etc.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
489 / 636
HPOM HSUT RST
MST
AUX
System clock (T0)
MSA H
HPT DCCR RSOH
from/to MATRIX main and spare
DCCM MSOH LPT
SDH–CS 4 x FE 2@50Mb/s
SDH–CS X
LPA
PREAMBLE SMAP
GFP BUF PPP
HDLC
S W I T C H
HDLC PPP POP
L
A
MPLS–CS
MPLS ROUTER
MPLS–CS
SNMP
SNMP
SDRAM
MPLS–CS
FLASH EPROM
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ (EPS) ISSB–SPARE
Configuration & Status for MPLS (MPLS–CS)
MICROPROCESSOR RESTART
from/to SPARE MPLS UNIT
QUEUING MANAGEMENT
from/to EQUICO
PUSH PUSH
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ ISSB–EC
Management Bus (ISPB)
Configuration & Status for SDH (SDH–CS)
M–BUS Driver
from/to
POP
SMAP
Struct/unstruct GFP
CMISS Bus–OFF Remote Inventory
1.8 V DC/DC 3.3 V
CONVERTERS
Unit Failure
RIBUS RIBUS I/F
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
2.5 V
ID F
+3.3 Vdc
48/60 V
FROM CONGI
5V
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
10/100 Mb/s FAST ETHERNET
622 MHz OSC
from/to SERVICE
MPLS + 4 x FAST ETHERNET
Figure 262. MPLS+4FE Unit (PREA4ETH) – Block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
490 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
SOH bytes
RSOH, MSOH, F2, F3
MST
from/to SERVICE
System clock (T0)
MSA H
HPT DCCR RSOH
DCCM MSOH LPT
SDH–CS 8@125Mb/s
SDH–CS X
LPA
PREAMBLE SMAP
GFP BUF PPP
HDLC
S W I T C H
HDLC PPP POP
SMAP
Struct/unstruct GFP
L
A
MPLS–CS
SNMP SNMP
SDRAM
MPLS–CS
FLASH EPROM (EPS) ISSB–SPARE
from/to SPARE MPLS UNIT
MPLS–CS
MPLS ROUTER
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ
Configuration & Status for MPLS (MPLS–CS)
MICROPROCESSOR
ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ
RESTART
ISSB–EC
Management Bus (ISPB)
Configuration & Status for SDH (SDH–CS)
M–BUS Driver CMISS Bus–OFF Remote Inventory
5V 1.8 V DC/DC 3.3 V
CONVERTERS
Unit Failure
RIBUS RIBUS I/F
2.5 V
ID F
from/to MATRIX main and spare
QUEUING MANAGEMENT
from/to EQUICO
PUSH PUSH
+3.3 Vdc
48/60 V
FROM CONGI
1 x GBE
POP
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
from/to MATRIX main and spare
622 MHz OSC 1 GIGABIT ETHERNET I/O
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
HPOM HSUT RST
AUX
SOH bytes
RSOH, MSOH, F2, F3
MPLS + 1 x GIGABIT ETHERNET
Figure 263. MPLS+1GbE Unit (PREA1GBE) – Block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
491 / 636
The role of the ISA–PR functionality inside 1660SM is to provide a shared carrier–class Ethernet Packet Ring embedded either physically or logically into the SDH infrastructure, in a flexible manner over SDH Virtual Containers. The ISA–PR Packet Ring transports and aggregates Metro Ethernet traffic within a metro access or metro core SDH access ring/rings, all packet traffic is statistically multiplexed, with multiple Classes of Services and guaranteed QoS support (according to the defined SLA). The ISA–PR port card is used in conjunction with the 16FEA–PR and 2GBA–PR Access cards. These Access cards are described in para. 4.9 at page 390 and 4.10 at page 4.10 respectively. Functional Overview The diagram below shows the main functional blocks of the ISA–PR port card and interconnections to the access cards I2C bus
GigaBit Ethernet Access Card
RI GMII
RI
GMII
RI
RI
MII1
NP
RGGI
RGGI
AC (Access chip)
1GData
1GData
1GHOST
1G(Ser) 1G(Ser)
1G 1G 1G
1G
1G
RI Unit Led
BT–Stratix2
AC
1G(Ser) 1G(Ser)
1G(Ser)
1G(Ser)
Octal SerDes
GMII
Port Card
6G(in) HSI 4G(eg)
BU param SRAM Bu Policer/
CI Map SRAM
Stratix1 Channel Scheduler
RGGI
1GHost
GMII
Octal SerDes
Host
1G
Host
FE Access Card
NP
RGGI
Craft Terminal & NMS
MII16
Policer
BM–Stratix1
Channel Scheduler Table
PM param
Mac I/F
ATI 32 (2.4G) ADM – OC12/OC48 Stratix2 Utopia 32bits 2Phy(4)
EDC Daughter Board
Framer TADM Power
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Optical transceiver Modules
– Batt / Ground from Congi
STM4 line signals
Figure 264. PR unit functional block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
492 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
4.33 ISA – Packet Ring unit (ISA–PR)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The main functional blocks of the ISA–PR port card are as follows: •
Optical transceivers – Physical ring interfaces: STM–4.
•
Framer ADM – Provides the SDH framing.
•
ADM (Add Drop Multiplexer) – Extracts traffic to be dropped in this port card, and merges traffic received from the access cards with through traffic on the ring.
•
Bandwidth Management – This block incorporates SLA control & policing and buffer management. It is this block that determines the precedence and delay with which packets are forwarded to/from the ring.
•
Host – System controller responsible for the local management of the ISA–PR port card and access cards. The host communicates with the different elements of the ISA–PR series via dedicated control paths. Loss of a host card through a fault does not affect the delivery of customer traffic. The host card can communicate via one of two interfaces:
•
–
External Ethernet interface presented on the faceplate of the ISA–PR port card.
–
Internal Ethernet interface transported in the payload of the packet ring; used for in band communication between network elements and between network elements and the NMS.
EDC (Extended Differential Delay) – The EDC block is implemented on a daughter board. The block is essential to meet various SDH underlay Route Diversity scenarios (Route Diversity refers to SDH signal delivery across more than one fiber in parallel).
Data Path Access to Port The port card receives classified and edited frames from the Network Processor block on the access card. These incoming frames are presented to the bandwidth management block for processing. The bandwidth management block performs: Frame Policing and Marking (crucial component in providing MEF compliant services). Frame marking refers to the method whereby some frames may be marked for possible discard. Under congestion conditions only these frames will be considered for discard. Buffer Management, i.e. frame storage in memory in the proper order till it is forwarded. Scheduled frame forwarding to the various destinations subject to bandwidth availability, priorities, Load Balancing considerations etc. Note that all destinations are possible, i.e. Ring interfaces at the Trunk card, Ethernet interfaces at a Line card, any combination thereof. Buffer Management may discard frames in course of Policing.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The next stage is the ADM block where through traffic from the ring is merged with traffic generated within this system. Frames are forwarded according to priority criteria to the Framer. The Framer maintains the Ring interfaces and maps the frames onto them.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
493 / 636
The ADM looks up the network tag (MPLS) makes a decision according to the following criteria:– • • • •
Drop Drop & forward Forward Discard decision.
All frames that are due to be forwarded on the ring are merged with locally generated frames. All frames that are dropped from the ring are forwarded to the bandwidth management block. The bandwidth management block buffers the frames till they can be forwarded to the Access cards, subject to bandwidth availability, congestion conditions and frame priorities. Control The ISA–PR port card is managed via the host controller housed on the port card itself. The control bus can be used to read inventory information such as serial number, construction information & date of manufacture. LEDs on the ISA–PR faceplate provide indications as specified in the table below.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Table 51. PR unit LED designation
LED name
State
OK
YELLOW
ED
Alarm / Status ON = Minor Blinking 50/50 = maintenance in progress (loopbacks...)
OK
RED
ON = Major/Critical alarms on ISA–PR or Slot alarms in Access Card or Major transmission alarms on Access Card. Access card slot alarms stand for: Card Mismatch, Card Unassigned Card failure on POST (Power On Self Test) Blinking 50/50 = during the POST (Power On Self Test) failure. On POST completion the LED will change its color according to the card status afterwards Blinking 20/80 = card mismatch
OK
GREEN
ON = OK Status Blinking 50/50 = ISA–PR in initialization process (following power–on or reset)
OK
OFF
Active
GREEN
Active
OFF
the card is not powered ON = the card is powered the card is not powered
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
494 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Data Path Port to Access The ISA–PR port card receives ring traffic over the SDH optical interfaces. The framer, which hosts the Ring interfaces, recovers and validates the frames and forwards them to ADM
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Physical Interfaces The faceplate for the ISA–PR port module (shown in Figure 49. on page 138) presents the following connectors: SFP optical connections for SDH ring interfaces. The interfaces are designated W1 and W2 for West ring interface and E1 and E2 for East ring interface RS232 – RJ45 connector, allows for connection of a local console interface for use by a qualified engineer for debug purposes Eth (Ethernet Management interface) – RJ45 connector, enables local connection to the web based craft interface. This interface can also be used to connect to the NMS (Network Management System) via a data communications network (DCN). Power The ISA–PR port module receives 48v DC from the backplane and converts to lower voltages for local use. The power consumption of the ISA–PR port module is 50 Watts.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
495 / 636
4.34 ISA – Ethernet/Fast Ethernet port (ETH–MB)
The ETHERNET–PORT is a new unit able to process twenty–five (10/100 Mbit/s) Ethernet and fast Ethernet streams and to map them towards the SDH world. The Ethernet frames are inserted into a GFP (Generic Framing Procedure) packet which is a universal container for data traffic. The unit is able to execute a RATE ADAPTING action, hence it is able to cross–connect a 10/100Mbit/s ETHERNET stream towards an SDH virtual container of any dimension (VC12, VC3, VC4). The Ethernet unit is able to memorize all the frames composing the incoming 10Mbit/s signal in a pseudo hard disk made up of eight RAM (1Mx18bit) memories to be forwarded to the selected VCx. Should the memories be filled up without emptying them in the Vcx, a flow control intervenes. The latter is able to communicate to the Ethernet transmitter to reduce or interrupt the frame transmission up to recovering the stable condition of the archived frames versus the ones sent over the SDH VC. All the write and read operations occur at the 125 Mhz frequency in order to reduce the risk of memory stuffing. The same operation will also be executed on the Tx side, i.e. the frames contained in the SDH virtual containers will pass in the RAMs before to be forwarded to the outgoing Ethernet stream. The ETH–ATX access port can be utilized in order to supply the highest number of Ethernet ports; it is provided only with a physical Ethernet interface facing with the ETHERNET–PORT (ETH–MB) via backpanel as regards the management and cross–connection functions towards the SDH world. In this manner 11 interfaces are made available on the ETHERNET–PORT and 14 interfaces are made available on the ETHERNET ACCESS for a total amount of 25 10/100Mbit/s streams. The ETH–MB can also be used in conjunction with the Gigabit Access card GETH–AG in order to process two 1.25 Gbit/s Ethernet stream and eleven 10/100 Mbit/s Ethernet stream (refer to paragraph 3.8.4.2 on page 268 for details).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
In the following is described the signal processing in the Ethernet line –––> SDH matrix (placed on the MATRIX unit) direction. On the opposite side are performed the complementary functions.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
496 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 265. on page 499)
The functions implemented on the board are the following:
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
Ethernet frames processing: •
SELF RATE ADAPTING and interfacing with the line: The Ethernet streams come into the unit via eleven connectors RJ45 on the front–cover, just after there are the transformers to realize the crossover function. The inner part of the line interface comprises the “Self Rate Adapting” block, which is able to perform the physical processing of the 10/100 Mbit/s signals. At the start–up, this block is automatically able to select the max. rate accepted by the remote station; it is however possible to force all the configurations (full–duplex, half–duplex, 10Mbit/s & 100Mbit/s) by means of the check signal “Rate Adapting forced settings” coming from the Microcontroller on the board. The “Self Rate Adapting” block requires a 125 MHz reference clock (supplied by a VCXO) in order to be able to process the input and output signals. The signals are sent to the “Retiming” block after having been processed.
•
RETIMING: The eleven Tx and Rx serial streams together with the clock and synchronism are retimed with the system clock to absorb phase differences (if any) with the clock recovered from the data.
•
GFP: The function of this block is to prepare the Ethernet frames to be mapped towards the SDH world by means of GFP encapsulation (see para. 3.8 on page 253 for details) thus guaranteeing the possibility to utilize any type of VCx virtual container. The “GFP” block” is connected to 8 SSRAM memory pads to create the pseudo hard disk functionality and to 3 external memories (Management memories) where are stored all the information required to perform the connections towards the VCx.
•
MICROCONTROLLER: The Microcontroller can set all the operation settings of the “Self Rate Adapting” block present on the ETH–MB board and the one on the ETH–ATX access unit. Moreover the Microcontroller can configure the “GFP” block cross–connections. The program executed by the microcontroller to perform the various processes resides in two SRAM memories and in one FLASH memory on the board.
•
SIPO & PISO:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
These blocks are used to parallel the 1.25Gbit/s streams received from the access port and then processed like the signals recovered from the 11 line interfaces on the same board. In fact, the 14 streams have been serialized by obtaining two 1.25Gbit/s links in order to connect 14 Ethernet streams on the access board via the backpanel. The 1.25Gbit/s streams are also utilized to connect the Ethernet port (ETH–MB) with the Gigabit Access card (GETH–AG).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
497 / 636
•
On the unit is present a VCXO supplying a 125MHz clock to all the logics processing the Ethernet signal. –
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
–
ED
SDH termination: •
SWITCH: The task of the SWITCH block is to send the signals coming from HPT or LPT block towards the matrix on the MATRIX board. The selection is made according to the type of signal to be connected (L if it is structured, X if unstructured). The “L” signals are sent to LPT – LPA blocks, the “X” to the HPT.
•
HPT: this block adds/removes the high order POH bytes to the C–4 unstructured payloads (bulks).
•
LPT: The LPT function terminates a VC–12 or a VC–3 by adding or removing the relevant POH bytes to a C–12 or a C–3.
•
LPA: This block adapts the low order payloads C12 or C3 to the higher order containers used for transportation in the SDH (TU–12 or TU–3). The adaptation includes timing synchronization and frame offset with pointers movements.
•
Struct/Unstr: this selector sends the bulk signals (unstructured) to HPT, while the structured signals are sent to LPA–LPT.
Other functions implemented on the board are: •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” serial stream, to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 VS supplied by the CONGI
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details about Remote Inventory information).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the serial Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure.
•
DC/DC CONVERTERS This block converts the 48/60 V power supply, to obtain the voltages used to supply all the components in the board. The DC/DC converter is synchronized with a synchronization clock at 300 MHz (signal Power–Sync, generated by the SDH asic) in order to avoid EMI problems.
•
LEDS The board presents on its front panel one LED the meaning of which is reported in Figure 41. on page 130.
•
Buses The main buses on the board are: ISSB–EC: serial bus from the EC, to communicate software data (download, etc.). SDH–CS: from the EC, after derivation from the serial “Management–bus”, for configuration and status information of SDH components. RIBUS: serial bus from the SC (shelf controller on MATRIX unit), to communicate inventory and peripheral data.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
498 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
VCXO:
System clock a System clock b
from/to
LPT
SDH–CS X
LPA
Power Sync. VCX0 125MHz
GFP Generic Framing Procedure
Data+Ck RETIMING 8
(not used)
12
1
RAM 1,2 Gb/s DATA SIPO & PISO
ÉÉ ÉÉ ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ ÉÉÉ ÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀÀ
Rate adapting forced settings
Configuration
SDRAM
ISSB–EC
MICROPROCESSOR
FLASH EPROM
Management Bus (ISPB)
M–BUS Driver
Configuration & Status for SDH (SDH–CS)
CMISS Power Sync.
Bus–OFF Remote Inventory
3.3 V 2.5 V
RIBUS
ID
1.8V DC/DC CONVERTERS
Unit Failure
RIBUS I/F
F
+3.3 Vdc
48/60 V
ETHERNET PORT
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
from/to ACCESS CARD
ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ ÎÎ ÎÎ ÎÎ
Full–duplex Half–duplex 10 Mbit/s 100 Mbit/s
É É É
Configuration
from/to EQUICO
11
Management Memory
System clock
SELF RATE ADAPTING
L
from/to
2
ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ
Struct/unstruct
FROM CONGI
ETHERNET INTERFACE 10 BASE T
1
S W I T C H
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
HPT
SDH–CS
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
622 MHz OSC
Figure 265. ETHERNET port (ETH–MB) – Block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
499 / 636
4.35 ISA –Giga Ethernet Main Board (GETH–MB)
This unit allows the management of Giga–bit Ethernet data and their transportation over the SDH network. The connections to the Ethernet network are accomplished by means of 4 full–duplex ethernet optical interfaces, type 1000Base–LX , 1000Base–SX, 1000Base–ZX ; the giga–ethernet links operate at rates up to 1.25Gb/s, with data–rate auto–negotiation option, connected by means of LC–Duplex fiber connectors. The SDH container used for Ethernet data transportation is VC–4. The four Ethernet channels can be connected to 4 SDH logical ports at VC4 rate. The main functions implemented on the board are the following: GbEth i/f SIPO&PISOa SIPO&PISOb ETH–GFP TABLES MEM GFP–SDH ALIGNMENT BUFFER SDH–BP Microprocessor RIBUS i/f & Remote Inventory DC/DC Converters. GbEth I/F: four of these blocks are located on the unit; it is a small–form factor pluggable (SFP) module, implementing the optical to electric conversion, and viceversa, to accomplish a full–duplex Gigabit Ethernet interface at 1.25 Gb/s, as specified in IEEE802.3. For its description refer to para. 4.16, page 411 (”Gbit Eth. i/f Module” 1000B–LX, 1000B–SX, 1000B–ZX).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
SIPO&PISO: two of these blocks are located on the unit: SIPO&PISOa serves the four Gigabit data afferent the optical interfaces on the present board, while SIPO&PISOb is not used. The SIPO&PISO block receives four ethernet differential signals at a rate of 1.25Gb/s and parallels each of them on ten wires at 125Mb/s rate; viceversa, in the opposite direction, it receives each gigabit signal on a parallel flow on 10–bits basis and serializes it. It accomplishes the PCS and PMA functions specified by the IEEE802.3: • receive clock recovery • data serialization/deserialization • encoding/decoding of octets data to/from ten–bits code–groups (8b/10b) • managing of the auto–negotiation process. ETH–GFP: this is an integrated circuit that accomplishes the data passage from ethernet frames to GFP (Generic Framing Procedure) frames and viceversa. Every function contained in it is repeated 4 times, in order to process the 4 ethernet signals. The ethernet MAC frame structure is illustrated in Figure 110. page 228 and is detailed in rec. IEEE 802.3. The GFP frame structure is illustrated in para. 3.8, page 253, and is detailed in rec.ITU–T G.7041. Its main functions are: NOTE: the functions are here described only in the direction from Ethernet to GFP, in the opposite direction they are opposite and specular. • ETH: it provides to acknowledge the boundaries of the ethernet frames as specified in rec. IEEE 802.3. The octets relevant to ethernet Preamble and Start–Of–Frame Delimiter are discarded.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
500 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 266. on page 503).
•
SIL: it provides to acknowledge the ethernet inter–frames silences and to discard them. In this way the useful data only are transferred to the subsequent data buffer. BUFF: it is a buffer in which the ethernet data are written by means of a smooth ethernet clock, as they are ready, and then are read by the GFP mapper. In case that the buffer is near to full the mechanism of flow–control is started, in order to slow down the remote ethernet data source. GFP: it is the GFP mapper. The data are drawn from the buffer at 155Mb/s rate; possible gaps between ethernet encapsulated frames are filled with Inter–Packet Gaps (IPG).
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
•
•
TABLES MEM: this is a memory storing some tables of data relevant to: routing, delays of the queues and delays of the links, destinations of the ethernet signals, etc. GFP–SDH: this is an integrated circuit that accomplishes the data passage from GFP frames to SDH frames and viceversa. Every function contained in it is repeated 4 times, in order to process the 4 afferent signals. Its main functions are: NOTE: the functions are here described only in the direction from GFP to SDH, in the opposite direction they are opposite and specular. • LPA: it provides to map, directly, the GFP data into an SDH higher order unstructured C4 container. • HPT: this block adds the higher order POH bytes to the C–4 payload (bulk); it accomplishes only a reduced HPT, since the complete function is implemented on the SDH–BP macro–block. • XC&VC: it implements the Cross–Connection (routing) and the Virtual Concatenation of the encapsulated ethernet signals. The Virtual Concatenation consists in the distribution of the bytes flow of a single ethernet signal, by bytes de–interleaving, over several, concatenated VC4 signals; the virtual concatenation can be done over 2 or 4 or 7 VC4’s. • MSA, MST, RST: they accomplish only reduced SDH functions for the STM1 signal, since they are used here only for intra–board framing purposes; ALIGNMENT BUFFER: this is a buffer storing the data, needed in the case of virtual concatenation: since different VC4’s can have different delays, they must be memorized to be aligned; the maximum tolerable delay difference is 250msec.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
SDH–BP: this is an integrated circuit that accomplishes the data passage from STM1 frames to VC4 frames for the BackPanel format and viceversa. Two of these macro–blocks are located on the board, in order to process the 8 afferent signals, since each of them can process 4 stm1 signals. Every function contained in it is repeated 4 times. Its main functions are: NOTE: the functions are here described only in the direction toward the back panel, in the opposite direction they are opposite and specular. • RST, MST, MSA: these are standard SDH functions for the STM1 signal, their function is reduced since they are used here only for intra–board framing purposes; • HPT: this block adds the higher order POH bytes to the C–4 payload (bulk); • 4:1&1:4 : this is a parallel–to–serial converter, in direction towards the backpanel, and a serial–to–parallel converter, in direction from the backpanel; the backpanel signal format is STM4–like, at 622 Mb/s rate. The backpanel signal is split in two: the first (D1a and D2a) going to the main MATRIX Unit and the second (D1b and D2b) to the spare MATRIX Unit
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
501 / 636
622MHz PLL: It is a phase locked loop generating the 622 Mhz reference clock for timing the downstream data toward the ethernet interfaces.
Microprocessor: It is a microcontroller (NIOS type) controlling and supporting the Ethernet functionalities, such as: configuration, alarms and states collections, performances monitoring, communications with the Shelf Controller (SC, on MATRIX unit) and with the OS, etc. It communicates with the SC by means of the configuration bus for SDH functions (SDH–CS), coming from the Management bus ISPB (intra shelf parallel bus). It is provided with relevant devices SDRAM (for data memory) and Flash EPROM (for program memory). The other functions implemented on the board are: •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” serial stream (SPI: serial peripheral inventory), to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 VS supplied by the rear access panel.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus (ISPB: intra–shelf parallel bus). These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
DC/DC CONVERTERS This block converts the 48/60 V power supply, to obtain the voltages used to supply all the components in the board. The DC/DC converter is synchronized with a synchronization clock at 300 MHz (signal Power–Sync, generated by the SDH asic) in order to avoid EMI problems.
ED
•
LEDS and Push–buttons The board presents, on its front panel, one LED, the use and meaning of the LED and of the frontal connectors is reported in Figure 42. on page 131.
•
Buses The main buses on the board are: SDH–CS: from the SC (shelf controller), after derivation from the “Management–bus” (M–bus), for configuration and status information of SDH components. ETH–CS: from microprocessor, for configuration and status information of the Ethernet functions. RIBUS: also called SPI (serial peripheral bus), from the SC (shelf controller on MATRIX unit), to communicate inventory and peripheral data. M–BUS: called also ISPB (Intra Shelf Parallel Bus), from the SC (shelf controller on MATRIX unit), to communicate data about SDH asics and traffic configuration, SDH alarms collection, performance monitoring, etc.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
502 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
VCXO25MHz: It generates a 25 Mhz frequency and, by means of a x5 multiplier, the 125 MHz ethernet transmitter reference clock.
622 MHz PLL
:4 622MHz
System clock (T0a, T0b) 2
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
SDH–CS
2
D1a
2
D1b
4:1
155MHz
2x8
LPA
MSA
HPT
MST
2x4
RST
MST
MSA
HPT
RST
1:4 SDH–BP
1
2x8
XC & VC GFP–SDH
from/to
SDH–CS
2x4 @155Mb/s
SDH–BP
2
D2a
2
D2b
2
@622Mb/s
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
155MHz
125MHz
ALIGNMENT BUFFER
PowerSync.
@1.25Gb/s
2x4
ETH–GFP 2x4
GbEth I/F 1
125MHz
155MHz
2x40@125Mb/s
SIPO & PISO a
ETH 2x40@125Mb/s
SIL
BUFF
GFP
2x8@155Mb/s
2 3 4
125MHz
ETH–CS 125MHz
TABLES MEM
125MHz
x5
SIPO & PISO b
2x4 @1.25Gb/s
not used
125MHz
VCX0 25MHz
Configuration for Eth.
SDRAM
MICROPROCESSOR (NIOS)
FLASH EPROM
M–BUS Driver CMISS Bus–OFF
internal voltages
PowerSync.
1.5V
Remote Inventory ID
1.8V 3.3 V
DC/DC CONVERTERS
Unit Failure
RIBUS I/F
2.5 V
RIBUS (SPI)
F
+3.3 Vdc
48/60 V
from CONGI
Configuration & Status for SDH (SDH–CS)
from/to
Management Bus (ISPB)
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
ETH–CS
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Gigabit Ethernet Unit Figure 266. Gigabit Ethernet Unit – Block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
503 / 636
The board ISA–ES1–8FE mainly works as a LAN switching, and in particular it provides the service of connecting two LANs as a point to point connection between two routers or switches through an SDH network. The connections to the Ethernet network are accomplished by means of eight local 10/100 Base T ethernet interfaces located on the front of the board, and eight ethernet over SDH interfaces through back–panel. The SDH container used for Ethernet data transportation are VC–4, VC–3, VC–12, VC3XV and VC12XV. The main functions implemented on the board are the following: [1]
Ethernet Physical interface
[2]
Ethernet Switch module
[3]
Ethernet Mapper (GFP/LAPS)
[4]
Bus converter
[5]
SDH interfacing to Back Panel (TTF and LVC)
[6]
Microprocessor
[7]
RIBUS interface
[8]
Power supply
[1] Ethernet Physical interface This block supports the eight 10/100 Mbit/s ports. The 10/100 Mbit/s Ethernet MAC block is IEEE 802.3, 802.3x and 802.3ac compliant and supports Full Duplex/Half Duplex for 10/100 Mbit/s Ethernet MAC (MAC implements the IEEE 802.3 MAC Control layer and PAUSE operation for flow control) mode of operation. In addition, 3 LED interface are provided for each port to reflect current status. [2] Ethernet Switch module In ISA ES1–8FE board, 16FE ports are used, in which 8 of them for 100BASE–T line side interface, while other 8 for SDH mapper.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The basic functions supported are following listed: • • • • • • • •
ED
MAC based forwarding and autolearning VLAN based forwarding 802.1Q VLAN add/remove/swap Stacked VLAN (802.1Q format) add/remove/swap Multicast/Broadcast 802.3x flow control 802.1Q Priority bits management for queuing, WFQ scheduling Policing and bandwidth allocation
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
504 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
4.36 ISA– Ethernet switch (ES1–8FE)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[3] Ethernet Mapping over SDH (GFP/LAPS) Ethernet packets are encapsulated and mapped into SDH frames for transmission. Ethernet mapper supports 8 independent channels for EOS encapsulation. Each channel can be mapped with multi SDH containers with appropriate bandwidth, such as VC12s/VT1.5, VC3s/STS–1s, or VC4s/STS–3c. Both high order and low order concatenation are supported, moreover, virtual concatenation with LCAS (Link Capacity Adjustment Scheme) providesr customer with powerful dynamic bandwidth adjustment scheme to fit various needs. Basic feature list as follows: •
Multi encapsulation mode supported: –
GFP Generic Framing Procedure (ITU–T G.7041)
–
LAPS Link Access Procedure SDH (ITU–T X.86/X.85)
–
BCP PPP Bridge Control Protocol (RFC 1662/2878)
•
Low order/High order Contiguous and Virtual Concatenation supported
•
Container supported:
•
–
VC12–xv (x = 1 to 63)
–
VC3–xv (x = 1 to 3)
Differential delay compensation = 48 ms
[4] Bus converter The task of the Bus converter is to translate 19 Mb/s A/D bus to 155 Mb/s data stream. [5] SDH interfacing with Back Panel (TTF and LVC) The TTF block is connected to the two central boards (MATRIXN) through 1 +1 links @622 Mbit/s in LVDS. TTF (Transport Terminal Function) block provides SDH termination for Regenerator Section and Multiplex Section. The LVC block is connected both to the HPC matrices and to the LPC matrices on the MATRIXN card through couple of 1+1 links @ 622 MBit/s working in protection, LVDS format, STM–4 equivalent capacity. LVC circuits perform the HOA function (Higher Order Assembler) and the Lower Order functions LTCM or LTCT sink, LPOM or LSUT sink, LSUT source and LTC source up to 4 STM1 equivalent.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
[6] Microprocessor It is a microcontroller controlling and supporting the Ethernet functionalities, such as: configuration, alarms and states collections, performances monitoring, communications with the Shelf Controller (SC, on MATRIX unit) and with the OS, etc. It communicates with the SC by means of the configuration bus for SDH functions (SDH–CS), coming from the Management bus ISPB (intra shelf parallel bus). It is provided with relevant devices SDRAM (for data memory) and Flash EPROM (for program memory).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
505 / 636
This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” serial stream (SPI: serial peripheral inventory), to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 VS supplied by the rear access panel. The following information/alarms coming from the boards are collected and sent to EQUICO: –
Card type and slot identification
–
Alim alarm : it arises in case of card power failure
–
ISPB control: it disables the card access to the ISPB bus in case of board power failure or incase of generic board failure.
–
LED control: it commands the on/off status of the green/red INT LED present on each card.
Moreover the component permits to read/write the remote inventory. [8] Power supply This block converts the 48/60 V power supply, to obtain the voltages used to supply all the components in the board. Ethernet card internally uses five different power voltages. The following voltages are needed: +3.3V , +2.5V, +1.8V, +1.5V, +3.3VS. The other functions implemented on the board are: •
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus (ISPB: intra–shelf parallel bus). These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure. DC/DC CONVERTERS
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
•
ED
LEDS and Push–buttons The board presents, on its front panel, nine LEDs, the use and meaning of the LED and of the frontal connectors is reported in Figure 42. on page 131.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
506 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[7] RIBUS interface
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
Link H
1+1
Link X
1+1
Link L
1+1
BUS
from/to
TTF
CONVERTER LVC
1
8
ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ
From/to SDRAM
Ethernet Physical Interface
Ethernet Switch
Ethernet Mapper (GFP, LAPS)
Module
ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ
Configuration & Status
SNMP
RESTART MICROPROCESSOR SDRAM FLASH EPROM M–BUS Driver
CMISS Bus–OFF 1.5V
Remote Inventory ID
1.8V 3.3 V
DC/DC CONVERTERS
Unit Failure
RIBUS I/F
RIBUS (SPI) F
2.5 V
+3.3 Vdc
48/60 V
from CONGI
internal voltages
PowerSync.
from/to
Management Bus (ISPB)
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
1
8
from/to EQUICO
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
System clock a System clock b
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ISA ES1–8FE unit
Figure 267. ISA ES1–8FE block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
507 / 636
The description of the board is similar to the ISA ES1–8FE (refer to paragraph 4.36 on page 504) taking into account that ISA ES1–8FX has eight 100 Base FX Optical SFP module instead of 10/100 Base T.
4.38 ISA– Ethernet switch (ES4–8FE) The board ISA–ES4–8FE mainly works as a LAN switching and as gateway from the Ethernet traffic towards the SDH network. In particular it provides the service of connecting two LANs and can be applied mainly in three scenario: [1]
Point to point application where a point to point connection is set–up between two routers or switches through an SDH network.
[2]
Ring application where local interfaces add/drop Ethernet traffic on a ring of virtual concatenated paths in the SDH network.
[3]
HUB application where several switches or routers convey traffic towards a single machine (for example POP router)
The connections to the Ethernet network are accomplished by means of 8 local 10/100 Base T ethernet interfaces located on the front of the board, and 16 ethernet over SDH interfaces through back–panel which has a 622 Mbit/s equivalent throughput. The front panel hosts also one Small Form factor Pluggable module supporting a Gigabit Ethernet interface, the ninth local interface. The SDH container used for Ethernet data transportation are VC–4, VC4XV (only when Gbit Ethernet interface will be managed) VC–3, VC–12, VC3XV and VC12XV. The main functions implemented on the board are the following: [1]
Ethernet Physical interface
[2]
Ethernet Switch module
[3]
Ethernet Mapper (GFP/LAPS)
[4]
SDH interfacing to Back Panel (TTF and LVC)
[5]
Local Microprocessor
[6]
RIBUS interface
[7]
Power supply
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
[1] Ethernet Physical interface This block supports the eight 10/100 Mbit/s ports. The 10/100 Mbit/s Ethernet MAC block is IEEE 802.3, 802.3x and 802.3ac compliant and supports Full Duplex only for 10/100 Mbit/s Ethernet MAC (MAC implements the IEEE 802.3 MAC Control layer and PAUSE operation for flow control) mode of operation; autonegotiation is also supported.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
508 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
4.37 ISA– Ethernet switch (ES1–8FX)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[2] Ethernet Switch module In ISA ES4–8FE board, 25 ports are used, in which 8 of them for 100BASE–T line side interface, one for 1000Base SX, LX, ZX while other 16 for SDH mapper. The basic functions supported are following listed: • • • • • • • •
MAC based forwarding and autolearning VLAN based forwarding 802.1Q VLAN add/remove/swap Stacked VLAN (802.1Q format) add/remove/swap Multicast/Broadcast 802.3x flow control 802.1Q Priority bits management for queuing, WFQ scheduling Policing and bandwidth allocation
[3] Ethernet Mapping over SDH (GFP/LAPS) Ethernet packets are encapsulated and mapped into SDH frames for transmission. Ethernet mapper supports 16 independent channels for EOS (Ethernet Over SDH) encapsulation. Each channel can be mapped with multi SDH containers with appropriate bandwidth, such as VC12, VC12XV, VC3, VC3XV, VC4 or VC4XV (with local Gb Ethernet interface) Both high order and low order concatenation are supported, moreover, virtual concatenation with LCAS (Link Capacity Adjustment Scheme) provides customer with powerful dynamic bandwidth adjustment scheme to fit various needs. Basic feature list as follows: •
Multi encapsulation mode supported: –
GFP Generic Framing Procedure (ITU–T G.7041)
–
LAPS Link Access Procedure SDH (ITU–T X.86/X.85)
–
BCP PPP Bridge Control Protocol (RFC 1662/2878)
•
Low order/High order Contiguous and Virtual Concatenation supported
•
XV Container supported: According to the port configuration two different operation mode are available for ISA ES–4–8FE as explained in the table below: XV container supported
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
XV type
SMII operating mode
GMII operating mode
VC12–xv
(x = 1 to 50)
(x = 1 to 63)
VC3–xv
(x = 1 to 2)
(x = 1 to 12)
VC4–xv
(x = 1 )
(x = 1 to 4 )
The choice between SMII or GMII operation is made via Craft Terminal. •
ED
Differential delay compensation = 48 ms 02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
509 / 636
[5] SDH interfacing with Back Panel (TTF and LVC)
TTF (Transport Terminal Function) block provides SDH termination for Regenerator Section and Multiplex Section. The LVC block is connected both to the HPC matrices and to the LPC matrices on the MATRIXN card through couple of 1+1 links @ 622 MBit/s working in protection, LVDS format, STM–4 equivalent capacity. LVC circuits perform the HOA function (Higher Order Assembler) and the Lower Order functions LTCM or LTCT sink, LPOM or LSUT sink, LSUT source and LTC source up to 4 STM1 equivalent. [6] Local Microprocessor It controls and supports the Ethernet functionalities (Ethernet Physical Interface, Ethernet Switch Module and Ethernet Mapper): configuration, alarms and states collections, performances monitoring, communications with the OS (SNMP). The microprocessor is provided with relevant devices SDRAM (for data memory), Flash EPROM (for program memory) and Compact Flash. External Shelf Controller (SC) controls SDH related circuits by ISPB bus. [7] RIBUS interface This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” serial stream (SPI: serial peripheral inventory), to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 VS supplied by the rear access panel. The following information/alarms coming from the boards are collected and sent to EQUICO: –
Card type and slot identification
–
Alim alarm : it arises in case of card power failure
–
ISPB control: it disables the card access to the ISPB bus in case of board power failure or incase of generic board failure.
–
LED control: it commands the on/off status of the green/red INT LED present on each card.
Moreover the component permits to read/write the remote inventory. [8] Power supply This block converts the 48/60 V power supply, to obtain the voltages used to supply all the components in the board. Ethernet card internally uses five different power voltages.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The following voltages are needed: +3.3V , +2.5V, +1.8V, +1.5V, +3.3VS.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
510 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The TTF block is connected to the two central boards (MATRIXN) through 1 +1 links @622 Mbit/s in LVDS.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The other functions implemented on the board are:
ED
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus (ISPB: intra–shelf parallel bus). These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure.
•
LEDS and Push–buttons The board presents, on its front panel, one LED, the meaning of which is reported in Figure 43. on page 132. A push–button for the microprocessor restart is present on the front of the unit.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
511 / 636
Link X
1+1
Link L
1+1
4XSTM–1
1
8
ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ
From/to SDRAM
1XSMII
2xSMII
(8 Fast Ethernet) Ethernet
Ethernet Physical Interface
ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ ÎÎÎ
(16 FE)
Switch
2XGMII
2xGMII
Module
Ethernet Mapper (GFP, LAPS)
(2 GB E)
(1 Gbit Ethernet)
from/to EQUICO
SFP module
ISPB
1
IBM
not used
SNMP
RESTART
MICROPROCESSOR
CONTROL BUS BRIDGE
Management Bus (ISPB)
M–BUS Driver
COMPACT FLASH
CMISS
internal voltages
Bus–OFF Remote Inventory
1.5V
ID
1.8V 3.3 V
DC/DC CONVERTERS
Unit Failure
RIBUS I/F
RIBUS (SPI)
from/to
CPLD
F +3.3 Vdc
2.5 V
48/60 V
from CONGI
FLASH EPROM
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
SDRAM
ISA ES4–8FE
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Figure 268. ISA ES4–8FE block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
512 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1+1
PCI
GIGABIT ETH Interface
ETHERNET INTERFACE 10 /100 BASE T
LVC
Link H
from/to
TTF
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
System clock a System clock b
4.39 ISA ES–16
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(Refer to Figure 269. on page 517) ISA ES16 unit has a throughput towards the SDH network of 2.5 Gbit/s and it hasn’t any local Ethernet interfaces on the front pane (stand–alone operation)l. The board is able to manage local Ethernet interfaces, but it has to be equipped together with the access card, which has to be plugged into the Access Area. The Access Card, which can be used in conjunction with ISA ES–16 are: –
14x Fast Ethernet access card for providing 14 FE local interface;
–
Gigabit Ethernet Access Card for providing up to four Gigabit Ethernet Local interfaces with SFP optical plugs, which can be 1000B– SX/LX/ZX.
Note: independently of the configured Ethernet local interfaces, the maximum number of ports towards SDH network (managed by Q3) is 64, while the number of ports of the switch can be increased up to 78 if the Fast Ethernet Access Card is applied or up to 68 if the Gigabit/s Access Card is applied. The management and control of those local interfaces is in charge of SNMP. The board mainly works as a LAN switching and as a gateway from the Ethernet traffic towards the SDH network. In particular the board can be used mainly for providing three services: –
Virtual Private Line: point to point application where a point to point is set–up between two routers or switches through a SDH network: the ISA ES–16 can be directly connected to the customer using the local interface of the Access Cards, or the connection to the customers can be remotized using for istance the Fast Ethernet Boards.
–
Virtual Private LAN service: multipoint to multipoint application, where each port of the customer can be connected to every other ports of its virtual private LAN. The forwarding of the Ethernet flows is based on proper classification process taking into account the SLA and the load of the network local interfaces. The topology exploiting this application could be for example a ring topology where the customer local or remote interface add/drop Ethernet traffic on a ring of (virtual) paths in the SDH network. In this way ISA ES–16 work as switch distributed in the network.
–
Broadband access service (hub application scenario) where several switches or routers convey traffic towards a single machine (for example a POP router).
The Ethernet traffic, opportunely mapped in the SDH transport structures, is then sent towards the SDH Matrix through the back–plane which has STM–16 equivalent throughput. This represents the maximum throughput of the board which depends also by the subrack slot. The Ethernet frames can be mapped in different types of SDH Virtual Containers (according the chooses of the operator) using the Frame based GFP (Generic Frame Procedure) protocol, LAPS (Link Access Procedure– SDH) protocol or PPP (Point to Point protocol) protocol over HDLS (High level Data Link Control).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The board is able to forward frames on port numbering, VLAN tag, priority coding, MAC Destination address, but also on MPLS (Multi Protocol Label Switching) label; It supports the Martini encapsulation for transporting the VLAN tagged Ethernet frames into MPLS network.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
513 / 636
–
4.5 Gbit/s layer 2 switching
–
SDH capabilities:
–
–
•
STM16 Ho/STM4 LO
•
virtual concatenation: up to 64 VCG groups
•
hitless LCAS (Link Capacity Adjustment Scheme)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Main functionalities:
Protocol support: •
POS (Packet Over SDH)
•
GFP
•
IEEE 802.3 Ethernet (10/100 or GBE)
Switching based on: •
Stacked VLAN
•
MPLS
•
MAC learning
–
HW support for EPS:
–
Ethernet access through FE access module or GBE acc module
ISA ES 16 is a single height module that fits in any port slot 1660SM equipment. The equivalent backplane capacity is 1xSTM4 in normal slot or 2xSTM4 in enhanced slots Local data access are available through access slot equipped with 14xFE access card or 4xGBE access card. When attached to 4xGBE access card the input traffic must be reduced in order not to overflow the fabric: in such a case backplane traffic is not affected, while GBE traffic can be reduced by means of 802.3 flow control protocol (pause frames). ISA ES–16 board supports the EPS protection scheme 1+1 where the main and spare position are assigned by management system in a flexible way (refer to paragraph 3.13.1 on page 311 for details). Data enter ES16 embedded in SDH streams by the matrixes and as Ethernet frames from Access Cards. Data connection with Matrixes is realized with MUX/DEMUX and G.A. block.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
MUX/DEMUX is connected to main and enhanced NGI ports supporting data up to 4 equivalent STM1 in normal slot and 8xSTM1 in enhanced slot. MUX/DEMUX is configured to talk to G.A block in 16xSTM1 mode; G.A. block generates a STM16 stream to “VCG management block” that handles up to 64 VCGs (Virtual Concatenation Group) with LCAS protocol; also terminates layer 2.5 on each group (GFP, LAPS and POS)..
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
514 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Although “VCG management block” can transport several type of layer 2 or 3 formats, foreseeable applications of ISA ES16 only calls for transport of Ethernet and MPLS frames. Extracted frames are sent for further processing to “ETHERNET Mapper” block the function of which are: –
Serial link alignment
–
frame delineation
–
storing of frames entering from SPI3 and access card and forwarding to AD FPGA
–
reassembling of ethernet frames received from AD FPGA and forwarding to Access card
–
format adaptation of segments coming from AD directed to Calla48
ISA ES16 UNIT is connected to FE or GE “access card” directly by “ETHERNET Mapper” block. “Ethernet Mapper” block interfaces to “Layer 2 processing” block through 2 monodirectional 13 LVDS links bus at 450 Mbps. In Rx direction full packet are transferred across the interface. Each packet is prepended with a control word carrying indications of input port, length and other service information. In Tx direction, segments of up to 128 bytes are transferred across the interface: “Ethernet Mapper” block dispatches data to Ethernet reassembling circuitry or to “VCG management” block. Ethernet packets are processed by “Layer 2 processing” block to: –
decode protocol header, up to eight nested protocols or MPLS labels can be extracted
–
search flow and session to which the packet belong
–
policing the streams according to session parameters
–
monitor the traffic with inflow and outflow counters
–
schedule forwarding of packets
–
encapsulation of outgoing packets
Output port, encapsulation and assigned quality of service of outgoing packets depend on a subset of input port, VLAN tags, MAC address and MPLS labels. “Layer 2 processing” block and the local microprocessor cooperates in dynamically learning and obsoleting MAC addresses. Local Microprocessor
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
It controls and supports the Ethernet functionalities (Ethernet Physical Interface, Ethernet Switch Module and Ethernet Mapper): configuration, alarms and states collections, performances monitoring, communications with the OS (SNMP). The microprocessor is provided with relevant devices SDRAM (for data memory), Flash EPROM (for program memory) and Compact Flash. External Shelf Controller (SC) controls SDH related circuits by ISPB bus.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
515 / 636
This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” serial stream (SPI: serial peripheral inventory), to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 VS supplied by the rear access panel. The following information/alarms coming from the boards are collected and sent to EQUICO: –
Card type and slot identification
–
Alim alarm : it arises in case of card power failure
–
ISPB control: it disables the card access to the ISPB bus in case of board power failure or incase of generic board failure.
–
LED control: it commands the on/off status of the green/red INT LED present on each card.
Moreover the component permits to read/write the remote inventory. The other functions implemented on the board are: •
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus (ISPB: intra–shelf parallel bus). These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure. DC/DC CONVERTERS Starting from the 48 dc supplyed by CONGI unit with the aids of internal DC/DC converter, are generated the following voltage: – – – – –
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
•
ED
3.3 Vdc 2.5 Vdc 1.8 Vdc 1.5 Vdc 1.2 Vdc
LEDS and Push–buttons The board presents, on its front panel, one LED, the meaning of which is reported in Figure 43. on page 132.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
516 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
RIBUS interface
from/to ACCESS CARD
1,2 Gb/s DATA
System clock a System clock b
G.A.
Link L
LVC
Link H 1+1
VCG
MUX/ DEMUX
TTF
management
Link X
from/to
Ethernet Mapper
LAYER 2 Processing
1+1
1+1
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
SIPO & PISO
EPS–ISSB from/to EQUICO
RESTART SNMP
PCI
Bus (ISPB)
MICROPROCESSOR
FLASH EPROM
COMPACT FLASH
CONTROL BUS BRIDGE
M–BUS Driver CMISS
internal voltages
Bus–OFF 1.2V
Remote Inventory
1.5V 1.8V 3.3 V
ID
DC/DC CONVERTERS Unit Failure
RIBUS I/F
RIBUS (SPI)
F
2.5 V
+3.3 Vdc
48/60 V
from CONGI
PowerSync.
from/to
Management Bus (ISPB)
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
SDRAM
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ISA ES16
Figure 269. ISA ES16 unit block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
517 / 636
4.40 4 X ANY HOST C card (4XANYC)
This port realizes the mapping of up to 4 “client” signals, into an equivalent bandwidth up to 16 AU4’s; the client allocation depends on the operative bitrate of client signal to be mapped, so as the availability of 16 AU4’s (rather than 8 AU4’s) is related to the type of slot used for the board equipment (refer to paragraph 3.10 on page 282 for details). AU4’s carrying ’client’ signals mapped can be, then, cross–connected at HO level by MATRIX card. ’Client’ interfacing is performed through specific ’pluggable’ modules. Serial data provided by client modules is then processed by the “primary and secondary 2xANY“ blocks in order to realize a ’bit–per–bit’ mapping of client signals supported, that result, after each block processing, ’virtually concatenated’ into an 8xSTM1 bandwidth. A specific FPGA interfaces the two “primary and secondary 2xANY“ blocks performing ’client mapping’ and then provides the whole SDH chain of functions from HPT to RST; this device allows also the optimization of client allocation into the available 8xSTM1’s, when equipped in ’H.S.’ slots (refer to paragraph 3.10 on page 282 for details). The data signal is, then, exchanged to MATRIX card, through the G.A. block operating as electrical interface: equivalent STM16 is received (transmitted) from FPGA block and provided (received) to MATRIX card with NGI framed format (X, L, H links in Figure 270. ) Note – TTF blocks supported by FPGA and G.A block are used only for interface purpose. An internal oscillator (VCXO 622.08 Mb/s) is hosted in order to handle CRU EPS events (physically on MATRIX unit) with no impact on ’client’ traffic transmitted to line.
TX SIDE –
4 X ANY module blocks: the client receiver interface regenerates the incoming client signal and recovers the relative timing; the interface characteristics are related to client type (refer to paragraph 5.7 on page 583). Line loopback commands for each interface are received by “Alarms and Control” block.
–
Primary and Secondary 2xANY blocks: inside these blocks the HPA function is performed; more in details: • • •
–
client clock adaptation virtual concatenation C2 insertion
HPT block: HPT source is performed for all VC–4 in FPGA block; the following function are performed: •
B3: Bit interleaved parity (BIP–8) is computed over all bits of the previous VC–4 and placed in B3 byte position. G1[1–4]: The number of errors indicated in RI_REI (remote error indication extracted in HPT sk) is encoded in the REI (bits 1 to 4 of the G1 byte) G1[5]: When there is an active RI_RDI (remote defect indication extracted in HPT sk), the RDI indication will be sent in bit 5 of G1 byte. Upon termination of the above conditions, the RDI indication will be removed.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
• •
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
518 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(Refer to Figure 270. on page 522)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
MSA block: it performs 16 POINTER GENERATOR functions in parallel, according to ITU and ETSI, on an AU–4 mapping basis.
–
MST block: it is located in FPGA and performs Multiplex Section Termination Source: •
K2 byte is also processed for RDI insertion. RDI is inserted according to sink function consequent actions; S1: Byte S1 is inserted; B2: The error monitoring byte B2 is allocated in the STM–16 for a multiplex section bit error–monitoring function. This function is a bit interleaved parity (BIP–24) code using even parity as defined in Recommendation G.707. The BIP–24 is computed over all bits (except those in the RSOH bytes) of the previous STM–16 frame and placed in the 3x16 respective B2 byte positions of the current STM–16 frame. M1: The number of errors detected by monitoring B2 in the sink side is passed to the source side via the aREI and is encoded in the MS–REI (byte M1) according to 9.2.2.12/G.707.
• •
•
–
RST block: FPGA block implements the RST source functions listed here below. •
B1: The error monitoring byte B1 is allocated in the STM–16 for a regenerator section bit error monitoring function. This function is a bit interleaved parity 8 (BIP–8) code using even parity as defined in Recommendation G.707. The BIP–8 is computed over all bits of the previous STM–16 frame the RSn_CP after scrambling. The result is placed in byte B1 position of the RSOH before scrambling. A1, A2: Frame alignment bytes A1 and A2 (3 x 16 of each) are generated and inserted in the first row of the RSOH. Scrambling is performed according to Recommendation G.707, which excludes the first row of the STM–16 RSOH (9x16 bytes, including the A1, A2, J0 and bytes reserved for national use or future international standardization) from scrambling.
• •
RX SIDE –
RST block: FPGA block implements the RST sink functions listed here below. • •
The STM–16 frame alignment process is performed according to G.783 Recommendation. After the recovery of the frame phase start the received signal is descramblered using the generator polynomial specified in G.707 Recommendation. B1 check is performed. Even bit parity is computed for each bit ”n” of every byte of the preceding scrambled STM–16 frame and compared with bit ”n” of B1 recovered from the current frame in order to detect errored blocks
•
–
MST block: it is located in FPGA block and the function performed are listed below; •
B2: The 3 x 16 error monitoring B2 bytes are recovered from the MSOH. A BIP–24–16 code is computed for the STM–16 frame. The computed BIP–24–16 value for the current frame is compared with the recovered B2 bytes from the following frame and errors are reported . B2 Errored Block events happened during the last second are reported in an “Alarms and controls” block register. B2 Errored Block is also used to calculate total number of errored blocks. M1: MS–REI information is decoded according to G.707 from byte M1 and reported as a 1 second count MS–REI Errored Block events happened during the last second are reported in an “Alarms and controls” block register. MS–REI indication is also used to calculate total number of remote errored block. K2: MS AIS detection
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
•
•
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
519 / 636
MSA block: pointer detection process. The pointer interpreter can detect two defect conditions: • •
Loss Of Pointer (LOP); AU–AIS.
If either of these defect conditions are detected, then a logical all–ones (AIS) signal is generated –
HPT block: •
B3: The error monitoring byte B3 is recovered. BIP–8 is computed for the VC–4 frame. The computed BIP–8 value for the current frame is compared with the recovered B3 byte from the following frame. The process for detecting excessive errors and signal degrade is described in ITU–T Reccomandation. G.806. B3 Errored Block event happened during the last second of VC–4 #0 are reported in “Alarms and controls” block register. B3 Errored Block of VC–4 #0 are also used to calculate total number of errored block. G1[1–4]: The REI is recovered and the derived performance primitives is reported for processing. G1[5]: The RDI defect is processed as described in ITU–T Reccomandation. G.806. C2: Unequipped defect is detected (refer to G.783)
• • • –
HPA block:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The following function are performed:
ED
•
C2 extraction: Byte C2 is recovered from VC–4 #0. If a dPLM is detected (see ITU–T G.806), then it will be reported in an “Alarms and controls” block register.
•
H4 extraction: Multiframe indicator is derived from the H4 byte. The received H4 value is compared to the next expected value in the multiframe sequence. The H4 value is assumed to be in phase when it is coincident with the expected value. If several H4 values are received consecutively not as expected but correctly in sequence with a different part of the multiframe sequence, then subsequent H4 values will be expected to follow this new alignment. If several H4 values are received consecutively not correctly in sequence with any part of the multiframe sequence, then a loss of multiframe (LOM) event is reported. When several H4 values have been received consecutively correctly in sequence with part of the multiframe sequence, then the event will be ended and subsequent H4 values will be expected to follow the new alignment.
•
extraction of payload from packets and process the header content
•
automatic client based band and latency preset
•
client clock adaptation
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
520 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The other functions implemented on the board are: •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” serial stream (SPI: serial peripheral inventory), to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 VS supplied by the rear access panel.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus (ISPB: intra–shelf parallel bus). These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure. DC/DC CONVERTERS This block converts the 48/60 V power supply, to obtain the voltages used to supply all the components in the board.
ED
•
LEDS and Push–buttons The board presents, on its front panel, one LED, the use and meaning of the LED and of the frontal connectors is reported in Figure 42. on page 131.
•
Alarms and Controls This block collect the alarm detected on the board and also sends commands like loopbacks.
•
Buses The main buses on the board are: RIBUS: also called SPI (serial peripheral bus), from the SC (shelf controller on MATRIX unit), to communicate inventory and peripheral data. M–BUS: called also ISPB (Intra Shelf Parallel Bus), from the SC (shelf controller on MATRIX unit), to communicate data about SDH asics and traffic configuration, SDH alarms collection, performance monitoring, etc.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
521 / 636
Client #3
ÏÏ Ï Ï ÏÏ
#3 #3 4xANY module
Client #2
Secondary 2xANY
#2 #2
HPA Vitual Concatenation
ÏÏ Ï Ï ÏÏ
Client #4 #4
FPGA
G.A. X
HPT
FRAMER MST/RST (*)
MSA
TTF
H
ÏÏ Ï Ï ÏÏ
System clock a System clock b
ÏÏ ÏÏÏ Ï ÏÏÏÏÏÏ
CDR
ÏÏ Ï ÏÏ
Internal STM–16 Frame
CMISS
Management Bus (ISPB)
Configuration & Status
CLIENT PHYSICAL INTERFACE
L
(*)
M–BUS Driver Bus–OFF
Remote Inventory
4xANY module #4 details
from/to
4xANY module
RIBUS ID
Unit Failure
#1 #2 #3 #4
RIBUS I/F
F
+3.3 Vdc
ALARMS & CONTROLS
1.8V 3.3 V 2.5 V
DC/DC CONVERTERS
1.5 V
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(*)– TTF blocks are used only for interface purpose
Figure 270. 4 x ANY HOST C card block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
522 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
HPA Vitual Concatenation
#1
MATRIX MAIN AND SPARE
Client #1
VCXO 622.08
Primary 2XANY
from CONGI
4xANY module #1
4.41 COADM1
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(Refer to Figure 271. on page 524) The COADM1 board is two slots wide and can be plugged in every slot of the Access Area without constraint. COADM 1 channel unit realizes wavelengths multi–demultiplexing allowing to add/drop 1 ch out of the 8 supported according to CWDM grid and the pass–through of remaining WDM channels not terminated. One specific item per ITU–T channel is foreseen: – – – – – – – –
1470 nm. 1490 nm. 1510 nm. 1530 nm. 1550 nm. 1570 nm. 1590 nm. 1610 nm.
The functionality of the board has to be considered for ring application, and performing ’one side’ channel termination: thus, two separate boards are required at a node of the ring in order to achieve the complete OADM functionality. Actual OADM functionality is based on specific devices performing mux/demux functionality as regards the channel to be locally terminated (by specific add/drop port) and supporting both bidirectional WDM ports for ’network connection’ and bidirectional WDM ports for ’pass–through’ connection (to/from opposite OADM board). ’Loss of Signal’ detection on CWDM optical signal received is provided in order to support the standard management of OMSN’s and sent to the Shelf Controller via RIBUS block. The CWDM LOS detection allows the operator to realize an efficient and specific maintenance of the network in case of break of ring/linear cables carrying multiplexed signals. The wavelength, which is added/dropped in COADM1, is specified in one of the additional fields of the board Remote Inventory. The configuration of the COADM1 requires the operator to specify the added/dropped wavelength. The operator has to connect the bundle of pass–through channels between two COADM1 boards (respectively on west and east side of the NE). Note – The bundle of a COADM1 cannot be connected to the bundle of another COADM1 with different added/dropped wavelength.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Remote inventory is handled by a dedicated EEPROM carrying the inventory code associated to the optical device; the communication towards Shelf Controller is performed by ’RIBUS block” through ’SPI’ bus.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
523 / 636
CWDM
λx
1xx0
λx
1xx0
output signal
CWDM λgrid – λx OADM CWDM input signal
CWDM λgrid – λx LOS DETECTION LOS HANDLING To/From OADM opposite side Remote Inventory EEPROM
RIBUS
COADM1 unit
SPI bus
TO / FROM Shelf Controller
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
on MATRIX board
Figure 271. COADM1 unit block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
524 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
To/From colored port or transponder
4.42 COADM2
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(Refer to Figure 272. on page 526) The COADM2 board is two slots wide and can be plugged in every slot of the Access Area without constraint. OADM 2ch board realizes wavelengths multi–demultiplexing allowing to add/drop 2 ch out of the 8 supported according to CWDM grid and the pass–through of remaining WDM channels not terminated. Four specific items are foreseen, considering to support the termination of two adjacent wavelengths per item: –
1470 – 1490 nm;
–
1510 – 1530 nm;
–
1550 – 1570 nm;
–
1590 – 1610 nm.
The functionality of the board has to be considered for ring application, and performing ’one side’ channel termination: thus, two separate boards are required at a node of the ring in order to achieve the complete OADM functionality. Actual OADM functionality is based on specific devices performing mux/demux functionality as regards the two channels to be locally terminated (by specific add/drop port) and supporting both bidirectional WDM ports for ’network connection’ and bidirectional WDM ports for ’pass–through’ connection (to/from opposite OADM board). ’Loss of Signal’ detection on CWDM optical signal received is provided in order to support the standard management of OMSN’s. The CWDM LOS detection allows the operator to realize an efficient and specific maintenance of the network in case of break of ring/linear cables carrying multiplexed signals. The two wavelengths, which are added/dropped in COADM2, are specified by the content of the additional fields of the board Remote Inventory. The configuration of the COADM2 requires the operator to specify the added/dropped wavelengths. The operator has to connect the bundle of pass–through channels between two COADM2 boards (respectively on west and east side of the NE). Note 1 – The bundle of a COADM2 cannot be connected to the bundle of a COADM1. Note 2 – The bundle of a COADM2 cannot be connected to the bundle of another COADM2 with different added/dropped wavelengths.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Remote inventory is handled by a dedicated EEPROM carrying the inventory code associated to the optical device; the communication towards Shelf Controller is performed by ’RIBUS block through ’SPI’ bus.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
525 / 636
CWDM λgrid – λx–λy
CWDM
λx λy
1xx0
λx λy
1xx0
output signal
1xx0
OADM CWDM λgrid – λx–λy
CWDM input signal
1xx0
LOS DETECTION LOS HANDLING To/From OADM opposite side Remote Inventory EEPROM
RIBUS
COADM2 unit
SPI bus
TO / FROM Shelf Controller
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
on MATRIX board
Figure 272. COADM2 block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
526 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
To/From colored port or transponder
4.43 COMDX8
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(Refer to Figure 273. on page 528) MUX/DEMUX 8ch board realizes wavelengths multi–demultiplexing on the whole group of 8 CWDM channels supported. One item is, then, foreseen. The functionality of the board can be considered both for linear and ring application; contrary to OADM board, no ’pass–through’ link is provided, then pass–through of wavelengths not terminated must be realized on each single wavelength. In ’ring’ application, the board performs ’one side’ channels termination: thus, two separate boards are required at a node of the ring in order to achieve the complete OADM functionality. ’Loss of Signal’ detection on CWDM optical signal received has to be provided in order to support the standard management of OMSN’s. The CWDM LOS detection allows the operator to realize an efficient and specific maintenance of the network in case of break of ring/linear cables carrying multiplexed signals. The COMDX8 board is two slots wide and can be plugged in every slot of the Access Area without constraint. Specific devices performs mux/demux functionality as regards the whole group of 8 channels to be locally terminated (by specific add/drop port). Bidirectional WDM ports for ’network connection’ are also supported. Remote inventory is handled by a dedicated EEPROM carrying the inventory code associated to the optical device; the communication towards Shelf Controller is performed by ’RIBUS block“ through ’SPI’ bus. The functionality of ’Loss of signal’ received on CWDM input of ’passive’ boards is handled as showed in the following Figure 273. An optical splitter is used in order to provide a low percentage of CWDM power level received to a detection stage including a large bandwidth photodetector and the specific HW for the generation of a LOS primitive.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
LOS alarm is reported through ’RIBUS block’ towards Shelf Controller on MATRIX unit.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
527 / 636
(from colored port or Transponder interface)
INPUT CHANNELS (to colored port or Transponder interface)
λ1 λ2 λ3 λ4 λ5 λ6 λ7 λ8
1470 1490 1510
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
OUTPUT CHANNELS
λ1 λ2 λ3 λ4 λ5 λ6 λ7 λ8
CWDM
1530 1550
MUX
1570 1610 1590
1470 1490 1510
LOS HANDLING
1530 1550
DEMUX
CWDM input signal
Optical Splitter
1570 1610 1590
LOS DETECTION
x% of CWDM Rx signal
LOS alarm
MUX/DEMUX8 unit
Remote Inventory EEPROM
RIBUS
SPI bus
TO / FROM Shelf Controller
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
on MATRIX board
Figure 273. MUX/DEMUX8 (COMDX8) block diagram and LOS detection in ’passive’ boards
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
528 / 636
4.44 2xCH Transponder SFP without optics (COWLA2)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(Refer to Figure 274. on page 533) This board realizes the function of double multi–rate transponder–regenerator in CWDM network. Double because it has two channels, multi–rate because it can handle various kinds of standard signals, transponder–regenerator because it can work both as transponder and as regenerator. Each channel of COWLA2 is constituted of two bi–directional optical interfaces on which is realized ’3R’ functionality (Re–amplification, Reshaping and Retiming). When working as transponder the optical interfaces of the COWLA2 channel are one ’B&W’ and one colored, so wavelength assignment is performed. On the contrary if both optical interfaces of the channel are colored, COWLA2 works as regenerator. Double ’B&W’ optical interface configuration, regenerator ’B&W’, isn’t foreseen because not applicable in the 1660SM (with CWDM unit) network scenarios. Colored interfaces, ’server or WDM domain’, are input–output of others equipment resident boards; these perform Coarse Wavelength Division Multiplexing using optical multiplexer–demultiplexer or Optical Add–Drop Multiplexer passive components. ’B&W’ lines, ’client domain’, are typically connected toward remote generic ’B&W’ clients. COWLA2 unit supports the following signal types: – – – – – – – – – – – – –
FDDI (125 Mb/s); Fast Ethernet (125 Mb/s); STM1/OC3; Escon (200 Mb/s); Digital Video (270 Mb/s); STM4/OC12; Fiber Channel (1.0625 Gb/s); FICON (1.0625 Gb/s); Gb Ethernet (1.25 Gb/s); 2 Fiber Channel (2.125 Gb/s); STM16/OC48; 2 Gb Ethernet (2.5 Gb/s); STM16 w/ FEC (2.667 Gb/s).
not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release not operative in current release
In case of SDH services the board performs the management of Regeneration Section overhead on Rx direction. For all others standard signals only ’3R’ functionality is foreseen without protocol specific handling. For all protocols optical LOS and URU alarms are generated. In case of optical LOS on Rx interface, Automatic Laser Shut down procedure is activated in the correspondent Tx side; at the same time laser shutdown or generic AIS insertion is done in the transponder channel Tx direction. When non–SDH services are configured, COWLA2 performs only ’3R’ functionality; signal is transparently regenerated without protocol specific management.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
In case of SDH services, besides ’3R’ regeneration, the following functionalities are realized on received side: –
alignment on received A1, A2 byte and generation of relative LOF alarm
–
received section trace identifier byte J0 extraction and generation of relative TIM alarm. J0 management is configurable as one repeated byte or as 16 byte modality (15 byte + CRC–7)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
529 / 636
received error monitoring byte B1 extraction and manipulation (RS non intrusive monitoring). Performance monitoring computation is done in order to produce DEG and LOWBER alarms. Primitive parameters are passed to Shelf Controller that computes PM handling.
–
RS–AIS (MS–AIS with J0 bit at all ’1’, Alcatel proprietary alarm) detection on the incoming signal and generation of relative RS–AIS alarm.
2xCh transponder SFP is a one slot wide plug–in unit constituted by a front panel and a Printed circuit Board Assembly (PBA). On the front panel are available four connectors for optical lines access and a multi–color LED used as visual indicator for card failure alarm and in–service/standby card operating status. Block diagram of COWLA2 unit is reported in Figure 274. Power supplies for all board components are produced from battery interface through DC/DC converts modules. Optical received signal O Rxm (1 = m = 4) is converted into electrical format, D Rxm, from SFPm photo–detector receiver. This block accomplishes re–amplification and reshaping. Electrical received signal, D Rxm, enters into any–rate deserializer Dxm that realizes signal retiming and 1 to 16 de–serialization. Received de–serialized signals, Dpn Rxm (1 = n = 16, 1 = m = 4) and clock, Ckp Rxm, go into FPGA. FPGA component, basing on configuration provisioning, cross–connect a 16 bit parallel data input, Dpn Rxm, with a 16 bit parallel data output, Dpn Txm. In case of SDH service it’s done received regenerator section overhead bytes management. Parallel signals, Dpn Txm, and clock, Ckp Txm, are sent to the any–rate serializer Mxm that carries out 16 to 1 data multiplexing. Multiplexed signal, D Txm, enters into SFPm laser transmitter that produces the optical output signal O Txm. The bi–directional optical to optical path described above constitutes one transponder channel. FPGA registers are configured from Shelf Controller using ISPB bus. FPGA manages programming and alarms of SFPs and any–rate serializers–deserializers through dedicated serial I2C bus interfaces and parallel input–output. PLLs VCXO loop filter blocks are a constituent part of deserializers’s Clock and Data Recovery circuits and of serializers’s Clock Multiplier Unit. They provide appropriate clock reference for serializer–deserializer components. Configuration device (Config Device) contains the program image that is downloaded into FPGA after power–on.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Board remote inventory information are contained in RI EEPROM, a serial non–volatile memory accessible via SPI bus. RIBUS block basically it reads or writes general input–output for commands activation or alarms acquisition and pilots on–board SPI slave bus. RIBUS is controlled from SC through SPI back–plane bus. In the following various COWLA2 blocks will be described.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
530 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
SFP OPTICAL MODULE
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
SFP optical module is a pluggable fiber optic transceiver that arises from a Multi–Source Agreement. Optical wavelength could be B&W or colored conform to CWDM grid. Line bit–rate could be single speed or multi–rate. On COWLA2 it’s for now foreseen the use of mono–mode, multi–rate B&W or multi–rate 8 wavelength colored SFP, capable of maximum span budget of about 80 Km. Photo detector transceiver and laser transmitter achieve respectively optical to electrical and electrical to optical conversion; In addition there are some configuration and alarm pins: –
Tx fault indicates a laser fault
–
LOS specifies an optical loss of signal
–
Presence reflects the insertion–extraction of the module
–
Tx disable when set shuts down the laser
–
Rate select is an optional command for data rate select for multi–rate transceiver.
These signals are input–output of FPGA and can be read–written using dedicated registers. Tx disable and LOS are used by FPGA for ALS functionality. Tx disable, LOS and Presence are also connected to RIBUS block for testing or future utilization. SFP module includes a 512 bytes serial EEPROM, that contains inventory and vendor specific information. This EEPROM can be read and written via ISPB bus.
SERIALIZER/DESERIALIZER
“Deserializer” main functions are clock recovery, data re–sampling and 1 to 16 de–serialization over a continuous bit–rate from 30 Mb/s up to 3.2 Gb/s.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
“Serializer” main functions are data re–timing and 16 to 1 serialization over a continuous bit–rate from 30 Mb/s up to 3.2 Gb/s.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
531 / 636
FPGA
–
flexible any rate data channel cross connection
–
E–SNCP/I (for all services) E–SNCP/N (for SDH services) protection schemes toward client or server domain
–
Automatic Laser Shut down procedure implementation
–
STMn Regenerator Section bytes termination for SDH services
–
laser shut down or generic AIS insertion on Tx transponder channel direction when a LOS is detected on Rx side
–
SFP and serializer/deserializer management by ISPB.
DC/DC CONVERTERS Power supply block produces the required on board supplies starting from 48 V ± 20 % battery input . All components work with 3.3 V voltage except FPGA that requires also 1.5 V.
ISPB BUS By mean of ISPB the Shelf Controller (SC) can load proper configuration setting within FPGA internal register, monitor the current status and alarms, collect data for performance monitoring and so on.
RIBUS block This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” serial stream (SPI: serial peripheral inventory), to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 VS supplied by the rear access panel.
REMOTE INVENTORY
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
532 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Its main functions are:
D Rx 1
O Tx 1
SFP #1 MODULE D Tx 1
FPGA
SERIALIZER DESERIALIZER #1
O Rx 2
D Rx 2
O Tx 2
SFP #2 D Tx 2 MODULE
CROSS–CONNECTION MATRIX STMn RS Sink GENERIC AIS
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
O Rx 1
SERIALIZER DESERIALIZER #2
O Rx 3
D Rx 3
O Tx 3
SFP #3 MODULE D Tx 3
SERIALIZER DESERIALIZER #3
O Rx 4
D Rx 4
SFP #4 MODULE
O Tx 4
SERIALIZER
D Tx 4
DESERIALIZER #4 #1 #2 #3 #4
ALARMS &
Ï Ï Ï Ï ÏÏÏ Ï
CONTROLS
Configuration & Status Management Bus (ISPB) M–BUS Driver Bus–OFF RIBUS(SPI) ID
3.3 V
CMISS
Remote Inventory
1.5V
+3.3 Vdc
F
DC/DC CONVERTERS
from CONGI
internal voltages
Unit Failure
RIBUS I/F
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
2XCH TRANSPONDER SFP W/O OPTICS
Figure 274. 2xCH Transponder SFP Without optics COWLA2
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
533 / 636
4.45 EQUICO card
The EQUICO unit through the Equipment Controller (EC) manage: •
local dialog with a personal computer (F interface)
•
dialog with the Operation System for Network Management operation through Q3 and DCC interface
•
dialog with a remote Operation System for Network Management operation through interface QAUX .
•
dialog with the external equipment for Network Management operations through Interface Q2 (Mediation Device Function)
•
remote alarms (RE) , alarms criteria towards the rack lamps (RA), housekeeping alarms (HK) and front cover led
•
ISSB bus
The EC performs as well all the SW functions related to the control and management activities like info–model processing, event reporting and logging, equipment data base management, SW downloading and management, etc. To support its activities the EC function requires a non volatile mass storage device (FLASH CARD), boot memory (FEPROM) and RAM memory. F interface: It is used for connection to a local Craft Terminal; The standard implementation of the physical layer for the F interface consists of an RS–232 UART port accessible from the EQUICO card front panel Q3 interface: It is dedicated to an OS station connection through Local Access Network (LAN); QB3 requires a 10BASE2 or a 10BASET interface that is physical provided by CONGI card DCC interface: It is a TMN related communication interface based on the use of the Embedded Communication Channels available in the SOH portion of the SDH frame. Through the QECC interface the 1660SM can exchange management messages with a remote OS. In the 1660SM up to three full duplex ECC channels can be terminated from each SDH interface: one DCC_M at 576 kbit/s, one DCC_R at 192 Kbit/s and one DCC_P 64 Kbit/s (F2, F3 bytes of VC4 ). QAUX interface:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
It is provided as an additional TMN communication interface for message exchange between the NE and a Remote OS station based on the use of a 2 Mbit/s proprietary protocol. It can be physically terminated on a 2 Mbit/s auxiliary channel on the SERVICE card. Q2 interface: A mediation function interface is provided to connect the 1660SM to non–SDH network element The RS–485 interface and the cable connector are provided on the CONGI card.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
534 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 275. on page 536 )
RE, RA, HK and leds interface:
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
RE consists of parallel I/O signals used for remote alarms that can be accessed on the CONGI card RA is dedicated to send commands toward the rack to light up the relevant lamps.; the physical interface is available on the CONGI card. By pressing a push button is possible to store an alarm; HK consist of parallel I/O signals used to handle housekeeping signals (for example alarms received from Fans Subrack, open door etc.); In this way they can be supervised by Craft Terminal. The physical interface is available on the CONGI card. The Equipment Controller also drive the leds present on the front cover to display alarms or status indication concerning the equipment ; for the meaning of the leds see para 2.4 on page 120. By pressing a push button present on the EQUICO front cover is possible to check the efficiency of the leds. ISSB bus: It is an high performance bus supporting communication among the EC function, the SC function on the MATRIX and Local Microprocessor present on the ATM board. Other functions implemented are : •
RESET PUSH–BUTTON used for EC reset.
•
RIBUS I/F This block control the LED on the unit and is also used by the Shelf Controller on the MATRIX to read the remote inventory data though the ”RIBUS” . RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 Vdc supply by CONGI boards.
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
DC/DC CONVERTERS This block converts the 48/60 V power supply to secondary voltages necessary for the circuits on the board: +3.3 V and + 2.5 V used to supply all the components in the board.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
535 / 636
F INTERFACE
DCC
DCC MANAGEMENT
To/from STM–N port
Q2 To/from CONGI
Q3
EC
QAUX
Reset
To/from SERVICE
ISSB
To/from MATRIX main and spare, ATM board
Lamp test Remote alarms RE
FEPROM
Alarm storing
REMOTE ALARMS Rack alarms RACK LAMPS RA HOUSEKEEPING Housekeeping LEDS HK
RAM
MANAGEMENT
FLASH CARD
front cover leds Remote Inventory
RIBUS RIBUS I/F
ID
3.3 V
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
2.5 V
From/to MATRIX main and spare
+3.3 Vdc
Unit Failure
EQUICO
To/from CONGI
48/60 V
DC/DC CONVERTERS
from CONGI A & B
Figure 275. 1660SM EQUICO Card Block Diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
536 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
To/From Craft Terminal
4.46 MATRIX card (MATRIXN)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 276. on page 540) The MATRIX card used in the 1660 SM equipment performs different functions : •
connections between ports (ATM matrix included)
•
equipment synchronization functions
•
Shelf Controller functions
•
performance monitoring collection
•
power supply
•
remote inventory
As the MATRIX is in 1+1 redundant configuration, all the functions realized by the unit are redundant as well. CONNECTIONS The connections between MATRIX and ports are realized by means of links at 622 Mbit/s (link X, link L and link H in Figure 276. on page 540)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
On the MATRIX are implemented the following SDH functions to realize the connections : •
MSP (Multiplex Section Protection) It performs the Multiplex Section Protection (linear and MS–PRING) according to the MSP algorithm result. Refer to para 3.13.2 on page 323 for details on MSP linear protection. Refer to para 3.13.8 on page 342 for details on MS–SPRING protection.
•
AU4 squelching It is used to avoid mis–connections when the MS–SPRING protection is active. For each incoming and outgoing AU4 , should be possible to insert AIS.
•
SNCP (Sub–Network Connection Protection) It performs the Sub–Network Connection Protections, in case of SNCP–ring network configuration, switching from A to B path signals (A and B are two generic transmission side). SNCP is of types HO–SNCP (for VC4 path signals) and LO–SNCP (for VC3 ,VC12, etc. path signals). It can be SNCP/I and SNCP/N; Refer to para 3.13.4 on page 327 for details on SNCP protection
•
HPC (High order Path Connection) This block acts as connection matrix, supporting cross–connection for a max of 96x96 STM1 equivalent signals at VC–4 level.
•
LPC (Low order Path Connection) This block acts as connection matrix, supporting cross–connection for a max of 64x64 STM1 equivalent signals at VC–12 level. In this condition the HPC matrix has a max capacity of 32x32 STM1 equivalent signals at VC–4 level.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
537 / 636
The equipment synchronization is realized by the SETS function (Synchronous Equipment Timing Source) that distributes to each equipment port the pertaining synchronization signals. A high stability oscillator at 10MHz is present to guarantee an holdover or free running working mode compliant to the ITU–T Recs. The clock reference working modes can be: locked, hold over and free running. When working in locked mode , the SETS block can select its reference signal among (the selection is accomplished by means of the software and craft terminal): • • •
timing reference signals coming from the SDH ports (T1 ) 2 MHz signal coming from the PDH ports (T2 ) 2 MHz clocks (T3) or 2 Mbit/s signals (T6) coming from the SERVICE card The T3/T6 clocks are two (i.e. T3a, T3b or T6a, T6b).
The SETG block (Synchronous Equipment Timing Generation) generates : •
a system clock T0 (at 622.08 MHz) locked to the selected reference (T1, T2, T3/T6) and distributed to the equipment. CK38Mhz : it is derived from the system clock (T0) and is distributed to all the ports. Its frequency is 38.88 MHz. MFSY : it is the multiframe synchronism at 500 Hz, obtained from the ck38MHz. It is distributed to all the ports. a 2 MHz clock T4 or a 2 Mbit/s signal T5 used as synchronization clock towards the external, accessible from the SERVICE board. The T4/T5 clocks are two (T4a, T4b and T5a, T5b).
• • •
For a detailed description of the synchronization subsystem refer to para 3.14 at page 351. SHELF CONTROLLER FUNCTIONS The MATRIX houses the circuitry necessary to realize the Shelf Controller. The SC provide the resources to support the SW functions related to the control and management operation of the boards. To perform its functions, the SC directly interfaces the ASICS on the board implementing the SDH functions for data collection (faults or alarm event detections, performance monitoring data) and configuration provisioning. As the SC is involved in critical activities ( for instance EPS ) , is 1+1 protected.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The internal interfaces supporting SC element for communication tasks are: –
Management –Bus. It is a parallel bus connecting the SC processor to all the transport Asics located on the traffic cards to provide communications among the units and the Controller, for management of the units (management of payload processing functions).
–
ISSB : Intra Shelf Serial Bus is a serial bus for communication among SC, EC (on the EQUICO card) and , if present, other processor in the Shelf.
–
RIBUS . It is a serial bus connecting the SC processor to the serially interfaced devices called RIBUS–I/F, located on each board for simple read or write operations, for communications about Remote Inventory, cards failure, bus releasing. RIBUS I/F is powered by the + 3.3 Vdc supply by CONGI boards.
A push–button is present to reset the SC.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
538 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
EQUIPMENT SYNCHRONIZATION
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
For a detailed description of the Controller refer to para 3.12 on page 304, where the control subsystem is described. PERFORMANCE MONITORING COLLECTION The “Performance Monitoring Management” block housed on the MATRIX card realizes Performance Monitoring functionalities; it collects and stores the data ( Defect seconds and Errored blocks) coming from all the flows. The Performance monitoring can be made at : • • • • • •
Adaptation and Regeneration section Multiplex section Multiplex section adaptation HSUT and LSUT HPOM and LPOM HPT and LPT
POWER SUPPLY The unit receives via backpanel connectors the –48V coming from CONGI boards. The DC/DC converter present on the board generates the following voltage: • • • •
+ 3.3 V + 2.5 V +1.8 V +1.6 V
The Remote–Inventory and RIBUS–I/F blocks are powered by the 3.3 V power service coming from the CONGI boards . REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory used to maintain the board history and data.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
For more details about the Remote Inventory function refer to para 3.17 on page 358.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
539 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
PERFORMANCE MONITORING MANAGEMENT
MATRIX LPC
MSP SNCP
AU4 Squelcing
Link L Link H
from/to all port cards
HPC Link X T2 T1 (port)
Timing & Synchronization (SETS)
T0 10MHz OSC
T3a/T6a T3b/T6b
SETG
T4a/T5a T4b/T5b
Reset
MFSY CK38 T0
T0
Management bus
SC
Remote Inventory
Unit Failure
RIBUS
ID From/to spare MATRIX and EQUICO
ISSB
3.3 V 2.5 V 1.8 V
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
MATRIX
to ports
From/to spare MATRIX and ports
+3.3 Vdc RIBUS I/F
RIBUS
to/from SERVICE
Management bus
M–BUS Driver Bus OFF
FLASH EPROM (1 Mb)
from ports
48/60 V DC/DC CONVERTERS
+3.3 Vdc
from CONGI A & B
1.6 V
Figure 276. MATRIX card block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
540 / 636
4.47 CONGI card
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 277. on page 545) The 1660SM equipment can house two CONGI cards, referred as CONGI A main (slot 10) and CONGI B (slot 12). They are not intended as main and spare : each card provides a set of functions . Both units are necessary to provide the complete set. CONGI A can be used as stand alone but in this case only a subset of interfaces can be used . Table 52. reports the interfaces present on each CONGI card. Table 52. CONGI A and CONGI B interfaces CONGI A (slot 10)
CONGI B (slot 12)
POWER
POWER
Housekeeping & Remote Alarms (a subset)
Housekeeping & Remote Alarms ( a subset)
Rack lamps (R/M)
Not used
QMD (Q2)
Not used
Q3 10 base 2
Not used
Q3 10 base T
Not used
INT led
INT led
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The main functions performed by the unit are: [1]
Input power stage
[2]
AND/OR and Remote Alarms
[3]
Housekeeping interface (only on CONGI in slot 10)
[4]
R/M interface (only on CONGI in slot 10)
[5]
QMD interface (only on CONGI in slot 10)
[6]
RIMMEL interface
[7]
Q3/QB3 interface (only on CONGI in slot 10)
[8]
Remote inventory
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
541 / 636
This circuit decouples the power station battery . It contains the ”Main Power block” with two fuses, EMI input filters, a ”protection circuit block” , a ”step up converter” to provide –9 V and a DC/DC converter to provide the +3.3 V to the RIBUS I/F block ( see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details ). In case of fuse broken an alarm is generated (FUSE)2. A solder strap is present to provide the main power (48V) in modality “two wires” (if +Vbatt is connected to ground or “three wire” (if + Vbatt is not connected to ground) in order to obtain a DC/I decoupling system. [2] AND/OR and Remote Alarms The circuit generates the remote alarms and lights up the the Rack lamps in case of station battery fault. It is powered from the 3.3Vdc power from the service battery and uses it to control the station battery. In case of loss of 3.3 Vdc a PWANDOR alarm is generated. The AND/OR circuit monitors the station battery and provides an alarm (BAT FAIL) in case the voltage level decreases more than 20 % of the nominal value. If BAT FAIL alarm of the CONGI in slot 10 or the same alarm of the CONGI in slot 12 are present , the ORALIM alarm is generated and set to the EQUICO card. Table 53. on page 542 and Table 54. on page 543 report a brief description of the alarms provided by the AND/OR block respectively on CONGI in slot 10 and CONGI in slot 12 . They are all Electronic Ground contacts (GND = alarm, OPEN = no alarm) sent towards the housekeeping and remote alarms connector. Table 53. Remote alarm provided by the AND/OR block available on CONGI in slot 10 ACRONYM T*TOR
T*INT
Fault or loss of one station battery . It concurs to generate NURG, T*NURG and RNURG (it can be stored) Fault or loss of both batteries stations. It concurs to generate T*URG and RURG (it can be stored). It indicates an internal alarm. It is received from EQUICO
T*URG
It indicates an urgent alarm. It is provided from EQUICO
T*NURG
It indicates a not urgent alarm. It is received from EQUICO
T*AND
N.B.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
DESCRIPTION
On the Craft Terminal (C.T.) and on the Operation System (O.S). application the T*URG, and T* NURG remote alarm are named in a different way; the relation between this two terminology is explained in Table 72. on page 609.
2. For the right management of the FUSE alarm refer to MAINTENANCE section of the METRO OMSN C.T Operator’s Handbook. As a matter of fact some setting must be checked when two CONGI with different Factory code / ANV suffix are equipped in the subrack.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
542 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
[1] Input power stage
Table 54. Remote alarm provided by the AND/OR block available on CONGI in slot 12
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ACRONYM T*TORC
DESCRIPTION It indicates a loss of +3.3V generated by the on board DC/DC converter of one CONGI card. Indeterminate alarm synthesis. Indicate synthesis of alarms not associated to other severity (not used) It indicates an EQUICO microprocessor fault (it can be stored)
T*IND T*TUP T*TANC
It indicates loss of + 3.3 V generated by the on board DC/DC converters of both CONGI cards (it can be stored). It indicates loss of communication with the Operation System (not used)
LOSQ2
[3] Housekeeping interface Two Housekeeping operating mode are supported for CONGI unit: –
CONGI unit preset 2 wire provide 6 inputs and 2 outputs contacts suitable for customer purpose.
–
CONGI unit preset 3 wire provide 4 inputs and 2 outputs contacts suitable for customer purpose.
[4] R/M interface It is used to connect the rack lamps and incoming call signal. Table 55. Rack lamps signals ACRONYM
FUNCTION
T*RATTD
alarms storing
T*RURG
urgent alarm
T*RNURG
not urgent alarm
T*CH
incoming call
T*TOR
absence of one battery
N.B.
On the Craft Terminal (C.T.) and on the Operation System (O.S). application the T*RURG, and T* RNURG remote alarm sent toward the rack lamp are named in a different way; the relation between this two terminology is explained in Table 72. on page 609.
[5] QMD interface It is a RS–485 interface that allows the dialogue between the NE (EC function) and a non SDH equipment. In this case the NE acts as a mediation device. [6] RIMMEL interface
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
This block provide a serial communication interface with the FANS Shelf in order to receive information like presence of fans unit, fan alarms, fans unit remote inventory etc. (for details about connection with FANS Shelf refer to Installation Handbook). “Rimmel block” is also connected with the Shelf Controller (housed on the MATRIX) and Equipment Controller (housed on the EQUICO) in order to: –
manage the HOUSEKEEPING contact
–
provisioning remote alarm
–
read the 2/3 wire operating mode
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
543 / 636
[7] Q3/QB3 interface
–
2 BNC for 10 Base 2 connection type
–
RJ45 for 10 base T connection type.
The Coaxial Transceiver Interface (CTI) circuit performs the driver/receiver interface between the Q3/QB3 coaxial cable ( BNC) and the universal ethernet adapter (AUI). The purpose of the AUI adapter is to adapt the signal, coming from the Equipment Controller on the EQUICO, to the LAN interface. It is directly connected to the RJ45 connector or through CTI to BNC connector.
[8] Remote inventory
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
It is the memory used to maintain the board history and communication and routing data relevant to the NE ;Remote Inventory activity is managed by the RIBUS I/F block as described on para. 3.17 on page 358.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
544 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The Q3/QB3 interface on CONGI is used for OS connection. Two connectors are available :
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2/3 wire mode + Batt_A Station battery – Batt_A
Fuse
Input Power Stage MAIN
– Batt
POWER BLOCK
Fuse
EMI FILTER
TO ALL BOARDS
+Batt STEP UP CONVERTER
–9V
PROTECTION CICUIT BLOCK
+3.3Vdc TO ALL BOARDS
DC/DC 3.3 V
to RIBUS I/F Fuse BAT FAIL
48V 20%
PWANDOR
OR ALIM
OR
RACK LAMPS
BAT FAIL
R/M AND/OR
HOUSEKEEPING AND REMOTE ALARM
URG, NURG, LOSQ2, INT, UP
To
EQUICO
To other CONGI To
EQUICO
To EQUICO From other CONGI alarms from EQUICO
REMOTE ALARM 6/4 HOUSKEEPING_IN
HK–IN
2 HOUSKEEPING_OUT
HK–OUT RIMMEL
FANS unit FANS management
to/from EQUICO and MATRIX
Serial Link
NON SDH EQUIPMENT
QMD INTERFACE (Q2)
to/from EQUICO
M U X
TRANSCEIVER
not used
–9V
OPERATION SYSTEM 10BASE2
COAX TRANSCEIVER INTERFACE (CTI)
10BASET
FAIL
Q3 INTERFACE
UNIVERSAL ETHERNET INTERFACE ADAPTER (AUI)
Remote Inventory
M U X
to/from EQUICO not used
+3.3 Vdc
RIBUS I/F
RIBUS
CMISS
to/from MATRIX main and spare
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
CONGI
Figure 277. CONGI – Block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
545 / 636
4.48 SERVICE card
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 278. on page 551) The SERVICE card provides the following functions : [1]
AUX (auxiliary) channels management
[2]
Input/output clock management
[3]
EOW channels management
[4]
POWER SUPPLY for internal board use.
[1] AUX channels management It provides : –
four G.703 64 Kbit/s channels, ITU–T G.703 compliant
–
four V11 channels , every one composed by data input, data output and clock
–
four RS–232 channels
–
two 2 Mbit/s G.703 signals that can be used as auxiliary channels
All the electrical interfaces are managed by the Matrix present on the unit. [2] Input/Output clock management Function performed: –
the unit can receives up to two 2 MHz clock (T3a and T3b) or up to two 2Mbit/s signals (T6a and T6b) that could be used to synchronize the N.E. The unit provide software programmability to switch between the two mode.
–
the unit provides up to two 2 MHz clock (T4a and T4b) or up to two 2Mbit/s signals (T5a and T5b) that can be used by another N.E. for synchronism purpose. The unit provide software programmability to switch between the two mode.
[3] EOW management The EOW channels allows to realize two different connections types: a)
between two stations (selective call)
b)
omnibus call (one station is connected with all the other
To this purpose a telephone jack is present on the unit front panel.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Two extension channels with different connectors (RJ45 and RJ11) are available to establish a connection with an external telephone set. Moreover the channel on RJ11 can be used to establish a connection with an external telephone network (future application). The ”Omnibus call” is identified with ”00”.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
546 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Two LEDs L1 and L2 indicate the line status according to the type of call . Table 56. on page 547 and Table 57. on page 547 show the L1 and L2 LEDs meaning for a selective/multiple call and for the omnibus call. Table 56. L1, L2 LEDs status for selective call STATUS
CALLING PARTY
CALLED PARTY
THIRD PARTY
L1 (green)
L2 (yellow)
L1 (green)
L2 (yellow)
L1 (green)
L2 (yellow)
Line engaged
ON
––
ON
––
ON
––
Selective call
ON
––
F
––
ON
––
Replay to selective call
ON
––
ON
––
ON
––
Third party inclusion
ON
––
ON
––
ON
––
Third party inclusion allowed
ON
ON
ON
––
ON
––
Third party selection ended
ON
ON
ON
––
F
––
Reply to third party
ON
––
ON
––
ON
––
Clear third party
ON
––
ON
––
ON
––
Clear forward
ON
––
ON
––
––
––
Clear back
ON
––
ON
––
––
––
Table 57. L1, L2 LEDs status for omnibus call
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
STATUS
CALLING PARTY
CALLED PARTY REPLY
NO ANSWER FROM CALLED PARTY
L1 (green)
L2 (yellow)
L1 (green)
L2 (yellow)
L1 (green)
L2 (yellow)
Line engaged
ON
––
ON
––
ON
––
Omnibus call
ON
––
F
F
F
F
T < 60 seconds An answer at least
ON
––
ON
F
F
F
T < 60 seconds Called party inclusion
ON
––
ON
ON
F
F
T > 60 seconds An answer at least
ON
––
ON
F
ON
F
T > 60 seconds Called party inclusion
ON
––
ON
ON
ON
F
Third party exclusion
ON
––
ON
F
ON
F
Clear back
ON
––
ON
F
ON
F
Clear forward
––
––
––
––
––
––
LEGENDA ON : LED on fixed –– : LED off F : LED flashing
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
547 / 636
The connection between two stations is made when the operator selects the service area desired and the phone number of the station to call. The logical sequence of the main operations about the connection is the following: 1)
Manual selection of the zone where we want to call, pushing Selection Button. The relative Zone’s Led will show the selection (ORANGE color).
2)
Verify the state of the line in the zone: –
Leds L1 and L2 show the state of the line
–
Free or Engaged Tone are sent to the Phone
3)
If the line is free and the Inclusion Button is pushed, the phone will be linked to the Party Line of the selected zone and the zone becomes engaged. The Green Led L1 will be ON on all stations of the zone.
4)
Selection of the phone number on the keyboard telephone handset
5)
Recognize call on called station The called station recognize the phone number and the consequent action is that the led L1 (Green) will flash and the buzzer will ring.
6)
Start of the conversation When the user hangs on the phone the conversation shall start In this condition the buzzer will be off and the led L1 (green) will be on.
7)
End of the conversation
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The connection will finish when the caller or the called user will hang off the phone making free the zone.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
548 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Selective call
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Omnibus call The Omnibus connection between one station and all the others in one zone is made when the operator selects the service area desired and the Omnibus call phone number ’00’. The logical sequence of the main operations about the connection is the following: 1)
Manual selection of the zone where we want to call, pushing Selection Button. The relative Zone’s Led will show the selection (ORANGE color).
2)
Verify the state of the line in the zone: –
Leds L1 and L2 show the state of the line
–
Free or Engaged Tone are sent to the Phone
3)
If the line is free and the Inclusion Button is pushed, the phone will be linked to the Party Line of the selectioned zone that becomes engaged. The Green Led L1 will be ON on all stations of the zone.
4)
Selection of the phone number that is 00 for an Omnibus call.
5)
Recognize call on called station the leds L1 (Green) and L2 (Yellow) will flash and the buzzer will ring.
6)
Start of the conversation When the called users hang on the phone the conversation shall start. In this situation the buzzer will be off, led L1 will be on (green) and led L2 will be flashing (yellow). During the conversation, the caller talks and all the other users listen to, but if any of the other users press the Inclusion Button they shall talk in the Omnibus Call while the button remains pressed.
7)
End of the conversation The connection will finish when the caller will hang off the phone making free the line. In the Omnibus call when the users called want to finish the listening, they hang off the phone.
Matrix
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The Matrix: –
receives / transmits data from /to the electrical interfaces (G.703, V11, RS–232, 2 Mbit/s, 2Mhz)
–
receives configurations data from ”Management Bus”
–
receives/transmits a serial signal from/to the digital party line (serial port)
–
receives /transmits data (SOH bytes) from/to the STM–N ports and EQUICO and realize cross connections.
–
receives clock and synchronism from the MATRIX
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
549 / 636
Digital party line
–
manages the information coming from the SOH matrix
–
detects DTMF code coming from the different channels
–
party line
–
manages LEDs , buzzer , push buttons and speech extensions present on the card front unit
–
receives configuration information from the ”Management Bus”
AD/DA This block is a voice–band audio processor and perform the transmit encoding (A/D conversion) and receive decoding (D/A conversion) together with transmit and receive filtering for voice–band communication systems. Other functions implemented are : •
RIBUS I/F This block is used to read/write from/to the ”RIBUS” stream, to control the LED on the unit, to release the Management–bus in case of power failure, and to use the remote inventory:
•
REMOTE INVENTORY It is the memory containing the board information, for identification purposes (see para. 3.17 on page 358 for details).
•
M–BUS Driver It drives the input–output gates of the Management–bus. These drivers can be disabled (by the Bus–OFF signal) in case of power failure.
[4] POWER SUPPLY The unit receives via backpanel connectors the –48V coming from CONGI boards. The DC/DC converter present on the board generates the following voltage: • • •
+ 3.3 V + 2.5 V to supply the party line and the SOH Matrix – 9 V to supply the phone
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The Remote–Inventory and RIBUS–I/F blocks are powered by the 3.3 V power service coming from the CONGI boards .
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
550 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The function performed by the Digital Party Line are:
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
2 x 2 Mbit/s
2 x 2MHz input
T3a/T6a T3b/T6b
2 x 2MHz output
T4a/T5a T4b/T5b
4 x 64 Kbit/s
AUX
G.703
QAUX OH MATRIX
DCC
to/from EQUICO
T3 T4
G.703
ck system A ck system A
V.11
4 x V.11
to/from STM–N ports
51 MHz RS–232
4 x RS232
L1 L2 Z1
Z8
Serial Port
2.5 V Config. & Status
Buzzer zone selection line reset line seizure
DIGITAL PARTY LINE
M–BUS Driver
RAM RJ11 External Phone extension
AD/DA
RJ45 External Phone extension
AD/DA
Telephone
AD/DA
to/from MATRIX main and spare
Management Bus
Bus–OFF
Remote Inventory
RIBUS
RIBUS I/F
FAULT
–9V 3.3 Vdc 3.3 V 2.5 V –9 V
48/60 V
from CONGI A& B
DC/DC CONVERTERS
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
SERVICE
Figure 278. SERVICE block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
551 / 636
4.49 FAN UNIT FOR FAN SHELF 19”
The FANS SHELF 19” is composed by a mechanical structure and a back–plane. The Fan Shelf is used to prevent high temperature inside the 1660SM equipment and must be equipped with four FAN UNIT FOR FAN SHELF 19” and two DUST FILTER FOR FAN SHELF 19”. In the lower part of the shelf are present 5 connectors the meaning of which is explained in Figure 76. on page 165. Each FANS UNIT is composed by four fans and some electronic circuits necessary to: •
fans and alarms management
•
dust filter management
•
remote inventory
•
power supply
FANS ALARM MANAGEMENT The core of the FAN UNIT FOR FAN SHELF is the “Fan Controller” that perform the following functionality: –
FAN power supply:at the start up the control of FANS is distributed in sharing mode, so the max current value is reduced at only one FAN at a time.
–
FAN control: the sensing criteria is integrated in order to have an alarm if almost one fan is out of order. If an alarm is present (FAN AL1, FAN AL2, FAN AL3, FAN AL4) because a fan is temporary out of order, the Fan controller try every 8 sec. to restart the fan.
–
Temperature sensor: an external sensor generate an alarm (TEMP AL) when the temperature exceed 55_ C.
–
Remote inventory: through this interface the fan controller read the information stored in the flash EPROM.
–
LED control: the meaning of the led is reported in Figure 76. on page 165.
–
Serial Alarms Interface: the FAN controller reports the alarm on a serial link toward the CONGI board in order to transfer the information to the Shelf Controller on the MATRIXN.
The Fans controller generate an alarm called ALM_URG B #n if at least one fan is faulty or the 12Vdc is not present.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
DUST FILTER Two filters are present at the bottom of the fan shelf in order to prevent dusty problem at cooled circuit. This filter could not be removed permanently because the bottom grid performs the function of anti–fire protection. Two electro–mechanical sensor checks if the filters has been removed from the Shelf. These information (FILTER AL1 and FILTER AL2) are than reported to the fan controller of each FAN UNIT FOR FAN SHELF 19”.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
552 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
(See Figure 279. on page 554 and Figure 279. on page 554)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
REMOTE INVENTORY It is a flash EPROM where are stored information about the unit like construction date, code number, maker name, Card–type, etc. POWER SUPPLY The main power supply is coming from two connectors: power supply “A” and power supply “B” coming from station battery. The voltage value for both battery is : 48 Vdc ± 20% 3A max; in case of failure an alarm is generated (AL BAT_A, AL BAT_B) A DC/DC converter on the unit provides the 12V necessary to power the FANs. Another DC/DC converter provides the 3.3V power supply voltage from which through a serial regulator is derived a 2.5 V. If one of the above secondary voltage are not present , is generated an alarm (PSU ALM #n).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
553 / 636
BATTERY A BATTERY B
ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÌÌ ÏÏÌÌ ÏÏ ÌÌ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ
FILTER AL1 FILTER AL2
F I L T E R
S E N S O R
SLOT ID
D U S T
FILTER AL1
BATTERY A BATTERY B FILTER AL1 FILTER AL2
BATTERY A
D U S T F I L T E R 2
S E N S O R
BATTERY B FILTER AL1 FILTER AL2 FILTER AL2 SLOT ID
ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏÌÌ ÏÏ ÌÌ ÏÏÌÌ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏ
SLOT ID
1
BATTERY A BATTERY B FILTER AL1 FILTER AL2
FAN UNIT FOR FAN SHELF 19” #0
FAN UNIT FOR FAN SHELF 19” #1
ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ FAN UNIT FOR FAN SHELF 19” #2
FAN UNIT FOR FAN SHELF 19” #3
PSU ALM #3 PSU ALM #2
> _ 1
PSU ALM
PSU ALM #1 PSU ALM #0
ALM_URG_B #0 ALM_URG_B #1 ALM_URG_B #2
> _ 1
ALM_URG
ALM_URG_B #3
PSU ALM #1
ALM_URG_B #1
PSU ALM #2
ALM_URG_B #2
PSU ALM #3
ALM_URG_B #3
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
FAN SHELF 19”
Figure 279. Fans shelf 19” general block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
554 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
BATTERY B
ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ
to CONGI Housekeeping
SLOT ID
BATTERY A
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏÏ AL_12V
ALBAT_A
BATTERY A
DC/DC Converter
BATTERY B
DC/DC Converter
+12 V
+12 V
P O W E R
+3.3 V
+3.3 V
+2.5 V
+2.5 V
SERIAL REGULATOR
A L A R M
PSU ALM
ALBAT_B
FANS1
FANS2
FAN AL1
FANS3
FAN AL2
+ 12 V
FANS4
FAN AL3
+ 12 V
FAN AL4
+ 12 V
+ 12 V
ALBAT_B
ALBAT_A
AL_12V
FAN AL3
FAN AL4
FAN AL2
FAN AL1
FAN control 4
FAN control 3
FAN control 2
FAN control 1
TEMP_AL
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
REMOTE
SLOT ID
INVENTORY
FANS CONTROL
FILTER AL1
FILTER
FILTER AL2
ALARM
FAULTY FANS SENSOR
POWER ALARM
LED
FANS CONTROLLER
ALM_URG_A
AL_12V
AL_FAN
SERIAL ALARM INTERFACE A
SERIAL ALARM INTERFACE B
NOT USED
ALM_URG_B
> _ 1
AL_FAN
NOT USED
NOT USED
FANS MANAGEMENT
to CONGI unit
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
FAN UNIT FOR FAN SHELF19”
Figure 280. Fans unit for fan shelf 19” block diagram
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
555 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
556 / 636 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5 TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS Data indicated in the handbook must be considered as standard values Data indicated in the contract must be considered as guaranteed values
5.1 General characteristics Optical Line bit rate
SDH:
Electrical Line bit rate
SDH: 155.520 Mbit/s (STM–1) SONET:155.520 Mbit/s (OC–3) PDH: 139.264 Mbit/s (PDH)
Type of optical fiber
Single mode according to ITU–TG.652, G.654 and Multimode G.651.
Wave length
See Table 63. on page 591, Table 64. on page 593, Table 66. on page 595 and Table 67. on page 597 .
Span length
Depending on fiber type and and optical power budget reported in Table 63. on page 591, Table 64. on page 593, Table 66. on page 595 and Table 67. on page 597 .
Application types
TM and ADM in protected and unprotected linear links and rings DXC (64 STM–1 equivalent port at VC12 level)
Applied standards
ITU–T G.703 for electrical interfaces TU–T G.707 for SDH frame and multiplexing structure ITU–T G.957 and G.958 for optical interfaces ITU–T G.821 and G.826 for transmission quality ITU–T G813 for synchronization ITU–T G.783 and G.841 for network protection architectures ITU–T G.784 and G.774 for system management functions ITU–T G.662 and G.663 for optical amplification
ED
155.520 Mbit/s (STM–1) 622.080 Mbit/s (STM–4) 2488.320 Mbit/s (STM–16) SONET:155.520 Mbit/s (OC–3) 622.080 Mbit/s (OC12)
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
557 / 636
Cross–Connections capacity
(96 x 96) STM1 equivalent ports at VC–4 level or (64 x 64) STM1 equivalent ports at VC12 and VC3 levels + (32 x 32) equivalent ports at VC–4 level.
Cross connect features
1660SM has a symmetrical architecture. All traffic port (PDH SDH) of the same type have the same functionality and behavior and there is no inherent split between tributaries and aggregates. This means that it is possible the allocation of the PDH and VCi signals into every port. Connection of concatenated AU4–4c among STM4 and STM–16 ports is supported 125 µs maximum for any traffic pathway
Transmission delay Protections Network protection
SNCP/I and SNCP/N Drop & Continue Single ended 1+1 MSP Dual ended 1+1 MSP Dual ended 1:N MSP 2 fiber MS–SPRING at STM–16 interfaces Collapsed single–node interconnection Collapsed dual–node interconnection ISA–PR packet level ring protection
Equipment protection
1 + 1 MATRIX and Timing EPS 1+1 ATM MATRIX (4X4 and 8x8) EPS 1+1 PR_EA MATRIX EPS 1+1 ISA ES–16 EPS N +1 63x2 Mbit/s EPS (N= 6 max) N + 1 3 x34 Mbit/s EPS (N= 15 max) N + 1 3 x 45 Mbit/s EPS (N= 15 max) N + 1 4 x STM–1 Electrical EPS (N= 15 max)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Management interface Local:
Craft Interface (Personal Computer)
RS232 PC compatible SUB–D 9 pins at 38 Kbit/s
Remote:
Craft Interface (Personal Computer)
RS232 PC compatible SUB–D 9 pins at 38 Kbit/s; it handles up to 31 NEs via DCC (D4 – D12 and/or D1–D3)
Remote:
Transmission Management Network (TMN) interface
G.773 QB3 10 base 2 and 10 base T
Information Model
According to ITU–T (G.774) and ETSI specification
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
558 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Add–Drop and Cross connect features
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Remote:
Management messaging with Alcatel Non–SDH equipments (Alcatel proprietary protocol)
Q2 (synchronous, bit rate = 19.2 kb/s) RQ2 (asynchronous, bit rates = 1.2–2.4–4.8–9.6 kb/s)
Protocol Stack/Information Model messages
According to ITU–T G.774 and ETSI rec. ISO–OSI 7–layers reference model. The ATM/IP functions are organized according to TCP/IP reference model; they are managed by means of SNMP protocol tunneling over OSI layers
Dual addressing to O.S.
It allows O.S. redundancy
Operation processes Configuration and provisioning
Equipment, ports, add–drop, cross–connect,synchronization, protection, MCF (Message Communications Function), SEMF (Synchronous Equipment Management Function) OH connection
Software download
It is made locally as well as remotely on non volatile memories without traffic interruption
Performance monitoring
According to G.784, G.826 and G.821.
Unit and Equipment acknowledgement
Through Remote Inventory (Company id, Unit Type, Unit Part Number, Serial Part Number , Software Part Number etc.) For detail refer to Operator Handbook.
Security
Password, operator profile, back–up for programs and data
Output Housekeeping signals (CPO) and Remote Alarms
By electronic relay contacts to be connected to external negative voltage:
Max. guaranteed current with closed condition 50 mA Voltage drops vs. ground with closed condition
–2 V ÷ 0 V
Max. allowed voltage with open condition
–72 V
Input Housekeeping signals (CPI)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Max. guaranteed current with closed condition 3 mA Voltage drops vs. ground with closed condition
–2 V ÷ 0 V
Max. allowed voltage with open condition
–72 V
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
559 / 636
Selectable input clock
2048 KHz from 2 Mbit/s port (T2) 2048 kHz external synch clock (2 input, T3a and T3b) or 2048 Mbit/s external synch (2 input, T6a and T6b) STM–N ports (T1)
No. of selected clock (normal mode)
6 max.
Synchronization output
2048 kHz G.703 (2 output, T4a and T4b) or 2048 Mbit/s (2 output T5a and T5b)
Operational modes
Locked to reference Free–run mode ±4.6 ppm (PLL without reference) Holdover mode drift 0.37 ppm max./day ( PLL with stored frequency for more than half an hour,with no selected input frequency)
Synchronization selection
Priority and SSM algorithm
Protection against lighting surges
TNV1 (Telecommunication Network Voltage) for 21 x 2 Mbit/s K20 access module
Additional features:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
VCi Signal Label management Programmable alarms severity VC–4, VC–3 and VC–12 Tandem Connection Termination & Monitoring (TCT/TCM) J0 – Section Trace Management J1/J2 Lower Order Path Trace Management (VC–12 and VC–3)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
560 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Clock characteristics
5.1.1 Optical Safety
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.1.1.1 Hazard Level classification The HAZARD LEVEL classification of the different optical interfaces is given in Table 58. on page 561. The hazard level can be assigned in accordance with the requirements of: –
IEC 60825–1 (1998), IEC 60825–2 (2000) or
–
IEC 60825–1 (1998) + Am. 2 (2001) and IEC 60825–2 (2000)
Table 58. Hazard level classification of different optical interfaces
OPTICAL INTERFACE
UNIT/PORT/ACRONYM
HAZARD LEVEL
STM–1
S–1.1 (short haul)
1
STM–1
L–1.1 (long haul)
3A ; 1M
STM–1
L–1.2 (long haul)
3A ; 1M
STM–1
L–1.2JE1 (long haul)
3A ; 1M
STM–1
MM1
3A ; 1M
STM–4
S–4.1 (short haul)
1
STM–4
L–4.1 (long haul)
3A ; 1M
STM–4
L–4.2 (long haul)
3A ; 1M
STM–16
S–16.1 (short haul)
3A ; 1M
STM–16
L–16.1 (long haul)
3A ; 1M
STM–16
L–16.2 (long haul)
3A ; 1M
STM–16
L–16.2JE2 (long haul)
3A ; 1M
STM–16
L–16.2JE3 (long haul)
3A ; 1M
STM–16
I–16.1 (Intra Office)
STM–16
L–16.2 colored port 16C 6400/12800
1 1M
BST10
1M
BST15
1M
BST17
1M
PR16
1
OPTO TRX 1.25GBE SFP–LX
1000B–LX
1
OPTO TRX 1.25GBE SFP–SX
1000B–SX
1
S–4.1 (short haul)
1
ISA–PR
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
5.1.1.2 Location type The equipment shall be installed in “restricted locations” (industrial and commercial premises) or “controlled locations” (optical cable ducts and switching centers).
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
561 / 636
Output optical interfaces data: the wavelength and the maximum optical power at the output connector of incorporated laser sources is given in Table 63. on page 591, Table 64. on page 593, Table 66. on page 595 and Table 67. on page on 597 . 5.1.1.4 Labelling The labels reported below are put during factory settings, except those (explanatory) concerning the STM–1 ports. In this case the labels are placed in a plastic bag and provided together with the module. The customer shall affix the label on the fibre protection cover of P4E4N, P4S1N units or A2S1 adapter depending on the particular interface of the module (STM–1 port). In the following description it is specified when the label shall be affixed by the customer. The optical interfaces which have HAZARD LEVEL 1 (see Table 58. on page 561) carry the following explanatory label:
The label is put on the fibre protection cover of the following ports: •
STM–1 PORT with S–1.1 interface (P4E4N, P4S1N units or A2S1 adapter – affixed by the customer) STM–4 PORT with S–4.1 interface STM–16 PORT with S–16.1 interface STM–16 PORT with I–16.1 interface PR–16
• • • •
The optical interfaces which have HAZARD LEVEL 3A (see Table 58. on page 561) carry the hazard symbol label:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The label is affixed near the optical connectors on the front plate of the following interfaces: • • • • • • • • • • • • • • •
ED
L–1.1 (STM–1 PORT) L–1.2 (STM–1 PORT) L–1.2JE1 (STM–1 PORT) L–4.1 (STM–4 PORT) L–4.2 (STM–4 PORT) S–16.1 (STM–16 PORT) L–16.1 (STM–16 PORT) L–16.2 (STM–16 PORT) L–16.2JE2 (STM–16 PORT) L–16.2JE3 (STM–16 PORT) L–16.2 (STM–16 colored PORT 6400/12800) BST10 BST15 BST17 ISA–PR
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
562 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.1.1.3 Incorporated laser sources characteristics
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The optical interfaces which have HAZARD LEVEL 3A (see Table 58. on page 561) and operate at 2nd window, carry the following explanatory label (a multilanguage label kit is also provided):
CAUTION LASER RADIATION WHEN OPEN DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM OR VIEW DIRECTLY WITH OPTICAL INSTRUMENTS
INVISIBLE LASER RADIATION DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM OR VIEW DIRECTLY WITH OPTICAL INSTRUMENTS
CLASS 3A LASER PRODUCT P.MAX=31mW,
= 1300 nm IEC 825 1993
The label is affixed on the fibre protection cover of the following ports: •
STM–1 PORT with L–1.1 interface (P4E4N, P4S1N units or A2S1 adapter – affixed by the customer) STM–4 PORT with L–4.1 interface STM–16 PORT with L–16.1 interface ISA–PR
• • •
The optical interfaces which have HAZARD LEVEL 3A (see Table 58. on page 561) and operate at 3rd window, carry the following explanatory label (a multilanguage label kit is also provided):
CAUTION LASER RADIATION WHEN OPEN DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM OR VIEW DIRECTLY WITH OPTICAL INSTRUMENTS
INVISIBLE LASER RADIATION DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM OR VIEW DIRECTLY WITH OPTICAL INSTRUMENTS
CLASS 3A LASER PRODUCT P.MAX=50 mW,
= 1550 nm IEC 825 1993
The label is put on the fibre protection cover of the following ports: •
STM–1 PORT with L–1.2 interface (P4E4N, P4S1N units or A2S1 adapter – affixed by the customer) STM–1 PORT with L–1.2JE1 interface (P4E4N, P4S1N units or A2S1 adapter – affixed by the customer) STM–4 PORT with L–4.2 interface STM–16 PORT with L–16.2 interface STM–16 PORT with L–16.2JE2 interface STM–16 PORT with L–16.2JE3 interface STM–16 colored PORT 6400/12800
•
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
• • • • •
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
563 / 636
The label is affixed on the fibre protection cover of the following ports: •
STM–1 PORT with L–1.1 interface (P4E4N, P4S1N units or A2S1 adapter – affixed by the customer) STM–4 PORT with L–4.1 interface STM–16 PORT with L–16.1 interface
• •
The optical interfaces which have HAZARD LEVEL 1M and operate at 3rd window (see Table 58. on page 561), carry the following explanatory label (a multilanguage label kit is also provided):
The label is affixed on the fibre protection cover of the following parts: •
STM–1 PORT with L–1.2 interface (P4E4N, P4S1N units or A2S1 adapter – affixed by the customer) STM–1 PORT with L–1.2JE1 interface (P4E4N, P4S1N units or A2S1 adapter – affixed by the customer) STM–4 PORT with L–4.2 interface STM–16 PORT with L–16.2 interface STM–16 PORT with L–16.2JE2 interface STM–16 PORT with L–16.2JE3 interface STM–16 colored PORT 6400/12800 BST10 BST15 BST17
• • • • • • • • •
The multilanguage label kit, for STM–1 ports, is placed in the same plastic bag provided together with the module where explanatory labels (in English language), above mentioned, are put. For all other ports (STM–4 and STM–16), the multilanguage label kit is inserted in the pre–package. The multilanguage label kit contains a set of label that reproduce the same (explanatory) above depicted in the following languages:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
• • • •
Italian Francaise Spanish German
The customer, to its own discretion, may stick the labels with appropriate language upon the pre–existing ones or, in case of STM–1 ports, directly on the fibre protection cover of P4E4N, P4S1N units or A2S1 adapter.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
564 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The optical interfaces which have HAZARD LEVEL 1M (see Table 58. on page 561) and operate at 2nd window, carry the following explanatory label (a multilanguage label kit is also provided):
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
N.B.
As an aid to identify the right label to be affixed to an optical module (HAZARD LEVEL 1, HAZARD LEVEL 3A 2nd window, HAZARD LEVEL 3A 3rd window, HAZARD LEVEL 1M 1st window, HAZARD LEVEL 1M 2nd window, HAZARD LEVEL 1M 3rd window) refer to paragraph 2.2 on page 88 where is reported the relationship between the Part number (ex. 3AL 78815AA––) and the interface type (ex. S–1.1) and then refer to Table 58. on page 561 where is reported the relationship between the interface type (ex. S–1.1) and the Hazard Level.
5.1.1.5 Aperture and fiber connectors The locations of apertures and fibre connectors are reported on topographical drawings of units front view and access cards front view in paragraph 2.4 on page 120.
5.1.1.6 Engineering design features In normal operating conditions, unless intentional manumission, the laser radiation is never accessible. The laser beam is launched in optical fibre through an appropriate connector that totally shuts up the laser radiation. Moreover a plastic cover is fitted upon optical connectors by means of screws. In case of cable fibre break, to minimize exposure times, ALS procedure according to ITU–T G.958 Rec. is implemented either on STM–1 port or on STM–4 and STM–16 ports. ALS timing are not longer than maximum specified in G.958.
5.1.1.7 Safety instruction The safety instructions for proper assembly, maintenance, and safe use including clear warning concerning precautions to avoid possible exposure to hazardous laser radiation, are reported in para. 3.2 on page 31 thru 38 and more specifically in para.3.2.4.2 on page 35. 5.1.2 Electrical Safety Electrical Safety Safety status of the connections with other equipments
TNV2 (Telecommunication Network Voltage) for Remote Alarms, Housekeeping Alarms (CPO, CPI), Rack Lamp (RM) SELV (Safety Extra Low Voltage) for all the other
5.1.2.1 Labelling The labels reproduced in para.3.2.3.1 on page 33 are affixed during factory settings. 5.1.2.2 Safety instructions
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The safety instructions for proper assembly, maintenance, and safe use including clear warning concerning precautions to avoid possible exposure to hazardous voltages, are reported in para. 3.2 on pages 31 thru 38 and more specifically in para.3.2.3.2 on page 33.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
565 / 636
5.2 Electrical interface characteristics
Type of interface
Electrical according to ITU–T Rec. G.703
Bit rate
2048 Kbit/s 50 ppm
No. of channels
21
Code
HDB3
Signal amplitude
2.37 Vp on 75 Ohm unbalance
Attenuation
0 to 6 dB at 1024 Khz with law Ǹ f
Return loss
w12 dB 51–102 kHz w18 dB 102–2048 kHz w14 dB 2048–3072 kHz
Pulse shape
See ITU–T Rec. G.703
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.2.1 21 X 2 Mbit/s 75 Ohm electrical characteristics (A21E1)
5.2.2 21 X 2 Mbit/s 120 Ohm electrical characteristics (A21E1) The electrical characteristics are the same of para 5.2.1 on page 566 except for: Signal amplitude
3 Vp on 120 Ohm balance
5.2.3 21 X 2 Mbit/s 120 Ohm K20 electrical characteristics (A21E1) The electrical characteristics are the same of para 5.2.2 on page 566 except for: Protection against lighting surges
According to ITU–T Rec. K20
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
5.2.4 3 X 34 Mbit/s electrical characteristics (A3E3) Type of interface
Electrical, according to ITU–T Rec. G703
Bit Rate
34368 Kbit/s " 20 ppm
No. of tributaries
3
Code
HDB3
Signal amplitude
1Vp/75ohms
Attenuation accepted on the incoming signal
0–12dB at 17.184kHz with law pf
Return loss
w12 dB 860–1720 kHz w18 dB 1720–34368 kHz w14 dB 34368–51550 kHz
Pulse shape
as per Fig.17 of ITU–T Rec. G.703
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
566 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.2.5 3 X 45 Mbit/s electrical characteristics (A3T3) Type of interface
Electrical, according to ITU–T Rec. G703 and to ANSI TS 102 Rec.
Bit rate
44.736 Kbit/s " 20ppm
No. of tributaries
3
Code
B3ZS
Signal amplitude
According to ITU–T Rec. G.703 par.5.8 and ANSI T1 102 Rec, Tab.5
Attenuation accepted on the incoming signal
According to ANSI T1 102, Annex A2.5
Pulse shape
as per Fig.14 of ITU–T Rec. G.703 or per Fig.14 of ANSI T1 102 Rec.
5.2.6 STM–1 electrical characteristics (A4 ES1 and ICMI) Type of interface
ITU–T Rec. G.703 compliant
Bit rate
155 520 Kbit/s 20 ppm
Code
CMI
Attenuation accepted on the incoming signal
0–12.7 dB at 78 Mhz with law Ǹ f
Return loss
w15 dB at 8–240 Mhz
Pulse shape
See ITU–T Rec. G.703
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
5.2.7 140 Mbit/s electrical characteristics (ICMI) Type of interface
ITU–T Rec. G.703 compliant
Bit rate
139264 Kbit/s 15 ppm
Code
CMI
Attenuation accepted on the incoming signal
0–12 dB at 70 Mhz with law Ǹ f
Return loss
w15 dB at 7–210 Mhz
Pulse shape
See ITU–T Rec. G.703
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
567 / 636
Speech Channel Interface
Front–panel telephone jack
Handset Impedance
600 ohms
Bandwidth
300 to 3400 Hz
Handset Operating current
18 mA
Input Tx gain
–4/0/0 dB
Output Rx gain
0/–7/0dB
Signalling
DTMF compliant with ITU–T Rec. Q.23
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.2.8 Engineering Order Wire characteristics (SERVICE)
Analog EOW Extension Impedance
600 ohms
Bandwidth
300–3400 Hz
Tx level
0 dBr ±0.5 dB
Rx level
0 dBr ±0.5 dB
5.2.9 AUX channels characteristics (SERVICE) Externally accessible data channel (OH bytes termination is Software programmable)
4 x 64 Kbit/s, G.703 codirectional (Rx synchronized) 4 x 64 Kbit/s V11 4 x 9600 baud RS232 2 x 2 Mbit/s G.703
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
64 Kbit/s (Rx synchronized) G.703 Bit rate
64 Kbit/s
Timing signals
64 Kbit/s and 8 kHz coding style embedded
Bearer
Two balanced pairs (120 ohms): one per route
Coding style
According to ITU–T Rec. G.703 codirectional
Outgoing pulse shape
See ITU–T Rec. G.703
Output Interface characteristics
See ITU–T Rec. G.703
Incoming Interface characteristics
as per the outgoing interface but modified by the characteristics of the interconnection pair. The input circuit can accept an 0 – 3 dB (128 KHz)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
568 / 636
V11 64Kbit/s contradirectional interface
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Type
electrical, according to ITU–T Rec. V11
Receivers Input impedance
> 6 Kohms
Rx levels
”1” or ”OFF” < –0.3 V ”0” or ”ON” > +0.3 V
Drivers Differential output
2 V (Min.)
Use: intrabuilding connections
RS–232 oversampled interface 9600 Kb/s Bit rate
9600 kb/s
Mode
RS–232 Tx & Rx data only
Electrical levels
24 Vpp
Use : intrabuilding connections
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
2 Mb/s G.703 /G.704 AUX channel interface Electrical
according to G.703 (75 Ohm or 120 Ohm using a special cable)
Attenuation
0 to 6 dB
Return loss
w12 dB 51–102 kHz w18 dB 102–2048 kHz w14 dB 2048–3072 kHz
Pulse shape
See ITU–T Rec. G.703
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
569 / 636
5.3 ATM interface characteristics
Throughput towards backpanel
622 Mbit/s
Switching capability
VC and VP switching
PDH containers
E1, E3
SDH containers
VC–12, VC–3, VC–4
Local port
VC–4
Port number
16 (any combination)
Connections
4000 max (VC or VP) unidirectional
VC/VP connection
Hard and Soft VCC/VPC
Policing
UPC and NPC (VC/VP)
Shaping
Input and Output (VC/VP)
Congestion management
SCD, EPD, TPD
OAM
AIS, RDI, CC
Signalling
PNNI
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.3.1 ATM matrix 4x4 switching capability (ATM4X4)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Table 59. ATM4X4 board: configurable TPs type and max, number Board acronym
max. TPs number
VC4–4C
VC4
VC3
VC12
E1
E3
T3
E1 IMA
ATM4X4
16
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
570 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.3.2 ATM matrix 4x4V2 switching capability (ATM4X4V2) Throughput towards backpanel
622 Mbit/s
Switching capability
VC and VP switching
PDH containers
E1, E3,T3
SDH containers
VC12, VC3, VC4
IMA(**) multiplexing
E1 from 1 to 8 channels
Port number
252 (any combination)
Connections
4000 max (VC or VP) unidirectional
VC/VP connection
Hard and Soft VCC/VPC
Policing
UPC and NPC (VC/VP)
Shaping
Input and Output (VC/VP)
Congestion management
SCD, EPD, TPD
OAM
AIS, RDI, CC
Signalling
PNNI
Table 60. ATM4X4V2 board: configurable TPs type and max, number Board acronym
max. TPs number
VC4–4C
VC4
VC3
VC12
E1
E3
T3
E1 IMA
ATM4X4V2
252
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(**) For deatailed information about IMA refer to AF–PHY–0086.001
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
571 / 636
Throughput towards backpanel
622 Mbit/s
Switching capability
VC and VP switching
PDH containers
E1, E3,T3
SDH containers
VC12, VC3, VC4
IMA(**) multiplexing
E1 from 1 to 8 channels
Port number
16 (any combination)
Connections
4000 max (VC or VP) unidirectional
VC/VP connection
Hard and Soft VCC/VPC
Policing
UPC and NPC (VC/VP)
Shaping
Input and Output (VC/VP)
Congestion management
SCD, EPD, TPD
OAM
AIS, RDI, CC
Signalling
PNNI
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.3.3 ATM matrix 4x4 D3 switching capability (ATM4X4D3)
Table 61. ATM4X4D3 board: configurable TPs type and max, number Board acronym
max. TPs number
VC4–4C
VC4
VC3
VC12
E1
E3
T3
E1 IMA
ATM4X4D3
16
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
(**) For deatailed information about IMA refer to AF–PHY–0086.001
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
572 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.3.4 ATM matrix 8x8 switching capability (ATM8X8) Throughput towards backpanel
1.2 Gbit/s
Switching capability
VC and VP switching
PDH containers
E1, E3
SDH containers
VC–12, VC–3, VC–4, VC4–4c
Local port
No
Port number
32 (any combination)
Connections
8000 max (VC or VP) unidirectional
VC/VP connection
Hard and Soft VCC/VPC
Policing
UPC and NPC (VC/VP)
Shaping
Input and Output (VC/VP)
Congestion management
SCD, EPD, TPD
OAM
AIS, RDI, CC
Signalling
PNNI
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Table 62. ATM8X8 board: configurable TPs type and max, number Board acronym
max. TPs number
VC4–4C
VC4
VC3
VC12
E1
E3
T3
E1 IMA
ATM8X8
32
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
573 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Throughput
1000 Mb/s (with 4xFE i/f) 1800 Mb/s (with 1xGbE i/f)
PDH containers (not operative)
E1, E3
Ethernet frames
MAC 802.3, optionally “tagged” with 802.1p/q fields (user priority and VLAN identifier) Martini Encapsulation: optional
SDH containers
VC–12, VC–3, SDH/HDLC/PPP)
Local Ethernet ports
4 x 10/100Base–T 1 x1000Base–LX , 1 x 1000Base–SX, 1 x 1000Base–ZX
Remote Ethernet ports
unstruct. VC–4, un–concatenated ethernet frames over SDH (SDH/GFP framing)
Logical Ports number
63 (any combination)
Managed protocols
SNMP,TMN messaging inside DCN
Congestion management
W–RED (Weighed–Random Early Discard) Cut–off on low priority traffic only
Quality of Service (QoS)
Best Effort bandwidth (BE–BW) Min–BW with regulated bursts Guaranted constant BW
Police mechanism
Dual–Rate Leaky–Bucket, based on PIR and CIR values of the traffic contract
Scheduling
HOL and WC–WFQ methods
ED
VC–4
(POS
framing,
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
574 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.4 PR_EA characteristics and MPLS data traffic management (PREA4ETH, PREA1GBE)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.5 PR characteristics 5.5.1 ISA–PR port card interface characteristics Type of interface
Plug–in SFP Optical module at 622.080 Mbps (STM–4/OC–12), for up to 40 Km; see Table 64. on page 593 for the optical characteristics
STM–4 / OC–12 ports
4 : 2 east + 2 west
Throughput towards backpanel
6.5 Gbps
Ethernet frames
MAC 802.3, optionally “tagged” with 802.1p/q fields (Ethernet frame priority and VLAN identifier). Martini Encapsulation
SDH containers
SDH VC–4 Virtual Concatenation (VC–4–nv): VC–4–4v, VC–4–6v, VC4–8v, VC–4–4c
Managed Ethernet ports (located on access cards) 32 x 10/100Base–T 4 x1000Base–LX/SX/ZX 2 x1000Base–LX/SX/ZX and 16 x 10/100Base–T Managed protocols
SNMP V2c, NMS messaging in Band
Quality of Service (QoS) SLAs
Best Effort bandwidth Regulated bandwidth Guaranted bandwidth
Cabling
Optical fiber
Connector
LC/PC on SFP (Small Formfactor Pluggable) module
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
5.5.2 16FEA–PR access card interface characteristics Type of interface
Electrical, compliant to IEEE–802.3 standard, 10/100 Base–Tx
Transmit operations
Auto–negotiation options: 10Mbps, 100Mbps, full–duplex, flow control
Bit rate
Autosensing: 10 Mb/s and 100 Mb/s
Provisioning Granularity
100 Kbit/s
Signal amplitude, coding, attenuation, pulse shape, return loss
According to IEEE–802.3 standard, 10Base–T and 100Base–T
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
575 / 636
16 per access card used in conjunction with PR port card
Cabling
Twisted–pair, as per IEEE–802.3 rec.
Connector
RJ45
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
5.5.3 2GBA–PR access card interface characteristics Type of interface
Plug–in Optical module 1000Base–LX, 1000Base–SX, 1000Base–ZX,
Transmit operations
Full–duplex, FlowControl
Bit rate
1000 Mb/s
Provisioning Granularity
100 Kbit/s
Tx and Rx Optical characteristics
According to IEEE–802.3 standard, 1000Base–LX 1000Base–SX and 1000Base–ZX
Port number
2 per access card used in conjunction with PR port card
Cabling
Optical fiber
Connector
SFP (Small Formfactor Pluggable)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
576 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Port number
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.6 ETHERNET characteristics 5.6.1 Ethernet 10/100Base–T interface characteristics (ETH–MB + ETH–ATX) Type of interface
Electrical, full compliant to IEEE–802.3 standard, 10Base–T and 100Base–T
Transmit operations
Auto–negotiation options: 10Mbps, 100Mbps, full–duplex
Bit rate
Autosensing: 10 Mb/s and 100 Mb/s
Signal amplitude, coding, attenuation, pulse shape, return loss
According to IEEE–802.3 standard, 10Base–T and 100Base–T
Throughput towards backpanel (ports card)
622 Mbit/s
SDH containers
VC–12, VC–3, VC–4
Port number
11 on the ports card 14 on the access card
Cabling
Twisted–pair, as per IEEE–802.3 rec.
Connector
RJ45
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
5.6.2 Ethernet switch port card characteristics (ES1–8FE) Type of interface
10 / 100 Base T
Local Ethernet ports number
8 per each ports card
Ethernet over SDH ports number
8
VC termination max.
VC–12 = 63 VC–3 = 3
Number of VCGs ETH over SDH
VC–12 = 8 VC – 3 = 3
VCs per VCG max.
VC–12 = 21 VC –3 = 3
VC comp. delay
48 ms
Mapping to SDH
GFP–F LAPS
Class forwarding criteria per port
according to 802.1 Q (outer VLAN) according to 802.1 p according to 802.3 MAC DA
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
577 / 636
VLAN–ids = 1 K MAC addresses = 8K
Multicast
Ethernet
VLAN capabilities
cVLAN (802.1 D) pVLAN (SVLAN)
CoS
Guaranteed Best Effort
Policer
Metering –> token–bucket Marking –> 3 colors Dropping –> out of profile
Scheduler
Head of line –> 4 piorities Deficit Round Robin
Spanning tree
802.1d 802.1 w 802.1s
Performance ethernet counter
yes
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Look up tables number
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
5.6.3 Ethernet switch port card characteristics (ES1–8FX) Type of interface
100 Base FX
Local Ethernet ports number
8 per each ports card
Ethernet over SDH ports number
8
VC termination max.
VC–12 = 63 VC–3 = 3
Number of VCGs ETH over SDH
VC–12 = 8 VC – 3 = 3 VC – 4 = 1
VCs per VCG max.
VC–12 = 21 VC –3 = 3 VC –4 = 1
VC comp. delay
48 ms
Mapping to SDH
GFP–F LAPS
Class forwarding criteria per port
according to 802.1 Q (outer VLAN) according to 802.1 p according to 802.3 MAC DA
Look up tables number
VLAN–ids = 1 K MAC addresses = 8K
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
578 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Multicast
Ethernet
VLAN capabilities
VLAN (802.1 Q) pVLAN (802.1ad)
CoS
Guaranteed Best Effort
Policer
Metering –> single rate token–bucket Dropping –> tail drop
Scheduler
Queues/port = 3 Queuing = Strict Priority
Spanning tree
802.1d 802.1 w 802.1s
Performance ethernet counter
yes
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
5.6.4 Ethernet switch port card characteristics (ES4–8FE) Type of interface
10 / 100 Base T 1000 Base SX/LX/ZX SFP
Local Ethernet ports number
eight 10 / 100 Base T and one1000 Base SX/LX/ ZX SFP per each port card.
Ethernet over SDH ports number
16 (SMII mode), 2 (GMII mode)
VC termination max.
VC–12 = 252 VC–3 = 12 VC–4 = 4
Number of VCGs ETH over SDH
VC–12 = 16 (SMII), 2 (GMII) VC – 3 = 12 (SMII), 2 (GMII) VC – 4 = 4 (SMII), 2 GMII)
VCs per VCG max.
VC–12 = 50 (SMII), 63 (GMII) VC –3 = 2 (SMII), 12 (GMII) VC –4 = 1 (SMII), 4 (GMII)
VC comp. delay
48 ms
Mapping to SDH
GFP–F LAPS
Class forwarding criteria per port
according to 802.1 Q (outer VLAN) according to 802.1 p according to 802.3 MAC DA
Look up tables number
VLAN–ids = 1 K MAC addresses = 8K
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
579 / 636
Ethernet
VLAN capabilities
cVLAN (802.1 D) pVLAN (SVLAN)
CoS
Guaranteed Best Effort
Policer
Metering –> token–bucket Marking –> 3 colors Dropping –> out of profile
Scheduler
Head of line –> 4 piorities Deficit Round Robin
Spanning tree
802.1d 802.1 w 802.1s
Performance ethernet counter
yes
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Multicast
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
5.6.5 Ethernet switch port card characteristics (ISA ES–16) Local Ethernet ports
none
Ethernet over SDH ports number
64
VC termination max.
VC–12 = 252 VC–3 = 12 VC–4 = 16
Number of VCGs ETH over SDH
VC–12 = 64 VC – 3 = 12 VC–4 = 16
VCs per VCG max.
VC–12 = 21 VC –3 = 3 VC – 4 = 8
VC comp. delay
64 ms
Mapping to SDH
GFP–F HDLC/PPP LAPS
Class forwarding criteria per port
according to 802.1 Q (outer VLAN) according to 802.1 p according to 802.3 MAC DA MPLS + exp. bits
Look up tables number
VLAN–ids = up to 64 K MAC addresses = up to 64K MPLS labels = up to 64K
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
580 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Multicast
Ethernet MPLS
MPLS capability
Martini enc. MPLS
VLAN capabilities
cVLAN (802.1 D) pVLAN (SVLAN) (push, pop, swap)
CoS
Guaranteed Regulated Best Effort
Policer
Metering –> token–bucket dual rate Marking –> 3 colors Dropping –> out of profile
Scheduler
Head of line –> 8 piorities Deficit Round Robin
Congestion Avoidance
RED per queue
Spanning tree
802.1d 802.1 w 802.1s
Performance ethernet counter
yes
MPLS counter
yes
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
5.6.6 Access Card Gigabit Ethernet interfaces characteristics (GETH–AG) Type of interface
Plug–in Optical module 1000Base–LX or 1000Base–SX or 1000 Base–ZX
Transmit operations
Full–duplex, Flow Control
Bit rate
1.25 Gb/s
Tx and Rx Optical characteristics
According to IEEE–802.3 standard, 1000Base–LX, 1000Base–SX and 1000Base– ZX (refer to Table 68. on page 598 and Table 69. on page 599 for details )
SDH containers
VC–4xV
Ports number
2 on the access card if used in conjunction with ETH–MB
Cabling
Optical fibre
Connector
LC–Duplex SFP (Small Formfactor Pluggable)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
581 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Type of interface
Plug–in Optical module 1000Base–LX or 1000Base–SX or 1000 Base ZX
Transmit operations
Full–duplex, Flow Control
Bit rate
1.25 Gb/s
Throughput towards backpanel (ports card)
2 x 622 Mbit/s
Tx and Rx Optical characteristics
According to IEEE–802.3 standard, 1000Base–LX, 1000Base–SX and 1000 Base ZX (refer to Table 68. on page 598 and Table 69. on page 599 for details )
SDH containers
VC–4xV
Local Gigabit Ethernet ports number
8 per each ports card
Cabling
Optical fibre
Connector
LC–Duplex SFP (Small Formfactor Pluggable)
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
582 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.6.7 Gigabit Ethernet ports card interfaces (GETH–MB)
5.7 4 x ANY clients characteristics
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The interface characteristics are related to client type according to the following paragraphs 5.7.1 Gigabit Ethernet LX The interface is according to IEEE g.802.3 1000Base–LX (clause 38.4) INPUT SIDE · · · · · · · · · · · · · ·
Bit Rate Bit Rate Tolerance Optical Connector Receive Sensitivity Stressed Receive Sensitivity Max Receive Optical Power Opt. Operating Wavelength Opt. Return Loss of Receiver Opt. Modulation Amplitude Signal detect – Asserted Signal detect – Clearing Hysteresis Signal detect Assert Time Signal detect Clearing Time
1250 Mb/s ±100 ppm LC – 20 dBm max. –14.4 dBm –3 dBm max. 1270 nm min., 1355 nm max 12 dB min. 15 µW min., 1000 µW max. –20 dBm max. , –30 dBm +Hyst. min. –30 dBm min (avg.) 0.5 dB min. < 100 µs (excepted SPI access time) < 100 µs (excepted SPI access time)
N.B.: GE flow control is not implemented.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
OUTPUT SIDE · · · · ·
Bit Rate Bit Rate Accuracy Optical Connector Laser Type Launched Optical Power
· ·
Opt. Center Wavelength Operating Range
· · · · · ·
Opt. Spectral Width (∆λRMS) Opt. Extinction ratio Opt. Modulation Amplitude Opt. Rise/Fall time (tr/tf) Relative Intensity Noise Deterministic Jitter
ED
1250 Mb/s ±100 ppm LC Class 1 laser safety –11.0 dBm min., –3 dBm max (avg.) 10 µm SMF –11.5 dBm min., –3 dBm max (avg.) 50 µm MMF –11.5 dBm min., –3 dBm max (avg.) 62.5 µm MMF 1270 nm min., 1355 nm max 2 m B 550 m (MMF 62.5 µm) 2 m B 550 m (MMF 50 µm) 2 m B 5000 m (SMF 9 µm) 4 nm max. 9 dB min 189 µW min. 260 ps max (20% B 80%) –116 dB/Hz max. 0.200 UI max.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
583 / 636
5.7.2 Gigabit Ethernet SX
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The interface is according to IEEE g.802.3 1000Base–SX INPUT SIDE · · · · · · · · · · · · ·
Bit Rate Bit Rate Tolerance Optical Connector Receive Sensitivity Max Receive Optical Power Opt. Operating Wavelength Opt. Return Loss of Receiver Opt. Modulation Amplitude Signal detect – Asserted Signal detect – Clearing Hysteresis Signal detect Assert Time Signal detect Clearing Time
1250 Mb/s ± 100 ppm LC – 17 dBm max. – 0 dBm max. 770 nm min., 860 nm max 12 dB min. 15 µW min., 1000 µW max. –17 dBm max. , –30 dBm +Hyst. min. –30 dBm min (avg.) 1.5 dB min. < 100 µs (excepted SPI access time) < 350µs (excepted SPI access time)
N.B.: GE flow control is not implemented.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
OUTPUT SIDE · · · · ·
Bit Rate Bit Rate Accuracy Optical Connector Laser Type Launched Optical Power
· · · · · ·
Opt. Center Wavelength Opt. Extinction ratio Opt. Modulation Amplitude Opt. Rise/Fall time (tr/tf) Relative Intensity Noise Deterministic Jitter
ED
1250 Mb/s ±100 ppm LC Class 1 laser safety –9.5 dBm min., –1.5 dBm max (avg.) 50 µm MMF –9.5 dBm min., –1.5 dBm max (avg.) 62.5 µm MMF 830 nm min., 860 nm max 9 dB min 189 µW min. 260 ps max (20% B 80%) –116 dB/Hz max. 0.200 UI max.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
584 / 636
5.7.3 Fiber Channel 100–SM–LL–I
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The FC I/F is compliant to Ansi x3.230 standard (100–SM–LL–I). INPUT SIDE · · · · · · · · · · · · · ·
Bit Rate Bit Rate Tolerance Optical Connector Receive Sensitivity Stressed Receive Sensitivity Max Receive Optical Power Opt. Operating Wavelength Opt. Return Loss of Receiver Opt. Modulation Amplitude Signal detect – Asserted Signal detect – Clearing Hysteresis Signal detect Assert Time Signal detect Clearing Time
1062.5 Mb/s ±100 ppm LC –20 dBm max. –14.4 dBm –3 dBm max. 1270 nm min., 1355 nm max 12 dB min. 15 µW min., 1000 µW max. –20 dBm max. , –30 dBm +Hyst. min. –30 dBm min (avg.) 0.5 dB min. < 100 µs (excepted SPI access time) < 100 µs (excepted SPI access time)
OUTPUT SIDE
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
· · · · · · · · · · · · · ·
ED
Bit Rate Bit Rate Accuracy Optical Connector Laser Type Launched Optical Power Operating Range Fiber Core Diameter Opt. Center Wavelength Opt. Spectral Width (∆λRMS) Opt. Extinction ratio Opt. Modulation Amplitude Opt. Rise/Fall time (tr/tf) Relative Intensity Noise Deterministic Jitter
1062.5 Mb/s ±100 ppm LC Class 1 laser safety –12.0 dBm min., –3 dBm max (avg.) 9 µm SMF 2 m B2 Km 9 µm 1270 nm min., 1355 nm max 4 nm max. 9 dB min 189 µW min. 260 ps max (20%B80%) –116 dB/Hz max. 0.200 UI max.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
585 / 636
5.7.4 Fiber Channel 100–M5–SL–I
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The FC I/F is compliant to Ansi x3.230 standard (100–M5–SL–I) except where specified. INPUT SIDE · · · · · · · · · · · · ·
Bit Rate Bit Rate Tolerance Optical Connector Receive Sensitivity Max Received Optical Power Opt. Operating Wavelength Opt. Return Loss of Receiver Opt. Modulation Amplitude Signal detect – Asserted Signal detect – Clearing Hysteresis Signal detect Assert Time Signal detect Clearing Time
1062.5 Mb/s ±100 ppm LC –13 dBm max. –1.5 dBm max. 770 nm min., 860 nm max 12 dB min. 15 µW min., 1000 µW max. –17 dBm max. , –30 dBm +Hyst. min. –30 dBm min (avg.) 1.5 dB min. < 100 µs (excepted SPI access time) < 350 µs (excepted SPI access time)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
OUTPUT SIDE · · · · ·
Bit Rate Bit Rate Accuracy Optical Connector Laser Type Launched Optical Power
· · · · · · ·
Opt. Center Wavelength RMS spectral width (max) Opt. Extinction ratio Opt. Modulation Amplitude Opt. Rise/Fall time (tr/tf) Relative Intensity Noise Deterministic Jitter
ED
1062.5 Mb/s ±100 ppm LC Class 1 laser safety –9.5 dBm min., –1.5 dBm max (avg.) 50 µm MMF –9.5 dBm min., –1.5 dBm max (avg.) 62.5 µm MMF 830 nm min., 860 nm max 4 nm max. 9 dB min 189 µW min. 260 ps max (20% " 80%) –116 dB/Hz max. 0.200 UI max.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
586 / 636
5.7.5 Fast Ethernet (100BASE FX)/FDDI
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
FDDI and Fast Ethernet I/F is compliant to ANSI x3.184–1993 and IEEE 802.3 except where specified. INPUT SIDE · · · · · · · · · · · ·
Bit Rate Bit Rate Tolerance Optical Connector Receive Sensitivity Max. Receive Optical Power Opt. Operating Wavelength Opt. Return Loss of Receiver Signal detect – Asserted Signal detect – Clearing Hysteresis Signal detect Assert Time Signal detect Clearing Time
125 Mb/s ±100 ppm LC – 28 dBm max. –8 dBm min. (avg.) 1270 nm min., 1360 nm max 12.5 dB min. –31 dBm max., –42 dBm + Hyst. min. ; –42 dBm min (avg.) 1 dB min. B 3 dB max. < 100 µs (excepted SPI access time) < 350 µs (excepted SPI access time)
OUTPUT SIDE · · · · · · · · · ·
Bit Rate Bit Rate Accuracy Optical Connector Laser Type Launched Optical Power Opt. Center Wavelength Opt. Spectral Width (∆λRMS) Opt. Extinction ratio Optical Rise/Fall Time (tr/tf) Relative Intensity Noise (RIN)
125 Mb/s ±100 ppm LC Class 1 laser safety –15 dBm min., –8 dBm max (avg.) 1274 nm min., 1356 nm max 2.5 nm max. 8.2 dB min 1.5 ns max. (20% B 80%) 125 dB/Hz nom., –112 dB/Hz max.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
N.B. :The Client Transmit Port provides a different ”Launched Optical Power” level than what required by the FDDI & FE standards: – MMF : –20 dBm B –14 dBm – SMF Cat I : –20 dBm B –14 dBm – SMF Cat II : 4 dBm B 0 dBm
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
587 / 636
5.7.6 ESCON
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
ESCON I/F is compliant to IBM SA–0394–03 INPUT SIDE · · · · · · · · · · · ·
Bit Rate Bit Rate Tolerance Optical Connector Receive Sensitivity Max. Receive Optical Power Opt. Operating Wavelength Opt. Return Loss of Receiver Signal detect – Asserted Signal detect – Clearing Hysteresis Signal detect Assert Time Signal detect Clearing Time
200 Mb/s ±100 ppm LC – 28 dBm max. –8 dBm min. (avg.) 1270 nm min., 1360 nm max 12.5 dB min. –31 dBm max., –42 dBm + Hyst. min. –42 dBm min (avg.) 1 dB min. B 3 dB max. < 100 µs (excepted SPI access time) < 350 µs (excepted SPI access time)
OUTPUT SIDE · · · · · · · · · ·
Bit Rate Bit Rate Accuracy Optical Connector Laser Type Launched Optical Power Opt. Center Wavelength Opt. Spectral Width (∆λRMS) Opt. Extinction ratio Optical Rise/Fall Time (tr/tf) Relative Intensity Noise (RIN)
200 Mb/s ±100 ppm LC Class 1 laser safety –15 dBm min., –8 dBm max (avg.) 1274 nm min., 1356 nm max 2.5 nm max. 8.2 dB min 1.5 ns max. (20% B 80%) 125 dB/Hz nom., –112 dB/Hz max.
N.B. The Client Transmit Port provides a different ”Launched Optical Power” level than what required by the ESCON standard: –MMPL : –20 dBm B –15 dBm –SMPL : –4 dBm B –0 dBm
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The bit rate accuracy required by ESCON standard is ±200 ppm
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
588 / 636
5.7.7 Digital Video
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Digital Video I/F is compliant to ITU–R Rec. BT.656–4, BT1363–1 and BT1367. INPUT SIDE · · · · · · · · · · · ·
Bit Rate Bit Rate Tolerance Optical Connector Receive Sensitivity Max. Receive Optical Power Opt. Operating Wavelength Signal detect – Asserted Opt. Return Loss of Receiver Signal detect – Clearing Hysteresis Signal detect Assert Time Signal detect Clearing Time
270 Mb/s "100 ppm LC – 28 dBm max. –8 dBm min. (avg.) 1270 nm min., 1360 nm max –31 dBm max., –42 dBm + Hyst. min. 12.5 dB min. –42 dBm min (avg.) 1 dB min. B 3 dB max. < 100 µs (excepted SPI access time) < 350 µs (excepted SPI access time)
OUTPUT SIDE · · · · · · · · · · ·
Bit Rate Bit Rate Accuracy Optical Connector Laser Type Launched Optical Power Opt. Center Wavelength Opt. Spectral Width (∆λRMS) Opt. Extinction ratio Optical Rise/Fall Time (tr/tf) Relative Intensity Noise (RIN) Output jitter
270 Mb/s " 100 ppm LC Class 1 laser safety –15 dBm min., –8 dBm max (avg.) 1274 nm min., 1356 nm max 2.5 nm max. 8.2 dB min 1.5 ns max. (20% B 80%) 125 dB/Hz nom., –112 dB/Hz max. 0.2 UIpp (10 Hz– 27 MHz)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
N.B: The Client Transmit Port provides a different ”Launched Optical Power” level than what required by the DV standards: –MM: –12 dBm B –7.5 dBm –SM: –12 dBm B –7.5 dBm
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
589 / 636
5.8 Optical interface characteristics
Types of optical interfaces
S–1.1, L–1.1, L–1.2 or L–1.2JE, MM1 Characteristics are given in Table 63. on page 591.
Optical connectors
SC/PC or FC/PC (alternative units)
Pulse shape
See ITU–T G.957
STM–4 optical characteristics: Types of optical interfaces
S–4.1, L–4.1 , L–4.2 Characteristics are given in Table 64. on page 593
Optical connectors
SC/PC, FC/PC (alternative units) or LC/PC on SFP (Small Formfactor Pluggable) module
Pulse shape
See ITU–T G.957
STM–16 optical characteristics: Types of optical interfaces
I–16.1, S–16.1, L.16–1, L.16–2 , L.16–2 JE2, L.16–2JE3, Characteristics are given in Table 66. at page 595. The ”second generation” optical interface characteristics are given in Table 16 which applies for HM1 Optical Units.
Optical connectors
SC/PC, FC/PC, SFF (alternative units)
Pulse shape
See ITU–T G.957
Booster (Optical Fiber Amplifier) characteristics: Types of Booster
BST10 (+10 dBm), BST15 (+15 dBm) and BST17 (+17 dBm). Characteristics are given in Table 71. on page 601
Optical connectors
SC/PC or FC/PC (alternative units)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Optical Preamplifier (PR16) characteristics: Optical connectors
SC/PC or FC/PC (alternative units)
Wavelength bandwidth (main signal):
1530 to 1565 nm
Input power:
–37 dBm to –18 dBm
Output power:
–15 dBm
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
590 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
STM–1 optical characteristics:
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 63. Parameters specified for STM–1 Optical Interface CHARACTERISTICS
UNIT
VALUES
DIGITAL SIGNAL Nominal bit rate
Kbit/s
STM–1 according to G.707 and G.958 155520 S–1.1
Application code (Table 1/G.957) Operating wavelength range
nm
L–1.1
L–1.2
L–1.2 JE1 nb1
1261–1360 1280–1335 1480–1580 1530–1560
TRANSMITTER AT REFERENCE POINT S Source type
SLM/MLM
SLM/MLM
SLM
SLM
Spectral characteristics
maximum RMS width
nm
7.7
4
–
–
maximum –20 dB width
nm
–
–
1
1
minimum side mode suppression ratio
dB
–
–
30
30
Mean launched power
maximum
dBm
–8
0
0
0
minimum
dBm
–15
–5
–5
–4
Minimum extinction ratio
dB
8.2
10
10
10
dB
0–12
10–28
10–28
10–29
ps/nm
100
250
1900
3200
Minimum optical return loss of cable plant at S, including any connectors
dB
NA
NA
20
20
Maximum discrete reflectance between S and R
dB
NA
NA
–25
–25
In Ga As PIN
In Ga As PIN
In Ga As PIN
In Ga As PIN
OPTICAL PATH BETWEEN S AND R Attenuation range Maximum dispersion
RECEIVER AT REFERENCE POINT R Type of detector
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Mean received power at BER= 1E–10 •
Minimum (sensitivity)
dBm
–28
–34
–34
–34
•
Maximum (overload)
dBm
–8
–10
–10
–10
Maximum optical path penalty
dB
1
1
1
1
Maximum reflectance of receiver measured at R
dB
–14
–14
–25
–25
nb1: To be used with Optical Boosters up to +15 dBm on G652 and G653 fibre N.A = not applicable table continue
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
591 / 636
DIGITAL SIGNAL Nominal bit rate
UNIT
VALUES
Kbit/s
STM–1 according to G.707 and G.958 155520
Application (ALCATEL code) Operating wavelength range
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
CHARACTERISTICS
MM–1 nm
TRANSMITTER AT REFERENCE POINT S Source type
1270–1360
SLM
Spectral characteristics
maximum RMS width
nm
–
maximum –20 dB width
nm
1
minimum side mode suppression ratio
dB
30
Mean launched power
maximum
dBm
–14
minimum
dBm
–19
Minimum extinction ratio
dB
10
dB
0–10
ps/nm
NA
Minimum optical return loss of cable plant at S, including any connectors
dB
NA
Maximum discrete reflectance between S and R
dB
NA
OPTICAL PATH BETWEEN S AND R Attenuation range Maximum dispersion
RECEIVER AT REFERENCE POINT R Type of detector
In Ga As PIN
Minimum sensitivity (BER 10–10)
dBm
–30
Minimum overload
dBm
–14
Maximum optical path penalty
dB
1 (a)
Maximum reflectance of receiver measured at R
dB
–14
NOTES: a= with max 3 Km of multimode fibre 50/125 um G.651 NA= not applicable
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
end of table.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
592 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 64. Parameters specified for STM–4 Optical Interface CHARACTERISTICS
UNIT
VALUES
DIGITAL SIGNAL Nominal bit rate
Kbit/s
STM–4 according to G.707 and G.958 622.080 S–4.1
Application code (Table 1/G.957) Operating wavelength range
nm
L–4.1 nb3
L–4.2
L–4.2 JE nb1, nb2
1274–1356 1280–1335 1480–1580 1530–1560
TRANSMITTER AT REFERENCE POINT S Source type
MLM
SLM
SLM
SLM
Spectral characteristics
maximum RMS width
nm
2.5
–
–
–
maximum –20 dB width
nm
–
1
1
0.6
minimum side mode suppression ratio
dB
–
30
30
30
Mean launched power
maximum
dBm
–8
+2
+2
+2
minimum
dBm
–15
–3
–3
–3
Minimum extinction ratio
dB
8.2
10
10
10
dB
0–12
10–24
10–24
10–27
ps/nm
84
250
1900
3200
Minimum optical return loss of cable plant at S, including any connectors
dB
14
20
24
24
Maximum discrete reflectance between S and R
dB
–20
–25
–27
–27
In Ga As PIN
In Ga As PIN
In Ga As PIN
In Ga As PIN
OPTICAL PATH BETWEEN S AND R Attenuation range Maximum dispersion
RECEIVER AT REFERENCE POINT R Type of detector
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Mean received power at BER= 1E–10 •
Minimum (sensitivity)
dBm
–28
–28
–28
–32
•
Maximum (overload)
dBm
–8
–8
–8
–8
Maximum optical path penalty
dB
1
1
1
2
Maximum reflectance of receiver measured at R
dB
–20
–20
–27
–27
nb1: Suitable for interworking with the L–4.2JE of the ADM product family with max dispersion 2400 ps/nm; on this application the attenuation range is 10–28 dB. nb2: For long distance applications and additionally suitable to be used with Optical Boosters up to +15 dBm on G652 and G653 fibre. nb3: Suitable for interworking with L–4.1 of ADM product family. In this application the power budget is 10–24 dBm, 250 ps/nm dispersion.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
593 / 636
CHARACTERISTICS
UNIT
VALUES
DIGITAL SIGNAL Nominal bit rate
Mbps
STM–4 according to G.707 and G.958 622.080
Application code (Table 1/G.957) Operating wavelength range
S–4.1 nm
1274–1356
TRANSMITTER AT REFERENCE POINT S Source type
SLM
Mean launched power
maximum
dBm
–8
minimum
dBm
–15
Spectral characteristics
maximum RMS width
nm
2.5
minimum side mode suppression ratio
dB
not applicable
dB
8.2
dBm
50
Maximum chromatic dispersion
ps/nm
+ 100
Minimum chromatic dispersion
ps/nm
– 100
Minimum optical return loss of cable plant at S
dB
14
Maximum discrete reflectance between S and R
dB
–20
Minimum extinction ratio Maximum shutdown optical output power OPTICAL PATH BETWEEN S AND R
RECEIVER AT REFERENCE POINT R Type of detector
In Ga As PIN
Mean received power at BER= 1E–10 •
Minimum (sensitivity)
dBm
–29
•
Maximum (overload)
dBm
–8
dB
–14
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Max. optical reflectance of receiver measured at R
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
594 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 65. Parameters specified for SFP STM–4 Optical Interface
Table 66. STM–16 Optical interfaces (Single Channel)
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
CHARACTERISTICS DIGITAL SIGNAL Nominal bit rate
UNIT
VALUES
Kb/s
STM–16 according to G.707 and G.958 2488320 S–16.1
L–16.1
L–16.2
1270–1360
1280–1335
1500–1580
SLM
SLM
SLM
nm nm dB
– 1 30
– 1 30
– 1 30
dBm dBm
0 –5
+2 –2
+2 –2
dB
8.2
8.2
8.2
dB ps/nm
0–12 100
10–24 250
10–24 1600
Minimum optical return loss of cable plant at S, including any connectors
dB
24
24
24
Maximum discrete reflectance between S and R
dB
–27
–27
–27
InGaAs PIN
InGaAs APD
InGaAs APD
–18 0
–27 –8
–28 –8
Application code Operating wavelength range TRANSMITTER AT REFERENCE POINT S Source type Spectral characteristics – maximum RMS width – maximum –20 dB width – minimum side mode suppression ratio Mean launched power – maximum – minimum Minimum extinction ratio OPTICAL PATH BETWEEN S AND R Attenuation range Maximum dispersion
RECEIVER AT REF. R Type of detector Mean received power at BER= 1E10–10 • •
Minimum (sensitivity) Maximum (overload)
dBm dBm
Maximum optical path penalty
dB
1
1
2
Maximum reflectance of receiver measured at R
dB
–27
–27
–27
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Table Continue
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
595 / 636
DIGITAL SIGNAL Nominal bit rate
UNIT
VALUES
Kb/s
STM–16 according to G.707 and G.958 2488320
Application code Operating wavelength range
L–16.2JE1
L–16.2 JE2
L–16.2 JE3
nb2
nb1
nb3
1530–1560
1550–1560
1550–1560
I–16.1
1266–1360
TRANSMITTER AT REFERENCE POINT S Source type
SLM
SLM–ILM SLM–ILM
MLM
Spectral characteristics nm nm dB
– 0.5 30
– 0.2 30
– 0.2 30
4 – –
dBm dBm
+4 +1
+2 –3
+2 –3
–3 –10
dB
8.2
8.2
8.2
8.2
dB ps/nm
13–28 1900
nb1 3200
nb3 4000
0–7 12
Minimum optical return loss of cable plant at S, including any connectors
dB
24
24
24
27
Maximum discrete reflectance between S and R
dB
–27
–27
–27
–27
InGaAs APD
InGaAs APD
InGaAs APD
InGaAs APD
dBm dBm
–29 –9
–29 –9
nb3 –9
–18 –3
Maximum optical path penalty
dB
2
1
1
1
Maximum reflectance of receiver measured at R
dB
–27
–27
–27
–27
– maximum RMS width – maximum –20 dB width – minimum side mode suppression ratio Mean launched power – maximum – minimum Minimum extinction ratio OPTICAL PATH BETWEEN S AND R Attenuation range Maximum dispersion
RECEIVER AT REF. R Type of detector Mean received power at BER= 1E10–10 • •
Minimum (sensitivity) Maximum (overload)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
nb1: to be used with booster amplifier on G.652 fiber; attenuation range according to the specific 1664OA power budget nb2: To be used with booster amplifier up to + 15dBm on G653 fiber; or in stand alone configuration nb3: To be used with booster in conjunction with the 1664OA preamplifier on G.652 and G.653 fiber; attenuation range according to the 1664OA characteristics. Suitable for submarine application too, in conjunction with Alcatel booster/preamplifier: specific reference value of max dispersion at 5400 ps/nm with optical path penalty 27
Power Wavelength Bandwidth
nm
1530÷1565
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
601 / 636
ÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏ
ÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏ ÏÏÏÏÏÏ
Booster
STM16 Port
STM16 Port
min –6dBm max 4dBm
R
S
Booster Input
15dBm 17dBm
–29dBm –9dBm
SPECIFICATIONS Maximum chromatic dispersion
3200 (ps/nm)
Optical fiber used
G.652
– fiber attenuation
0.25 dB/km
– chromatic dispersion of the fiber
18 ps/nm/km
– penalty
1 dB
Attenuation range min = +17–(–9) max = +15 –(–29)–1
26 dB 43 dB
Minimum span length (26dB/0.25)
104 Km
Maximum span length (due to the attenuation (sensitivity: 43/0.25
172 Km
Following there are the formulas to calculate the minimum and maximum span length. The maximum length can be limited by the receiver sensitivity or by the maximum chromatic dispersion, whichever is most restrictive; the minimum length is limited by the receiver overload. The optical interface characteristics are deduced from Table 66. on page 595 depending on the type of interface. The optical fiber characteristics are reported in rec. ITU–T G.957. Span attenuation range: Min Atten.= (max Tx Power)–(min. Rx Overload)=+17–(–9)=26dB Max Atten.= (minTx Power)–(min. Rx Sensitivity)–(penalty)=+15–(–29)–21=43 dB
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Minimum span length (for overload) = (Min Att.)/(fiber att.)=26/0.25=104 Km Maximum span length (for sensitivity) = (Max Att.)/(fiber att.)=43/0.25=172 Km Maximum span length (for dispersion) = (Max dispers.)/(fiber disp.)=3200/18=177.7 Km Thus the maximum fiber span length is limited for attenuation (sensitivity): 172 Km, while the minimum span to avoid overload problems should be 104 Km.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
602 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.8.1 Example of a link using 1660SM with L–16.2 JE2 Port and 15 dBm Booster
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.9 Coarse WDM subsystem units characteristics 5.9.1 COADM–1 Channel General Characteristics Number of channels that can be add/drop per unit:
One channel among the following λ: 1470 nm, 1490 nm, 1510 nm, 1530 nm, 1550 nm, 1570 nm, 1590 nm, 1610 nm
Connector type
MU horizontal
Pass–through Insertion Loss (dB)
ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ Â ÂÂ
2.1
ÂÂÂ ÂÂÂ ÂÂÂ ÂÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂÂ
Pass–through
Demux side specification In – Drop Ch.
CWDM line In
ÂÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂÂ ÂÂÂ ÂÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂÂ
DROP Ch.
In–Drop Ch. Insertion Loss (dB)
Channels (nm)
1.25
1470 nm
1.25
1490 nm
1.25
1510 nm
1.25
1530 nm
1.25
1550 nm
1.25
1570 nm
1.25
1590 nm
1.25
1610 nm
Add Ch.– Out Insertion Loss (dB)
Channels (nm)
1.25
1470 nm
1.25
1490 nm
1.25
1510 nm
1.25
1530 nm
1.25
1550 nm
1.25
1570 nm
1.25
1590 nm
1.25
1610 nm
Mux side specificaton ADD Ch. –Out
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ÂÂ Â ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ Â ÂÂ ADD Ch.
ED
CWDM Line OUT
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
603 / 636
5.9.2 COADM–2 Channels
Number of channels that can be add/drop per unit:
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
General Characteristics Two channels among the following λ: 1470 – 1490 nm 1510 – 1530 nm 1550 – 1570 nm 1590 – 1610 nm
Connector type
MU horizontal
Pass–through Insertion Loss (dB)
2.5
Pass–through
ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ Â ÂÂ Â
Demux side specification
ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ Â ÂÂ Â
ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ
In – Drop Ch.
CWDM line In
DROP Ch.
In–Drop Ch. Insertion Loss (dB)
Channels (nm)
1.55
1470 nm
1.55
1490 nm
1.55
1510 nm
1.55
1530 nm
1.55
1550 nm
1.55
1570 nm
1.55
1590 nm
1.55
1610 nm
Add Ch.– Out Insertion Loss (dB)
Channels (nm)
1.55
1470 nm
1.55
1490 nm
1.55
1510 nm
1.55
1530 nm
1.55
1550 nm
1.55
1570 nm
1.55
1590 nm
1.55
1610 nm
Mux side specificaton
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ADD Ch. –Out
ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ Â ÂÂ
ADD Ch.
ED
CWDM Line OUT
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
604 / 636
5.9.3 MUX/DEMUX 8 Channels
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
General Characteristics Channels number
8
Channels wavelenght
1470 nm, 1490 nm, 1510 nm, 1530 nm, 1550 nm, 1570 nm, 1590 nm, 1610 nm
Connector type
MU horizontal
Demux side specification In – Drop Ch.
CWDM line In
ÂÂ ÂÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂÂ ÂÂÂ ÂÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂÂ
DROP Ch.
In–Drop Ch. Insertion Loss (dB)
Channels (nm)
1.05
1470 nm
3.15
1490 nm
2.85
1510 nm
2.55
1530 nm
2.25
1550 nm
1.95
1570 nm
1.65
1590 nm
1.35
1610 nm
Add Ch.– Out Insertion Loss (dB)
Channels (nm)
1.05
1470 nm
1.35
1490 nm
1.65
1510 nm
1.95
1530 nm
2.25
1550 nm
2.55
1570 nm
2.85
1590 nm
3.15
1610 nm
Mux side specificaton ADD Ch. –Out
ÂÂ Â ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ ÂÂ Â ÂÂ
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ADD Ch.
ED
CWDM Line OUT
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
605 / 636
5.9.4 2 Channels TRANSPONDER SFP without optical modulle
Optical interface characteristics: Refer to paragraph 5.9.5 on page 606 Optical module type:
SFP (APD or PIN) plug–in module
Bit rate client side
2488.320 Mbps : STM–16 / OC–48 2500 Mbps: 2 Gbit Ethernet (not operative in current release) 2.667 Gbps: STM–16 w/FEC (not operative in current release) 2125.00 Mbps: 2 Fiber Channel (not operative in current release) 1250 Mbps: Gbit Ethernet (not operative in current release) 1062.5 Mbps: FICON (not operative in current release) 1062.5 Mbps: Fiber Channel (not operative in current release) 622.080 Mbps: STM–4/OC12 (not operative in current release) 270 Mbps: Digital Video (not operative in current release) 200 Mbps: Escon (not operative in current release) 155.520 Mbps: STM–1/OC3 (not operative in current release) 125 Mbps: Fast Ethernet (not operative in current release) 125 Mbps: FDDI (not operative in current release)
5.9.5 CWDM optical PLUGIN
SFP module type
CWDM Silver
CWDM Bronze
APD
PIN
Detector type Addressed wavelength (nm)
1470,1490,1510,1530,1550,1570,1590,1610
Min. launched power (dBm)
0
0
Max launched power (dBm)
5
5
125 Mbps to 2.7 Gbps
125 Mbps to 2.7 Gbps
8.2
8.2
Max. –20dB bandwidth (nm)
1
1
Minimum SMSR (dB)
30
30
Allowed bitrates Min. extinction ratio (dB)
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Chromatic disp. (ps/nm)
1600 1600 1500 1400 1400 1300 1200 1100
1610 nm (λ) 1590 nm (λ) 1570 nm (λ) 1550 nm (λ) 1530 nm (λ) 1510 nm (λ) 1490 nm (λ) 1470 nm (λ)
1000 900 900 900 800 800 700 700
1610 nm (λ) 1590 nm (λ) 1570 nm (λ) 1550 nm (λ) 1530 nm (λ) 1510 nm (λ) 1490 nm (λ) 1470 nm (λ)
Minimum sensitivity (dBm)
–28
–18
Minimum overload (dBm)
–9
–3
Max optic. path penalty (dB)
2
1
Max receiver reflect. (dB)
–27
–27
Optical connector (Tx/Rx)
LC
LC
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
606 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
General Characteristics
S–16.1
L–16.1
L–16.2
Addressed wavelength (nm)
1270–1360
1280–1335
1500–1580
Min. launched power (dBm)
–5
–2
–2
Max launched power (dBm)
0
+2
+2
Allowed bitrates (Mbps)
2488320
2488320
2488320
Min. extinction ratio (dB)
8.2
8.2
8.2
Minimum sensitivity (dBm)
–18
–27
–28
Minimum overload (dBm)
–3
not available
not available
Max receiver reflect. (dB)
–27
–27
–27
Optical connector (Tx/Rx)
LC
LC
LC
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
SFP module type
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
607 / 636
Input Voltage
48/60 Vdc " 20%
Input current
25 A max
Power supply interface
according to ETS 300132–2
5.11 Alarm Characteristics Units Alarms: Each port card or access card of the equipment is provided with a bicolor LED (green/red) on the front coverplate. This LED indicates: – –
when red, internal failure when green, in service unit
ATM MATRIX Alarms: All the alarm detected on the unit are related to the ATM traffic management; on the front are present optical indication (LEDs) with the following meaning: • • • • •
Red LED (3): detection of an MAJOR or CRITICAL (URGENT) alarm Red LED (4): detection of a MINOR (NOT URGENT) alarm Yellow LED (5): alarm condition ATTENDED Yellow LED (6): detection of an ABNORMAL operative condition. Yellow LED (7): detection of an WARNING (INDICATIVE) alarm
Refer to Figure 39. on 128 where the front view of the unit and the led locations are illustrated. Centralized Equipment Alarms: All the alarms detected on the units (except ATM matrix board) are collected by the EQUICO unit which will deliver centralized optical indications (by means of LEDs on its front coverplate). Specifically: • • • •
Red LED (4): detection of an MAJOR (URGENT) alarm Red LED (5): detection of a MINOR (NOT URGENT) alarm Yellow LED (6): alarm condition ATTENDED Yellow LED (7): detection of an ABNORMAL operative condition. Type: active loopbacks, forcing the unit into service, laser forced ON or OFF, try to restore after ALS Yellow LED (8): detection of an WARNING (INDICATIVE) alarm
•
Refer to para. 2.4 , page 120, where the front view of each unit and the LED locations are illustrated.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
N.B.
ED
On the Craft Terminal (C.T.) and on the Operation System (O.S). application the URGENT (URG), NOT URGENT (NURG) and INDICATIVE alarm are named in a different way; the relation between this two terminology is explained in Table 72. on page 609.
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
608 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.10 Power Supply characteristics
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 72. Relation between Alarm severity terminology displayed on C.T./O.S. and alarm severity terminology used for the EQUICO leds and CONGI remote alarm connector pins. Alarm severity terminology on C.T. and O.S.
Alarm severity terminology used for EQUICO leds and for CONGI remote alarm connector pins
CRITICAL or MAJOR
URG , T*URG, T*RURG,
MINOR
NURG, , T*NURG, T*RNURG
WARNING
INDICATIVE
INDETERMINATE (not used)
––
Rack lamps and Remote Alarms: Some equipment alarms are carried to a connector, for customer applications, such as lighting–up of alarm lamps (rack–lamps) or to drive a custom–alarms interface. Rack alarm and Remote Alarm are physically available on the CONGI board connectors. The available alarms are the following: Rack lamps alarms: • • •
T*RURG: urgent alarm (see Table 72. on page 609 for the C.T. terminology) T*RNURG: not urgent alarm (see Table 72. on page 609 for the C.T. terminology) T*RATTD: alarm storing
Remote alarms: Remote alarms delivered by CONGI in slot 10: •
T*URG: detection of an urgent alarm (from Controller) (see Table 72. on page 609 for the C.T. terminology) T*NURG: detection of a non–urgent alarm (from Controller) (see Table 72. on page 609 for the C.T. terminology) T*INT: detection of an Internal alarm (from Controller) T*AND: loss of both battery station T*OR : fault or loss of one battery station
• • • •
Remote alarms delivered by CONGI in slot 12: • • •
T*TORC: It indicates a loss of +3.3V generated by the on board DC/DC converter of one CONGI card. T*IND: Indeterminate alarm. It indicates synthesis of alarms not associated to the other severity (not used) T*TUP: It indicates aN EQUICO microprocessor fault T*TANC: It indicates loss of + 3.3 V generated by the on board DC/DC converters of both CONGI cards (it can be stored). LOSQ2 : It indicates loss of communication with the Mediation Device (not used).
• •
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
•
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
609 / 636
HouseKeeping Alarms/Commands:
–
2 wires mode Four output (CPO) and 12 input (CPI) contacts for house–keeping alarms or commands are available on the CONGI board connector, for customer applications The available house–keeping contacts are the following: • •
–
HK–OUT 1 to 4: outgoing contacts HK–IN 1 to 12: Incoming contacts
3 wires mode: Four output (CPO) and eight input (CPI) contacts for house–keeping alarms or commands are available on the CONGI board connector, for customer applications The available house–keeping contacts are the following: • •
HK–OUT 1 to 4: outgoing contacts HK–IN 1 to 8: Incoming contacts
Alarm Attending: The detected SDH units alarm condition can be stored through push–button (10) on the EQUICO unit (Attended). This operation will turn OFF the general red LED (4) and will light up the yellow LED (6) on the EQUICO unit (Attended); The attended command is also sent to the rack lamps (if present) through the CONGI board. Trouble–shooting: The 1660SM equipment has been designed to dialog with a Personal Computer (PC) in order to service, activate and trouble–shoot the equipment. Trouble–shoot procedure for the equipment and details of the alarms for each card and relevant indications are described in the Operator’s Handbook. Connection with the PC is achieved through connector (2) available on the EQUICO board. The unit can be connected to an Operations System associated to the Transmission Management Network in order to execute operations similar to those carried out by the PC.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Characteristics of the cited remote alarms and Housekeeping contacts interface (EM type) are inserted in Chapter 5.1 on page 557.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
610 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
According to CONGI units settings two operative mode are available:
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.12 Mechanical characteristics Mechanical compatibility
ETSI ETS/E3, S9
Subrack size
482 W x 250 D x 650 H mm
Board size
213 D x 265 H mm
Subrack weight
35 Kg
Cooling
Fans in additional subrack
Rack cabling
Vertical between rack and subrack front access
Electrical Connectors
IEC 603/DIN 41612 IEC 807 (Sub–D) IEC 169–1 (coax. 1.0/2.3) BNC 50 Ω RJ45 RJ11
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Back–to–back installation
ED
Yes
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
611 / 636
5.13.1 Climatic for operating conditions The Equipment meets the requirements of ETSI Standard with use of fans housed in an external subrack. The functionality of the 1660SM Equipment, Vs. Temperature, is in compliance with : ETS 300 019–1–3 :1992 , class 3.2. Class 3.2:
Partly temperature–controlled locations. (see climatogram on Figure 281. on page 613)
5.13.1.1 Class 3.2: partly Temperature controlled locations This applies to locations: –
where installed equipment may be exposed to solar radiation and heat radiation. They may also be exposed to movements of the surrounding air due to draughts in buildings, e.g. through open windows. They may be subjected to condensed water and to water from sources other than rain and icing. They are not subjected to precipitation;
–
where mould growth or attacks by animals, except termites, may occur;
–
with normal levels of contaminants experienced in urban areas with industrial activities scattered over the whole area and/or with heavy traffic;
–
In close proximity to sources of sand or dust;
–
with vibration of low significance, e.g. for products fastened to light supporting structures subjected to negligible vibrations.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The conditions of this class may be found in : –
entrances and staircases of buildings;
–
garages;
–
cellars;
–
certain workshops;
–
buildings in factories and industrial process plants;
–
unattended equipment stations;
–
certain telecommunication buildings;
–
ordinary storage rooms for frost resistant products and farm buildings, ect.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
612 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
5.13 Environmental conditions
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
29
5
ED 95
Figure 281. Climatogram for Class 3.2 : Partly temperature controlled locations
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
613 / 636
5.13.2 Storage
ETS 300 019–1–1 : 1992, class 1.2 Class 1.2 : weatherprotected, not temper. controlled storage location. This class applies to weatherprotected storage having neither temperature nor humidity control. The location may have openings directly to the open air, i.e., it may be only partly weatherproofed. The climatogram is shown on Figure 282. on page 615. This class applies to storage locations : –
where equipment may be exposed to solar radiation and temporarily to heat radiation: They may also be exposed to movements of the surrounding air due to draughts, e.g. through doors, windows or other openings. They may be subjected to condensed water, dripping water and to icing. They may also be subjected to limited wind–driven precipitation including snow;
–
where mould growth or attacks by animals, except termites, may occur;
–
with normal levels of contaminants experienced in urban areas with industrial activities scattered over the whole area, ad/or with heavy traffic;
–
in areas with sources of sand or dust, including urban areas;
–
with vibration of low significance and insignificant shock.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The conditions of this class may occur in : –
unattended buildings ;
–
some entrances of buildings ;
–
some garages and shacks.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
614 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The 1660SM equipment meet the following requirements Vs. Storage :
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
29
Figure 282. Climatogram for Class 1.2: not temperature controlled storage location
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
615 / 636
5.13.3 Transportation
ETS 300 019–1–2 : 1992, class 2.2
Class 2.2 : Careful transportation (see Table 73. on page 617 ). This class applies to transportation where special cars has been taken e.g. with respect to low temperature and handling. Class 2.2 covers the condition of class 2.1. In addition class 2.2 includes transportation in all types of lorries and trailers in areas with well–developed road system. It also includes transportation by ship and by train specially designed, shock–reducing buffers. Manual loading and unloading of to 20 Kg is included. Extension of extreme low temperature during transportation is permitted for the 1660SM equipment in its standard packing : AT –40° C for 72 Hours maximum
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
without damaging the Optical interfaces.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
616 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
The 1660SM equipment meets the following requirements Vs. transportation :
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 73. Transportation climatic
Unit
2.1 and 2.2
2.3
°C
– 25
– 40
°C
+ 70
+ 70
°C
+ 40
+ 40
°C
–25 / +30
–40 / +30
°C
+40 / +5
+40 / +5
relative humidity, not combined with rapid temperature changes
% °C
95 +40
95 +45
relative humidity, combined with rapid (G) temperature changes air/air, at high relative humidity (NOTE 3 , 6)
%
95
95
°C
–25 / +30
–40 / +30
absolute humidity, combined with rapid (H) temperature changes : air/air at high water content (NOTE 4)
g/m3
60
60
°C
+70 / +15
+70 / +15
(I)
low air pressure
KPa
70
70
(J)
change of air pressure
KPa/min
no
no
m/s
20
20
mm/min
6 (NOTE 7)
6
(M) radiation, solar
W/m2
1120
1120
(N) radiation, heat
W/m2
600
600
m/s
1 (NOTE 7)
1
Environmental parameter (A) low temperature air (B)
high temperature, air enclosures (NOTE 1)
in
(C)
high temperature, air in ventilated enclosures or outdoor air (NOTE 2)
(D) change of temperature air/air
unventilated
(NOTE 3)
(E) change of temperature air/water (F)
(NOTE 3)
(K) movement of the surrounding medium, air (L)
precipitation rain
(O) water from sources other than rain (NOTE 5) (P) wetness
none
conditions of wet surfaces
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Notes on next page.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
617 / 636
NOTE 1 :
The high temperature of the surfaces of a product may be influenced by both the surrounding air temperature, given here, and the solar radiation through a window or another opening.
NOTE 2 :
The high temperature of the surface of a product is influenced by the surrounding air temperature, given here, and the solar radiation defined below.
NOTE 3 :
A direct transfer of the product between the two given temperature is presumed.
NOTE 4 :
The product is assumed to be subjected to a rapid decrease of temperature only (no rapid increase). The figures of water content apply to temperatures down to the dew–point; at lower temperatures the relative humidity is assumed to be approximately 100 %.
NOTE 5 :
The figure indicates the velocity of water and not the height of water accumulated.
NOTE 6 :
Occurrence of condensation.
NOTE 7 :
For short duration only.
5.13.4 EMI/EMC condition
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
For the EMI/EMC condition see para 4.1 on page 39.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
618 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Notes to Table 73. :
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
MAINTENANCE
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
619 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
620 / 636 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
6 MAINTENANCE
ATTENTION
EMC NORMS
WHEN CARRYING OUT THE GIVEN OPERATIONS OBSERVE THE NORMS STATED IN PARA. 4.1.3 ON PAGE 40
6.1 General safety rules
SAFETY RULES Carefully observe the front–panel warning labels prior to working on optical connections while the equipment is in–service. Should it be necessary to cut off power during the maintenance phase, proceed to switch off the power supply units as well as cut off power station upstream (rack or station distribution frame)
SAFETY RULES A TNV–2 (battery) voltage could be present on “R/M interface connector” (cable side); do not touch the pins when unplugged . DANGER: Possibility of personal injury. Short circuiting, low-voltage, low-impedance, dc circuits can cause severe arcing that can result in burns and/or eye damage. Remove rings, watches, and other metal jewelry before working with primary circuits. Exercise caution to avoid shorting power input terminals.
SAFETY RULES
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
DANGER: Possibility of eyes damage: read carefully and strictly observe the rules pointed out in para.3.2.4.2 on page 35.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
621 / 636
•
Check that the equipment is operating with all the shields properly positioned (dummy covers, ESD connector protections, etc)
•
In order to reduce the risk of damage the electrostatic sensitive devices, is mandatory to use the elasticized band (around the wrist) and the coiled cord joined connect with the ground rack during the touching of the equipment
6.3 Maintenance Aspects Maintenance consists of a set of operations which maintain or bring back the assembly to optimum operating conditions in a very short time, with the aim of obtaining maximum operational availability. Maintenance is classified as: •
ROUTINE
•
CORRECTIVE
6.4 Instruments And Accessories There is a local terminal (PC) which permits to display all the alarms and manages the Equipment. The relative processing is described in the operator’s handbook. Where TMN is implemented, an Operation System displays alarms and manages all the connected Equipments of the network. Refer to the relevant handbooks.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
The need of special tools and accessories to perform possible routine and corrective maintenance procedures is described inside the procedures themselves.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
622 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
6.2 General rules
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
6.5 Routine Maintenance Routine maintenance is a periodic set of measurements and checks. This maintenance discovers those devices whose function has deteriorated with time and therefore need adjustment or replacement. Typically, digital equipment requires no routine maintenance. The equipment allows to assess the quality of the connection links for SECTION and PATH o counting the errored events and obtaining performance data. The Performance Monitoring Application, described in the Operator’s Handbook, allows this function.
6.5.1 Routine maintenance every three months According to the filter type It is suggested to carry out the following operations every three months: –
Metallic filter cleaning
–
Dust filter substitution
6.5.1.1 Metallic filter cleaning Metallic Filter cleaning (caution to avoid equipment damage) WARNING: BEFORE INSTALLING OR REMOVING THE METALLIC FILTER , CHECK THAT THE PROTECTIVE ADHESIVE FILM HAS BEEN REMOVED.
SAFETY RULES DANGER: Possibility of personal injury. Personal injury can be caused by rotating fans. •
Replace the “Metallic filter” from the FANS Shelf as follow : – unscrew the screws that ensure the Metallic filter to the fans shelf – extract the Metallic filter – clean the metallic filter removing the dust – Insert and ensure the “Metallic filter” to the “FAN shelf“ using the relevant screw
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Note: the period of one three months is only indicative; according to the environmental conditions could be necessary to reduce this period.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
623 / 636
6.5.1.2 Dust filter for fan shelf 19” substitution
(caution to avoid equipment damage) WARNING: BEFORE INSTALLING OR REMOVING THE DUST FILTER , CHECK THAT THE PROTECTIVE ADHESIVE FILM HAS BEEN REMOVED.
SAFETY RULES DANGER: Possibility of personal injury. Personal injury can be caused by rotating fans. •
Replace the “Dust filter” from the FANS Shelf as follow : – unscrew the screws that ensure the dust filter to the fans shelf – extract the Dust filter – insert the new Dust filter – ensure the “Dust filter” to the “FAN shelf“ using the relevant screw
Note: It is suggested to replace the filter every 3 months; this period is indicative and must be verified according to the environmental conditions. 6.5.2 Routine maintenance every year It is suggested to carry out the following operations yearly: •
power cables check
6.5.2.1 Power cables check
SAFETY RULES DANGER: Possibility of personal injury. Personal injury can be caused by –48 V dc. DANGER: Possibility of personal injury. Short circuiting, low-voltage, low-impedance, dc circuits can cause severe arcing that can result in burns and/or eye damage. Remove rings, watches, and other metal jewelry before working with primary circuits. Exercise caution to avoid shorting power input terminals.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
Make these operations:
ED
•
Check that the power cable is perfectly safety grounded.
•
Make sure that the subrack has been tightly fastened to the rack with screws, to guarantee grounding (the rack is connected to the station ground).
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
624 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Dust Filter SUBSTITUTION
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
6.5.3 Routine Maintenance every five year It is suggested the replacement of each FANS UNIT equipped in the Fans Subrack after five years of working. For the substitution refer to the sequences shown in paragraph 6.6.1 on page 625 (Fan unit for fan shelf 19”substitution).
6.6 Corrective Maintenance (Trouble/Shooting) Since the Troubleshooting procedure is carried out with the use of the Craft Terminal , please refer ,for details, to the Maintenance Section of the Operator’s Handbook. FIXING THE UNITS (AND MODULES) INTO THE SUBRACK (caution to avoid equipment damage) The screw tightening torque for fixing the units (and modules, if any and if fixed by screws) into the subrack must be:
2.8 kg x cm (0.28 Newton x m) " 10 % Exceeding this value may result in screw breaking.
6.6.1 Fan unit for fan shelf 19”substitution
SAFETY RULES DANGER: Possibility of personal injury. Personal injury can be caused by –48 V dc. DANGER: Possibility of personal injury. Short circuiting, low-voltage, low-impedance, dc circuits can cause severe arcing that can result in burns and/or eye damage. Remove rings, watches, and other metal jewelry before working with primary circuits. Exercise caution to avoid shorting power input terminals. When an ALM_URG alarm is displayed on C.T or O.S. ( associated to an Housekeeping alarm) it means that at least one fan is broken, so it is necessary to replace the “FAN unit” involved. These alarm indications are also displayed on the Fans Subrack front panel.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
To substitute the faulty “ Fan unit “ (red led ON) follows the instruction below : –
unscrew the screws that ensure the Fan unit to the fans shelf
–
extract the Fan unit from the Fan shelf
–
insert the new Fan unit into the Fan shelf
–
ensure the Fan unit to the “FAN shelf“ using the relevant screw
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
625 / 636
6.7.1 Suggested Spare Parts The overall number of spares depends on Customer requirements, and should be based on the average amount of transmission circuits available to be accounted for not only during MTBF but also during MTTR; the latter depending on the amount of spare parts available. The set of spare parts is inclusive of a minimum number of spares for each type of replaceable plug–in unit (see unit list in Chapter 2 on page 85). 6.7.2 General rules on spare parts management Before storing the spare units make sure that they are working by inserting them in an operating equipment It is suggested to periodically check those spare units have not been utilized for over a year. If the spare parts and the equipment are stored in the same environment, make sure that the spare parts are placed in cabinets to safeguard them from dust and damp. Moreover, they should also be well grounded to avoid electrostatic discharges. If the spare parts are stored in another room, or have to be moved from another place, building or site, make sure that the following is observed: –
the spare parts must be wrapped in anti–static and padded envelopes;
–
the spare parts must not touch wet surfaces or chemical agents that might damage them , gas);
–
if during transport the temperature is lower than that of the room where they had been kept, make sure that before using them they pass a certain period in a climatic chamber to prevent thermal shocks and/or the possibility of steaming up.
(e.g.
When replacing a unit/sub–unit, make sure that the spare unit/sub–unit is set exactly as the replaced one. For the presettings procedures see section HARDWARE SETTING DOCUMENTATION.
6.7.3 Particular rules on spare parts management Whenever some units with flash-memories are common to different kinds of equipment or to different versions of the same type of equipment, it is possible to maintain one spare part only: this allows spare part stock saving, even though software downloading will be necessary when the software loaded into the unit (program part or data part) is different from that necessary in the equipment where the spare unit must be used. At the end of the commissioning phase or after an equipment data change, it is suggested to save the equipment data, e.g. on floppy disk, and store this floppy disk in the spare part stock pointing out the equipment it refers to.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
6.8 Repair Form To facilitate operation, data on the faulty unit must be reported on the form shown in Figure 283. on page 627. The repair form must be filled–in with as much data as possible and returned to ALCATEL together with the faulty unit.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
626 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
6.7 Set of spare parts
ALCATE L
REPAIR FORM CUSTOMER NAME
ORDER NUMBER/CONTRACT NUMBER
SITE
BRANCH/UNIT/COUNTRY
SYSTEM/EQUIPMENT
PRODUCT RELEASE
STATION/RACK
TO BE FILLED IN BY THE SENDER
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Fill in this form and affix it to the faulty unit to be returned to Alcatel
EQUIPMENT SOFTWARE PART NUMBER
SUBRACK
SLOT
MNEMONIC
ALCATEL PART NUMBER
SERIAL NUMBER
FAULTY UNIT SOFTWARE VERSION
FAULT PHASE
REASON FOR REPAIR
PRESUMED CAUSE
INSTALLATION / TURN ON
CLEAR FAULT
DROP IN PERFORMANCE
OPERATION
INTERMITTENT FAULT
UPGRADE/QUALITY ALERT
INTERNAL
LIGHTNING
EXTERNAL
MAINTENANCE
AIR COND.
TEMPERATURE FAULT
OTHER
DATE
NAME OF SENDER
FAULT STILL PRESENT AFTER REPAIR
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
TO BE FILLED IN BY THE REPAIR OPERATOR
COMMENTS
FAULTS DETECTED
PROCESSING UPGRADE
NO FAULTS FOUND
SOLDERING / WIRING
A STANDARD REPAIRING
I NOT REPAIRABLE (REJECTED)
F–L
MECHANICAL M
B–D
ADJUSTMENT
COMPONENT C PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD V1
P DIRT
V1
V2
SUBSTITUTED QUALITY ALERT
CORROSION I
OTHER
S–X
V3
NOTE : LETTERS ARE FOR FACTORY USE
COMMENTS
DATE
REPAIRING NUMBER
REPAIRING CENTRE
NAME OF REPAIR OPERATOR
Figure 283. Repair form
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
627 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
628 / 636 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
HARDWARE SETTING DOCUMENTATION
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
629 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
630 / 636 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
UNITS DOCUMENTATION LIST This section contains the documents sheets to refer to for unit/sub–unit hardware setting options. The list of the enclosed documents is given in Table 75. on page 634, according to the ANV part number. TABLE EXPLANATION: –
UNIT IDENTIFICATION P/Ns AND CHANGE STATUS Each unit or sub-unit is distinguished by: •
a dual Part No.: –
Factory P/N (4xx.xxx.xxx x)
–
ANV P/N (xxx.xxxxx xx) (NOTE)
NOTE
•
The last two ANV-P/N letters (in the following stated as ’suffix’) stand for a ”feasible alternative”, they might differentiate two units eventhough still functionally compatible. For this reason the indicated ANV P/N does not include the last two letters. For example : the units having P/Ns ”3AL–34065–AAAA” and ”3AL–34065–AABA” are functionally compatible and, as regards to hardware settings, the MSxxx document (described hereafter) 3AL–34065–AAAA-MSxxx is applicable for both.
and by a pair of design & production series (change status): –
CS, associated to the Factory P/N (4xx.xxx.xxx x)
–
ICS, associated to ANV P/N (xxx.xxxxx xx)
The following table shows an example of correspondence between ”FACTORY P/N + CS” and ”ANV P/N + ICS” Table 74. Example of correspondence between CS and ’suffix + ICS’ N.B.
The P/Ns used in this example have no correspondence with those of the actual equipment part list! FACTORY CODE
ANV CODE
P/N
CS
P/N
ICS
487.156.612
01
3AL 34422 AA AA
01
487.156.612
02
3AL 34422 AA AB
01
487.156.612
03
3AL 34422 AA AC
01
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
In this example you can see that the production series is identified only by the CS as far as the Factory code is concerned, and by the ’suffix + ICS’ if the ANV code is referred to. Some of the possible positions of the label indicating the unit’s P/Ns and CS–ICS are illustrated in para. 4.4 on page 42.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
631 / 636
CROSS–REFERENCE •
Id.
Unit alphabetical notation. It indicates the unit containing one or more subunits.
•
App.
It reports the unit notation (Id) to which the sub–unit belongs.
The HARDWARE SETTINGS can be executed after having checked all the sub–units belonging to a unit, by considering the above cited cross–reference, and by using the presetting documents indicated in Table 75. page 634 and presented in the following point. –
ENCLOSED DOCUMENTS For each type of unit or sub-unit having customizing setting options, the document ”ANV P/N”–MSxxx is annexed to this handbook (in the case of Documentation on CD-ROM the MSxxx documents may be given in a CD-ROM different from that containing this Technical Handbook). The MSxxx documents are enclosed in numerical order. The Edition of the enclosed MSxxx document is the highest available on the date on which the Technical Handbook is assembled. Use of the document MSxxx: •
MSxxx means ”document for hardware presetting options” (the MSxxx document’s Part No. is as that of the unit or sub-unit and its MS acronym defines type). The xxx part of MSxxx is relevant to ANV internal identification codes.
•
As the Customer may have to manage many units of the same type (same P/N) but with different CS–ICS, the document MSxxx describes with possible different chapters the different setting options, according to all the possible CSs–ICSs. For this purpose, a table at the beginning of document (PREFACE) indicates the chapter to be used according to the CS or the corresponding ’suffix + ICS’, taking into account that: –
–
–
a change of the production series does not necessarily imply a change in the setting options; a change of the ANV P/N suffix does not imply a new MSxxx document; the CS, SUFFIX and ICS must be meant as: • from specified CS, SUFFIX or ICS (included) • to next CS, SUFFIX or ICS (excluded) if listed the sequence of CSs is increasing from alphanumeric to numeric (e.g. CS=A0 is lower than CS=01).
Each chapter contains: – –
one or more tables defining the relationship between the functions achievable and the setting options to make; the unit layout drawing which shows the exact location of all the setting options. N.B.
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
N.B.
IDENTIFIES PIN 1 OF COMPONENT When necessary to make ”TC” Hardware Settings fitted on the rear side of the board, remove the protective cover plate present on the same rear side and replace it at the end of the operation
The setting options described in the documents MSxxx must be used according to 3AL377470001 (962.000.022 F) MSxxx document, inserted in Table 75. on page 634, which shows the ’ON’ (closed) position of microswitches. Those setting options that on the table are indicated by the caption For factory use only should never be modified.
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
632 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
–
EXAMPLE The P/Ns used in this example have no correspondence with those of the actual equipment part list!
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
N.B.
Taking into account the same unit of Table 74. on page 631: FACTORY CODE
ANV CODE
P/N
CS
P/N
ICS
487.156.612
01
3AL 34422 AAAA
01
487.156.612
02
3AL 34422 AAAB
01
487.156.612
03
3AL 34422 AAAC
01
and supposing that the setting options valid for CS=01 are equal to those for CS=02, but change for CS=03, the table at the beginning of the document 3AL 34422 AAAA MSZZQ will be:
CHAPTER CAPITOLO
FACTORY P/N CODICE DI FABBRICA
ANV P/N CODICE ANV
FROM CS DA CS
FROM SUFFIX DA SUFFISSO
FROM ICS DA ICS
1
01
––AA
01
2
03
––AC
01
If you have the unit identified by one of this identification data: FACTORY CODE
ANV CODE
P/N
CS
P/N
ICS
487.156.612
01
3AL 34422 AAAA
01
487.156.612
02
3AL 34422 AAAB
01
you will use Chapter 1 of document 3AL 34422 AAAA MSZZQ
If you have the unit identified by one of this identification data:
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
FACTORY CODE
ANV CODE
P/N
CS
P/N
ICS
487.156.612
03
3AL 34422 AAAC
01
487.156.612
04
3AL 34422 AAAD
01
you will use Chapter 2 of document 3AL 34422 AAAA MSZZQ
ED
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
633 / 636
The edition of the documents (listed in this table) that are physically enclosed in the handbook is the highest available when this handbook is assembled. The edition of enclosed documents is not specified in this table.
NAME
Id
3AL 78830 AD––
Document for hardware presetting 3AL 78830 AAAG MSZZQ
Control and general XT
b
Equipment Controller
3AL 78836 AA–– (411.100.708V )
–
c
ATM MATRIX 4x4
3AL 79093 AA–– (411.101.035 J)
–
d
ATM MATRIX D3
3AL89917 AA–– ––.––.––
–
e
ATM MATRIX 4x4 ENHANCED
3AL 81185 AA–– (411.102.475 Z)
–
f
ATM MATRIX 8x8
3AL79094 AA–– (411.101.036 K)
–
g
PR_EA MATRIX 4XETH
3AL 79631 AA–– (411.101.281 W)
–
h
PR_EA MATRIX 1XGB–ETH
3AL 81275 AA–– (411.102.505 Y)
–
i
ISA–ES1 8FE BOARD
3AL 98128 AA––
–
j
ISA–ES1 8FX BOARD (SFP)
3AL98150AA––
–
k
ISA–ES4 8FE + 1GE BOARD
3AL 81879AA––
–
l
ISA–ES16 BOARD
3AL 81915 AA––
–
Microswitches ”ON” position
3AL 37747 0001 (962.000.022 F)
3AL 37747 0001 MSZZQ
f
3AL 79202 AA–– (487.156.804 W)
3AL 79202 AAAA MSZZQ
g, h
3AL 79425 AA–– (483.100.252 )
3AL 79425 AAAA MSZZQ
Equipment Controller
b
3AL 79747 AAAA (487.156.090 Z)
3AL 79747 AAAA MSZZQ
ATM MATRIX 4x4
c
3AL 80481 AA–– (487.156.138 Z)
3AL 80481 AAAA MSZZQ
ATM MATRIX 4x4 ENHANCED
d, e
3AL 81183 AA–– (487.156.274)
3AL 81183 AAAA MSZZQ
L2 ETHERNET PORT BOARD
k
3AL81878AA––
3AL81878AAAA MSZZQ
NETWORK PROCESSOR 2
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
ANV P/N (Factory P/N)
a
ATM MATRIX 8x8
ED
App
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
634 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Table 75. Hardware presetting documentation
App
ANV P/N (Factory P/N)
Document for hardware presetting
PBA–ISA–PREA V2
l
3AL81916AA––
3AL81916AAAA MSZZQ
PBA–ISA FE V2–155
i
3AL98127AA––
3AL98127AAAA MSZZQ
PBA–ES1–8FX
j
3AL98149AA––
3AL98149AAAA MSZZQ
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
Id
ED
NAME
02 3AL 91668 AA AA 636
635 / 636
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
END OF DOCUMENT
ED
02
3AL 91668 AA AA
636
636 / 636
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
LABELS AND ASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS TARGHETTE E INFORMAZIONI PER IL CENTRO STAMPA
QUESTA PAGINA NON VA INSERITA NEL MANUALE THIS PAGE MUST NOT BE INCLUDED IN THE HANDBOOK COD.MANUALE HDBK P/N:
3AL 91668 AAAA Ed.02
1660SM Rel.4.4 TECHNICAL HANDBOOK ORIGINALE INTERLEAF: FILE ARCHIVIAZIONE: cod ANV (PD1-PD2) – –
No PAGINE TOTALI PER ARCHIVIAZIONE: 638+4=642 DIMENSIONE BINDER SORGENTE (du –ks): 79.836 kBytes
INFORMAZIONI PER IL CENTRO STAMPA - ASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS –
STAMPARE FRONTE/RETRO RECTO-VERSO PRINTING
–
COMPOSIZIONE ED ASSIEMAGGIO DEL MANUALE: HANDBOOK COMPOSITION AND ASSEMBLY: numerate numbered
No pagine (facciate) No pages
da from
a to
2
1/2
2/2
TARGHETTE - LABELS frontespizio front 3AL 91668 AAAA Ed.02
manuale manual
ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ 636
1/636
Vedere lista a pagina: ALLEGATI DI UNITÀ (MSZZQ) See list on page: UNIT PRESETTING DOCUMENTS (MSZZQ) 636 TOTALE PAGINE A4 (FACCIATE) TOTAL A4 PAGES:
638
TOTALE FOGLI A4 TOTAL A4 SHEETS:
319
636/636
No documenti MSZZQ No documents MSZZQ 11
WARNING FOR A-UNITS OTHER THAN A-ITALY
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
•
The documents MSZZQ cited in section ’HARDWARE SETTING DOCUMENTATION’ are stored in eMATRIX. Labels are done according to A-Italy binder format. Source file ALICE 6.10
• •
ED
02
RELEASED 3AL 91668 AAAA TQZZA 4
Y
1/ 4
QUESTA PAGINA NON VA INSERITA NEL MANUALE
Site VIMERCATE
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
THIS PAGE MUST NOT BE INCLUDED IN THE HANDBOOK
FCG
Originators P. GHELFI
1660SM REL.4.4
TECHNICAL HANDBOOK
Domain Division Rubric Type Distribution Codes
: : : :
OND SDH 1660SM 1660SM REL. 4.4 TECHNICAL HANDBOOK Internal : External :
Approvals J. MIR
Name App.
S. MAGGIO
C. FAVERO
Name App.
INFORMAZIONI EDITORIALI –
ORIGINALE SU FILE: ALICE 6.10 • sistemazione ’figlist’
3AL 91668 AAAA Ed.02 3AL 91668 AAAA Ed.02
1660SM Rel.4.4 STM 16 Multiservice Metro Node
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
TECHNICAL HANDBOOK
ED
02
RELEASED 3AL 91668 AAAA TQZZA 4
Y
2/ 4
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.
1660SM Rel.4.4
STM 16 Multiservice Metro Node
TECHNICAL HANDBOOK 3AL 91668 AAAA Ed.02
VOL.1/1
1660SM Rel.4.4 STM 16 Multiservice Metro Node TECHNICAL HANDBOOK 3AL 91668 AAAA Ed.02
VOL.1/1 1660SM Rel.4.4 STM 16 Multiservice Metro Node 3AL 91668 AAAA Ed.02
TECHNICAL HANDBOOK
VOL.1/1
1660SM Rel.4.4 3AL 91668 AAAA Ed.02
STM 16 Multiservice Metro Node TECHNICAL HANDBOOK
VOL.1/1
1660SM Rel.4.4 STM 16 Multiservice Metro Node
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
3AL 91668 AAAA Ed.02
ED
02
TECHNICAL HANDBOOK
VOL.1/1
RELEASED 3AL 91668 AAAA TQZZA 4
Y
3/ 4
1AA 00014 0004 (9007) A4 – ALICE 04.10
END OF DOCUMENT
ED
02
RELEASED
3AL 91668 AAAA TQZZA
4
Y
4/ 4 All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use and communication of its contents not permitted without written authorization from Alcatel.